gdb: SPARC ADI support
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662 place:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668 @end smallexample
1669
1670 @noindent
1671 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680 @cindex completion of structure field names
1681 @cindex structure field name completion
1682 @cindex completion of union field names
1683 @cindex union field name completion
1684 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689 left-hand-side:
1690
1691 @smallexample
1692 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694 to_data to_isatty to_write
1695 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696 to_flush to_read
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 @noindent
1700 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702 follows:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 struct ui_file
1706 @{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718 @}
1719 @end smallexample
1720
1721
1722 @node Help
1723 @section Getting Help
1724 @cindex online documentation
1725 @kindex help
1726
1727 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728 using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730 @table @code
1731 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732 @item help
1733 @itemx h
1734 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 (@value{GDBP}) help
1739 List of classes of commands:
1740
1741 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743 data -- Examining data
1744 files -- Specifying and examining files
1745 internals -- Maintenance commands
1746 obscure -- Obscure features
1747 running -- Running the program
1748 stack -- Examining the stack
1749 status -- Status inquiries
1750 support -- Support facilities
1751 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756 commands in that class.
1757 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758 documentation.
1759 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760 (@value{GDBP})
1761 @end smallexample
1762 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764 @item help @var{class}
1765 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767 help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1771 Status inquiries.
1772
1773 List of commands:
1774
1775 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777 info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779 show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783 documentation.
1784 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785 (@value{GDBP})
1786 @end smallexample
1787
1788 @item help @var{command}
1789 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792 @kindex apropos
1793 @item apropos @var{args}
1794 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798 @smallexample
1799 apropos alias
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent
1803 results in:
1804
1805 @smallexample
1806 @c @group
1807 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 @c @end group
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @kindex complete
1816 @item complete @var{args}
1817 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819 command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 complete i
1823 @end smallexample
1824
1825 @noindent results in:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 @group
1829 if
1830 ignore
1831 info
1832 inspect
1833 @end group
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837 @end table
1838
1839 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845 Index}.
1846
1847 @c @group
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex info
1850 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851 @item info
1852 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857 @w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859 @kindex set
1860 @item set
1861 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863 @code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865 @kindex show
1866 @item show
1867 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868 @value{GDBN} itself.
1869 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874 @kindex info set
1875 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881 @end table
1882 @c @end group
1883
1884 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @kindex show version
1889 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890 @item show version
1891 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899 @value{GDBN}.
1900
1901 @kindex show copying
1902 @kindex info copying
1903 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904 @item show copying
1905 @itemx info copying
1906 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908 @kindex show warranty
1909 @kindex info warranty
1910 @item show warranty
1911 @itemx info warranty
1912 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915 @kindex show configuration
1916 @item show configuration
1917 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922 your report.
1923
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Running
1927 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930 debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935 kill a child process.
1936
1937 @menu
1938 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939 * Starting:: Starting your program
1940 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1951 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952 @end menu
1953
1954 @node Compilation
1955 @section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961 and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964 the compiler.
1965
1966 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970 executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996 format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998 @need 2000
1999 @node Starting
2000 @section Starting your Program
2001 @cindex starting
2002 @cindex running
2003
2004 @table @code
2005 @kindex run
2006 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007 @item run
2008 @itemx r
2009 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015 @end table
2016
2017 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022 message like this one:
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026 Try "help target" or "continue".
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031 first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038 divided into four categories:
2039
2040 @table @asis
2041 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2042 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046 the arguments.
2047 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051 below for details).
2052
2053 @item The @emph{environment.}
2054 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2060 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2061 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2062 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2063
2064 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2065 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2066 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2067 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2068 set a different device for your program.
2069 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2070
2071 @cindex pipes
2072 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2073 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2074 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2075 wrong program.
2076 @end table
2077
2078 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2079 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2080 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2081 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2082 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2083
2084 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2085 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2086 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2087 your current breakpoints.
2088
2089 @table @code
2090 @kindex start
2091 @item start
2092 @cindex run to main procedure
2093 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2094 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2095 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2096 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2097 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2098 procedure, depending on the language used.
2099
2100 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2101 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2102 the @samp{run} command.
2103
2104 @cindex elaboration phase
2105 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2106 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2107 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2108 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2109 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2110 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2111 will remain to halt execution.
2112
2113 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2114 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2115 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2116 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2117 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2118
2119 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2120 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2121 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2122 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2123 elaboration code before running your program.
2124
2125 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2126 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2127 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2128 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2129 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2130 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2131 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2132 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2133 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2134 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2135 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2136 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2137
2138 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2139 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2140 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2141 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2142
2143 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2144 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2145 environment:
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2149 (@value{GDBP}) run
2150 @end smallexample
2151
2152 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2153 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2154
2155 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2156 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2157 @item set startup-with-shell
2158 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2159 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2160 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2161 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2162 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2163 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2164 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2165 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2166 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2167 startup failures such as:
2168
2169 @smallexample
2170 (@value{GDBP}) run
2171 Starting program: ./a.out
2172 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2173 @end smallexample
2174
2175 @noindent
2176 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2177 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2178 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2179 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2180 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2181 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2182
2183 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2184 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2185 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2186 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2187 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2188 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2189
2190 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2191 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2192 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2193 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2194 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2195 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2196
2197 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2198 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2199 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2200
2201 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2202 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 (@value{GDBP}) run
2206 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2207 @end smallexample
2208
2209 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2210 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2211
2212 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2213 @code{target native} command. For example,
2214
2215 @smallexample
2216 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2217 (@value{GDBP}) run
2218 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2219 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2220 (@value{GDBP}) run
2221 Starting program: ./a.out
2222 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2223 @end smallexample
2224
2225 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2226 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2227 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2228 disconnect.
2229
2230 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2231 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2232 proc}, @code{info os}.
2233
2234 @kindex set disable-randomization
2235 @item set disable-randomization
2236 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2237 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2238 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2239 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2240 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2241
2242 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2243 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2247 @end smallexample
2248
2249 @item set disable-randomization off
2250 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2251 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2252 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2253 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2254 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2255 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2256
2257 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2258 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2259 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2260 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2261 a code at its expected addresses.
2262
2263 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2264 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2265 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2266 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2267 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2268 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2269 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2270 a randomly chosen address.
2271
2272 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2273 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2274 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2275 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2276 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2277
2278 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2279 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2280
2281 @item show disable-randomization
2282 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2283 the virtual address space of the started program.
2284
2285 @end table
2286
2287 @node Arguments
2288 @section Your Program's Arguments
2289
2290 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2291 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2292 @code{run} command.
2293 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2294 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2295 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2296 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2297 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2298
2299 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2300 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2301 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2302 the program, not by the shell.
2303
2304 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2305 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2306
2307 @table @code
2308 @kindex set args
2309 @item set args
2310 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2311 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2312 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2313 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2314 it again without arguments.
2315
2316 @kindex show args
2317 @item show args
2318 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2319 @end table
2320
2321 @node Environment
2322 @section Your Program's Environment
2323
2324 @cindex environment (of your program)
2325 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2326 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2327 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2328 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2329 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2330 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2331 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2332
2333 @table @code
2334 @kindex path
2335 @item path @var{directory}
2336 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2337 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2338 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2339 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2340 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2341 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2342 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2343
2344 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2345 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2346 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2347 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2348 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2349 @var{directory} to the search path.
2350 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2351 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2352
2353 @kindex show paths
2354 @item show paths
2355 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2356 environment variable).
2357
2358 @kindex show environment
2359 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2360 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2361 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2362 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2363 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2364
2365 @kindex set environment
2366 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2367 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2368 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2369 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2370 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2371 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2372 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2373 null value.
2374 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2375 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2376
2377 For example, this command:
2378
2379 @smallexample
2380 set env USER = foo
2381 @end smallexample
2382
2383 @noindent
2384 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2385 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2386 are not actually required.)
2387
2388 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2389 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2390 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2391 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2392 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2393
2394 @kindex unset environment
2395 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2396 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2397 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2398 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2399 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2400 @end table
2401
2402 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2403 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2404 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2405 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2406 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2407 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2408 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2409 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2410 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2411 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2412
2413 @node Working Directory
2414 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2415
2416 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2417 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2418 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2419 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2420 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2421 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2422
2423 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2424 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2425 Specify Files}.
2426
2427 @table @code
2428 @kindex cd
2429 @cindex change working directory
2430 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2431 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2432 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2433
2434 @kindex pwd
2435 @item pwd
2436 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2437 @end table
2438
2439 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2440 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2441 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2442 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2443 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2444 current working directory of the debuggee.
2445
2446 @node Input/Output
2447 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2448
2449 @cindex redirection
2450 @cindex i/o
2451 @cindex terminal
2452 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2453 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2454 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2455 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2456 running your program.
2457
2458 @table @code
2459 @kindex info terminal
2460 @item info terminal
2461 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2462 program is using.
2463 @end table
2464
2465 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2466 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2467
2468 @smallexample
2469 run > outfile
2470 @end smallexample
2471
2472 @noindent
2473 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2474
2475 @kindex tty
2476 @cindex controlling terminal
2477 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2478 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2479 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2480 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2481 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2482
2483 @smallexample
2484 tty /dev/ttyb
2485 @end smallexample
2486
2487 @noindent
2488 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2489 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2490 that as their controlling terminal.
2491
2492 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2493 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2494 terminal.
2495
2496 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2497 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2498 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2499 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2500
2501 @cindex inferior tty
2502 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2503 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2504 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2505 program.
2506
2507 @table @code
2508 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2509 @kindex set inferior-tty
2510 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2511 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2512 @value{GDBN}.
2513
2514 @item show inferior-tty
2515 @kindex show inferior-tty
2516 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2517 @end table
2518
2519 @node Attach
2520 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2521 @kindex attach
2522 @cindex attach
2523
2524 @table @code
2525 @item attach @var{process-id}
2526 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2527 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2528 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2529 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2530 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2531
2532 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2533 executing the command.
2534 @end table
2535
2536 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2537 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2538 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2539 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2540
2541 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2542 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2543 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2544 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2545 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2546 Specify Files}.
2547
2548 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2549 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2550 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2551 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2552 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2553 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2554 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2555
2556 @table @code
2557 @kindex detach
2558 @item detach
2559 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2560 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2561 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2562 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2563 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2564 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2565 executing the command.
2566 @end table
2567
2568 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2569 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2570 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2571 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2572 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2573 Messages}).
2574
2575 @node Kill Process
2576 @section Killing the Child Process
2577
2578 @table @code
2579 @kindex kill
2580 @item kill
2581 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2582 @end table
2583
2584 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2585 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2586 is running.
2587
2588 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2589 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2590 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2591 outside the debugger.
2592
2593 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2594 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2595 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2596 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2597 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2598 breakpoint settings).
2599
2600 @node Inferiors and Programs
2601 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2602
2603 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2604 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2605 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2606 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2607 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2608 from multiple executables.
2609
2610 @cindex inferior
2611 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2612 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2613 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2614 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2615 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2616 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2617 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2618 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2619 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2620 threads running in it.
2621
2622 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2623 inferiors}}:
2624
2625 @table @code
2626 @kindex info inferiors
2627 @item info inferiors
2628 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2629
2630 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2631
2632 @enumerate
2633 @item
2634 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2635
2636 @item
2637 the target system's inferior identifier
2638
2639 @item
2640 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2641
2642 @end enumerate
2643
2644 @noindent
2645 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2646 indicates the current inferior.
2647
2648 For example,
2649 @end table
2650 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2651
2652 @smallexample
2653 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2654 Num Description Executable
2655 2 process 2307 hello
2656 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2657 @end smallexample
2658
2659 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2660
2661 @table @code
2662 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2663 @item inferior @var{infno}
2664 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2665 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2666 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2670 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2671 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2672 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2673 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2674 information on convenience variables.
2675
2676 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2677 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2678 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2679 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2680 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2681 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2682
2683 @table @code
2684 @kindex add-inferior
2685 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2687 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2688 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2689 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2690 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2691
2692 @kindex clone-inferior
2693 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2694 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2695 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2696 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2697 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2698
2699 @smallexample
2700 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2701 Num Description Executable
2702 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2703 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2704 Added inferior 2.
2705 1 inferiors added.
2706 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2707 Num Description Executable
2708 2 <null> helloworld
2709 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2710 @end smallexample
2711
2712 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2713
2714 @kindex remove-inferiors
2715 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2717 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2718 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2719
2720 @end table
2721
2722 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2723 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2724 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2725 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2726
2727 @table @code
2728 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2730 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2731 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2732 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2733 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2734
2735 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2736 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2737 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2738 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2739 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2740 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2741 @end table
2742
2743 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2744 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2745 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2746 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2747
2748
2749 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2750 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2751
2752 @table @code
2753 @kindex set print inferior-events
2754 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2755 @item set print inferior-events
2756 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2757 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2758 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2759 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2760 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2761 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2762
2763 @kindex show print inferior-events
2764 @item show print inferior-events
2765 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2766 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2767 @end table
2768
2769 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2770 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2771 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2772
2773
2774 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2775 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2776 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2777 info program-spaces}} command.
2778
2779 @table @code
2780 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2781 @item maint info program-spaces
2782 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2783 @value{GDBN}.
2784
2785 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2786
2787 @enumerate
2788 @item
2789 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2790
2791 @item
2792 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2793 the @code{file} command.
2794
2795 @end enumerate
2796
2797 @noindent
2798 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2799 indicates the current program space.
2800
2801 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2802 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2803 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 hello
2809 2 goodbye
2810 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2811 @end smallexample
2812
2813 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2814 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2815 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2816 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2817 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2818
2819 @smallexample
2820 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2821 Id Executable
2822 * 1 vfork-test
2823 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2824 @end smallexample
2825
2826 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2827 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2828 @end table
2829
2830 @node Threads
2831 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2832
2833 @cindex threads of execution
2834 @cindex multiple threads
2835 @cindex switching threads
2836 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2837 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2838 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2839 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2840 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2841 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2842 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2843
2844 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2845 programs:
2846
2847 @itemize @bullet
2848 @item automatic notification of new threads
2849 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2850 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2851 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2852 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2853 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2854 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2855 messages on thread start and exit.
2856 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2857 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2858 isn't compatible with the program.
2859 @end itemize
2860
2861 @cindex focus of debugging
2862 @cindex current thread
2863 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2864 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2865 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2866 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2867 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2868
2869 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2870 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2871 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2872 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2873 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2874 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2875 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2876 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2877 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2878 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2879
2880 @smallexample
2881 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2882 @end smallexample
2883
2884 @noindent
2885 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2886 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2887 further qualifier.
2888
2889 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2890 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2891 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2892 @c program?
2893 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2894 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2895 @c threads ab initio?
2896
2897 @anchor{thread numbers}
2898 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2899 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2900 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2901 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2902 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2903 between threads of different inferiors.
2904
2905 @cindex qualified thread ID
2906 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2907 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2908 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2909 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2910 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2911 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2912 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2913 inferior.
2914
2915 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2916 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2917 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2918 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2919
2920 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2921 @cindex thread ID lists
2922 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2923 argument. A list element can be:
2924
2925 @enumerate
2926 @item
2927 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2928 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2929 @samp{1}.
2930
2931 @item
2932 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2933 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2934 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2935
2936 @item
2937 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2938 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2939 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2940 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2941 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2942
2943 @end enumerate
2944
2945 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2946 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2947 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2948 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2949 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2950 7.1}.
2951
2952
2953 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2954 @cindex global thread number
2955 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2956 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2957 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2958 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2959 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2960 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2961
2962 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2963 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2964 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2965
2966 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2967 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2968 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2969 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2970 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2971 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2972 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2973 general information on convenience variables.
2974
2975 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2976 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2977 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2978
2979 @smallexample
2980 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2981 @end smallexample
2982
2983 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2984
2985 @smallexample
2986 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2987 @end smallexample
2988
2989 @table @code
2990 @kindex info threads
2991 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2992
2993 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2994 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2995 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2996 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2997
2998 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2999
3000 @enumerate
3001 @item
3002 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3003
3004 @item
3005 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3006 option was specified
3007
3008 @item
3009 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3010
3011 @item
3012 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3013 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3014 program itself.
3015
3016 @item
3017 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3018 @end enumerate
3019
3020 @noindent
3021 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3022 indicates the current thread.
3023
3024 For example,
3025 @end table
3026 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3027
3028 @smallexample
3029 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3030 Id Target Id Frame
3031 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3032 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3033 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3034 at threadtest.c:68
3035 @end smallexample
3036
3037 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3038 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3039 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3040
3041 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3042 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3043
3044 @smallexample
3045 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3046 Id GId Target Id Frame
3047 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3048 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3049 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3050 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3051 @end smallexample
3052
3053 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3054 Solaris-specific command:
3055
3056 @table @code
3057 @item maint info sol-threads
3058 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3059 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3060 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3061 @end table
3062
3063 @table @code
3064 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3065 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3066 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3067 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3068 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3069 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3070
3071 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3072 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3073
3074 @smallexample
3075 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3076 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3077 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3078 8 printf ("hello\n");
3079 @end smallexample
3080
3081 @noindent
3082 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3083 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3084 threads.
3085
3086 @kindex thread apply
3087 @cindex apply command to several threads
3088 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3089 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3090 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3091 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3092 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3093 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3094 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3095 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3096
3097
3098 @kindex thread name
3099 @cindex name a thread
3100 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3101 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3102 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3103 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3104
3105 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3106 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3107 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3108 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3109 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3110
3111 @kindex thread find
3112 @cindex search for a thread
3113 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3114 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3115 matches the supplied regular expression.
3116
3117 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3118 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3119 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3120 is the LWP id.
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3124 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3125 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3126 Id Target Id Frame
3127 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3128 @end smallexample
3129
3130 @kindex set print thread-events
3131 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3132 @item set print thread-events
3133 @itemx set print thread-events on
3134 @itemx set print thread-events off
3135 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3136 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3137 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3138 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3139 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3140
3141 @kindex show print thread-events
3142 @item show print thread-events
3143 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3144 have started and exited.
3145 @end table
3146
3147 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3148 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3149 programs with multiple threads.
3150
3151 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3152 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3153
3154 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3155 @table @code
3156 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3157 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3158 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3159 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3160 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3161 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3162 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3163 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3164 macro.
3165
3166 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3167 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3168 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3169 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3170 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3171 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3172
3173 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3174 refers to the default system directories that are
3175 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3176 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3177 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3178
3179 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3180 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3181 was loaded in the inferior process.
3182
3183 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3184 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3185 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3186 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3187 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3188 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3189 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3190
3191 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3192 only on some platforms.
3193
3194 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3195 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3196 Display current libthread_db search path.
3197
3198 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3199 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3200 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3201 @item set debug libthread-db
3202 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3203 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3204 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3205 @end table
3206
3207 @node Forks
3208 @section Debugging Forks
3209
3210 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3211 @cindex multiple processes
3212 @cindex processes, multiple
3213 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3214 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3215 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3216 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3217 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3218 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3219 will cause it to terminate.
3220
3221 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3222 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3223 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3224 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3225 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3226 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3227 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3228 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3229 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3230 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3231
3232 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3233 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3234 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3235 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3236
3237 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3238 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3239 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3240
3241 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3242 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3243
3244 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3245 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3246
3247 @table @code
3248 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3249 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3250 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3251 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3252 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3253
3254 @table @code
3255 @item parent
3256 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3257 unimpeded. This is the default.
3258
3259 @item child
3260 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3261 unimpeded.
3262
3263 @end table
3264
3265 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3266 @item show follow-fork-mode
3267 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3268 @end table
3269
3270 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3271 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3272 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3273
3274 @table @code
3275 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3276 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3277 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3278 retain debugger control over them both.
3279
3280 @table @code
3281 @item on
3282 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3283 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3284 independently. This is the default.
3285
3286 @item off
3287 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3288 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3289 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3290 is held suspended.
3291
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3295 @item show detach-on-fork
3296 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3297 @end table
3298
3299 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3300 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3301 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3302 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3303 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3304 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3305
3306 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3307 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3308 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3309 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3310 and Programs}.
3311
3312 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3313 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3314 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3315 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3316 the child process's @code{main}.
3317
3318 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3319 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3320
3321 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3322 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3323 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3324 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3325 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3326 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3327 command.
3328
3329 @table @code
3330 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3331 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3332
3333 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3334 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3335
3336 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3337
3338 @table @code
3339 @item new
3340 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3341 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3342 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3343 original inferior.
3344
3345 For example:
3346
3347 @smallexample
3348 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3349 (gdb) info inferior
3350 Id Description Executable
3351 * 1 <null> prog1
3352 (@value{GDBP}) run
3353 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3354 Program exited normally.
3355 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3356 Id Description Executable
3357 1 <null> prog1
3358 * 2 <null> prog2
3359 @end smallexample
3360
3361 @item same
3362 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3363 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3364 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3365 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3366 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3367
3368 For example:
3369
3370 @smallexample
3371 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3372 Id Description Executable
3373 * 1 <null> prog1
3374 (@value{GDBP}) run
3375 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3376 Program exited normally.
3377 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3378 Id Description Executable
3379 * 1 <null> prog2
3380 @end smallexample
3381
3382 @end table
3383 @end table
3384
3385 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3389 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3390 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3391
3392 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3393 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3394
3395 @cindex checkpoint
3396 @cindex restart
3397 @cindex bookmark
3398 @cindex snapshot of a process
3399 @cindex rewind program state
3400
3401 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3402 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3403 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3404 later.
3405
3406 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3407 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3408 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3409 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3410 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3411
3412 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3413 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3414 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3415 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3416 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3417 start again from there.
3418
3419 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3420 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3421
3422 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3423
3424 @table @code
3425 @kindex checkpoint
3426 @item checkpoint
3427 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3428 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3429 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3430
3431 @kindex info checkpoints
3432 @item info checkpoints
3433 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3434 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3435 listed:
3436
3437 @table @code
3438 @item Checkpoint ID
3439 @item Process ID
3440 @item Code Address
3441 @item Source line, or label
3442 @end table
3443
3444 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3445 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3446 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3447 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3448 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3449 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3450 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3451
3452 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3453 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3454 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3455 the debugger.
3456
3457 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3458 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3459 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3460
3461 @end table
3462
3463 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3464 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3465 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3466 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3467 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3468 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3469 previously read data can be read again.
3470
3471 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3472 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3473 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3474 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3475 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3476 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3477
3478 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3479 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3480 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3481 different execution path this time.
3482
3483 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3484 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3485 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3486 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3487 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3488 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3489 potentially pose a problem.
3490
3491 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3492
3493 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3494 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3495 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3496 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3497 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3498 next.
3499
3500 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3501 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3502 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3503 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3504 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3505
3506 @node Stopping
3507 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3508
3509 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3510 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3511 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3512
3513 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3514 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3515 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3516 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3517 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3518 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3519 explicitly request this information at any time.
3520
3521 @table @code
3522 @kindex info program
3523 @item info program
3524 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3525 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3526 @end table
3527
3528 @menu
3529 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3530 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3531 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3532 Skipping over functions and files
3533 * Signals:: Signals
3534 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3535 @end menu
3536
3537 @node Breakpoints
3538 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3539
3540 @cindex breakpoints
3541 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3542 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3543 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3544 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3545 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3546 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3547 program.
3548
3549 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3550 the executable is run.
3551
3552 @cindex watchpoints
3553 @cindex data breakpoints
3554 @cindex memory tracing
3555 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3556 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3557 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3558 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3559 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3560 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3561 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3562 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3563 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3564 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3565 same commands.
3566
3567 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3568 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3569 Automatic Display}.
3570
3571 @cindex catchpoints
3572 @cindex breakpoint on events
3573 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3574 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3575 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3576 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3577 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3578 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3579 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3580
3581 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3582 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3583 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3584 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3585 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3586 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3587 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3588 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3589 enable it again.
3590
3591 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3592 @cindex breakpoint lists
3593 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3594 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3595 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3596 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3597 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3598 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3599 are operated on.
3600
3601 @menu
3602 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3603 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3604 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3605 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3606 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3607 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3608 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3609 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3610 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3611 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3612 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3613 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3614 @end menu
3615
3616 @node Set Breaks
3617 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3618
3619 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3620 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3621 @c
3622 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3623
3624 @kindex break
3625 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3626 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3627 @cindex latest breakpoint
3628 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3629 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3630 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3631 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3632 convenience variables.
3633
3634 @table @code
3635 @item break @var{location}
3636 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3637 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3638 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3639 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3640 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3641
3642 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3643 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3644 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3645 that situation.
3646
3647 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3648 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3649 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3650
3651 @item break
3652 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3653 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3654 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3655 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3656 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3657 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3658 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3659 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3660 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3661 inside loops.
3662
3663 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3664 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3665 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3666 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3667 existed when your program stopped.
3668
3669 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3670 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3671 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3672 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3673 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3674 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3675 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3676
3677 @kindex tbreak
3678 @item tbreak @var{args}
3679 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3680 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3681 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3682 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3683
3684 @kindex hbreak
3685 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3686 @item hbreak @var{args}
3687 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3688 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3689 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3690 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3691 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3692 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3693 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3694 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3695 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3696 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3697 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3698 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3699 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3700 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3701 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3702 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3703 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3704 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3705
3706 @kindex thbreak
3707 @item thbreak @var{args}
3708 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3709 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3710 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3711 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3712 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3713 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3714 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3715 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3716
3717 @kindex rbreak
3718 @cindex regular expression
3719 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3720 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3721 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3722 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3723 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3724 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3725 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3726 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3727 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3728
3729 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3730 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3731 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3732 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3733 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3734 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3735
3736 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3737 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3738 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3739 classes.
3740
3741 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3742 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3743 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3750 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3751 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3752 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3753 every function in a given file:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3757 @end smallexample
3758
3759 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3760 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3761
3762 @kindex info breakpoints
3763 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3764 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3765 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3766 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3767 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3768 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3769 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3770
3771 @table @emph
3772 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3773 @item Type
3774 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3775 @item Disposition
3776 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3777 @item Enabled or Disabled
3778 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3779 that are not enabled.
3780 @item Address
3781 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3782 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3783 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3784 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3785 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3786 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3787 @item What
3788 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3789 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3790 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3791 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3792 @end table
3793
3794 @noindent
3795 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3796 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3797 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3798 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3799 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3800 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3801
3802 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3803 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3804 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3805 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3806
3807 @noindent
3808 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3809 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3810 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3811 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3812 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3813
3814 @noindent
3815 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3816 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3817 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3818 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3819 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3820 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3821
3822 @noindent
3823 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3824 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3825
3826 @end table
3827
3828 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3829 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3830 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3831 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3832
3833 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3834 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3835 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3836 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3837
3838 @itemize @bullet
3839 @item
3840 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3841
3842 @item
3843 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3844 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3845
3846 @item
3847 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3848 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3849
3850 @item
3851 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3852 several places where that function is inlined.
3853 @end itemize
3854
3855 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3856 the relevant locations.
3857
3858 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3859 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3860 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3861 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3862 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3863 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3864 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3865
3866 For example:
3867
3868 @smallexample
3869 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3870 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3871 stop only if i==1
3872 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3873 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3874 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3875 @end smallexample
3876
3877 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3878 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3879 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3880 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3881 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3882 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3883 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3884 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3885 that belong to that breakpoint.
3886
3887 @cindex pending breakpoints
3888 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3889 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3890 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3891 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3892 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3893 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3894 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3895 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3896 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3897 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3898 is not yet resolved.
3899
3900 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3901 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3902 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3903 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3904 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3905 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3906
3907 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3908 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3909 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3910 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3911
3912 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3913 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3914 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3915
3916 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3917 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3918 address specification to an address:
3919
3920 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3921 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3922 @table @code
3923 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3924 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3925 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3926
3927 @item set breakpoint pending on
3928 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3929 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3930
3931 @item set breakpoint pending off
3932 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3933 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3934 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3935
3936 @item show breakpoint pending
3937 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3938 @end table
3939
3940 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3941 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3942 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3943
3944 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3945 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3946 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3947 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3948 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3949 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3950 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3951 breakpoints.
3952
3953 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
3954
3955 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3956 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3957 @table @code
3958 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3959 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3960 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3961 breakpoint must be used.
3962
3963 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3964 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3965 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3966 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3970 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3971 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3972 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3973 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3974 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3975 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3976 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3977 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3978
3979 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3980 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3981 @table @code
3982 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3983 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3984 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3985 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3986
3987 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3988 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3989 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3990 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3991 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3992 @end table
3993
3994 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3995 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3996 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3997
3998 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3999 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4000
4001 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4002
4003 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4004 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4005 @table @code
4006 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4007 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4008 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4009 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4010 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4011
4012 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4013 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4014 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4015 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4016 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4017 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4018 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4019 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4020 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4021 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4022 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4023 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4024 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4025
4026 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4027 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4028 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4029 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4030 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4031 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4032 @end table
4033
4034
4035 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4036 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4037 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4038 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4039 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4040 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4041 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4042 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4043
4044
4045 @node Set Watchpoints
4046 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4047
4048 @cindex setting watchpoints
4049 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4050 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4051 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4052 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4053 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4054
4055 @itemize @bullet
4056 @item
4057 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4058
4059 @item
4060 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4061 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4062 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4063
4064 @item
4065 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4066 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4067 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4068 @end itemize
4069
4070 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4071 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4072 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4073 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4074 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4075 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4076 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4077 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4078 the expression changes.
4079
4080 @cindex software watchpoints
4081 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4082 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4083 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4084 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4085 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4086 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4087 culprit.)
4088
4089 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4090 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4091 slow down the running of your program.
4092
4093 @table @code
4094 @kindex watch
4095 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4096 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4097 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4098 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4099 to watch the value of a single variable:
4100
4101 @smallexample
4102 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4106 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4107 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4108 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4109 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4110 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4111
4112 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4113 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4114 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4115 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4116 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4117 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4118 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4119 error.
4120
4121 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4122 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4123 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4124 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4125 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4126 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4127 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4128 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4129 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4130 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4131 Examples:
4132
4133 @smallexample
4134 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4135 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4136 @end smallexample
4137
4138 @kindex rwatch
4139 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4140 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4141 by the program.
4142
4143 @kindex awatch
4144 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4145 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4146 or written into by the program.
4147
4148 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4149 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4150 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4151 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4152 @end table
4153
4154 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4155 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4156 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4157 a never-changing value:
4158
4159 @smallexample
4160 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4161 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4162 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4163 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4164 @end smallexample
4165
4166 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4167 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4168 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4169 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4170 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4171 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4172
4173 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4174 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4175 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4176 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4177 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4178 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4179 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4180 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4181
4182 @table @code
4183 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4184 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4185 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4186
4187 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4188 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4189 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4190 @end table
4191
4192 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4193 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4194 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4195
4196 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4197
4198 @smallexample
4199 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4200 @end smallexample
4201
4202 @noindent
4203 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4204
4205 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4206 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4207 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4208 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4209 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4210 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4211 will print a message like this:
4212
4213 @smallexample
4214 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4215 @end smallexample
4216
4217 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4218 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4219 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4220 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4221 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4222 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4223 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4224 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4225
4226 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4227 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4228 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4229 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4230 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4231 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4232
4233 @smallexample
4234 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4235 @end smallexample
4236
4237 @noindent
4238 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4239
4240 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4241 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4242 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4243 expression with separately allocated resources.
4244
4245 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4246 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4247 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4248
4249 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4250 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4251 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4252 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4253 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4254 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4255 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4256 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4257 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4258
4259 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4260 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4261 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4262 watched expression from every thread.
4263
4264 @quotation
4265 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4266 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4267 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4268 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4269 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4270 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4271 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4272 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4273 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4274 @end quotation
4275
4276 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4277
4278 @node Set Catchpoints
4279 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4280 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4281 @cindex exception handlers
4282 @cindex event handling
4283
4284 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4285 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4286 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4287
4288 @table @code
4289 @kindex catch
4290 @item catch @var{event}
4291 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4292
4293 @table @code
4294 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4295 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4296 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4297 @kindex catch throw
4298 @kindex catch rethrow
4299 @kindex catch catch
4300 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4301 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4302
4303 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4304 regular expression will be caught.
4305
4306 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4307 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4308 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4309 exception being thrown.
4310
4311 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4312 @value{GDBN}:
4313
4314 @itemize @bullet
4315 @item
4316 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4317 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4318 supported.
4319
4320 @item
4321 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4322 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4323 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4324 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4325 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4326 built.
4327
4328 @item
4329 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4330 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4331
4332 @item
4333 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4334 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4335 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4336 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4337
4338 @item
4339 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4340 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4341 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4342 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4343 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4344 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4345 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4346 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4347 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4348
4349 @item
4350 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4351
4352 @item
4353 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4354 @end itemize
4355
4356 @item exception
4357 @kindex catch exception
4358 @cindex Ada exception catching
4359 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4360 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4361 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4362 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4363 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4364
4365 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4366 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4367 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4368 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4369 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4370 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4371 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4372 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4373
4374 @item exception unhandled
4375 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4376 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4377
4378 @item assert
4379 @kindex catch assert
4380 A failed Ada assertion.
4381
4382 @item exec
4383 @kindex catch exec
4384 @cindex break on fork/exec
4385 A call to @code{exec}.
4386
4387 @item syscall
4388 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4389 @kindex catch syscall
4390 @cindex break on a system call.
4391 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4392 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4393 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4394 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4395 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4396 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4397 will be caught.
4398
4399 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4400 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4401 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4402 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4403
4404 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4405 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4406 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4407 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4408
4409 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4410 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4411 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4412 available choices.
4413
4414 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4415 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4416 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4417 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4418 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4419 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4420 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4421 behind the OS upgrades).
4422
4423 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4424 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4425 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4426 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4427 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4428 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4429 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4430 syscall groups available on your environment.
4431
4432 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4433 arguments to it:
4434
4435 @smallexample
4436 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4437 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4438 (@value{GDBP}) r
4439 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4440
4441 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4442 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4443 (@value{GDBP}) c
4444 Continuing.
4445
4446 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4447 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4448 (@value{GDBP})
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4452
4453 @smallexample
4454 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4455 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4456 (@value{GDBP}) r
4457 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4458
4459 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4460 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4461 (@value{GDBP}) c
4462 Continuing.
4463
4464 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4465 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4466 (@value{GDBP})
4467 @end smallexample
4468
4469 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4470 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4471 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4472
4473 @smallexample
4474 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4475 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4476 (@value{GDBP}) r
4477 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4478
4479 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4480 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4481 (@value{GDBP}) c
4482 Continuing.
4483
4484 Program exited normally.
4485 (@value{GDBP})
4486 @end smallexample
4487
4488 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4489
4490 @smallexample
4491 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4492 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4493 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4494 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4495 (@value{GDBP}) r
4496 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4497
4498 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4499 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4500
4501 (@value{GDBP}) c
4502 Continuing.
4503 @end smallexample
4504
4505 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4506 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4507 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4508 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4509
4510 @smallexample
4511 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4512 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4513 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4514 (@value{GDBP})
4515 @end smallexample
4516
4517 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4518 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4519 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4520 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4521 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4522 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4523
4524 @smallexample
4525 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4526 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4527 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4528 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4529 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4530 (@value{GDBP})
4531 @end smallexample
4532
4533 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4534
4535 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4536 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4537
4538 @smallexample
4539 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4540 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4541 @end smallexample
4542
4543 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4544
4545 @item fork
4546 @kindex catch fork
4547 A call to @code{fork}.
4548
4549 @item vfork
4550 @kindex catch vfork
4551 A call to @code{vfork}.
4552
4553 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4554 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4555 @kindex catch load
4556 @kindex catch unload
4557 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4558 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4559 matches one of the affected libraries.
4560
4561 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4562 @kindex catch signal
4563 The delivery of a signal.
4564
4565 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4566 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4567 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4568
4569 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4570 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4571 signal names.
4572
4573 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4574 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4575 will be caught.
4576
4577 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4578 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4579 catchpoint.
4580
4581 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4582 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4583 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4584 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4585 commands.
4586
4587 @end table
4588
4589 @item tcatch @var{event}
4590 @kindex tcatch
4591 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4592 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4593
4594 @end table
4595
4596 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4597
4598
4599 @node Delete Breaks
4600 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4601
4602 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4603 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4604 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4605 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4606 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4607 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4608
4609 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4610 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4611 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4612 their breakpoint numbers.
4613
4614 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4615 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4616 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4617
4618 @table @code
4619 @kindex clear
4620 @item clear
4621 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4622 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4623 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4624 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4625
4626 @item clear @var{location}
4627 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4628 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4629 most useful ones are listed below:
4630
4631 @table @code
4632 @item clear @var{function}
4633 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4634 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4635
4636 @item clear @var{linenum}
4637 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4638 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4639 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4640 @end table
4641
4642 @cindex delete breakpoints
4643 @kindex delete
4644 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4645 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4646 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4647 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4648 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4649 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4650 @end table
4651
4652 @node Disabling
4653 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4654
4655 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4656 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4657 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4658 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4659 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4660
4661 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4662 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4663 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4664 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4665 do not know which numbers to use.
4666
4667 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4668 affects all of its locations.
4669
4670 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4671 different states of enablement:
4672
4673 @itemize @bullet
4674 @item
4675 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4676 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4677 @item
4678 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4679 @item
4680 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4681 disabled.
4682 @item
4683 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4684 N times, then becomes disabled.
4685 @item
4686 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4687 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4688 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4689 @end itemize
4690
4691 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4692 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4693
4694 @table @code
4695 @kindex disable
4696 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4697 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4698 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4699 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4700 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4701 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4702 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4703
4704 @kindex enable
4705 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4706 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4707 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4708
4709 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4710 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4711 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4712
4713 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4714 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4715 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4716 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4717 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4718 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4719 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4720
4721 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4722 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4723 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4724 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4725 @end table
4726
4727 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4728 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4729 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4730 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4731 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4732 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4733 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4734 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4735 Stepping}.)
4736
4737 @node Conditions
4738 @subsection Break Conditions
4739 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4740 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4741
4742 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4743 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4744 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4745 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4746 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4747 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4748 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4749 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4750
4751 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4752 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4753 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4754 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4755 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4756
4757 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4758 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4759 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4760 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4761 one.
4762
4763 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4764 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4765 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4766 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4767 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4768 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4769 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4770 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4771 conditions for the
4772 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4773 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4774
4775 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4776 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4777 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4778 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4779 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4780 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4781
4782 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4783 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4784 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4785 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4786 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4787
4788 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4789 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4790 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4791 with the @code{condition} command.
4792
4793 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4794 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4795 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4796 catchpoint.
4797
4798 @table @code
4799 @kindex condition
4800 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4801 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4802 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4803 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4804 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4805 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4806 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4807 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4808 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4809 prints an error message:
4810
4811 @smallexample
4812 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4813 @end smallexample
4814
4815 @noindent
4816 @value{GDBN} does
4817 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4818 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4819 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4820
4821 @item condition @var{bnum}
4822 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4823 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4824 @end table
4825
4826 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4827 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4828 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4829 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4830 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4831 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4832 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4833 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4834 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4835 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4836 your program reaches it.
4837
4838 @table @code
4839 @kindex ignore
4840 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4841 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4842 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4843 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4844 takes no action.
4845
4846 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4847 a count of zero.
4848
4849 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4850 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4851 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4852 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4853
4854 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4855 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4856 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4857
4858 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4859 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4860 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4861 Variables}.
4862 @end table
4863
4864 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4865
4866
4867 @node Break Commands
4868 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4869
4870 @cindex breakpoint commands
4871 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4872 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4873 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4874 enable other breakpoints.
4875
4876 @table @code
4877 @kindex commands
4878 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4879 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4880 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4881 @itemx end
4882 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4883 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4884 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4885
4886 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4887 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4888
4889 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4890 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4891 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4892 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4893 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4894 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4895 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4896 Expressions}).
4897 @end table
4898
4899 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4900 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4901
4902 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4903 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4904 that resumes execution.
4905
4906 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4907 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4908 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4909 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4910 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4911
4912 @kindex silent
4913 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4914 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4915 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4916 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4917 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4918 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4919
4920 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4921 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4922 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4923
4924 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4925 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4926
4927 @smallexample
4928 break foo if x>0
4929 commands
4930 silent
4931 printf "x is %d\n",x
4932 cont
4933 end
4934 @end smallexample
4935
4936 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4937 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4938 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4939 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4940 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4941 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4942 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4943
4944 @smallexample
4945 break 403
4946 commands
4947 silent
4948 set x = y + 4
4949 cont
4950 end
4951 @end smallexample
4952
4953 @node Dynamic Printf
4954 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4955
4956 @cindex dynamic printf
4957 @cindex dprintf
4958 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4959 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4960 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4961 having to recompile it.
4962
4963 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4964 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4965 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4966 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4967 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4968 redirects to files and so forth.
4969
4970 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4971 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4972 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4973 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4974 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4975 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4976 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4977
4978 @table @code
4979 @kindex dprintf
4980 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4981 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4982 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4983 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4984
4985 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4986 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4987 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4988 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4989 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4990 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4991
4992 @table @code
4993 @item gdb
4994 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4995 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4996
4997 @item call
4998 @kindex dprintf-style call
4999 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5000 @code{printf}).
5001
5002 @item agent
5003 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5004 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5005 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5006 support running commands on the target.
5007 @end table
5008
5009 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5010 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5011 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5012 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5013 command.
5014
5015 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5016 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5017 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5018 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5019 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5020 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5021
5022 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5023 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5024 you could do the following:
5025
5026 @example
5027 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5028 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5029 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5030 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5031 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5032 (gdb) info break
5033 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5034 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5035 continue
5036 (gdb)
5037 @end example
5038
5039 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5040 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5041 the variable settings.
5042
5043 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5044 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5045 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5046 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5047 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5048 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5049
5050 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5051 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5052 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5053
5054 @end table
5055
5056 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5057 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5058 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5059 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5060 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5061 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5062
5063 @node Save Breakpoints
5064 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5065
5066 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5067 breakpoints}} command.
5068
5069 @table @code
5070 @kindex save breakpoints
5071 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5072 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5073 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5074 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5075 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5076 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5077 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5078 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5079 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5080 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5081 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5082 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5083 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5084 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5085 that can no longer be recreated.
5086 @end table
5087
5088 @node Static Probe Points
5089 @subsection Static Probe Points
5090
5091 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5092 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5093 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5094 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5095 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5096
5097 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5098 ELF-compatible systems:
5099
5100 @itemize @bullet
5101
5102 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5103 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5104 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5105 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5106 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5107 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5108 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5109 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5110
5111 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5112 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5113 C@t{++} languages.
5114 @end itemize
5115
5116 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5117 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5118 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5119 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5120 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5121 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5122 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5123 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5124 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5125
5126 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5127 probes}, with optional arguments:
5128
5129 @table @code
5130 @kindex info probes
5131 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5132 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5133 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5134 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5135
5136 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5137 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5138 probes from all providers are listed.
5139
5140 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5141 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5142 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5143
5144 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5145 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5146 given, all object files are considered.
5147
5148 @item info probes all
5149 List the available static probes, from all types.
5150 @end table
5151
5152 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5153 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5154 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5155 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5156 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5157
5158 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5159 commands, with optional arguments:
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @kindex enable probes
5163 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5164 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5165 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5166 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5167
5168 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5169 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5170 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5171
5172 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5173 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5174 given, all object files are considered.
5175
5176 @kindex disable probes
5177 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5178 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5179 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5180 @end table
5181
5182 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5183 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5184 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5185 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5186 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5187 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5188 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5189 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5190 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5191 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5192 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5193 at the current probe point.
5194
5195 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5196 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5197 an error message.
5198
5199
5200 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5201 @node Error in Breakpoints
5202 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5203
5204 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5205 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5206
5207 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5208 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5209 @smallexample
5210 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5211 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5212 @end smallexample
5213
5214 @noindent
5215 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5216 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5217 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5218
5219 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5220 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5221
5222 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5223 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5224 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5225
5226 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5227 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5228 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5229 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5230
5231 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5232 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5233 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5234 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5235 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5236 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5237 first in the bundle.
5238
5239 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5240 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5241 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5242 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5243 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5244 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5245 is hit.
5246
5247 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5248 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5249
5250 @smallexample
5251 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5252 @end smallexample
5253
5254 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5255 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5256 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5257 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5258 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5259 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5260 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5261 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5262
5263 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5264 adjusted breakpoints:
5265
5266 @smallexample
5267 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5268 to 0x00010410.
5269 @end smallexample
5270
5271 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5272 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5273 frequently than expected.
5274
5275 @node Continuing and Stepping
5276 @section Continuing and Stepping
5277
5278 @cindex stepping
5279 @cindex continuing
5280 @cindex resuming execution
5281 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5282 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5283 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5284 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5285 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5286 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5287 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5288 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5289 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5290 handlers}).)
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex continue
5294 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5295 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5296 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5297 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5298 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5299 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5300 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5301 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5302 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5303 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5304
5305 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5306 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5307 @code{continue} is ignored.
5308
5309 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5310 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5311 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5312 @code{continue}.
5313 @end table
5314
5315 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5316 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5317 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5318 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5319
5320 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5321 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5322 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5323 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5324 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5325 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5326
5327 @table @code
5328 @kindex step
5329 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5330 @item step
5331 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5332 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5333 abbreviated @code{s}.
5334
5335 @quotation
5336 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5337 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5338 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5339 @c distinction here.
5340 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5341 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5342 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5343 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5344 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5345 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5346 below.
5347 @end quotation
5348
5349 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5350 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5351 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5352 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5353 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5354 called within the line.
5355
5356 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5357 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5358 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5359 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5360 was any debugging information about the routine.
5361
5362 @item step @var{count}
5363 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5364 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5365 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5366
5367 @kindex next
5368 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5369 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5370 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5371 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5372 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5373 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5374 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5375 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5376
5377 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5378
5379
5380 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5381 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5382 @c
5383 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5384 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5385 @c function are executed without stopping.
5386
5387 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5388 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5389 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5390
5391 @kindex set step-mode
5392 @item set step-mode
5393 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5394 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5395 @itemx set step-mode on
5396 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5397 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5398 information rather than stepping over it.
5399
5400 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5401 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5402 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5403
5404 @item set step-mode off
5405 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5406 debug information. This is the default.
5407
5408 @item show step-mode
5409 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5410 source line debug information.
5411
5412 @kindex finish
5413 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5414 @item finish
5415 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5416 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5417 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5418
5419 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5420 ,Returning from a Function}).
5421
5422 @kindex until
5423 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5424 @cindex run until specified location
5425 @item until
5426 @itemx u
5427 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5428 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5429 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5430 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5431 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5432 than the address of the jump.
5433
5434 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5435 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5436 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5437 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5438 through the next iteration.
5439
5440 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5441 stack frame.
5442
5443 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5444 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5445 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5446 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5447 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5448
5449 @smallexample
5450 (@value{GDBP}) f
5451 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5452 206 expand_input();
5453 (@value{GDBP}) until
5454 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5455 @end smallexample
5456
5457 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5458 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5459 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5460 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5461 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5462 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5463 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5464
5465 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5466 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5467 argument.
5468
5469 @item until @var{location}
5470 @itemx u @var{location}
5471 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5472 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5473 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5474 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5475 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5476 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5477 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5478 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5479 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5480 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5481 invocations have returned.
5482
5483 @smallexample
5484 94 int factorial (int value)
5485 95 @{
5486 96 if (value > 1) @{
5487 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5488 98 @}
5489 99 return (value);
5490 100 @}
5491 @end smallexample
5492
5493
5494 @kindex advance @var{location}
5495 @item advance @var{location}
5496 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5497 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5498 @ref{Specify Location}.
5499 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5500 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5501 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5502 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5503
5504
5505 @kindex stepi
5506 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5507 @item stepi
5508 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5509 @itemx si
5510 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5511
5512 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5513 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5514 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5515 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5516
5517 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5518
5519 @need 750
5520 @kindex nexti
5521 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5522 @item nexti
5523 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5524 @itemx ni
5525 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5526 proceed until the function returns.
5527
5528 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5529
5530 @end table
5531
5532 @anchor{range stepping}
5533 @cindex range stepping
5534 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5535 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5536 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5537 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5538 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5539 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5540 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5541 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5542 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5543 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5544 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5545 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5546 if necessary:
5547
5548 @table @code
5549 @kindex set range-stepping
5550 @kindex show range-stepping
5551 @item set range-stepping
5552 @itemx show range-stepping
5553 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5554
5555 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5556 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5557 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5558 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5559 default is @code{on}.
5560
5561 @end table
5562
5563 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5564 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5565 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5566
5567 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5568 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5569 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5570 a particular file when stepping.
5571
5572 For example, consider the following C function:
5573
5574 @smallexample
5575 101 int func()
5576 102 @{
5577 103 foo(boring());
5578 104 bar(boring());
5579 105 @}
5580 @end smallexample
5581
5582 @noindent
5583 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5584 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5585 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5586 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5587
5588 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5589 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5590 is called from many places.
5591
5592 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5593 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5594 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5595 @code{foo}.
5596
5597 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5598 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5599 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5600
5601 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5602 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5603 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5604 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5605 the underlying system.
5606 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5607 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5608
5609 @table @code
5610 @kindex skip
5611 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5612 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5613 that specify what to skip.
5614 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5615
5616 @table @code
5617 @item -file @var{file}
5618 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5619 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5620
5621 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5622 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5623 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5624 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5625 over when stepping.
5626
5627 @smallexample
5628 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5629 @end smallexample
5630
5631 @item -function @var{linespec}
5632 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5633 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5634 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5635 @xref{Specify Location}.
5636
5637 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5638 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5639 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5640 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5641
5642 This form is useful for complex function names.
5643 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5644 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5645 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5646 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5647 regular expression makes this easier.
5648
5649 @smallexample
5650 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5651 @end smallexample
5652
5653 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5654 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5658 @end smallexample
5659 @end table
5660
5661 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5662 will be skipped.
5663
5664 @kindex skip function
5665 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5666 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5667 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5668 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5669
5670 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5671 will be skipped.
5672
5673 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5674 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5675
5676 @kindex skip file
5677 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5678 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5679 will be skipped over when stepping.
5680
5681 @smallexample
5682 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5683 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5684 @end smallexample
5685
5686 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5687 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5688 @end table
5689
5690 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5691 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5692
5693 @table @code
5694 @kindex info skip
5695 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5696 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5697 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5698 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5699
5700 @table @emph
5701 @item Identifier
5702 A number identifying this skip.
5703 @item Enabled or Disabled
5704 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5705 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5706 @item Glob
5707 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5708 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5709 @item File
5710 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5711 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5712 @item RE
5713 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5714 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5715 @item Function
5716 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5717 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5718 @end table
5719
5720 @kindex skip delete
5721 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5722 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5723 skips.
5724
5725 @kindex skip enable
5726 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5727 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5728 skips.
5729
5730 @kindex skip disable
5731 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5732 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5733 skips.
5734
5735 @end table
5736
5737 @node Signals
5738 @section Signals
5739 @cindex signals
5740
5741 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5742 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5743 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5744 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5745 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5746 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5747 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5748 requested an alarm).
5749
5750 @cindex fatal signals
5751 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5752 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5753 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5754 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5755 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5756 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5757
5758 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5759 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5760 signal.
5761
5762 @cindex handling signals
5763 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5764 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5765 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5766 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5767 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5768
5769 @table @code
5770 @kindex info signals
5771 @kindex info handle
5772 @item info signals
5773 @itemx info handle
5774 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5775 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5776 the defined types of signals.
5777
5778 @item info signals @var{sig}
5779 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5780
5781 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5782
5783 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5784 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5785 for details about this command.
5786
5787 @kindex handle
5788 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5789 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5790 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5791 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5792 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5793 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5794 say what change to make.
5795 @end table
5796
5797 @c @group
5798 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5799 Their full names are:
5800
5801 @table @code
5802 @item nostop
5803 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5804 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5805
5806 @item stop
5807 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5808 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5809
5810 @item print
5811 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5812
5813 @item noprint
5814 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5815 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5816
5817 @item pass
5818 @itemx noignore
5819 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5820 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5821 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5822
5823 @item nopass
5824 @itemx ignore
5825 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5826 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5827 @end table
5828 @c @end group
5829
5830 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5831 program until you
5832 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5833 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5834 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5835 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5836 program sees that signal when you continue.
5837
5838 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5839 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5840 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5841 erroneous signals.
5842
5843 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5844 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5845 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5846 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5847 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5848 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5849 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5850 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5851 Program a Signal}.
5852
5853 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5854 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5855
5856 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5857 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5858 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5859 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5860 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5861 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5862 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5863 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5864 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5865 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5866 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5867 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5868 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5869
5870 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5871
5872 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5873 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5874 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5875 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5876
5877 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5878 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5879 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5880 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5881
5882 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5883 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5884
5885 @smallexample
5886 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5887 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5888 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5889 (@value{GDBP}) c
5890 Continuing.
5891
5892 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5893 main () sigusr1.c:28
5894 28 p = 0;
5895 (@value{GDBP}) si
5896 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5897 9 @{
5898 @end smallexample
5899
5900 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5901 program to receive the signal first:
5902
5903 @smallexample
5904 (@value{GDBP}) n
5905 28 p = 0;
5906 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5907 (@value{GDBP}) si
5908 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5909 9 @{
5910 (@value{GDBP})
5911 @end smallexample
5912
5913 @cindex extra signal information
5914 @anchor{extra signal information}
5915
5916 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5917 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5918 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5919 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5920 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5921 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5922 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5923 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5924 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5925 system header.
5926
5927 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5928 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5929
5930 @smallexample
5931 @group
5932 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5933 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5934 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5935 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5936 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5937 type = struct @{
5938 int si_signo;
5939 int si_errno;
5940 int si_code;
5941 union @{
5942 int _pad[28];
5943 struct @{...@} _kill;
5944 struct @{...@} _timer;
5945 struct @{...@} _rt;
5946 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5947 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5948 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5949 @} _sifields;
5950 @}
5951 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5952 type = struct @{
5953 void *si_addr;
5954 @}
5955 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5956 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5957 @end group
5958 @end smallexample
5959
5960 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5961
5962 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5963 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5964 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5965 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5966 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5967 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5968 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5969 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5970 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5971 information is displayed.
5972
5973 The usual output of a segfault is:
5974 @smallexample
5975 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5976 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5977 68 value = *(p + len);
5978 @end smallexample
5979
5980 While a bound violation is presented as:
5981 @smallexample
5982 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5983 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5984 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5985 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5986 68 value = *(p + len);
5987 @end smallexample
5988
5989 @node Thread Stops
5990 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5991
5992 @cindex stopped threads
5993 @cindex threads, stopped
5994
5995 @cindex continuing threads
5996 @cindex threads, continuing
5997
5998 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5999 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6000 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6001 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6002 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6003 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6004 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6005 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6006 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6007
6008 @menu
6009 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6010 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6011 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6012 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6013 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6014 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6015 @end menu
6016
6017 @node All-Stop Mode
6018 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6019
6020 @cindex all-stop mode
6021
6022 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6023 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6024 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6025 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6026 underfoot.
6027
6028 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6029 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6030 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6031
6032 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6033 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6034 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6035 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6036 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6037 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6038 stops.
6039
6040 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6041 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6042 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6043 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6044
6045 @cindex automatic thread selection
6046 @cindex switching threads automatically
6047 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6048 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6049 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6050 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6051 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6052 thread.
6053
6054 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6055 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6056
6057 @table @code
6058 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6059 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6060 @cindex lock scheduler
6061 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6062 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6063 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6064 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6065 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6066 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6067 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6068 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6069 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6070 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6071 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6072 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6073 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6074 @code{on} in replay mode.
6075
6076 @item show scheduler-locking
6077 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6078 @end table
6079
6080 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6081 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6082 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6083 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6084 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6085 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6086 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6087 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6088 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6089 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6090 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6091 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6092 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6093 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6094
6095 @table @code
6096 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6097 @item set schedule-multiple
6098 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6099 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6100 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6101 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6102 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6103 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6104
6105 @item show schedule-multiple
6106 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6107 multiple processes.
6108 @end table
6109
6110 @node Non-Stop Mode
6111 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6112
6113 @cindex non-stop mode
6114
6115 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6116 @c with more details.
6117
6118 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6119 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6120 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6121 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6122 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6123 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6124
6125 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6126 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6127 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6128 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6129 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6130 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6131 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6132 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6133 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6134 independently and simultaneously.
6135
6136 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6137 or attach to your program:
6138
6139 @smallexample
6140 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6141 set pagination off
6142
6143 # Finally, turn it on!
6144 set non-stop on
6145 @end smallexample
6146
6147 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6148
6149 @table @code
6150 @kindex set non-stop
6151 @item set non-stop on
6152 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6153 @item set non-stop off
6154 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6155 @kindex show non-stop
6156 @item show non-stop
6157 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6158 @end table
6159
6160 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6161 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6162 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6163 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6164 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6165 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6166 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6167 default.
6168
6169 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6170 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6171 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6172
6173 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6174 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6175 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6176 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6177 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6178
6179 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6180 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6181 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6182 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6183 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6184
6185 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6186
6187 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6188 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6189 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6190 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6191 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6192 previously current thread.
6193
6194 @node Background Execution
6195 @subsection Background Execution
6196
6197 @cindex foreground execution
6198 @cindex background execution
6199 @cindex asynchronous execution
6200 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6201
6202 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6203 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6204 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6205 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6206 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6207 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6208
6209 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6210 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6211
6212 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6213 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6214 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6215 are:
6216
6217 @table @code
6218 @kindex run&
6219 @item run
6220 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6221
6222 @item attach
6223 @kindex attach&
6224 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6225
6226 @item step
6227 @kindex step&
6228 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6229
6230 @item stepi
6231 @kindex stepi&
6232 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6233
6234 @item next
6235 @kindex next&
6236 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6237
6238 @item nexti
6239 @kindex nexti&
6240 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6241
6242 @item continue
6243 @kindex continue&
6244 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6245
6246 @item finish
6247 @kindex finish&
6248 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6249
6250 @item until
6251 @kindex until&
6252 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6253
6254 @end table
6255
6256 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6257 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6258 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6259 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6260 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6261 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6262
6263 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6264 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex interrupt
6268 @item interrupt
6269 @itemx interrupt -a
6270
6271 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6272 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6273 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6274 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6275 @end table
6276
6277 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6278 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6279
6280 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6281 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6282 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6283
6284 @table @code
6285 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6286 @cindex thread breakpoints
6287 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6288 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6289 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6290 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6291 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6292 specify some source line.
6293
6294 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6295 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6296 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6297 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6298 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6299
6300 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6301 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6302 program.
6303
6304 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6305 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6306 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6307
6308 @smallexample
6309 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6310 @end smallexample
6311
6312 @end table
6313
6314 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6315 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6316 thread list. For example:
6317
6318 @smallexample
6319 (@value{GDBP}) c
6320 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6321 @end smallexample
6322
6323 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6324 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6325 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6326 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6327 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6328 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6329 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6330 command.
6331
6332 @node Interrupted System Calls
6333 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6334
6335 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6336 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6337 @cindex premature return from system calls
6338 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6339 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6340 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6341 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6342 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6343 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6344 stop execution.
6345
6346 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6347 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6348 style anyways.
6349
6350 For example, do not write code like this:
6351
6352 @smallexample
6353 sleep (10);
6354 @end smallexample
6355
6356 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6357 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6358
6359 Instead, write this:
6360
6361 @smallexample
6362 int unslept = 10;
6363 while (unslept > 0)
6364 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6365 @end smallexample
6366
6367 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6368 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6369 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6370 @value{GDBN}.
6371
6372 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6373 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6374 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6375 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6376
6377 @node Observer Mode
6378 @subsection Observer Mode
6379
6380 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6381 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6382 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6383 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6384 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6385
6386 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6387 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6388 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6389 mode.
6390
6391 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6392 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6393 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6394 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6395 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6396
6397 @table @code
6398
6399 @kindex observer
6400 @item set observer on
6401 @itemx set observer off
6402 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6403 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6404 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6405 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6406
6407 @item show observer
6408 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6409
6410 @kindex may-write-registers
6411 @item set may-write-registers on
6412 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6413 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6414 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6415 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6416
6417 @item show may-write-registers
6418 Show the current permission to write registers.
6419
6420 @kindex may-write-memory
6421 @item set may-write-memory on
6422 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6423 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6424 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6425 defaults to @code{on}.
6426
6427 @item show may-write-memory
6428 Show the current permission to write memory.
6429
6430 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6431 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6432 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6433 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6434 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6435 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6436
6437 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6438 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6439
6440 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6441 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6442 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6443 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6444 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6445 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6446 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6447
6448 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6449 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6450
6451 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6452 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6453 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6454 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6455 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6456 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6457 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6458
6459 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6460 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6461
6462 @kindex may-interrupt
6463 @item set may-interrupt on
6464 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6465 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6466 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6467 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6468 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6469
6470 @item show may-interrupt
6471 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6472
6473 @end table
6474
6475 @node Reverse Execution
6476 @chapter Running programs backward
6477 @cindex reverse execution
6478 @cindex running programs backward
6479
6480 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6481 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6482 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6483 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6484
6485 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6486 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6487 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6488 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6489 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6490 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6491
6492 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6493 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6494 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6495 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6496 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6497 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6498 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6499 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6500 prior values@footnote{
6501 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6502 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6503 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6504
6505 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6506 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6507 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6508 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6509 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6510 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6511 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6512 }.
6513
6514 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6515 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6516
6517 @table @code
6518 @kindex reverse-continue
6519 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6520 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6521 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6522 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6523 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6524 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6525 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6526
6527 @kindex reverse-step
6528 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6529 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6530 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6531 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6532
6533 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6534 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6535 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6536 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6537 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6538 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6539
6540 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6541 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6542
6543 @kindex reverse-stepi
6544 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6545 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6546 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6547 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6548 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6549 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6550 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6551
6552 @kindex reverse-next
6553 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6554 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6555 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6556 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6557 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6558 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6559 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6560 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6561 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6562 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6563
6564 @kindex reverse-nexti
6565 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6566 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6567 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6568 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6569 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6570 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6571 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6572 frame) is reached.
6573
6574 @kindex reverse-finish
6575 @item reverse-finish
6576 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6577 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6578 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6579 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6580
6581 @kindex set exec-direction
6582 @item set exec-direction
6583 Set the direction of target execution.
6584 @item set exec-direction reverse
6585 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6586 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6587 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6588 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6589 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6590 @item set exec-direction forward
6591 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6592 This is the default.
6593 @end table
6594
6595
6596 @node Process Record and Replay
6597 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6598 @cindex process record and replay
6599 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6600
6601 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6602 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6603 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6604
6605 @cindex replay mode
6606 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6607 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6608 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6609 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6610 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6611 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6612 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6613 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6614 execution log.
6615
6616 @cindex record mode
6617 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6618 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6619 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6620 for future replay.
6621
6622 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6623 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6624 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6625 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6626 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6627 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6628
6629 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6630 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6631 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6632 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6633
6634 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6635 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6636
6637 @table @code
6638 @kindex target record
6639 @kindex target record-full
6640 @kindex target record-btrace
6641 @kindex record
6642 @kindex record full
6643 @kindex record btrace
6644 @kindex record btrace bts
6645 @kindex record btrace pt
6646 @kindex record bts
6647 @kindex record pt
6648 @kindex rec
6649 @kindex rec full
6650 @kindex rec btrace
6651 @kindex rec btrace bts
6652 @kindex rec btrace pt
6653 @kindex rec bts
6654 @kindex rec pt
6655 @item record @var{method}
6656 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6657 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6658 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6659 recording methods are available:
6660
6661 @table @code
6662 @item full
6663 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6664 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6665 execution.
6666
6667 @item btrace @var{format}
6668 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6669 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6670 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6671 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6672 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6673 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6674 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6675
6676 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6677 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6678 formats are available:
6679
6680 @table @code
6681 @item bts
6682 @cindex branch trace store
6683 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6684 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6685 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6686
6687 @item pt
6688 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6689 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6690 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6691 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6692
6693 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6694 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6695 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6696
6697 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6698 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6699 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6700 buffer-size with care.
6701 @end table
6702
6703 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6704 @end table
6705
6706 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6707 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6708 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6709 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6710
6711 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6712 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6713 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6714 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6715 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6716
6717 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6718 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6719 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6720 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6721 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6722 does not support these two modes.
6723
6724 @kindex record stop
6725 @kindex rec s
6726 @item record stop
6727 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6728 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6729 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6730
6731 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6732 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6733 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6734 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6735 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6736
6737 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6738 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6739 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6740 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6741 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6742
6743 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6744 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6745
6746 @kindex record goto
6747 @item record goto
6748 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6749 ways to specify the location to go to:
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @item record goto begin
6753 @itemx record goto start
6754 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6755
6756 @item record goto end
6757 Go to the end of the execution log.
6758
6759 @item record goto @var{n}
6760 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6761 @end table
6762
6763 @kindex record save
6764 @item record save @var{filename}
6765 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6766 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6767 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6768
6769 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6770
6771 @kindex record restore
6772 @item record restore @var{filename}
6773 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6774 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6775
6776 @kindex set record full
6777 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6778 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6779 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6780 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6781
6782 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6783 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6784 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6785 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6786 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6787 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6788 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6789 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6790
6791 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6792 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6793 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6794
6795 @kindex show record full
6796 @item show record full insn-number-max
6797 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6798 recording method.
6799
6800 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6801 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6802 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6803 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6804 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6805 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6806 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6807 oldest one to be deleted.
6808
6809 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6810 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6811
6812 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6813 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6814
6815 @item set record full memory-query
6816 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6817 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6818 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6819 case.
6820
6821 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6822 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6823 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6824 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6825 results.
6826
6827 @item show record full memory-query
6828 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6829
6830 @kindex set record btrace
6831 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6832 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6833 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6834 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6835 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6836 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6837 You can use the following command for that:
6838
6839 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6840 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6841 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6842 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6843 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6844 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6845 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6846 position.
6847
6848 @kindex show record btrace
6849 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6850 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6851
6852 @kindex set record btrace bts
6853 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6854 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6855 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6856 format. Default is 64KB.
6857
6858 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6859 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6860 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6861 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6862 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6863 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6864 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6865
6866 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6867 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6868
6869 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6870 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6871
6872 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6873 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6874 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6875
6876 @kindex set record btrace pt
6877 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6878 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6879 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6880 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6881
6882 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6883 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6884 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6885 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6886 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6887 actual buffer size for each thread.
6888
6889 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6890 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6891
6892 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6893 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6894
6895 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6896 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6897 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6898
6899 @kindex info record
6900 @item info record
6901 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6902 method:
6903
6904 @table @code
6905 @item full
6906 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6907 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6908
6909 @itemize @bullet
6910 @item
6911 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6912 @item
6913 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6914 @item
6915 Highest recorded instruction number.
6916 @item
6917 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6918 @item
6919 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6920 @item
6921 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6922 @end itemize
6923
6924 @item btrace
6925 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6926
6927 @itemize @bullet
6928 @item
6929 Recording format.
6930 @item
6931 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6932 @item
6933 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6934 instructions.
6935 @item
6936 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6937 @end itemize
6938
6939 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6940 @itemize @bullet
6941 @item
6942 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6943 @end itemize
6944
6945 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6946 @itemize @bullet
6947 @item
6948 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6949 @end itemize
6950 @end table
6951
6952 @kindex record delete
6953 @kindex rec del
6954 @item record delete
6955 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6956 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6957 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6958 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6959
6960 @kindex record instruction-history
6961 @kindex rec instruction-history
6962 @item record instruction-history
6963 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6964 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6965 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6966 are printed in execution order.
6967
6968 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6969 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6970 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6971
6972 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6973 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6974 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6975 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6976 @code{/p} modifier.
6977
6978 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6979 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6980 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6981
6982 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6983 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6984
6985 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6986 disassemble:
6987
6988 @table @code
6989 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6990 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6991 @var{insn}.
6992
6993 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6994 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6995 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6996 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6997 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6998 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6999
7000 @item record instruction-history
7001 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7002
7003 @item record instruction-history -
7004 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7005
7006 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7007 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7008 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7009 number @var{end} is included.
7010 @end table
7011
7012 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7013
7014 @kindex set record
7015 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7016 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7017 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7018 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7019 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7020
7021 @kindex show record
7022 @item show record instruction-history-size
7023 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7024 instruction-history} command.
7025
7026 @kindex record function-call-history
7027 @kindex rec function-call-history
7028 @item record function-call-history
7029 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7030 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7031 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7032 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7033 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7034 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7035 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7036 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7037 given together.
7038
7039 @smallexample
7040 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7041 1 void foo (void)
7042 2 @{
7043 3 @}
7044 4
7045 5 void bar (void)
7046 6 @{
7047 7 ...
7048 8 foo ();
7049 9 ...
7050 10 @}
7051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7052 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7053 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7054 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7055 @end smallexample
7056
7057 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7058 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7059 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7060 to print:
7061
7062 @table @code
7063 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7064 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7065
7066 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7067 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7068 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7069 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7070 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7071
7072 @item record function-call-history
7073 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7074
7075 @item record function-call-history -
7076 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7077
7078 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7079 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7080 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7081 @end table
7082
7083 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7084
7085 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7086 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7087 Define how many lines to print in the
7088 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7089 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7090
7091 @item show record function-call-history-size
7092 Show how many lines to print in the
7093 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7094 @end table
7095
7096
7097 @node Stack
7098 @chapter Examining the Stack
7099
7100 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7101 stopped and how it got there.
7102
7103 @cindex call stack
7104 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7105 is generated.
7106 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7107 the arguments of the call,
7108 and the local variables of the function being called.
7109 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7110 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7111 stack}.
7112
7113 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7114 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7115
7116 @cindex selected frame
7117 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7118 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7119 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7120 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7121 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7122 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7123
7124 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7125 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7126 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7127
7128 @menu
7129 * Frames:: Stack frames
7130 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7131 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7132 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7133 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7134
7135 @end menu
7136
7137 @node Frames
7138 @section Stack Frames
7139
7140 @cindex frame, definition
7141 @cindex stack frame
7142 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7143 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7144 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7145 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7146 which the function is executing.
7147
7148 @cindex initial frame
7149 @cindex outermost frame
7150 @cindex innermost frame
7151 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7152 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7153 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7154 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7155 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7156 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7157 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7158 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7159
7160 @cindex frame pointer
7161 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7162 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7163 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7164 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7165 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7166 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7167
7168 @cindex frame number
7169 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7170 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7171 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7172 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7173 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7174
7175 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7176 @c underflow problems.
7177 @cindex frameless execution
7178 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7179 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7180 @smallexample
7181 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7182 @end smallexample
7183 generates functions without a frame.)
7184 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7185 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7186 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7187 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7188 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7189 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7190 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7191
7192 @node Backtrace
7193 @section Backtraces
7194
7195 @cindex traceback
7196 @cindex call stack traces
7197 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7198 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7199 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7200 stack.
7201
7202 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7203 @table @code
7204 @kindex backtrace
7205 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7206 @item backtrace
7207 @itemx bt
7208 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7209 frames in the stack.
7210
7211 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7212 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7213
7214 @item backtrace @var{n}
7215 @itemx bt @var{n}
7216 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7217
7218 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7219 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7220 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7221
7222 @item backtrace full
7223 @itemx bt full
7224 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7225 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7226 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7227 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7228
7229 @item backtrace no-filters
7230 @itemx bt no-filters
7231 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7232 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7233 @itemx bt no-filters full
7234 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7235 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7236 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7237 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7238 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7239 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7240 support.
7241 @end table
7242
7243 @kindex where
7244 @kindex info stack
7245 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7246 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7247
7248 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7249 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7250 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7251 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7252 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7253 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7254 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7255 multi-threaded program.
7256
7257 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7258 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7259 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7260 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7261 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7262 line number.
7263
7264 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7265 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7266
7267 @smallexample
7268 @group
7269 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7270 at builtin.c:993
7271 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7272 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7273 at macro.c:71
7274 (More stack frames follow...)
7275 @end group
7276 @end smallexample
7277
7278 @noindent
7279 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7280 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7281 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7282
7283 @noindent
7284 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7285 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7286 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7287 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7288 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7289
7290 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7291 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7292 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7293 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7294 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7295 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7296 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7297 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7298 such a backtrace might look like:
7299
7300 @smallexample
7301 @group
7302 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7303 at builtin.c:993
7304 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7305 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7306 at macro.c:71
7307 (More stack frames follow...)
7308 @end group
7309 @end smallexample
7310
7311 @noindent
7312 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7313 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7314
7315 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7316 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7317 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7318
7319 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7320 @cindex program entry point
7321 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7322 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7323 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7324 @code{main}@footnote{
7325 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7326 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7327 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7328 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7329 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7330 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7331
7332 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7333 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7334
7335 @table @code
7336 @item set backtrace past-main
7337 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7338 @kindex set backtrace
7339 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7340
7341 @item set backtrace past-main off
7342 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7343 default.
7344
7345 @item show backtrace past-main
7346 @kindex show backtrace
7347 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7348
7349 @item set backtrace past-entry
7350 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7351 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7352 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7353 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7354
7355 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7356 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7357 application. This is the default.
7358
7359 @item show backtrace past-entry
7360 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7361
7362 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7363 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7364 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7365 @cindex backtrace limit
7366 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7367 or zero means unlimited levels.
7368
7369 @item show backtrace limit
7370 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7371 @end table
7372
7373 You can control how file names are displayed.
7374
7375 @table @code
7376 @item set filename-display
7377 @itemx set filename-display relative
7378 @cindex filename-display
7379 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7380
7381 @item set filename-display basename
7382 Display only basename of a filename.
7383
7384 @item set filename-display absolute
7385 Display an absolute filename.
7386
7387 @item show filename-display
7388 Show the current way to display filenames.
7389 @end table
7390
7391 @node Selection
7392 @section Selecting a Frame
7393
7394 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7395 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7396 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7397 of the stack frame just selected.
7398
7399 @table @code
7400 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7401 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7402 @item frame @var{n}
7403 @itemx f @var{n}
7404 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7405 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7406 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7407 @code{main}.
7408
7409 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7410 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7411 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7412 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7413 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7414 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7415 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7416 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7417
7418 @kindex up
7419 @item up @var{n}
7420 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7421 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7422 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7423
7424 @kindex down
7425 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7426 @item down @var{n}
7427 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7428 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7429 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7430 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7431 @end table
7432
7433 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7434 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7435 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7436 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7437
7438 @need 1000
7439 For example:
7440
7441 @smallexample
7442 @group
7443 (@value{GDBP}) up
7444 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7445 at env.c:10
7446 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7447 @end group
7448 @end smallexample
7449
7450 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7451 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7452 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7453 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7454 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7455 for details.
7456
7457 @table @code
7458 @kindex select-frame
7459 @item select-frame
7460 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7461 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7462 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7463 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7464
7465 @kindex down-silently
7466 @kindex up-silently
7467 @item up-silently @var{n}
7468 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7469 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7470 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7471 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7472 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7473 distracting.
7474 @end table
7475
7476 @node Frame Info
7477 @section Information About a Frame
7478
7479 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7480 stack frame.
7481
7482 @table @code
7483 @item frame
7484 @itemx f
7485 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7486 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7487 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7488 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7489 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7490
7491 @kindex info frame
7492 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7493 @item info frame
7494 @itemx info f
7495 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7496 including:
7497
7498 @itemize @bullet
7499 @item
7500 the address of the frame
7501 @item
7502 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7503 @item
7504 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7505 @item
7506 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7507 @item
7508 the address of the frame's arguments
7509 @item
7510 the address of the frame's local variables
7511 @item
7512 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7513 @item
7514 which registers were saved in the frame
7515 @end itemize
7516
7517 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7518 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7519 the usual conventions.
7520
7521 @item info frame @var{addr}
7522 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7523 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7524 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7525 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7526 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7527 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7528
7529 @kindex info args
7530 @item info args
7531 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7532
7533 @item info locals
7534 @kindex info locals
7535 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7536 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7537 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7538
7539 @end table
7540
7541 @node Frame Filter Management
7542 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7543 @cindex managing frame filters
7544
7545 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7546 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7547
7548 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7549 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7550
7551 @table @code
7552 @kindex info frame-filter
7553 @item info frame-filter
7554 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7555 their name, priority and enabled status.
7556
7557 @kindex disable frame-filter
7558 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7559 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7560 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7561 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7562 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7563 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7564 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7565 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7566 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7567 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7568 may be enabled again later.
7569
7570 @kindex enable frame-filter
7571 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7572 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7573 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7574 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7575 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7576 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7577 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7578 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7579 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7580
7581 Example:
7582
7583 @smallexample
7584 (gdb) info frame-filter
7585
7586 global frame-filters:
7587 Priority Enabled Name
7588 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7589 100 Yes Reverse
7590
7591 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7592 Priority Enabled Name
7593 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7594
7595 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7596 Priority Enabled Name
7597 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7598
7599 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7600 (gdb) info frame-filter
7601
7602 global frame-filters:
7603 Priority Enabled Name
7604 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7605 100 Yes Reverse
7606
7607 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7608 Priority Enabled Name
7609 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7610
7611 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7612 Priority Enabled Name
7613 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7614
7615 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7616 (gdb) info frame-filter
7617
7618 global frame-filters:
7619 Priority Enabled Name
7620 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7621 100 Yes Reverse
7622
7623 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7624 Priority Enabled Name
7625 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7626
7627 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7628 Priority Enabled Name
7629 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7630 @end smallexample
7631
7632 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7633 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7634 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7635 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7636 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7637 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7638 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7639
7640 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7641 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7642 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7643 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7644 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7645 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7646 dictionary resides.
7647
7648 Example:
7649
7650 @smallexample
7651 (gdb) info frame-filter
7652
7653 global frame-filters:
7654 Priority Enabled Name
7655 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7656 100 Yes Reverse
7657
7658 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7659 Priority Enabled Name
7660 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7661
7662 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7663 Priority Enabled Name
7664 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7665
7666 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7667 (gdb) info frame-filter
7668
7669 global frame-filters:
7670 Priority Enabled Name
7671 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7672 50 Yes Reverse
7673
7674 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7675 Priority Enabled Name
7676 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7677
7678 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7679 Priority Enabled Name
7680 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7681 @end smallexample
7682 @end table
7683
7684 @node Source
7685 @chapter Examining Source Files
7686
7687 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7688 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7689 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7690 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7691 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7692 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7693 source files by explicit command.
7694
7695 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7696 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7697 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7698
7699 @menu
7700 * List:: Printing source lines
7701 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7702 * Edit:: Editing source files
7703 * Search:: Searching source files
7704 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7705 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7706 @end menu
7707
7708 @node List
7709 @section Printing Source Lines
7710
7711 @kindex list
7712 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7713 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7714 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7715 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7716 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7717
7718 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7719
7720 @table @code
7721 @item list @var{linenum}
7722 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7723 current source file.
7724
7725 @item list @var{function}
7726 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7727 @var{function}.
7728
7729 @item list
7730 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7731 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7732 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7733 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7734 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7735
7736 @item list -
7737 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7738 @end table
7739
7740 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7741 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7742 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7743
7744 @table @code
7745 @kindex set listsize
7746 @item set listsize @var{count}
7747 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7748 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7749 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7750 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7751
7752 @kindex show listsize
7753 @item show listsize
7754 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7755 @end table
7756
7757 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7758 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7759 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7760 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7761 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7762
7763 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7764 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7765 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7766 to specify some source line.
7767
7768 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7769
7770 @table @code
7771 @item list @var{location}
7772 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7773
7774 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7775 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7776 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7777 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7778 the same source file as the first location.
7779
7780 @item list ,@var{last}
7781 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7782
7783 @item list @var{first},
7784 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7785
7786 @item list +
7787 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7788
7789 @item list -
7790 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7791
7792 @item list
7793 As described in the preceding table.
7794 @end table
7795
7796 @node Specify Location
7797 @section Specifying a Location
7798 @cindex specifying location
7799 @cindex location
7800 @cindex source location
7801
7802 @menu
7803 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7804 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7805 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7806 @end menu
7807
7808 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7809 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7810 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7811 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7812 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7813
7814 @node Linespec Locations
7815 @subsection Linespec Locations
7816 @cindex linespec locations
7817
7818 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7819 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7820 specifying a linespec:
7821
7822 @table @code
7823 @item @var{linenum}
7824 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7825
7826 @item -@var{offset}
7827 @itemx +@var{offset}
7828 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7829 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7830 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7831 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7832 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7833 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7834 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7835 linespec.
7836
7837 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7838 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7839 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7840 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7841 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7842 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7843 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7844
7845 @item @var{function}
7846 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7847 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7848
7849 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7850 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7851
7852 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7853 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7854 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7855 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7856 functions in different source files.
7857
7858 @item @var{label}
7859 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7860 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7861 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7862 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7863
7864 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7865 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7866 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7867 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7868 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7869 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7870
7871 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7872 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7873 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7874 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7875 each one of those probes.
7876 @end table
7877
7878 @node Explicit Locations
7879 @subsection Explicit Locations
7880 @cindex explicit locations
7881
7882 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7883 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7884
7885 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7886 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7887 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7888 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7889 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7890
7891 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7892 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7893 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7894 the symbol table to know.
7895
7896 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7897 following table:
7898
7899 @table @code
7900 @item -source @var{filename}
7901 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7902 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7903 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7904 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7905 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7906
7907 @item -function @var{function}
7908 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7909 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7910 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7911 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7912
7913 @item -label @var{label}
7914 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7915 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7916 selected stack frame.
7917
7918 @item -line @var{number}
7919 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7920 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7921 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7922 relative to the current line.
7923 @end table
7924
7925 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7926 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7927
7928 @node Address Locations
7929 @subsection Address Locations
7930 @cindex address locations
7931
7932 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7933 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7934
7935 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7936 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7937 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7938 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7939 source files.
7940
7941 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7942 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7943 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7944 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7945 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7946 of @var{address}:
7947
7948 @table @code
7949 @item @var{expression}
7950 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7951
7952 @item @var{funcaddr}
7953 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7954 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7955 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7956 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7957 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7958 (although the Pascal form also works).
7959
7960 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7961 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7962
7963 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7964 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7965 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7966 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7967 functions with identical names in different source files.
7968 @end table
7969
7970 @node Edit
7971 @section Editing Source Files
7972 @cindex editing source files
7973
7974 @kindex edit
7975 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7976 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7977 The editing program of your choice
7978 is invoked with the current line set to
7979 the active line in the program.
7980 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7981 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7982
7983 @table @code
7984 @item edit @var{location}
7985 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7986 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7987 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7988 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7989 command most commonly used:
7990
7991 @table @code
7992 @item edit @var{number}
7993 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7994
7995 @item edit @var{function}
7996 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7997 @end table
7998
7999 @end table
8000
8001 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8002 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8003 @footnote{
8004 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8005 following command-line syntax:
8006 @smallexample
8007 ex +@var{number} file
8008 @end smallexample
8009 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8010 the file where to start editing.}.
8011 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8012 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8013 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8014 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8015 @smallexample
8016 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8017 export EDITOR
8018 gdb @dots{}
8019 @end smallexample
8020 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8021 @smallexample
8022 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8023 gdb @dots{}
8024 @end smallexample
8025
8026 @node Search
8027 @section Searching Source Files
8028 @cindex searching source files
8029
8030 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8031 regular expression.
8032
8033 @table @code
8034 @kindex search
8035 @kindex forward-search
8036 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8037 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8038 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8039 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8040 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8041 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8042 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8043 @code{fo}.
8044
8045 @kindex reverse-search
8046 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8047 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8048 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8049 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8050 this command as @code{rev}.
8051 @end table
8052
8053 @node Source Path
8054 @section Specifying Source Directories
8055
8056 @cindex source path
8057 @cindex directories for source files
8058 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8059 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8060 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8061 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8062 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8063 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8064 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8065
8066 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8067 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8068 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8069 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8070 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8071 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8072 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8073 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8074 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8075 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8076 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8077
8078 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8079 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8080 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8081 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8082 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8083 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8084
8085 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8086 source files.
8087
8088 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8089 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8090 each line is in the file.
8091
8092 @kindex directory
8093 @kindex dir
8094 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8095 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8096 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8097
8098 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8099 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8100
8101 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8102 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8103 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8104 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8105 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8106 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8107 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8108 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8109 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8110 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8111 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8112 name to look up the sources.
8113
8114 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8115 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8116 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8117 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8118 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8119 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8120 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8121 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8122
8123 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8124 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8125 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8126 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8127 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8128 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8129 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8130
8131 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8132 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8133 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8134 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8135 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8136 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8137 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8138 command.
8139
8140 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8141 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8142 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8143 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8144 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8145 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8146 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8147
8148 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8149 @cindex default source path substitution
8150 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8151 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8152 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8153 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8154 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8155 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8156 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8157 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8158 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8159 together.
8160
8161 @table @code
8162 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8163 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8164 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8165 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8166 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8167 part of absolute file names) or
8168 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8169 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8170
8171 @kindex cdir
8172 @kindex cwd
8173 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8174 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8175 @cindex compilation directory
8176 @cindex current directory
8177 @cindex working directory
8178 @cindex directory, current
8179 @cindex directory, compilation
8180 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8181 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8182 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8183 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8184 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8185 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8186
8187 @item directory
8188 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8189
8190 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8191 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8192
8193 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8194 @kindex set directories
8195 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8196 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8197
8198 @item show directories
8199 @kindex show directories
8200 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8201
8202 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8203 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8204 @kindex set substitute-path
8205 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8206 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8207 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8208
8209 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8210 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8211
8212 @smallexample
8213 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8218 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8219 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8220
8221 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8222 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8223 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8224 the substitution.
8225
8226 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8227
8228 @smallexample
8229 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8230 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8231 @end smallexample
8232
8233 @noindent
8234 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8235 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8236 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8237 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8238
8239
8240 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8241 @kindex unset substitute-path
8242 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8243 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8244 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8245
8246 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8247
8248 @item show substitute-path [path]
8249 @kindex show substitute-path
8250 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8251 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8252
8253 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8254 rules.
8255
8256 @end table
8257
8258 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8259 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8260 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8261
8262 @enumerate
8263 @item
8264 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8265
8266 @item
8267 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8268 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8269 directories in one command.
8270 @end enumerate
8271
8272 @node Machine Code
8273 @section Source and Machine Code
8274 @cindex source line and its code address
8275
8276 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8277 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8278 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8279 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8280 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8281 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8282 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8283 well as hex.
8284
8285 @table @code
8286 @kindex info line
8287 @item info line @var{location}
8288 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8289 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8290 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8291 @end table
8292
8293 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8294 the object code for the first line of function
8295 @code{m4_changequote}:
8296
8297 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8298 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8299 @smallexample
8300 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8301 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8302 @end smallexample
8303
8304 @noindent
8305 @cindex code address and its source line
8306 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8307 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8308 @smallexample
8309 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8310 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8311 @end smallexample
8312
8313 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8314 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8315 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8316 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8317 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8318 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8319 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8320 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8321 Variables}).
8322
8323 @table @code
8324 @kindex disassemble
8325 @cindex assembly instructions
8326 @cindex instructions, assembly
8327 @cindex machine instructions
8328 @cindex listing machine instructions
8329 @item disassemble
8330 @itemx disassemble /m
8331 @itemx disassemble /s
8332 @itemx disassemble /r
8333 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8334 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8335 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8336 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8337 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8338 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8339 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8340 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8341 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8342 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8343
8344 @table @code
8345 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8346 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8347 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8348 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8349 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8350 @end table
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8354 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8355
8356 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8357 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8358
8359 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8360 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8361 @end table
8362
8363 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8364 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8365
8366 @smallexample
8367 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8368 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8369 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8370 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8371 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8372 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8373 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8374 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8375 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8376 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8377 End of assembler dump.
8378 @end smallexample
8379
8380 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8381 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8382 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8383
8384 @smallexample
8385 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8386 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8387 5 @{
8388 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8389 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8390 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8391 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8392 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8393
8394 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8395 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8396 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8397
8398 7 return 0;
8399 8 @}
8400 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8401 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8402 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8403
8404 End of assembler dump.
8405 @end smallexample
8406
8407 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8408 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8409 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8410 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8411 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8412 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8413 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8414 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8415 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8416
8417 @file{foo.h}:
8418
8419 @smallexample
8420 int
8421 foo (int a)
8422 @{
8423 if (a < 0)
8424 return a * 2;
8425 if (a == 0)
8426 return 1;
8427 return a + 10;
8428 @}
8429 @end smallexample
8430
8431 @file{foo.c}:
8432
8433 @smallexample
8434 #include "foo.h"
8435 volatile int x, y;
8436 int
8437 main ()
8438 @{
8439 x = foo (y);
8440 return 0;
8441 @}
8442 @end smallexample
8443
8444 @smallexample
8445 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8446 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8447 5 @{
8448
8449 6 x = foo (y);
8450 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8451 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8452
8453 7 return 0;
8454 8 @}
8455 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8456 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8457 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8458 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8459
8460 End of assembler dump.
8461 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8462 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8463 foo.c:
8464 5 @{
8465 6 x = foo (y);
8466 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8467
8468 foo.h:
8469 4 if (a < 0)
8470 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8471 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8472
8473 6 if (a == 0)
8474 7 return 1;
8475 8 return a + 10;
8476 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8477 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8478 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8479 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8480
8481 foo.c:
8482 6 x = foo (y);
8483 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8484
8485 7 return 0;
8486 8 @}
8487 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8488 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8489
8490 foo.h:
8491 5 return a * 2;
8492 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8493 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8494 End of assembler dump.
8495 @end smallexample
8496
8497 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8498
8499 @smallexample
8500 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8501 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8502 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8503 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8504 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8505 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8506 End of assembler dump.
8507 @end smallexample
8508
8509 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8510 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8511 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8512 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8513
8514 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8515 mnemonics or other syntax.
8516
8517 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8518 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8519 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8520 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8521 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8522
8523 @table @code
8524 @kindex set disassembler-options
8525 @cindex disassembler options
8526 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8527 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8528 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8529 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8530 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8531 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8532 The default value is the empty string.
8533
8534 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8535 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8536 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8537 and S/390.
8538
8539 @kindex show disassembler-options
8540 @item show disassembler-options
8541 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8542 @end table
8543
8544 @table @code
8545 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8546 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8547 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8548 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8549 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8550 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8551
8552 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8553 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8554 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8555 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8556
8557 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8558 @item show disassembly-flavor
8559 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8560 @end table
8561
8562 @table @code
8563 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8564 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8565 @item set disassemble-next-line
8566 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8567 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8568 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8569 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8570 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8571 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8572 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8573 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8574 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8575 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8576 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8577 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8578 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8579 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8580 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8581 instruction.
8582 @end table
8583
8584
8585 @node Data
8586 @chapter Examining Data
8587
8588 @cindex printing data
8589 @cindex examining data
8590 @kindex print
8591 @kindex inspect
8592 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8593 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8594 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8595 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8596 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8597 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8598
8599 @table @code
8600 @item print @var{expr}
8601 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8602 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8603 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8604 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8605 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8606 Formats}.
8607
8608 @item print
8609 @itemx print /@var{f}
8610 @cindex reprint the last value
8611 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8612 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8613 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8614 @end table
8615
8616 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8617 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8618 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8619
8620 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8621 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8622 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8623 Table}.
8624
8625 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8626 @kindex explore
8627 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8628 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8629 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8630 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8631 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8632 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8633 embedded in the higher level data types.
8634
8635 @table @code
8636 @item explore @var{arg}
8637 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8638 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8639 @end table
8640
8641 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8642 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8643 C program as
8644
8645 @smallexample
8646 struct SimpleStruct
8647 @{
8648 int i;
8649 double d;
8650 @};
8651
8652 struct ComplexStruct
8653 @{
8654 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8655 int arr[10];
8656 @};
8657 @end smallexample
8658
8659 @noindent
8660 followed by variable declarations as
8661
8662 @smallexample
8663 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8664 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8665 @end smallexample
8666
8667 @noindent
8668 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8669 @code{explore} command as follows.
8670
8671 @smallexample
8672 (gdb) explore cs
8673 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8674 the following fields:
8675
8676 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8677 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8678
8679 Enter the field number of choice:
8680 @end smallexample
8681
8682 @noindent
8683 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8684 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8685 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8686 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8687 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8688 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8689 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8690 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8691
8692 @smallexample
8693 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8694 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8695 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8696 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8697
8698 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8699 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8700
8701 Press enter to return to parent value:
8702 @end smallexample
8703
8704 @noindent
8705 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8706 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8707 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8708 to explore.
8709
8710 @smallexample
8711 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8712 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8713
8714 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8715
8716 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8717
8718 Press enter to return to parent value:
8719 @end smallexample
8720
8721 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8722 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8723 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8724 level data structure).
8725
8726 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8727 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8728 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8729 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8730 same example as above, your can explore the type
8731 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8732 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8733
8734 @smallexample
8735 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8736 @end smallexample
8737
8738 @noindent
8739 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8740 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8741 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8742 example.
8743
8744 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8745 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8746 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8747 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8748 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8749
8750 @table @code
8751 @item explore value @var{expr}
8752 @cindex explore value
8753 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8754 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8755 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8756 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8757 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8758
8759 @item explore type @var{arg}
8760 @cindex explore type
8761 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8762 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8763 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8764 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8765 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8766 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8767 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8768 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8769 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8770 @end table
8771
8772 @menu
8773 * Expressions:: Expressions
8774 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8775 * Variables:: Program variables
8776 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8777 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8778 * Memory:: Examining memory
8779 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8780 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8781 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8782 * Value History:: Value history
8783 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8784 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8785 * Registers:: Registers
8786 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8787 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8788 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8789 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8790 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8791 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8792 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8793 character set than GDB does
8794 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8795 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8796 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8797 @end menu
8798
8799 @node Expressions
8800 @section Expressions
8801
8802 @cindex expressions
8803 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8804 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8805 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8806 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8807 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8808 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8809 @ref{Compilation}.
8810
8811 @cindex arrays in expressions
8812 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8813 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8814 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8815 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8816 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8817 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8818
8819 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8820 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8821 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8822 languages.
8823
8824 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8825 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8826
8827 @cindex casts, in expressions
8828 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8829 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8830 at that address in memory.
8831 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8832
8833 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8834 to programming languages:
8835
8836 @table @code
8837 @item @@
8838 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8839 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8840
8841 @item ::
8842 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8843 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8844
8845 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8846 @cindex type casting memory
8847 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8848 @cindex casts, to view memory
8849 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8850 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8851 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8852 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8853 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8854 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8855 @end table
8856
8857 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8858 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8859 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8860
8861 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8862 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8863 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8864 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8865 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8866 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8867 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8868
8869 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8870 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8871 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8872 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8873 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8874 as well.
8875
8876 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8877 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8878 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8879 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8880 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8881 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8882 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8883 choices.
8884
8885 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8886 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8887 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8888
8889 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8890 @smallexample
8891 @group
8892 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8893 [0] cancel
8894 [1] all
8895 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8896 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8897 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8898 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8899 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8900 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8901 > 2 4 6
8902 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8903 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8904 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8905 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8906 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8907 breakpoints.
8908 (@value{GDBP})
8909 @end group
8910 @end smallexample
8911
8912 @table @code
8913 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8914 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8915 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8916
8917 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8918 is ambiguous.
8919
8920 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8921 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8922 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8923 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8924 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8925 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8926 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8927 in the use of the menu.
8928
8929 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8930 when an ambiguity is detected.
8931
8932 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8933 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8934
8935 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8936 @item show multiple-symbols
8937 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8938 @end table
8939
8940 @node Variables
8941 @section Program Variables
8942
8943 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8944 in your program.
8945
8946 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8947 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8948
8949 @itemize @bullet
8950 @item
8951 global (or file-static)
8952 @end itemize
8953
8954 @noindent or
8955
8956 @itemize @bullet
8957 @item
8958 visible according to the scope rules of the
8959 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8960 @end itemize
8961
8962 @noindent This means that in the function
8963
8964 @smallexample
8965 foo (a)
8966 int a;
8967 @{
8968 bar (a);
8969 @{
8970 int b = test ();
8971 bar (b);
8972 @}
8973 @}
8974 @end smallexample
8975
8976 @noindent
8977 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8978 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8979 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8980 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8981
8982 @cindex variable name conflict
8983 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8984 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8985 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8986 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8987 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8988 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8989 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8990
8991 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8992 @ifnotinfo
8993 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8994 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8995 @end ifnotinfo
8996 @smallexample
8997 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8998 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8999 @end smallexample
9000
9001 @noindent
9002 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9003 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9004 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9005 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9006
9007 @smallexample
9008 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9009 @end smallexample
9010
9011 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9012 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9013 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9014 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9015 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9016
9017 @smallexample
9018 void
9019 foo (int a)
9020 @{
9021 if (a < 10)
9022 bar (a);
9023 else
9024 process (a); /* Stop here */
9025 @}
9026
9027 int
9028 bar (int a)
9029 @{
9030 foo (a + 5);
9031 @}
9032 @end smallexample
9033
9034 @noindent
9035 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9036 here is what you might see
9037 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9038
9039 @smallexample
9040 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9041 $1 = 10
9042 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9043 $2 = 5
9044 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9045 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9046 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9047 $3 = 5
9048 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9049 $4 = 0
9050 @end smallexample
9051
9052 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9053 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9054 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9055 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9056 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9057
9058 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9059 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9060 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9061 @code{some_global}.
9062
9063 @smallexample
9064 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9065 $1 = 23
9066 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9067 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9068 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9069 $2 = 27
9070 @end smallexample
9071
9072 @cindex wrong values
9073 @cindex variable values, wrong
9074 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9075 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9076 @quotation
9077 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9078 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9079 scope, and just before exit.
9080 @end quotation
9081 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9082 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9083 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9084 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9085 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9086 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9087 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9088 variable definitions may be gone.
9089
9090 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9091 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9092 when compiling.
9093
9094 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9095 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9096 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9097 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9098 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9099 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9100 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9101
9102 @smallexample
9103 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9104 @end smallexample
9105
9106 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9107 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9108 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9109 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9110 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9111
9112 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9113 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9114 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9115 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9116
9117 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9118 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9119 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9120 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9121 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9122
9123 @smallexample
9124 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9125 29 i++;
9126 (gdb) next
9127 30 e (i);
9128 (gdb) print i
9129 $1 = 31
9130 (gdb) print i@@entry
9131 $2 = 30
9132 @end smallexample
9133
9134 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9135 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9136 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9137 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9138 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9139 For program code
9140
9141 @smallexample
9142 char var0[] = "A";
9143 signed char var1[] = "A";
9144 @end smallexample
9145
9146 You get during debugging
9147 @smallexample
9148 (gdb) print var0
9149 $1 = "A"
9150 (gdb) print var1
9151 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9152 @end smallexample
9153
9154 @node Arrays
9155 @section Artificial Arrays
9156
9157 @cindex artificial array
9158 @cindex arrays
9159 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9160 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9161 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9162 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9163 program.
9164
9165 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9166 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9167 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9168 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9169 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9170 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9171 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9172 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9173 example. If a program says
9174
9175 @smallexample
9176 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9177 @end smallexample
9178
9179 @noindent
9180 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9181
9182 @smallexample
9183 p *array@@len
9184 @end smallexample
9185
9186 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9187 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9188 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9189 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9190 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9191
9192 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9193 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9194 The value need not be in memory:
9195 @smallexample
9196 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9197 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9198 @end smallexample
9199
9200 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9201 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9202 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9203 @smallexample
9204 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9205 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9206 @end smallexample
9207
9208 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9209 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9210 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9211 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9212 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9213 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9214 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9215 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9216 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9217 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9218
9219 @smallexample
9220 set $i = 0
9221 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9222 @key{RET}
9223 @key{RET}
9224 @dots{}
9225 @end smallexample
9226
9227 @node Output Formats
9228 @section Output Formats
9229
9230 @cindex formatted output
9231 @cindex output formats
9232 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9233 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9234 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9235 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9236 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9237
9238 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9239 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9240 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9241 letters supported are:
9242
9243 @table @code
9244 @item x
9245 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9246 hexadecimal.
9247
9248 @item d
9249 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9250
9251 @item u
9252 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9253
9254 @item o
9255 Print as integer in octal.
9256
9257 @item t
9258 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9259 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9260 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9261 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9262
9263 @item a
9264 @cindex unknown address, locating
9265 @cindex locate address
9266 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9267 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9268 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9269
9270 @smallexample
9271 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9272 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9273 @end smallexample
9274
9275 @noindent
9276 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9277 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9278
9279 @item c
9280 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9281 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9282 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9283 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9284
9285 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9286 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9287 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9288 data.
9289
9290 @item f
9291 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9292 using typical floating point syntax.
9293
9294 @item s
9295 @cindex printing strings
9296 @cindex printing byte arrays
9297 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9298 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9299 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9300 natural types.
9301
9302 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9303 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9304 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9305 array.
9306
9307 @item z
9308 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9309 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9310 to the size of the integer type.
9311
9312 @item r
9313 @cindex raw printing
9314 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9315 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9316 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9317 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9318 pretty-printer which might exist.
9319 @end table
9320
9321 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9322
9323 @smallexample
9324 p/x $pc
9325 @end smallexample
9326
9327 @noindent
9328 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9329 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9330
9331 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9332 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9333 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9334
9335 @node Memory
9336 @section Examining Memory
9337
9338 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9339 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9340
9341 @cindex examining memory
9342 @table @code
9343 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9344 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9345 @itemx x @var{addr}
9346 @itemx x
9347 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9348 @end table
9349
9350 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9351 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9352 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9353 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9354 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9355
9356 @table @r
9357 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9358 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9359 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9360 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9361 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9362 @c 4.1.2.
9363
9364 @item @var{f}, the display format
9365 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9366 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9367 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9368 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9369 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9370
9371 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9372 The unit size is any of
9373
9374 @table @code
9375 @item b
9376 Bytes.
9377 @item h
9378 Halfwords (two bytes).
9379 @item w
9380 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9381 @item g
9382 Giant words (eight bytes).
9383 @end table
9384
9385 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9386 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9387 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9388 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9389 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9390 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9391 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9392 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9393 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9394 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9395 be altered.
9396
9397 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9398 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9399 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9400 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9401 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9402 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9403 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9404 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9405 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9406 a value from memory).
9407 @end table
9408
9409 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9410 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9411 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9412 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9413 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9414
9415 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9416 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9417 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9418
9419 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9420 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9421 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9422 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9423 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9424
9425 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9426 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9427 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9428 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9429 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9430 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9431 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9432 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9433 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9434
9435 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9436 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9437 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9438 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9439 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9440 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9441
9442 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9443 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9444 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9445 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9446 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9447 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9448 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9449
9450 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9451 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9452
9453 @smallexample
9454 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9455 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9456 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9457 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9458 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9459 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9460 @end smallexample
9461
9462 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9463 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9464 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9465 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9466 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9467 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9468 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9469 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9470 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9471
9472 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9473 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9474 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9475
9476 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9477 @cindex addressable memory unit
9478 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9479 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9480 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9481 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9482 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9483 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9484 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9485 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9486 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9487
9488 @cindex remote memory comparison
9489 @cindex target memory comparison
9490 @cindex verify remote memory image
9491 @cindex verify target memory image
9492 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9493 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9494 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9495 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9496 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9497 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9498
9499 @table @code
9500 @kindex compare-sections
9501 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9502 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9503 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9504 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9505 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9506 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9507
9508 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9509 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9510 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9511 @end table
9512
9513 @node Auto Display
9514 @section Automatic Display
9515 @cindex automatic display
9516 @cindex display of expressions
9517
9518 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9519 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9520 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9521 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9522 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9523 The automatic display looks like this:
9524
9525 @smallexample
9526 2: foo = 38
9527 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9528 @end smallexample
9529
9530 @noindent
9531 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9532 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9533 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9534 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9535 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9536 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9537
9538 @table @code
9539 @kindex display
9540 @item display @var{expr}
9541 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9542 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9543
9544 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9545
9546 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9547 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9548 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9549 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9550 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9551
9552 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9553 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9554 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9555 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9556 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9557 @end table
9558
9559 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9560 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9561 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9562
9563 @table @code
9564 @kindex delete display
9565 @kindex undisplay
9566 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9567 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9568 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9569 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9570 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9571 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9572 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9573
9574 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9575 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9576
9577 @kindex disable display
9578 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9579 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9580 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9581 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9582 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9583 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9584 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9585 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9586
9587 @kindex enable display
9588 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9589 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9590 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9591 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9592 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9593 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9594 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9595
9596 @item display
9597 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9598 done when your program stops.
9599
9600 @kindex info display
9601 @item info display
9602 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9603 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9604 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9605 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9606 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9607 @end table
9608
9609 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9610 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9611 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9612 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9613 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9614 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9615 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9616 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9617 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9618 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9619 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9620
9621 @node Print Settings
9622 @section Print Settings
9623
9624 @cindex format options
9625 @cindex print settings
9626 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9627 and symbols are printed.
9628
9629 @noindent
9630 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9631
9632 @table @code
9633 @kindex set print
9634 @item set print address
9635 @itemx set print address on
9636 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9637 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9638 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9639 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9640 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9641 @code{set print address on}:
9642
9643 @smallexample
9644 @group
9645 (@value{GDBP}) f
9646 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9647 at input.c:530
9648 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9649 @end group
9650 @end smallexample
9651
9652 @item set print address off
9653 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9654 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9655
9656 @smallexample
9657 @group
9658 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9659 (@value{GDBP}) f
9660 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9661 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9662 @end group
9663 @end smallexample
9664
9665 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9666 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9667 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9668 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9669
9670 @kindex show print
9671 @item show print address
9672 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9673 @end table
9674
9675 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9676 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9677 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9678 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9679 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9680 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9681 it prints a symbolic address:
9682
9683 @table @code
9684 @item set print symbol-filename on
9685 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9686 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9687 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9688 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9689
9690 @item set print symbol-filename off
9691 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9692 default.
9693
9694 @item show print symbol-filename
9695 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9696 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9697 @end table
9698
9699 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9700 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9701 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9702
9703 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9704 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9705
9706 @table @code
9707 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9708 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9709 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9710 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9711 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9712 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9713 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9714 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9715
9716 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9717 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9718 symbolic address.
9719 @end table
9720
9721 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9722 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9723 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9724 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9725 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9726 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9727 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9728 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9729
9730 @smallexample
9731 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9732 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9733 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9734 @end smallexample
9735
9736 @quotation
9737 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9738 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9739 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9740 @end quotation
9741
9742 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9743 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9744
9745 @table @code
9746 @item set print symbol on
9747 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9748 one exists.
9749
9750 @item set print symbol off
9751 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9752 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9753 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9754
9755 @item show print symbol
9756 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9757 address.
9758 @end table
9759
9760 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9761
9762 @table @code
9763 @item set print array
9764 @itemx set print array on
9765 @cindex pretty print arrays
9766 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9767 but uses more space. The default is off.
9768
9769 @item set print array off
9770 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9771
9772 @item show print array
9773 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9774 arrays.
9775
9776 @cindex print array indexes
9777 @item set print array-indexes
9778 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9779 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9780 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9781 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9782
9783 @item set print array-indexes off
9784 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9785
9786 @item show print array-indexes
9787 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9788 arrays.
9789
9790 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9791 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9792 @cindex number of array elements to print
9793 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9794 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9795 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9796 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9797 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9798 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9799 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9800 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9801
9802 @item show print elements
9803 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9804 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9805
9806 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9807 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9808 @cindex printing frame argument values
9809 @cindex print all frame argument values
9810 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9811 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9812 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9813 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9814 values are:
9815
9816 @table @code
9817 @item all
9818 The values of all arguments are printed.
9819
9820 @item scalars
9821 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9822 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9823 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9824 only scalar arguments are shown:
9825
9826 @smallexample
9827 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9828 at frame-args.c:23
9829 @end smallexample
9830
9831 @item none
9832 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9833 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9834
9835 @smallexample
9836 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9837 at frame-args.c:23
9838 @end smallexample
9839 @end table
9840
9841 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9842 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9843 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9844 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9845 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9846 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9847 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9848 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9849 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9850 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9851
9852 @item show print frame-arguments
9853 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9854
9855 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9856 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9857
9858 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9859 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9860 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9861 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9862 This is the default.
9863
9864 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9865 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9866
9867 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9868 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9869 @kindex set print entry-values
9870 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9871 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9872 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9873 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9874 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9875
9876 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9877 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9878 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9879 @code{no} setting.
9880
9881 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9882 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9883 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9884 this information.
9885
9886 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9887
9888 @table @code
9889 @item no
9890 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9891 point.
9892 @smallexample
9893 #0 equal (val=5)
9894 #0 different (val=6)
9895 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9896 #0 born (val=10)
9897 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9898 @end smallexample
9899
9900 @item only
9901 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9902 values are never printed.
9903 @smallexample
9904 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9905 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9906 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9907 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9908 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9909 @end smallexample
9910
9911 @item preferred
9912 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9913 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9914 value for such parameter.
9915 @smallexample
9916 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9917 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9918 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9919 #0 born (val=10)
9920 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9921 @end smallexample
9922
9923 @item if-needed
9924 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9925 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9926 parameter.
9927 @smallexample
9928 #0 equal (val=5)
9929 #0 different (val=6)
9930 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9931 #0 born (val=10)
9932 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9933 @end smallexample
9934
9935 @item both
9936 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9937 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9938 optimizations.
9939 @smallexample
9940 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9941 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9942 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9943 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9944 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9945 @end smallexample
9946
9947 @item compact
9948 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9949 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9950 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9951 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9952 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9953 @smallexample
9954 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9955 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9956 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9957 #0 born (val=10)
9958 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9959 @end smallexample
9960
9961 @item default
9962 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9963 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9964 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9965 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9966 @smallexample
9967 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9968 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9969 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9970 #0 born (val=10)
9971 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9972 @end smallexample
9973 @end table
9974
9975 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9976 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9977
9978 @item show print entry-values
9979 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9980 entry.
9981
9982 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9983 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9984 @cindex repeated array elements
9985 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9986 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9987 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9988 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9989 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9990 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9991 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9992 is 10.
9993
9994 @item show print repeats
9995 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9996 elements.
9997
9998 @item set print null-stop
9999 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10000 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10001 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10002 contain only short strings.
10003 The default is off.
10004
10005 @item show print null-stop
10006 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10007 @sc{null} character.
10008
10009 @item set print pretty on
10010 @cindex print structures in indented form
10011 @cindex indentation in structure display
10012 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10013 per line, like this:
10014
10015 @smallexample
10016 @group
10017 $1 = @{
10018 next = 0x0,
10019 flags = @{
10020 sweet = 1,
10021 sour = 1
10022 @},
10023 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10024 @}
10025 @end group
10026 @end smallexample
10027
10028 @item set print pretty off
10029 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10030
10031 @smallexample
10032 @group
10033 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10034 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10035 @end group
10036 @end smallexample
10037
10038 @noindent
10039 This is the default format.
10040
10041 @item show print pretty
10042 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10043
10044 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10045 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10046 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10047 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10048 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10049 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10050 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10051 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10052
10053 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10054 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10055 international character sets, and is the default.
10056
10057 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10058 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10059
10060 @item set print union on
10061 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10062 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10063 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10064
10065 @item set print union off
10066 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10067 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10068 instead.
10069
10070 @item show print union
10071 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10072 structures and other unions.
10073
10074 For example, given the declarations
10075
10076 @smallexample
10077 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10078 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10079 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10080 Bug_forms;
10081
10082 struct thing @{
10083 Species it;
10084 union @{
10085 Tree_forms tree;
10086 Bug_forms bug;
10087 @} form;
10088 @};
10089
10090 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 @noindent
10094 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10095
10096 @smallexample
10097 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10098 @end smallexample
10099
10100 @noindent
10101 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10102
10103 @smallexample
10104 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @noindent
10108 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10109 and in Pascal.
10110 @end table
10111
10112 @need 1000
10113 @noindent
10114 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10115
10116 @table @code
10117 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10118 @item set print demangle
10119 @itemx set print demangle on
10120 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10121 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10122 linkage. The default is on.
10123
10124 @item show print demangle
10125 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10126
10127 @item set print asm-demangle
10128 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10129 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10130 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10131 The default is off.
10132
10133 @item show print asm-demangle
10134 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10135 or demangled form.
10136
10137 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10138 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10139 @kindex set demangle-style
10140 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10141 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10142 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10143
10144 @table @code
10145 @item auto
10146 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10147 This is the default.
10148
10149 @item gnu
10150 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10151
10152 @item hp
10153 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10154
10155 @item lucid
10156 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10157
10158 @item arm
10159 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10160 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10161 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10162 require further enhancement to permit that.
10163
10164 @end table
10165 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10166
10167 @item show demangle-style
10168 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10169
10170 @item set print object
10171 @itemx set print object on
10172 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10173 @cindex display derived types
10174 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10175 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10176 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10177 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10178 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10179 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10180 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10181
10182 @item set print object off
10183 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10184 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10185
10186 @item show print object
10187 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10188
10189 @item set print static-members
10190 @itemx set print static-members on
10191 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10192 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10193
10194 @item set print static-members off
10195 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10196
10197 @item show print static-members
10198 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10199
10200 @item set print pascal_static-members
10201 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10202 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10203 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10204 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10205
10206 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10207 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10208
10209 @item show print pascal_static-members
10210 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10211
10212 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10213 @item set print vtbl
10214 @itemx set print vtbl on
10215 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10216 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10217 @cindex VTBL display
10218 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10219 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10220 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10221
10222 @item set print vtbl off
10223 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10224
10225 @item show print vtbl
10226 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10227 @end table
10228
10229 @node Pretty Printing
10230 @section Pretty Printing
10231
10232 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10233 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10234 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10235
10236 @menu
10237 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10238 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10239 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10240 @end menu
10241
10242 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10243 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10244
10245 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10246 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10247 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10248
10249 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10250 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10251 pretty-printers with their names.
10252 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10253 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10254 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10255 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10256
10257 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10258 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10259 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10260 do anything special.
10261
10262 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10263
10264 @itemize @bullet
10265 @item
10266 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10267 all inferiors.
10268
10269 @item
10270 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10271 when debugging that program.
10272 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10273
10274 @item
10275 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10276 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10277 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10278 @end itemize
10279
10280 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10281 pretty-printers are selected,
10282
10283 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10284 for new types.
10285
10286 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10287 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10288
10289 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10290
10291 @smallexample
10292 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10293 $1 = @{
10294 static npos = 4294967295,
10295 _M_dataplus = @{
10296 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10297 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10298 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10299 @},
10300 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10301 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10302 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10303 @}
10304 @}
10305 @end smallexample
10306
10307 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10308
10309 @smallexample
10310 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10311 $2 = "abcd"
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10315 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10316 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10317
10318 @table @code
10319 @kindex info pretty-printer
10320 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10321 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10322 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10323
10324 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10325 whose pretty-printers to list.
10326 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10327 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10328 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10329 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10330 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10331
10332 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10333 to list.
10334
10335 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10336 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10337 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10338 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10339
10340 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10341 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10342 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10343 @end table
10344
10345 Example:
10346
10347 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10348 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10349 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10350 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10351
10352 @smallexample
10353 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10354 library1.so:
10355 foo
10356 library2.so:
10357 bar
10358 bar1
10359 bar2
10360 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10361 library2.so:
10362 bar
10363 bar1
10364 bar2
10365 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10366 1 printer disabled
10367 2 of 3 printers enabled
10368 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10369 library1.so:
10370 foo [disabled]
10371 library2.so:
10372 bar
10373 bar1
10374 bar2
10375 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10376 1 printer disabled
10377 1 of 3 printers enabled
10378 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10379 library1.so:
10380 foo [disabled]
10381 library2.so:
10382 bar
10383 bar1 [disabled]
10384 bar2
10385 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10386 1 printer disabled
10387 0 of 3 printers enabled
10388 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10389 library1.so:
10390 foo [disabled]
10391 library2.so:
10392 bar [disabled]
10393 bar1 [disabled]
10394 bar2
10395 @end smallexample
10396
10397 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10398 as can each individual subprinter.
10399
10400 @node Value History
10401 @section Value History
10402
10403 @cindex value history
10404 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10405 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10406 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10407 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10408 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10409 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10410 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10411 symbol table.
10412
10413 @cindex @code{$}
10414 @cindex @code{$$}
10415 @cindex history number
10416 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10417 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10418 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10419 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10420 history number.
10421
10422 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10423 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10424 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10425 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10426 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10427 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10428 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10429
10430 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10431 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10432
10433 @smallexample
10434 p *$
10435 @end smallexample
10436
10437 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10438 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10439
10440 @smallexample
10441 p *$.next
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 @noindent
10445 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10446 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10447
10448 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10449 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10450
10451 @smallexample
10452 print x
10453 set x=5
10454 @end smallexample
10455
10456 @noindent
10457 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10458 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10459
10460 @table @code
10461 @kindex show values
10462 @item show values
10463 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10464 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10465 values} does not change the history.
10466
10467 @item show values @var{n}
10468 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10469
10470 @item show values +
10471 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10472 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10473 @end table
10474
10475 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10476 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10477
10478 @node Convenience Vars
10479 @section Convenience Variables
10480
10481 @cindex convenience variables
10482 @cindex user-defined variables
10483 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10484 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10485 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10486 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10487 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10488
10489 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10490 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10491 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10492 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10493 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10494
10495 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10496 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10497 For example:
10498
10499 @smallexample
10500 set $foo = *object_ptr
10501 @end smallexample
10502
10503 @noindent
10504 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10505 @code{object_ptr}.
10506
10507 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10508 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10509 value with another assignment at any time.
10510
10511 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10512 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10513 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10514 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10515
10516 @table @code
10517 @kindex show convenience
10518 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10519 @item show convenience
10520 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10521 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10522 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10523
10524 @kindex init-if-undefined
10525 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10526 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10527 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10528 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10529 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10530 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10531 override default values used in a command script.
10532
10533 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10534 any side-effects do not occur.
10535 @end table
10536
10537 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10538 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10539 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10540
10541 @smallexample
10542 set $i = 0
10543 print bar[$i++]->contents
10544 @end smallexample
10545
10546 @noindent
10547 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10548
10549 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10550 values likely to be useful.
10551
10552 @table @code
10553 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10554 @item $_
10555 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10556 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10557 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10558 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10559 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10560 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10561 to the type of @code{$__}.
10562
10563 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10564 @item $__
10565 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10566 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10567 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10568
10569 @item $_exitcode
10570 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10571 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10572 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10573 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10574
10575 @item $_exitsignal
10576 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10577 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10578 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10579 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10580
10581 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10582 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10583 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10584 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10585 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10586
10587 @smallexample
10588 #include <signal.h>
10589
10590 int
10591 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10592 @{
10593 raise (SIGALRM);
10594 return 0;
10595 @}
10596 @end smallexample
10597
10598 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10599 or signalled would be:
10600
10601 @smallexample
10602 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10603 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10604 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10605 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10606 >echo The program has exited\n
10607 >else
10608 >echo The program has signalled\n
10609 >end
10610 >end
10611 (@value{GDBP}) run
10612 Starting program:
10613
10614 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10615 The program no longer exists.
10616 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10617 The program has signalled
10618 @end smallexample
10619
10620 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10621 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10622 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10623 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10624
10625 @smallexample
10626 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10627 The program has exited
10628 @end smallexample
10629
10630 @item $_exception
10631 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10632 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10633
10634 @item $_probe_argc
10635 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10636 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10637
10638 @item $_sdata
10639 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10640 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10641 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10642 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10643 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10644
10645 @item $_siginfo
10646 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10647 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10648 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10649 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10650 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10651
10652 @item $_tlb
10653 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10654 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10655 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10656 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10657 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10658 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10659
10660 @item $_inferior
10661 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10662 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10663
10664 @item $_thread
10665 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10666
10667 @item $_gthread
10668 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10669
10670 @end table
10671
10672 @node Convenience Funs
10673 @section Convenience Functions
10674
10675 @cindex convenience functions
10676 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10677 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10678 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10679 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10680 @value{GDBN}.
10681
10682 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10683 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10684
10685 @table @code
10686
10687 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10688 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10689 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10690 returns zero.
10691
10692 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10693 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10694 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10695 it is @code{void}:
10696
10697 @smallexample
10698 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10699 $1 = void
10700 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10701 $2 = 1
10702 (@value{GDBP}) run
10703 Starting program: ./a.out
10704 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10705 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10706 $3 = 0
10707 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10708 $4 = 0
10709 @end smallexample
10710
10711 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10712 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10713 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10714 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10715 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10716 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10717 anymore.
10718
10719 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10720 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10721
10722 @smallexample
10723 void
10724 foo (void)
10725 @{
10726 @}
10727 @end smallexample
10728
10729 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10730
10731 @smallexample
10732 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10733 $1 = void
10734 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10735 $2 = 1
10736 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10737 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10738 $3 = void
10739 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10740 $4 = 1
10741 @end smallexample
10742
10743 @end table
10744
10745 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10746 @code{Python} support.
10747
10748 @table @code
10749
10750 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10751 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10752 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10753 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10754 Otherwise it returns zero.
10755
10756 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10757 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10758 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10759 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10760 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10761 regular expression support.
10762
10763 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10764 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10765 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10766 Otherwise it returns zero.
10767
10768 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10769 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10770 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10771
10772 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10773 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10774 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10775 Otherwise it returns zero.
10776
10777 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10778 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10779 The default is 1.
10780
10781 Example:
10782
10783 @smallexample
10784 (gdb) backtrace
10785 #0 bottom_func ()
10786 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10787 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10788 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10789 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10790 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10791 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10792 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10793 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10794 $1 = 1
10795 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10796 $1 = 1
10797 @end smallexample
10798
10799 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10800 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10801 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10802 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10803
10804 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10805 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10806 The default is 1.
10807
10808 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10809 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10810 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10811 Otherwise it returns zero.
10812
10813 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10814 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10815 The default is 1.
10816
10817 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10818 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10819 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10820 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10821
10822 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10823 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10824 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10825 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10826
10827 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10828 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10829 The default is 1.
10830
10831 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10832 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10833 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10834 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10835
10836 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10837 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10838 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10839
10840 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10841 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10842 an enumerated type:
10843
10844 @smallexample
10845 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10846 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10847 @end smallexample
10848
10849 @end table
10850
10851 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10852 convenience functions.
10853
10854 @table @code
10855 @item help function
10856 @kindex help function
10857 @cindex show all convenience functions
10858 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10859 @end table
10860
10861 @node Registers
10862 @section Registers
10863
10864 @cindex registers
10865 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10866 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10867 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10868 your machine.
10869
10870 @table @code
10871 @kindex info registers
10872 @item info registers
10873 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10874 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10875
10876 @kindex info all-registers
10877 @cindex floating point registers
10878 @item info all-registers
10879 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10880 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10881
10882 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10883 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10884 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10885 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10886 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10887 @end table
10888
10889 @anchor{standard registers}
10890 @cindex stack pointer register
10891 @cindex program counter register
10892 @cindex process status register
10893 @cindex frame pointer register
10894 @cindex standard registers
10895 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10896 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10897 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10898 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10899 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10900 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10901 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10902 you could print the program counter in hex with
10903
10904 @smallexample
10905 p/x $pc
10906 @end smallexample
10907
10908 @noindent
10909 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10910
10911 @smallexample
10912 x/i $pc
10913 @end smallexample
10914
10915 @noindent
10916 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10917 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10918 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10919 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10920 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10921 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10922 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10923
10924 @smallexample
10925 set $sp += 4
10926 @end smallexample
10927
10928 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10929 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10930 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10931 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10932 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10933 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10934 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10935
10936 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10937 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10938 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10939 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10940 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10941 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10942 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10943
10944 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10945 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10946 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10947 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10948 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10949 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10950 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10951 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10952 prints the data in both formats.
10953
10954 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10955 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10956 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10957 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10958 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10959 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10960 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10961
10962 @smallexample
10963 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10964 $1 = @{
10965 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10966 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10967 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10968 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10969 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10970 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10971 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10972 @}
10973 @end smallexample
10974
10975 @noindent
10976 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10977 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10978 value to a @code{struct} member:
10979
10980 @smallexample
10981 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10982 @end smallexample
10983
10984 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10985 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10986 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10987 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10988 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10989 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10990
10991 @cindex caller-saved registers
10992 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10993 @cindex volatile registers
10994 @cindex <not saved> values
10995 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10996 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10997 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10998 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10999 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11000 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11001 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11002 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11003 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11004 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11005 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11006 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11007 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11008 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11009 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11010 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11011 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11012 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11013 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11014 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11015 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11016 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11017 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11018
11019 @node Floating Point Hardware
11020 @section Floating Point Hardware
11021 @cindex floating point
11022
11023 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11024 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11025
11026 @table @code
11027 @kindex info float
11028 @item info float
11029 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11030 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11031 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11032 the ARM and x86 machines.
11033 @end table
11034
11035 @node Vector Unit
11036 @section Vector Unit
11037 @cindex vector unit
11038
11039 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11040 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11041
11042 @table @code
11043 @kindex info vector
11044 @item info vector
11045 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11046 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11047 @end table
11048
11049 @node OS Information
11050 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11051 @cindex OS information
11052
11053 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11054 you debug your program.
11055
11056 @cindex auxiliary vector
11057 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11058 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11059 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11060 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11061 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11062 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11063 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11064 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11065 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11066 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11067 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11068 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11069
11070 @table @code
11071 @kindex info auxv
11072 @item info auxv
11073 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11074 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11075 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11076 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11077 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11078 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11079 an unrecognized tag.
11080 @end table
11081
11082 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11083 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11084 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11085 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11086 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11087 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11088 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11089
11090 @table @code
11091 @kindex info os
11092 @item info os @var{infotype}
11093
11094 Display OS information of the requested type.
11095
11096 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11097
11098 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11099 @table @code
11100 @kindex info os cpus
11101 @item cpus
11102 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11103 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11104 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11105 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11106 kernel initialization.
11107
11108 @kindex info os files
11109 @item files
11110 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11111 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11112 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11113 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11114
11115 @kindex info os modules
11116 @item modules
11117 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11118 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11119 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11120 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11121 in memory.
11122
11123 @kindex info os msg
11124 @item msg
11125 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11126 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11127 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11128 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11129 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11130 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11131 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11132 the message queue was last changed.
11133
11134 @kindex info os processes
11135 @item processes
11136 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11137 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11138 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11139 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11140 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11141 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11142
11143 @kindex info os procgroups
11144 @item procgroups
11145 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11146 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11147 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11148 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11149 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11150 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11151 and the process group leader is listed first.
11152
11153 @kindex info os semaphores
11154 @item semaphores
11155 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11156 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11157 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11158 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11159 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11160
11161 @kindex info os shm
11162 @item shm
11163 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11164 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11165 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11166 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11167 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11168 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11169 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11170
11171 @kindex info os sockets
11172 @item sockets
11173 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11174 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11175 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11176 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11177 connection.
11178
11179 @kindex info os threads
11180 @item threads
11181 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11182 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11183 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11184 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11185 process is not listed.
11186 @end table
11187
11188 @item info os
11189 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11190 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11191 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11192 types, this command will report an error.
11193 @end table
11194
11195 @node Memory Region Attributes
11196 @section Memory Region Attributes
11197 @cindex memory region attributes
11198
11199 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11200 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11201 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11202 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11203 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11204 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11205 user can override the fetched regions.
11206
11207 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11208 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11209 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11210 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11211 all memory.
11212
11213 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11214 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11215
11216 @table @code
11217 @kindex mem
11218 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11219 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11220 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11221 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11222 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11223 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11224
11225 @item mem auto
11226 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11227 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11228
11229 @kindex delete mem
11230 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11231 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11232 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11233
11234 @kindex disable mem
11235 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11236 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11237 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11238 It may be enabled again later.
11239
11240 @kindex enable mem
11241 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11242 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11243
11244 @kindex info mem
11245 @item info mem
11246 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11247 for each region:
11248
11249 @table @emph
11250 @item Memory Region Number
11251 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11252 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11253 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11254
11255 @item Lo Address
11256 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11257
11258 @item Hi Address
11259 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11260
11261 @item Attributes
11262 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11263 @end table
11264 @end table
11265
11266
11267 @subsection Attributes
11268
11269 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11270 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11271 write accesses to a memory region.
11272
11273 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11274 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11275 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11276
11277 @table @code
11278 @item ro
11279 Memory is read only.
11280 @item wo
11281 Memory is write only.
11282 @item rw
11283 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11284 @end table
11285
11286 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11287 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11288 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11289 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11290 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11291
11292 @table @code
11293 @item 8
11294 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11295 @item 16
11296 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11297 @item 32
11298 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11299 @item 64
11300 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11301 @end table
11302
11303 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11304 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11305 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11306 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11307 @c
11308 @c @table @code
11309 @c @item hwbreak
11310 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11311 @c @item swbreak (default)
11312 @c @end table
11313
11314 @subsubsection Data Cache
11315 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11316 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11317 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11318 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11319 registers.
11320
11321 @table @code
11322 @item cache
11323 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11324 @item nocache
11325 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11326 @end table
11327
11328 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11329 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11330 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11331 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11332 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11333
11334 @table @code
11335 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11336 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11337 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11338 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11339 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11340 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11341 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11342 The default value is @code{on}.
11343 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11344 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11345 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11346 @end table
11347
11348
11349 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11350 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11351 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11352 @c
11353 @c @table @code
11354 @c @item verify
11355 @c @item noverify (default)
11356 @c @end table
11357
11358 @node Dump/Restore Files
11359 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11360 @cindex dump/restore files
11361 @cindex append data to a file
11362 @cindex dump data to a file
11363 @cindex restore data from a file
11364
11365 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11366 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11367 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11368 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11369 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11370 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11371 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11372
11373 @table @code
11374
11375 @kindex dump
11376 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11377 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11378 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11379 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11380
11381 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11382 @table @code
11383 @item binary
11384 Raw binary form.
11385 @item ihex
11386 Intel hex format.
11387 @item srec
11388 Motorola S-record format.
11389 @item tekhex
11390 Tektronix Hex format.
11391 @item verilog
11392 Verilog Hex format.
11393 @end table
11394
11395 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11396 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11397 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11398 form.
11399
11400 @kindex append
11401 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11402 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11403 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11404 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11405 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11406
11407 @kindex restore
11408 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11409 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11410 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11411 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11412 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11413
11414 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11415 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11416 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11417 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11418 from that location.
11419
11420 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11421 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11422 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11423 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11424
11425 @end table
11426
11427 @node Core File Generation
11428 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11429 @cindex dump core from inferior
11430
11431 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11432 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11433 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11434 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11435 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11436 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11437 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11438
11439 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11440 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11441 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11442
11443 @table @code
11444 @kindex gcore
11445 @kindex generate-core-file
11446 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11447 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11448 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11449 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11450 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11451 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11452
11453 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11454 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11455
11456 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11457 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11458 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11459
11460 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11461 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11462 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11463 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11464 Enable or disable the use of the file
11465 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11466 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11467 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11468 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11469
11470 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11471 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11472 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11473 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11474 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11475 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11476 about the bits that can be set in the
11477 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11478 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11479
11480 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11481 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11482 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11483 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11484 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11485 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11486 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11487 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11488 @end table
11489
11490 @node Character Sets
11491 @section Character Sets
11492 @cindex character sets
11493 @cindex charset
11494 @cindex translating between character sets
11495 @cindex host character set
11496 @cindex target character set
11497
11498 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11499 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11500 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11501 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11502 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11503 @dfn{target character set}.
11504
11505 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11506 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11507 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11508 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11509 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11510 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11511 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11512 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11513 character and string literals in expressions.
11514
11515 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11516 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11517 target-charset} command, described below.
11518
11519 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11520 support:
11521
11522 @table @code
11523 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11524 @kindex set target-charset
11525 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11526 list of supported target character sets, type
11527 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11528
11529 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11530 @kindex set host-charset
11531 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11532
11533 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11534 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11535 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11536 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11537 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11538
11539 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11540 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11541 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11542
11543 @item set charset @var{charset}
11544 @kindex set charset
11545 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11546 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11547 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11548 for both host and target.
11549
11550 @item show charset
11551 @kindex show charset
11552 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11553
11554 @item show host-charset
11555 @kindex show host-charset
11556 Show the name of the current host character set.
11557
11558 @item show target-charset
11559 @kindex show target-charset
11560 Show the name of the current target character set.
11561
11562 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11563 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11564 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11565 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11566 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11567 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11568
11569 @item show target-wide-charset
11570 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11571 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11572 @end table
11573
11574 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11575 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11576 @file{charset-test.c}:
11577
11578 @smallexample
11579 #include <stdio.h>
11580
11581 char ascii_hello[]
11582 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11583 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11584 char ibm1047_hello[]
11585 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11586 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11587
11588 main ()
11589 @{
11590 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11591 @}
11592 @end smallexample
11593
11594 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11595 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11596 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11597
11598 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11599
11600 @smallexample
11601 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11602 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11603 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11604 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11605 @dots{}
11606 (@value{GDBP})
11607 @end smallexample
11608
11609 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11610 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11611 strings:
11612
11613 @smallexample
11614 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11615 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11616 (@value{GDBP})
11617 @end smallexample
11618
11619 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11620 initial character set:
11621 @smallexample
11622 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11623 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11624 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11625 (@value{GDBP})
11626 @end smallexample
11627
11628 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11629 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11630 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11631 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11632 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11633
11634 @smallexample
11635 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11636 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11637 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11638 $2 = 72 'H'
11639 (@value{GDBP})
11640 @end smallexample
11641
11642 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11643 literals you use in expressions:
11644
11645 @smallexample
11646 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11647 $3 = 43 '+'
11648 (@value{GDBP})
11649 @end smallexample
11650
11651 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11652 character.
11653
11654 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11655 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11656 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11657
11658 @smallexample
11659 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11660 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11661 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11662 $5 = 200 '\310'
11663 (@value{GDBP})
11664 @end smallexample
11665
11666 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11667 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11668
11669 @smallexample
11670 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11671 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11672 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11676 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11677 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11678 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11679 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11680
11681 @smallexample
11682 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11683 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11684 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11685 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11686 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11687 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11688 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11689 $7 = 72 '\110'
11690 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11691 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11692 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11693 $9 = 200 'H'
11694 (@value{GDBP})
11695 @end smallexample
11696
11697 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11698 string literals you use in expressions:
11699
11700 @smallexample
11701 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11702 $10 = 78 '+'
11703 (@value{GDBP})
11704 @end smallexample
11705
11706 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11707 character.
11708
11709 @node Caching Target Data
11710 @section Caching Data of Targets
11711 @cindex caching data of targets
11712
11713 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11714 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11715 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11716 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11717 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11718 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11719 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11720 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11721 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11722 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11723 is executing.
11724 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11725 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11726 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11727 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11728 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11729 in the code segment.
11730 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11731 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11732
11733 @table @code
11734 @kindex set remotecache
11735 @item set remotecache on
11736 @itemx set remotecache off
11737 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11738 with old scripts.
11739
11740 @kindex show remotecache
11741 @item show remotecache
11742 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11743
11744 @kindex set stack-cache
11745 @item set stack-cache on
11746 @itemx set stack-cache off
11747 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11748 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11749
11750 @kindex show stack-cache
11751 @item show stack-cache
11752 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11753
11754 @kindex set code-cache
11755 @item set code-cache on
11756 @itemx set code-cache off
11757 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11758 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11759 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11760
11761 @kindex show code-cache
11762 @item show code-cache
11763 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11764 accesses.
11765
11766 @kindex info dcache
11767 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11768 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11769 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11770 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11771 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11772 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11773
11774 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11775 printed in hex.
11776
11777 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11778 @cindex dcache size
11779 @kindex set dcache size
11780 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11781
11782 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11783 @cindex dcache line-size
11784 @kindex set dcache line-size
11785 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11786 Must be a power of 2.
11787
11788 @item show dcache size
11789 @kindex show dcache size
11790 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11791
11792 @item show dcache line-size
11793 @kindex show dcache line-size
11794 Show default size of dcache lines.
11795
11796 @end table
11797
11798 @node Searching Memory
11799 @section Search Memory
11800 @cindex searching memory
11801
11802 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11803 @code{find} command.
11804
11805 @table @code
11806 @kindex find
11807 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11808 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11809 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11810 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11811 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11812 @end table
11813
11814 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11815 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11816
11817 @table @r
11818 @item @var{s}, search query size
11819 The size of each search query value.
11820
11821 @table @code
11822 @item b
11823 bytes
11824 @item h
11825 halfwords (two bytes)
11826 @item w
11827 words (four bytes)
11828 @item g
11829 giant words (eight bytes)
11830 @end table
11831
11832 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11833 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11834 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11835
11836 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11837 value's type in the current language.
11838 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11839 pattern as a mixture of types.
11840 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11841 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11842 which is typically four bytes.
11843
11844 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11845 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11846 @end table
11847
11848 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11849 (@code{"}).
11850 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11851 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11852
11853 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11854 number of matches found.
11855
11856 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11857 @samp{$_}.
11858 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11859
11860 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11861
11862 @smallexample
11863 void
11864 hello ()
11865 @{
11866 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11867 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11868 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11869 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11870 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11871 @}
11872 @end smallexample
11873
11874 @noindent
11875 you get during debugging:
11876
11877 @smallexample
11878 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11879 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11880 1 pattern found
11881 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11882 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11883 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11884 2 patterns found
11885 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11886 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11887 1 pattern found
11888 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11889 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11890 1 pattern found
11891 (gdb) print $numfound
11892 $1 = 1
11893 (gdb) print $_
11894 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11895 @end smallexample
11896
11897 @node Value Sizes
11898 @section Value Sizes
11899
11900 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11901 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11902 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11903 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11904 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11905
11906 @table @code
11907 @kindex set max-value-size
11908 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11909 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11910 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11911 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11912 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11913
11914 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11915 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11916
11917 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11918 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11919 currently 16 bytes.
11920
11921 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11922 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11923 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11924 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11925 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11926 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11927 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11928 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11929
11930 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11931
11932 @kindex show max-value-size
11933 @item show max-value-size
11934 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11935 allocate for the contents of a value.
11936 @end table
11937
11938 @node Optimized Code
11939 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11940 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11941 @cindex debugging optimized code
11942
11943 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11944 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11945 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11946 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11947 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11948 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11949 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11950
11951 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11952 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11953 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11954 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11955
11956 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11957 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11958 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11959 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11960 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11961 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11962
11963 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11964 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11965 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11966 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11967 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11968
11969 @menu
11970 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11971 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11972 @end menu
11973
11974 @node Inline Functions
11975 @section Inline Functions
11976 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11977
11978 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11979 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11980 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11981 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11982 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11983 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11984 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11985 @code{info frame} command.
11986
11987 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11988 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11989 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11990 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11991 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11992 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11993 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11994 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11995 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11996 local variables in the caller.
11997
11998 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11999 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12000 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12001 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12002 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12003 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12004 instructions are executed.
12005
12006 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12007 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12008 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12009 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12010
12011 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12012 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12013
12014 @itemize @bullet
12015 @item
12016 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12017 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12018 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12019 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12020 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12021 or inside the inlined function instead.
12022
12023 @item
12024 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12025 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12026 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12027 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12028
12029 @end itemize
12030
12031 @node Tail Call Frames
12032 @section Tail Call Frames
12033 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12034
12035 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12036 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12037 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12038 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12039 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12040
12041 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12042 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12043 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12044 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12045 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12046 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12047 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12048
12049 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12050 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12051 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12052 this information.
12053
12054 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12055 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12056
12057 @smallexample
12058 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12059 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12060 (gdb) info frame
12061 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12062 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12063 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12064 source language c++.
12065 Arglist at unknown address.
12066 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12067 @end smallexample
12068
12069 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12070 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12071 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12072 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12073 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12074 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12075
12076 @table @code
12077 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12078 @item set debug entry-values
12079 @kindex set debug entry-values
12080 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12081 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12082 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12083 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12084 result.
12085
12086 @item show debug entry-values
12087 @kindex show debug entry-values
12088 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12089 values at function entry and tail calls.
12090 @end table
12091
12092 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12093 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12094 reference by variable @code{x}):
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12098 void (*x) (void) = c;
12099 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12100 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12101 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12102
12103 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12104 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12105 a () at t.c:3
12106 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12107 (gdb) bt
12108 #0 a () at t.c:3
12109 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12110 @end smallexample
12111
12112 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12113
12114 @smallexample
12115 int i;
12116 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12117 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12118 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12119 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12120 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12121 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12122 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12123 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12124
12125 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12126 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12127 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12128 (gdb) bt
12129 #0 f () at t.c:2
12130 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12131 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12132 @end smallexample
12133
12134 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12135 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12136
12137 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12138 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12139 @set ARROW @click{}
12140 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12141 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12142 @end ifset
12143 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12144 @set ARROW ->
12145 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12146 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12147 @end ifclear
12148
12149 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12150 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12151 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12152
12153 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12154 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12155 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12156 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12157 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12158 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12159
12160 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12161 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12162 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12163 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12164 omitted.
12165
12166 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12167 entry may fail:
12168
12169 @smallexample
12170 int v;
12171 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12172 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12173 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12174 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12175 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12176 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12177
12178 (gdb) bt
12179 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12180 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12181 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12182 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12183 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12184 @end smallexample
12185
12186 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12187 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12188 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12189 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12190 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12191
12192 @node Macros
12193 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12194
12195 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12196 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12197 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12198 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12199 where it was defined.
12200
12201 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12202 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12203 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12204 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12205
12206 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12207 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12208 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12209 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12210 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12211 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12212 see @ref{List}.
12213
12214 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12215 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12216 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12217
12218 @table @code
12219
12220 @kindex macro expand
12221 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12222 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12223 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12224 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12225 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12226 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12227 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12228 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12229 it can be any string of tokens.
12230
12231 @kindex macro exp1
12232 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12233 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12234 @cindex expand macro once
12235 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12236 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12237 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12238 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12239 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12240 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12241 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12242 can be any string of tokens.
12243
12244 @kindex info macro
12245 @cindex macro definition, showing
12246 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12247 @cindex macros, from debug info
12248 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12249 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12250 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12251 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12252 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12253 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12254
12255 @kindex info macros
12256 @item info macros @var{location}
12257 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12258 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12259 command-line where those definitions were established.
12260
12261 @kindex macro define
12262 @cindex user-defined macros
12263 @cindex defining macros interactively
12264 @cindex macros, user-defined
12265 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12266 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12267 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12268 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12269 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12270 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12271 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12272 @var{arglist}.
12273
12274 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12275 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12276 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12277 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12278 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12279
12280 @kindex macro undef
12281 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12282 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12283 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12284 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12285 in the program being debugged.
12286
12287 @kindex macro list
12288 @item macro list
12289 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12290 @end table
12291
12292 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12293 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12294 show our source files:
12295
12296 @smallexample
12297 $ cat sample.c
12298 #include <stdio.h>
12299 #include "sample.h"
12300
12301 #define M 42
12302 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12303
12304 main ()
12305 @{
12306 #define N 28
12307 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12308 #undef N
12309 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12310 #define N 1729
12311 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12312 @}
12313 $ cat sample.h
12314 #define Q <
12315 $
12316 @end smallexample
12317
12318 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12319 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12320 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12321 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12322 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12323 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12324 information.
12325
12326 @smallexample
12327 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12328 $
12329 @end smallexample
12330
12331 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12332
12333 @smallexample
12334 $ gdb -nw sample
12335 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12336 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12337 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12338 (@value{GDBP})
12339 @end smallexample
12340
12341 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12342 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12343 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12344
12345 @smallexample
12346 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12347 3
12348 4 #define M 42
12349 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12350 6
12351 7 main ()
12352 8 @{
12353 9 #define N 28
12354 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12355 11 #undef N
12356 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12357 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12358 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12359 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12360 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12361 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12362 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12363 #define Q <
12364 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12365 expands to: (42 + 1)
12366 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12367 expands to: once (M + 1)
12368 (@value{GDBP})
12369 @end smallexample
12370
12371 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12372 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12373 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12374 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12375
12376 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12377 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12378
12379 @smallexample
12380 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12381 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12382 (@value{GDBP}) run
12383 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12384
12385 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12386 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12387 (@value{GDBP})
12388 @end smallexample
12389
12390 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12391
12392 @smallexample
12393 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12394 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12395 #define N 28
12396 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12397 expands to: 28 < 42
12398 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12399 $1 = 1
12400 (@value{GDBP})
12401 @end smallexample
12402
12403 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12404 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12405 thereof) in force at each point:
12406
12407 @smallexample
12408 (@value{GDBP}) next
12409 Hello, world!
12410 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12411 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12412 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12413 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12414 (@value{GDBP}) next
12415 We're so creative.
12416 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12417 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12418 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12419 #define N 1729
12420 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12421 expands to: 1729 < 42
12422 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12423 $2 = 0
12424 (@value{GDBP})
12425 @end smallexample
12426
12427 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12428 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12429 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12430 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12431
12432 @smallexample
12433 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12434 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12435 -D__STDC__=1
12436 (@value{GDBP})
12437 @end smallexample
12438
12439
12440 @node Tracepoints
12441 @chapter Tracepoints
12442 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12443 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12444
12445 @cindex tracepoints
12446 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12447 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12448 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12449 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12450 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12451 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12452 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12453
12454 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12455 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12456 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12457 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12458 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12459 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12460 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12461 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12462 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12463 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12464 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12465
12466 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12467 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12468 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12469 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12470 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12471 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12472 Packets}.
12473
12474 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12475 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12476 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12477
12478 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12479
12480 @menu
12481 * Set Tracepoints::
12482 * Analyze Collected Data::
12483 * Tracepoint Variables::
12484 * Trace Files::
12485 @end menu
12486
12487 @node Set Tracepoints
12488 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12489
12490 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12491 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12492 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12493 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12494 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12495 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12496 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12497
12498 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12499 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12500 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12501 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12502 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12503 tracepoint was hit.
12504
12505 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12506 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12507 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12508 either.
12509
12510 @cindex fast tracepoints
12511 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12512 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12513 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12514
12515 @cindex static tracepoints
12516 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12517 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12518 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12519 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12520 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12521 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12522 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12523 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12524 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12525 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12526 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12527 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12528 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12529 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12530 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12531 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12532 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12533 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12534 static tracepoint marker.
12535
12536 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12537 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12538
12539 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12540 conditions and actions.
12541
12542 @menu
12543 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12544 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12545 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12546 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12547 * Trace State Variables::
12548 * Tracepoint Actions::
12549 * Listing Tracepoints::
12550 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12551 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12552 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12553 @end menu
12554
12555 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12556 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12557
12558 @table @code
12559 @cindex set tracepoint
12560 @kindex trace
12561 @item trace @var{location}
12562 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12563 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12564 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12565 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12566 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12567 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12568 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12569 in tracing}).
12570 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12571 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12572 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12573 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12574 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12575 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12576 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12577 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12578 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12579 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12580 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12581 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12582
12583 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12584
12585 @smallexample
12586 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12587
12588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12589
12590 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12591
12592 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12593
12594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12595 @end smallexample
12596
12597 @noindent
12598 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12599
12600 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12601 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12602 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12603 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12604 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12605 information on tracepoint conditions.
12606
12607 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12608 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12609 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12610 @kindex ftrace
12611 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12612 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12613 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12614 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12615 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12616 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12617 message.
12618
12619 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12620 @code{trace}.
12621
12622 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12623 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12624 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12625 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12626 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12627 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12628 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12629 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12630
12631 @example
12632 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12633 @end example
12634
12635 @noindent
12636 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12637 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12638
12639 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12640 @cindex set static tracepoint
12641 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12642 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12643 @kindex strace
12644 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12645 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12646 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12647 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12648 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12649
12650 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12651 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12652 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12653 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12654 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12655 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12656 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12657 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12658 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12659 tracing engine:
12660
12661 @smallexample
12662 main ()
12663 @{
12664 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12665 @}
12666 @end smallexample
12667
12668 @noindent
12669 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12670 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12671
12672 @smallexample
12673 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12674 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12675 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12676 Data: "str %s"
12677 [etc...]
12678 @end smallexample
12679
12680 @noindent
12681 so you may probe the marker above with:
12682
12683 @smallexample
12684 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12685 @end smallexample
12686
12687 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12688 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12689 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12690 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12691 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12692 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12693 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12694 the @samp{Data:} field.
12695
12696 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12697 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12698 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12699
12700 @vindex $tpnum
12701 @cindex last tracepoint number
12702 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12703 @cindex tracepoint number
12704 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12705 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12706
12707 @kindex delete tracepoint
12708 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12709 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12710 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12711 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12712 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12713
12714 Examples:
12715
12716 @smallexample
12717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12718
12719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12720 @end smallexample
12721
12722 @noindent
12723 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12724 @end table
12725
12726 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12727 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12728
12729 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12730
12731 @table @code
12732 @kindex disable tracepoint
12733 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12734 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12735 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12736 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12737 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12738 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12739 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12740 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12741 next trace experiment.
12742
12743 @kindex enable tracepoint
12744 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12745 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12746 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12747 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12748 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12749 next time a trace experiment is run.
12750 @end table
12751
12752 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12753 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12754
12755 @table @code
12756 @kindex passcount
12757 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12758 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12759 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12760 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12761 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12762 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12763 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12764 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12765 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12766 user.
12767
12768 Examples:
12769
12770 @smallexample
12771 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12772 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12773
12774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12775 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12777 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12781 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12782 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12783 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12784 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12785 @end smallexample
12786 @end table
12787
12788 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12789 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12790 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12791 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12792
12793 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12794 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12795 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12796 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12797 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12798 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12799 is true.
12800
12801 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12802 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12803 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12804 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12805 just as with breakpoints.
12806
12807 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12808 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12809 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12810 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12811 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12812 accesses, and so forth.
12813
12814 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12815 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12816 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12817 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12818 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12819 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12820 search through.
12821
12822 @smallexample
12823 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12824 @end smallexample
12825
12826 @node Trace State Variables
12827 @subsection Trace State Variables
12828 @cindex trace state variables
12829
12830 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12831 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12832 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12833 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12834 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12835 integers.
12836
12837 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12838 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12839 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12840 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12841
12842 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12843 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12844 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12845 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12846 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12847 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12848 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12849 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12850 variable with the same name.
12851
12852 @table @code
12853
12854 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12855 @kindex tvariable
12856 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12857 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12858 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12859 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12860 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12861 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12862 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12863 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12864 value. The default initial value is 0.
12865
12866 @item info tvariables
12867 @kindex info tvariables
12868 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12869 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12870 currently running.
12871
12872 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12873 @kindex delete tvariable
12874 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12875 are specified.
12876
12877 @end table
12878
12879 @node Tracepoint Actions
12880 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12881
12882 @table @code
12883 @kindex actions
12884 @cindex tracepoint actions
12885 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12886 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12887 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12888 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12889 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12890 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12891 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12892 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12893 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12894 @code{while-stepping}.
12895
12896 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12897 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12898 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12899
12900 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12901 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12902 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12903
12904 @smallexample
12905 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12906
12907 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12908
12909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12910 @end smallexample
12911
12912 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12913 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12914 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12915 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12916 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12917 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12918 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12919 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12920
12921 @smallexample
12922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12923 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12924 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12925 > collect bar,baz
12926 > collect $regs
12927 > while-stepping 12
12928 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12929 > end
12930 end
12931 @end smallexample
12932
12933 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12934 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12935 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12936 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12937 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12938 special arguments are supported:
12939
12940 @table @code
12941 @item $regs
12942 Collect all registers.
12943
12944 @item $args
12945 Collect all function arguments.
12946
12947 @item $locals
12948 Collect all local variables.
12949
12950 @item $_ret
12951 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12952 of a backtrace.
12953
12954 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12955 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12956 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12957 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12958 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12959 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12960
12961 @item $_probe_argc
12962 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12963 tracepoint is located.
12964 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12965
12966 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12967 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12968 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12969 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12970
12971 @item $_sdata
12972 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12973 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12974 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12975 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12976 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12977 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12978 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12979 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12980 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12981
12982 @smallexample
12983 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12984 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12985 @end smallexample
12986
12987 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12988 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12989 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12990 @value{GDBN}.
12991 @end table
12992
12993 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12994 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12995 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12996
12997 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12998 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12999 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13000 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13001 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13002 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13003 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13004 @samp{mystr}.
13005
13006 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13007 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13008
13009 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13010 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13011 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13012 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13013 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13014 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13015 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13016 action were used.
13017
13018 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13019 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13020 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13021 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13022 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13023 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13024
13025 @smallexample
13026 > while-stepping 12
13027 > collect $regs, myglobal
13028 > end
13029 >
13030 @end smallexample
13031
13032 @noindent
13033 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13034 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13035 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13036 @code{stepping}.
13037
13038 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13039 @kindex set default-collect
13040 @cindex default collection action
13041 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13042 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13043 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13044 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13045 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13046 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13047
13048 @item show default-collect
13049 @kindex show default-collect
13050 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13051 tracepoint hit.
13052
13053 @end table
13054
13055 @node Listing Tracepoints
13056 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13057
13058 @table @code
13059 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13060 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13061 @cindex information about tracepoints
13062 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13063 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13064 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13065 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13066 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13067 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13068
13069 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13070 tracing:
13071
13072 @itemize @bullet
13073 @item
13074 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13075
13076 @item
13077 the state about installed on target of each location
13078 @end itemize
13079
13080 @smallexample
13081 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13082 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13083 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13084 while-stepping 20
13085 collect globfoo, $regs
13086 end
13087 collect globfoo2
13088 end
13089 pass count 1200
13090 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13091 collect $eip
13092 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13093 installed on target
13094 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13095 installed on target
13096 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13097 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13098 not installed on target
13099 (@value{GDBP})
13100 @end smallexample
13101
13102 @noindent
13103 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13104 @end table
13105
13106 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13107 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13108
13109 @table @code
13110 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13111 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13112 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13113 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13114 program.
13115
13116 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13117
13118 @table @emph
13119 @item Count
13120 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13121 stable identifier.
13122 @item ID
13123 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13124 @item Enabled or Disabled
13125 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13126 that are not enabled.
13127 @item Address
13128 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13129 @item What
13130 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13131 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13132 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13133 will be left blank.
13134 @end table
13135
13136 @noindent
13137 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13138
13139 @table @emph
13140 @item Data
13141 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13142 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13143 marker call.
13144 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13145 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13146 @end table
13147
13148 @smallexample
13149 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13150 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13151 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13152 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13153 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13154 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13155 Data: str %s
13156 (@value{GDBP})
13157 @end smallexample
13158 @end table
13159
13160 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13161 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13162
13163 @table @code
13164 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13165 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13166 @cindex collected data discarded
13167 @item tstart
13168 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13169 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13170 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13171 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13172 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13173 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13174 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13175 information, and so forth.
13176
13177 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13178 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13179 @item tstop
13180 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13181 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13182 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13183 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13184 needs to be stopped quickly.
13185
13186 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13187 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13188 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13189
13190 @kindex tstatus
13191 @cindex status of trace data collection
13192 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13193 @item tstatus
13194 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13195 collection.
13196 @end table
13197
13198 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13199
13200 @smallexample
13201 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13202 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13203 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13204 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13205 > while-stepping 11
13206 > collect $regs
13207 > end
13208 > end
13209 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13210 [time passes @dots{}]
13211 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13212 @end smallexample
13213
13214 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13215 @cindex disconnected tracing
13216 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13217 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13218 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13219 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13220 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13221 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13222 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13223 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13224
13225 @table @code
13226 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13227 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13228 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13229 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13230 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13231 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13232 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13233 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13234
13235 @item show disconnected-tracing
13236 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13237 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13238
13239 @end table
13240
13241 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13242 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13243 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13244 it will continue after reconnection.
13245
13246 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13247 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13248 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13249 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13250 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13251 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13252 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13253 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13254 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13255 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13256
13257 @cindex circular trace buffer
13258 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13259 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13260 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13261 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13262 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13263 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13264 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13265 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13266 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13267 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13268 the next run.
13269
13270 @table @code
13271 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13272 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13273 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13274 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13275 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13276 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13277 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13278
13279 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13280 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13281 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13282 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13283 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13284 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13285
13286 @end table
13287
13288 @table @code
13289 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13290 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13291 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13292 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13293 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13294 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13295 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13296 likes. This is also the default.
13297
13298 @item show trace-buffer-size
13299 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13300 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13301 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13302 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13303 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13304 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13305 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13306 @end table
13307
13308 @table @code
13309 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13310 @kindex set trace-user
13311
13312 @item show trace-user
13313 @kindex show trace-user
13314
13315 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13316 @kindex set trace-notes
13317 Set the trace run's notes.
13318
13319 @item show trace-notes
13320 @kindex show trace-notes
13321 Show the trace run's notes.
13322
13323 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13324 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13325 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13326 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13327 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13328
13329 @item show trace-stop-notes
13330 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13331 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13332
13333 @end table
13334
13335 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13336 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13337
13338 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13339 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13340 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13341 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13342 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13343 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13344 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13345 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13346 mentioned here.
13347
13348 @itemize @bullet
13349
13350 @item
13351 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13352 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13353 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13354 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13355 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13356 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13357 cannot be collected either.
13358
13359 @item
13360 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13361 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13362 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13363 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13364 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13365 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13366 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13367 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13368 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13369 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13370
13371 @item
13372 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13373 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13374 in a misleading way.
13375
13376 @item
13377 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13378 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13379 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13380 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13381 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13382 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13383 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13384 by @code{ptr}.
13385
13386 @item
13387 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13388 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13389 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13390 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13391 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13392 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13393 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13394 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13395 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13396 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13397 invalid address.
13398
13399 @item
13400 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13401 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13402 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13403 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13404 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13405 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13406 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13407 it to zero.
13408
13409 @end itemize
13410
13411 @node Analyze Collected Data
13412 @section Using the Collected Data
13413
13414 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13415 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13416 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13417 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13418 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13419 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13420 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13421 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13422 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13423 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13424 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13425 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13426 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13427 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13428 the buffer will fail.
13429
13430 @menu
13431 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13432 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13433 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13434 @end menu
13435
13436 @node tfind
13437 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13438
13439 @kindex tfind
13440 @cindex select trace snapshot
13441 @cindex find trace snapshot
13442 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13443 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13444 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13445 snapshot is selected.
13446
13447 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13448
13449 @table @code
13450 @item tfind start
13451 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13452 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13453
13454 @item tfind none
13455 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13456
13457 @item tfind end
13458 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13459
13460 @item tfind
13461 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13462 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13463
13464 @item tfind -
13465 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13466 retracing earlier steps.
13467
13468 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13469 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13470 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13471 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13472 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13473
13474 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13475 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13476 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13477 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13478 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13479
13480 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13481 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13482 addresses (exclusive).
13483
13484 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13485 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13486 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13487
13488 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13489 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13490 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13491 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13492 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13493 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13494 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13495 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13496 @end table
13497
13498 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13499 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13500 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13501 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13502 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13503 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13504 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13505 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13506 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13507 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13508 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13509 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13510 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13511 tracepoint as the current one.
13512
13513 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13514 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13515 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13516 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13517 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13518
13519 @smallexample
13520 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13521 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13522 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13523 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13524 > tfind
13525 > end
13526
13527 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13528 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13529 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13530 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13531 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13532 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13533 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13534 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13535 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13536 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13537 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13538 @end smallexample
13539
13540 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13541 the buffer:
13542
13543 @smallexample
13544 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13545 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13546 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13547 > tfind line
13548 > end
13549
13550 Frame 0, X = 1
13551 Frame 7, X = 2
13552 Frame 13, X = 255
13553 @end smallexample
13554
13555 @node tdump
13556 @subsection @code{tdump}
13557 @kindex tdump
13558 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13559 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13560
13561 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13562 the current trace snapshot.
13563
13564 @smallexample
13565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13566 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13567 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13568 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13569 > end
13570
13571 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13572
13573 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13574 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13575 at gdb_test.c:444
13576 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13577
13578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13579 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13580 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13581 d1 0x18 24
13582 d2 0x80 128
13583 d3 0x33 51
13584 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13585 d5 0x22 34
13586 d6 0xe0 224
13587 d7 0x380035 3670069
13588 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13589 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13590 a2 0x100 256
13591 a3 0x322000 3284992
13592 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13593 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13594 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13595 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13596 ps 0x0 0
13597 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13598 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13599 fpstatus 0x0 0
13600 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13601 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13602 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13603 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13604 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13605 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13606 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13607 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13608 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13609
13610 (@value{GDBP})
13611 @end smallexample
13612
13613 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13614 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13615 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13616 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13617
13618 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13619 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13620 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13621 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13622 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13623 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13624 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13625 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13626 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13627 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13628
13629 @node save tracepoints
13630 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13631 @kindex save tracepoints
13632 @kindex save-tracepoints
13633 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13634
13635 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13636 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13637 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13638 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13639 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13640 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13641
13642 @node Tracepoint Variables
13643 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13644 @cindex tracepoint variables
13645 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13646
13647 @table @code
13648 @vindex $trace_frame
13649 @item (int) $trace_frame
13650 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13651 snapshot is selected.
13652
13653 @vindex $tracepoint
13654 @item (int) $tracepoint
13655 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13656
13657 @vindex $trace_line
13658 @item (int) $trace_line
13659 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13660
13661 @vindex $trace_file
13662 @item (char []) $trace_file
13663 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13664
13665 @vindex $trace_func
13666 @item (char []) $trace_func
13667 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13668 @end table
13669
13670 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13671 use @code{output} instead.
13672
13673 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13674 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13675 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13676 which are managed by the target.
13677
13678 @smallexample
13679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13680
13681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13682 > output $trace_file
13683 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13684 > tfind
13685 > end
13686 @end smallexample
13687
13688 @node Trace Files
13689 @section Using Trace Files
13690 @cindex trace files
13691
13692 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13693 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13694 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13695 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13696 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13697
13698 @table @code
13699
13700 @kindex tsave
13701 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13702 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13703 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13704 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13705 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13706 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13707 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13708 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13709 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13710 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13711 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13712 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13713 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13714 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13715 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13716
13717 @kindex target tfile
13718 @kindex tfile
13719 @kindex target ctf
13720 @kindex ctf
13721 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13722 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13723 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13724 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13725 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13726 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13727 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13728 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13729 the host.
13730
13731 @smallexample
13732 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13733 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13734 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13735 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13736 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13737 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13738 i = 0
13739 a = 0
13740 b = 1 '\001'
13741 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13742 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13743 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13744 $1 = 1
13745 @end smallexample
13746
13747 @end table
13748
13749 @node Overlays
13750 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13751 @cindex overlays
13752
13753 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13754 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13755 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13756 use overlays.
13757
13758 @menu
13759 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13760 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13761 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13762 mapped by asking the inferior.
13763 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13764 @end menu
13765
13766 @node How Overlays Work
13767 @section How Overlays Work
13768 @cindex mapped overlays
13769 @cindex unmapped overlays
13770 @cindex load address, overlay's
13771 @cindex mapped address
13772 @cindex overlay area
13773
13774 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13775 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13776 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13777 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13778 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13779
13780 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13781 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13782 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13783 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13784 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13785 largest overlay as well.
13786
13787 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13788 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13789 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13790 there.
13791
13792 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13793 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13794 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13795
13796 @smallexample
13797 @group
13798 Data Instruction Larger
13799 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13800 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13801 | | | | | |
13802 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13803 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13804 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13805 | and heap | | | | | |
13806 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13807 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13808 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13809 | | | | | |
13810 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13811 address | | | | | |
13812 | overlay | <-' | | |
13813 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13814 | | <---. | | load address
13815 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13816 | | | |
13817 +-----------+ | |
13818 +-----------+
13819 | |
13820 +-----------+
13821
13822 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13823 @end group
13824 @end smallexample
13825
13826 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13827 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13828 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13829 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13830 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13831 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13832 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13833 program and the overlay area.
13834
13835 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13836 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13837 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13838 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13839 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13840 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13841 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13842
13843 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13844 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13845 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13846
13847 @itemize @bullet
13848
13849 @item
13850 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13851 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13852 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13853 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13854
13855 @item
13856 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13857 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13858 your program's performance.
13859
13860 @item
13861 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13862 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13863 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13864 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13865 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13866 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13867 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13868
13869 @item
13870 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13871 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13872 instruction and data spaces.
13873
13874 @end itemize
13875
13876 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13877 improved in many ways:
13878
13879 @itemize @bullet
13880
13881 @item
13882 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13883 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13884 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13885 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13886 area in the usual way.
13887
13888 @item
13889 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13890 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13891
13892 @item
13893 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13894 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13895 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13896 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13897 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13898 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13899 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13900
13901 @end itemize
13902
13903
13904 @node Overlay Commands
13905 @section Overlay Commands
13906
13907 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13908 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13909 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13910 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13911 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13912 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13913
13914 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13915 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13916
13917 @table @code
13918 @item overlay off
13919 @kindex overlay
13920 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13921 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13922 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13923 overlay support is disabled.
13924
13925 @item overlay manual
13926 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13927 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13928 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13929 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13930 commands described below.
13931
13932 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13933 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13934 @cindex map an overlay
13935 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13936 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13937 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13938 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13939 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13940 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13941
13942 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13943 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13944 @cindex unmap an overlay
13945 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13946 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13947 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13948 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13949
13950 @item overlay auto
13951 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13952 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13953 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13954 Overlay Debugging}.
13955
13956 @item overlay load-target
13957 @itemx overlay load
13958 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13959 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13960 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13961 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13962 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13963 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13964
13965 @item overlay list-overlays
13966 @itemx overlay list
13967 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13968 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13969 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13970
13971 @end table
13972
13973 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13974 of the function the address falls in:
13975
13976 @smallexample
13977 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13978 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13979 @end smallexample
13980 @noindent
13981 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13982 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13983 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13984 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13985
13986 @smallexample
13987 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13988 No sections are mapped.
13989 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13990 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13991 @end smallexample
13992 @noindent
13993 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13994 name normally:
13995
13996 @smallexample
13997 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13998 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13999 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14000 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14001 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14002 @end smallexample
14003
14004 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14005 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14006 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14007 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14008 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14009
14010 @itemize @bullet
14011 @item
14012 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14013 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14014 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14015 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14016 @item
14017 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14018 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14019 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14020 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14021 breakpoints properly.
14022 @end itemize
14023
14024
14025 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14026 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14027 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14028
14029 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14030 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14031 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14032 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14033 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14034 current state of the overlays.
14035
14036 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14037 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14038
14039 @table @asis
14040
14041 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14042 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14043
14044 @smallexample
14045 struct
14046 @{
14047 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14048 unsigned long vma;
14049
14050 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14051 unsigned long size;
14052
14053 /* The overlay's load address. */
14054 unsigned long lma;
14055
14056 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14057 zero otherwise. */
14058 unsigned long mapped;
14059 @}
14060 @end smallexample
14061
14062 @item @code{_novlys}:
14063 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14064 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14065
14066 @end table
14067
14068 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14069 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14070 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14071 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14072 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14073 currently mapped.
14074
14075 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14076 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14077 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14078 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14079 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14080 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14081 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14082 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14083 are not being executed.
14084
14085 @node Overlay Sample Program
14086 @section Overlay Sample Program
14087 @cindex overlay example program
14088
14089 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14090 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14091 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14092 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14093 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14094 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14095 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14096
14097 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14098 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14099 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14100 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14101
14102 @table @file
14103 @item overlays.c
14104 The main program file.
14105 @item ovlymgr.c
14106 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14107 @item foo.c
14108 @itemx bar.c
14109 @itemx baz.c
14110 @itemx grbx.c
14111 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14112 @item d10v.ld
14113 @itemx m32r.ld
14114 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14115 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14116 @end table
14117
14118 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14119 cross-compiler like this:
14120
14121 @smallexample
14122 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14123 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14124 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14125 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14126 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14127 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14128 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14129 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14130 @end smallexample
14131
14132 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14133 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14134 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14135
14136
14137 @node Languages
14138 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14139 @cindex languages
14140
14141 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14142 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14143 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14144 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14145 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14146 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14147
14148 @cindex working language
14149 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14150 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14151 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14152 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14153 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14154 language}.
14155
14156 @menu
14157 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14158 * Show:: Displaying the language
14159 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14160 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14161 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14162 @end menu
14163
14164 @node Setting
14165 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14166
14167 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14168 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14169 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14170 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14171 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14172 are printed, etc.
14173
14174 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14175 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14176 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14177 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14178 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14179 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14180 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14181 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14182 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14183 Displaying the Language}.
14184
14185 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14186 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14187 another language. In that case, make the
14188 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14189 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14190 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14191
14192 @menu
14193 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14194 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14195 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14196 @end menu
14197
14198 @node Filenames
14199 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14200
14201 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14202 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14203
14204 @table @file
14205 @item .ada
14206 @itemx .ads
14207 @itemx .adb
14208 @itemx .a
14209 Ada source file.
14210
14211 @item .c
14212 C source file
14213
14214 @item .C
14215 @itemx .cc
14216 @itemx .cp
14217 @itemx .cpp
14218 @itemx .cxx
14219 @itemx .c++
14220 C@t{++} source file
14221
14222 @item .d
14223 D source file
14224
14225 @item .m
14226 Objective-C source file
14227
14228 @item .f
14229 @itemx .F
14230 Fortran source file
14231
14232 @item .mod
14233 Modula-2 source file
14234
14235 @item .s
14236 @itemx .S
14237 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14238 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14239 @end table
14240
14241 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14242 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14243
14244 @node Manually
14245 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14246
14247 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14248 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14249 your program.
14250
14251 @kindex set language
14252 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14253 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14254 a language, such as
14255 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14256 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14257
14258 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14259 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14260 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14261 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14262 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14263 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14264 command such as:
14265
14266 @smallexample
14267 print a = b + c
14268 @end smallexample
14269
14270 @noindent
14271 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14272 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14273 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14274 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14275
14276 @node Automatically
14277 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14278
14279 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14280 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14281 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14282 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14283 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14284 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14285 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14286 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14287 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14288
14289 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14290 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14291 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14292 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14293 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14294
14295 @node Show
14296 @section Displaying the Language
14297
14298 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14299 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14300
14301 @table @code
14302 @item show language
14303 @anchor{show language}
14304 @kindex show language
14305 Display the current working language. This is the
14306 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14307 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14308
14309 @item info frame
14310 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14311 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14312 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14313 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14314 information listed here.
14315
14316 @item info source
14317 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14318 Display the source language of this source file.
14319 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14320 information listed here.
14321 @end table
14322
14323 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14324 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14325 with a language explicitly:
14326
14327 @table @code
14328 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14329 @kindex set extension-language
14330 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14331 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14332
14333 @item info extensions
14334 @kindex info extensions
14335 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14336 @end table
14337
14338 @node Checks
14339 @section Type and Range Checking
14340
14341 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14342 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14343 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14344 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14345 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14346 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14347 errors when your program is running.
14348
14349 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14350 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14351 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14352 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14353
14354 @menu
14355 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14356 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14357 @end menu
14358
14359 @cindex type checking
14360 @cindex checks, type
14361 @node Type Checking
14362 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14363
14364 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14365 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14366 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14367 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14368
14369 @smallexample
14370 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14371
14372 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14373 $1 = 2
14374 @exdent but
14375 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14376 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14377 @end smallexample
14378
14379 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14380 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14381
14382 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14383 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14384 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14385 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14386 expressions like the second example above.
14387
14388 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14389 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14390 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14391 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14392 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14393 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14394
14395 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14396
14397 @kindex set check type
14398 @kindex show check type
14399 @table @code
14400 @item set check type on
14401 @itemx set check type off
14402 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14403 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14404 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14405
14406 @item show check type
14407 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14408 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14409 @end table
14410
14411 @cindex range checking
14412 @cindex checks, range
14413 @node Range Checking
14414 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14415
14416 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14417 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14418 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14419 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14420 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14421
14422 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14423 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14424 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14425 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14426
14427 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14428 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14429 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14430 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14431 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14432 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14433
14434 @smallexample
14435 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14436 @end smallexample
14437
14438 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14439 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14440 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14441
14442 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14443
14444 @kindex set check range
14445 @kindex show check range
14446 @table @code
14447 @item set check range auto
14448 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14449 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14450 each language.
14451
14452 @item set check range on
14453 @itemx set check range off
14454 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14455 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14456 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14457 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14458
14459 @item set check range warn
14460 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14461 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14462 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14463 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14464 systems).
14465
14466 @item show range
14467 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14468 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14469 @end table
14470
14471 @node Supported Languages
14472 @section Supported Languages
14473
14474 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14475 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14476 @c This is false ...
14477 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14478 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14479 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14480 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14481 language.
14482
14483 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14484 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14485 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14486 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14487 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14488 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14489 language reference or tutorial.
14490
14491 @menu
14492 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14493 * D:: D
14494 * Go:: Go
14495 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14496 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14497 * Fortran:: Fortran
14498 * Pascal:: Pascal
14499 * Rust:: Rust
14500 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14501 * Ada:: Ada
14502 @end menu
14503
14504 @node C
14505 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14506
14507 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14508 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14509
14510 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14511 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14512 together.
14513
14514 @cindex C@t{++}
14515 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14516 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14517 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14518 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14519 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14520 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14521 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14522
14523 @menu
14524 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14525 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14526 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14527 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14528 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14529 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14530 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14531 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14532 @end menu
14533
14534 @node C Operators
14535 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14536
14537 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14538
14539 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14540 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14541 often defined on groups of types.
14542
14543 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14544
14545 @itemize @bullet
14546
14547 @item
14548 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14549 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14550
14551 @item
14552 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14553 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14554
14555 @item
14556 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14557
14558 @item
14559 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14560
14561 @end itemize
14562
14563 @noindent
14564 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14565 in order of increasing precedence:
14566
14567 @table @code
14568 @item ,
14569 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14570 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14571 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14572
14573 @item =
14574 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14575 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14576
14577 @item @var{op}=
14578 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14579 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14580 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14581 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14582 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14583
14584 @item ?:
14585 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14586 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14587 should be of an integral type.
14588
14589 @item ||
14590 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14591
14592 @item &&
14593 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14594
14595 @item |
14596 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14597
14598 @item ^
14599 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14600
14601 @item &
14602 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14603
14604 @item ==@r{, }!=
14605 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14606 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14607
14608 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14609 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14610 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14611 and non-zero for true.
14612
14613 @item <<@r{, }>>
14614 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14615
14616 @item @@
14617 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14618
14619 @item +@r{, }-
14620 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14621 pointer types.
14622
14623 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14624 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14625 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14626 integral types.
14627
14628 @item ++@r{, }--
14629 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14630 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14631 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14632 operation takes place.
14633
14634 @item *
14635 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14636 @code{++}.
14637
14638 @item &
14639 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14640
14641 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14642 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14643 to examine the address
14644 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14645 stored.
14646
14647 @item -
14648 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14649 precedence as @code{++}.
14650
14651 @item !
14652 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14653 @code{++}.
14654
14655 @item ~
14656 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14657 @code{++}.
14658
14659
14660 @item .@r{, }->
14661 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14662 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14663 pointer based on the stored type information.
14664 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14665
14666 @item .*@r{, }->*
14667 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14668
14669 @item []
14670 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14671 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14672
14673 @item ()
14674 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14675
14676 @item ::
14677 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14678 and @code{class} types.
14679
14680 @item ::
14681 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14682 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14683 above.
14684 @end table
14685
14686 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14687 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14688 predefined meaning.
14689
14690 @node C Constants
14691 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14692
14693 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14694
14695 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14696 following ways:
14697
14698 @itemize @bullet
14699 @item
14700 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14701 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14702 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14703 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14704 @code{long} value.
14705
14706 @item
14707 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14708 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14709 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14710 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14711 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14712 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14713 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14714 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14715 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14716 constant.
14717
14718 @item
14719 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14720 integral equivalents.
14721
14722 @item
14723 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14724 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14725 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14726 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14727 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14728 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14729 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14730 @samp{\n} for newline.
14731
14732 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14733 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14734 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14735 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14736
14737 @item
14738 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14739 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14740 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14741 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14742 characters.
14743
14744 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14745 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14746 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14747
14748 @item
14749 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14750 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14751
14752 @item
14753 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14754 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14755 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14756 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14757 @end itemize
14758
14759 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14760 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14761
14762 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14763 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14764
14765 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14766 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14767 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14768 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14769 @quotation
14770 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14771 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14772 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14773 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14774 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14775 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14776 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14777 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14778 @end quotation
14779
14780 @enumerate
14781
14782 @cindex member functions
14783 @item
14784 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14785
14786 @smallexample
14787 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14788 @end smallexample
14789
14790 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14791 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14792 @item
14793 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14794 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14795 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14796 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14797 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14798
14799 @cindex call overloaded functions
14800 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14801 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14802 @item
14803 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14804 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14805 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14806 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14807 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14808 default arguments.
14809
14810 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14811 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14812 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14813 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14814 number of function arguments.
14815
14816 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14817 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14818 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14819
14820 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14821 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14822 @smallexample
14823 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14824 @end smallexample
14825
14826 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14827 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14828
14829 @cindex reference declarations
14830 @item
14831 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14832 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14833 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14834
14835 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14836 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14837 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14838 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14839 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14840
14841 @item
14842 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14843 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14844 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14845 necessary, for example in an expression like
14846 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14847 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14848 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14849
14850 @item
14851 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14852 specification.
14853 @end enumerate
14854
14855 @node C Defaults
14856 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14857
14858 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14859
14860 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14861 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14862 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14863 selects the working language.
14864
14865 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14866 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14867 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14868 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14869 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14870 for further details.
14871
14872 @node C Checks
14873 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14874
14875 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14876
14877 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14878 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14879 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14880 constants to pointers.
14881
14882 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14883 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14884 that is not itself an array.
14885
14886 @node Debugging C
14887 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14888
14889 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14890 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14891 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14892 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14893
14894 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14895 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14896 ,Expressions}.
14897
14898 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14899 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14900
14901 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14902
14903 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14904 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14905
14906 @table @code
14907 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14908 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14909 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14910 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14911 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14912 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14913
14914 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14915 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14916 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14917 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14918 classes.
14919 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14920
14921 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14922 @item catch throw
14923 @itemx catch rethrow
14924 @itemx catch catch
14925 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14926 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14927
14928 @cindex inheritance
14929 @item ptype @var{typename}
14930 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14931 @var{typename}.
14932 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14933
14934 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14935 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14936 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14937 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14938 multiple inheritance is in use.
14939
14940 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14941 @item demangle @var{name}
14942 Demangle @var{name}.
14943 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14944
14945 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14946 @item set print demangle
14947 @itemx show print demangle
14948 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14949 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14950 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14951 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14952 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14953
14954 @item set print object
14955 @itemx show print object
14956 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14957 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14958
14959 @item set print vtbl
14960 @itemx show print vtbl
14961 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14962 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14963 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14964 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14965
14966 @kindex set overload-resolution
14967 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14968 @item set overload-resolution on
14969 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14970 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14971 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14972 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14973 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14974 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14975
14976 @item set overload-resolution off
14977 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14978 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14979 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14980 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14981 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14982 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14983 argument types.
14984
14985 @kindex show overload-resolution
14986 @item show overload-resolution
14987 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14988
14989 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14990 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14991 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14992 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14993 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14994 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14995 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14996 @end table
14997
14998 @node Decimal Floating Point
14999 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15000 @cindex decimal floating point format
15001
15002 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15003 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15004 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15005 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15006
15007 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15008 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15009 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15010 configured target.
15011
15012 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15013 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15014 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15015
15016 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15017 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15018 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15019
15020 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15021 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15022 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15023
15024 @node D
15025 @subsection D
15026
15027 @cindex D
15028 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15029 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15030 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15031
15032 @node Go
15033 @subsection Go
15034
15035 @cindex Go (programming language)
15036 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15037 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15038
15039 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15040
15041 @table @code
15042 @cindex current Go package
15043 @item The current Go package
15044 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15045 specifying global variables and functions.
15046
15047 For example, given the program:
15048
15049 @example
15050 package main
15051 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15052 func main () @{
15053 // ...
15054 @}
15055 @end example
15056
15057 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15058
15059 @example
15060 (gdb) p myglob
15061 (gdb) p main.myglob
15062 @end example
15063
15064 @cindex builtin Go types
15065 @item Builtin Go types
15066 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15067 as a string.
15068
15069 @cindex builtin Go functions
15070 @item Builtin Go functions
15071 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15072 function and handles it internally.
15073
15074 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15075 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15076 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15077 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15078 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15079 @end table
15080
15081 @node Objective-C
15082 @subsection Objective-C
15083
15084 @cindex Objective-C
15085 This section provides information about some commands and command
15086 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15087 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15088 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15089
15090 @menu
15091 * Method Names in Commands::
15092 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15093 @end menu
15094
15095 @node Method Names in Commands
15096 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15097
15098 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15099 names as line specifications:
15100
15101 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15102 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15103 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15104 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15105 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15106 @itemize
15107 @item @code{clear}
15108 @item @code{break}
15109 @item @code{info line}
15110 @item @code{jump}
15111 @item @code{list}
15112 @end itemize
15113
15114 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15115
15116 @smallexample
15117 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15118 @end smallexample
15119
15120 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15121 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15122 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15123 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15124 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15125 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15126 debugged, enter:
15127
15128 @smallexample
15129 break -[Fruit create]
15130 @end smallexample
15131
15132 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15133 enter:
15134
15135 @smallexample
15136 list +[NSText initialize]
15137 @end smallexample
15138
15139 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15140 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15141 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15142 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15143
15144 @smallexample
15145 break create
15146 @end smallexample
15147
15148 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15149 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15150 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15151 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15152 none apply.
15153
15154 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15155 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15156
15157 @smallexample
15158 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15159 @end smallexample
15160
15161 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15162 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15163 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15164 @kindex print-object
15165 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15166
15167 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 print -[@var{object} hash]
15171 @end smallexample
15172
15173 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15174 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15175 @noindent
15176 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15177 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15178 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15179 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15180 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15181 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15182
15183 @node OpenCL C
15184 @subsection OpenCL C
15185
15186 @cindex OpenCL C
15187 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15188
15189 @menu
15190 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15191 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15192 * OpenCL C Operators::
15193 @end menu
15194
15195 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15196 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15197
15198 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15199 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15200 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15201 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15202 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15203
15204 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15205 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15206
15207 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15208 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15209 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15210 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15211
15212 @node OpenCL C Operators
15213 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15214
15215 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15216 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15217 vector data types.
15218
15219 @node Fortran
15220 @subsection Fortran
15221 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15222
15223 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15224 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15225
15226 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15227 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15228 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15229 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15230 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15231 underscore.
15232
15233 @menu
15234 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15235 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15236 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15237 @end menu
15238
15239 @node Fortran Operators
15240 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15241
15242 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15243
15244 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15245 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15246 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15247
15248 @table @code
15249 @item **
15250 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15251 of the second one.
15252
15253 @item :
15254 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15255 represent a section of array.
15256
15257 @item %
15258 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15259 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15260 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15261 union type.
15262 @end table
15263
15264 @node Fortran Defaults
15265 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15266
15267 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15268
15269 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15270 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15271 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15272 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15273
15274 @node Special Fortran Commands
15275 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15276
15277 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15278
15279 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15280 such as displaying common blocks.
15281
15282 @table @code
15283 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15284 @kindex info common
15285 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15286 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15287 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15288 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15289 printed.
15290 @end table
15291
15292 @node Pascal
15293 @subsection Pascal
15294
15295 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15296 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15297 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15298 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15299 syntax.
15300
15301 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15302 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15303 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15304
15305 @node Rust
15306 @subsection Rust
15307
15308 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15309 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15310 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15311 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15312
15313 @itemize @bullet
15314 @item
15315 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15316 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15317 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15318
15319 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15320 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15321 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15322 @samp{B}.
15323
15324 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15325 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15326
15327 @item
15328 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15329 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15330 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15331 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15332 @samp{K::x::y}.
15333
15334 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15335 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15336 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15337 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15338 scope.
15339
15340 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15341 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15342
15343 @item
15344 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15345 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15346
15347 @item
15348 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15349
15350 @item
15351 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15352 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15353 never be destroyed.
15354
15355 @item
15356 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15357 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15358 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15359
15360 @item
15361 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15362 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15363 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15364 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15365 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15366 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15367 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15368 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15369
15370 @item
15371 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15372 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15373 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15374 @itemize @bullet
15375
15376 @item
15377 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15378
15379 @item
15380 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15381
15382 @item
15383 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15384
15385 @item
15386 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15387 type names.
15388
15389 @item
15390 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15391
15392 @item
15393 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15394 available in the crate.
15395 @end itemize
15396 @end itemize
15397
15398 @node Modula-2
15399 @subsection Modula-2
15400
15401 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15402
15403 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15404 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15405 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15406 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15407 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15408 table.
15409
15410 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15411 @menu
15412 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15413 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15414 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15415 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15416 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15417 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15418 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15419 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15420 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15421 @end menu
15422
15423 @node M2 Operators
15424 @subsubsection Operators
15425 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15426
15427 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15428 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15429 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15430 following definitions hold:
15431
15432 @itemize @bullet
15433
15434 @item
15435 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15436 their subranges.
15437
15438 @item
15439 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15440
15441 @item
15442 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15443
15444 @item
15445 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15446 @var{type}}.
15447
15448 @item
15449 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15450
15451 @item
15452 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15453
15454 @item
15455 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15456 @end itemize
15457
15458 @noindent
15459 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15460 increasing precedence:
15461
15462 @table @code
15463 @item ,
15464 Function argument or array index separator.
15465
15466 @item :=
15467 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15468 @var{value}.
15469
15470 @item <@r{, }>
15471 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15472 types.
15473
15474 @item <=@r{, }>=
15475 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15476 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15477 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15478
15479 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15480 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15481 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15482 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15483 comment character.
15484
15485 @item IN
15486 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15487 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15488
15489 @item OR
15490 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15491
15492 @item AND@r{, }&
15493 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15494
15495 @item @@
15496 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15497
15498 @item +@r{, }-
15499 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15500 and difference on set types.
15501
15502 @item *
15503 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15504 on set types.
15505
15506 @item /
15507 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15508 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15509
15510 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15511 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15512 precedence as @code{*}.
15513
15514 @item -
15515 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15516
15517 @item ^
15518 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15519
15520 @item NOT
15521 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15522 @code{^}.
15523
15524 @item .
15525 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15526 precedence as @code{^}.
15527
15528 @item []
15529 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15530
15531 @item ()
15532 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15533 as @code{^}.
15534
15535 @item ::@r{, }.
15536 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15537 @end table
15538
15539 @quotation
15540 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15541 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15542 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15543 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15544 @end quotation
15545
15546
15547 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15548 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15549 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15550
15551 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15552 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15553
15554 @table @var
15555
15556 @item a
15557 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15558
15559 @item c
15560 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15561
15562 @item i
15563 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15564
15565 @item m
15566 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15567 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15568 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15569
15570 @item n
15571 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15572
15573 @item r
15574 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15575
15576 @item t
15577 represents a type.
15578
15579 @item v
15580 represents a variable.
15581
15582 @item x
15583 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15584 explanation of the function for details.
15585 @end table
15586
15587 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15588
15589 @table @code
15590 @item ABS(@var{n})
15591 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15592
15593 @item CAP(@var{c})
15594 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15595 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15596
15597 @item CHR(@var{i})
15598 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15599
15600 @item DEC(@var{v})
15601 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15602
15603 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15604 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15605 new value.
15606
15607 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15608 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15609 set.
15610
15611 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15612 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15613
15614 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15615 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15616
15617 @item INC(@var{v})
15618 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15619
15620 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15621 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15622 new value.
15623
15624 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15625 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15626 there. Returns the new set.
15627
15628 @item MAX(@var{t})
15629 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15630
15631 @item MIN(@var{t})
15632 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15633
15634 @item ODD(@var{i})
15635 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15636
15637 @item ORD(@var{x})
15638 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15639 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15640 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15641 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15642
15643 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15644 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15645 variable or a type.
15646
15647 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15648 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15649
15650 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15651 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15652 variable or a type.
15653
15654 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15655 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15656 @end table
15657
15658 @quotation
15659 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15660 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15661 an error.
15662 @end quotation
15663
15664 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15665 @node M2 Constants
15666 @subsubsection Constants
15667
15668 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15669 ways:
15670
15671 @itemize @bullet
15672
15673 @item
15674 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15675 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15676 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15677 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15678
15679 @item
15680 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15681 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15682 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15683 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15684 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15685 digits.
15686
15687 @item
15688 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15689 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15690 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15691 followed by a @samp{C}.
15692
15693 @item
15694 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15695 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15696 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15697 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15698 sequences.
15699
15700 @item
15701 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15702
15703 @item
15704 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15705 @code{FALSE}.
15706
15707 @item
15708 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15709
15710 @item
15711 Set constants are not yet supported.
15712 @end itemize
15713
15714 @node M2 Types
15715 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15716 @cindex Modula-2 types
15717
15718 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15719 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15720 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15721 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15722 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15723 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15724
15725 The first example contains the following section of code:
15726
15727 @smallexample
15728 VAR
15729 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15730 r: [20..40] ;
15731 @end smallexample
15732
15733 @noindent
15734 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15735 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15736
15737 @smallexample
15738 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15739 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15740 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15741 SET OF CHAR
15742 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15743 21
15744 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15745 [20..40]
15746 @end smallexample
15747
15748 @noindent
15749 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15750
15751 @smallexample
15752 VAR
15753 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15754 @end smallexample
15755
15756 @noindent
15757 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15758
15759 @smallexample
15760 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15761 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15762 @end smallexample
15763
15764 @noindent
15765 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15766 expressions using the debugger.
15767
15768 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15769 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15770
15771 @smallexample
15772 VAR
15773 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15774 @end smallexample
15775
15776 @smallexample
15777 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15778 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15779 @end smallexample
15780
15781 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15782 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15783 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15784 above.
15785
15786 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15787
15788 @smallexample
15789 TYPE
15790 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15791 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15792 VAR
15793 s: t ;
15794 BEGIN
15795 s := blue ;
15796 @end smallexample
15797
15798 @noindent
15799 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15800 and value of a variable.
15801
15802 @smallexample
15803 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15804 $1 = blue
15805 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15806 type = [blue..yellow]
15807 @end smallexample
15808
15809 @noindent
15810 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15811 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15812 their @code{C} counterparts.
15813
15814 @smallexample
15815 VAR
15816 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15817 BEGIN
15818 s[1] := 1 ;
15819 @end smallexample
15820
15821 @smallexample
15822 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15823 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15824 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15825 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15826 @end smallexample
15827
15828 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15829 pointer types as shown in this example:
15830
15831 @smallexample
15832 VAR
15833 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15834 BEGIN
15835 NEW(s) ;
15836 s^[1] := 1 ;
15837 @end smallexample
15838
15839 @noindent
15840 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15841
15842 @smallexample
15843 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15844 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15845 @end smallexample
15846
15847 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15848 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15849 types:
15850
15851 @smallexample
15852 TYPE
15853 foo = RECORD
15854 f1: CARDINAL ;
15855 f2: CHAR ;
15856 f3: myarray ;
15857 END ;
15858
15859 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15860 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15861 VAR
15862 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15863 @end smallexample
15864
15865 @noindent
15866 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15867 below.
15868
15869 @smallexample
15870 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15871 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15872 f1 : CARDINAL;
15873 f2 : CHAR;
15874 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15875 END
15876 @end smallexample
15877
15878 @node M2 Defaults
15879 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15880 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15881
15882 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15883 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15884 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15885 selected the working language.
15886
15887 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15888 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15889 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15890 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15891
15892 @node Deviations
15893 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15894 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15895
15896 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15897 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15898
15899 @itemize @bullet
15900 @item
15901 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15902 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15903 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15904 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15905 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15906 returned a pointer.)
15907
15908 @item
15909 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15910 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15911 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15912 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15913
15914 @item
15915 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15916 argument.
15917
15918 @item
15919 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15920 @end itemize
15921
15922 @node M2 Checks
15923 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15924 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15925
15926 @quotation
15927 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15928 range checking.
15929 @end quotation
15930 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15931
15932 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15933
15934 @itemize @bullet
15935 @item
15936 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15937 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15938
15939 @item
15940 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15941 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15942 @end itemize
15943
15944 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15945 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15946
15947 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15948 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15949
15950 @node M2 Scope
15951 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15952 @cindex scope
15953 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15954 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15955 @ifinfo
15956 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15957 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15958 @end ifinfo
15959 @ifnotinfo
15960 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15961 @end ifnotinfo
15962
15963 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15964 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15965 similar syntax:
15966
15967 @smallexample
15968
15969 @var{module} . @var{id}
15970 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15971 @end smallexample
15972
15973 @noindent
15974 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15975 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15976 identifier within your program, except another module.
15977
15978 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15979 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15980 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15981 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15982
15983 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15984 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15985 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15986 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15987 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15988 @var{module}.
15989
15990 @node GDB/M2
15991 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15992
15993 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15994 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15995 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15996 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15997 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15998 analogue in Modula-2.
15999
16000 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16001 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16002 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16003 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16004 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16005 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16006
16007 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16008 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16009 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16010
16011 @node Ada
16012 @subsection Ada
16013 @cindex Ada
16014
16015 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16016 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16017 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16018 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16019 to be difficult.
16020
16021
16022 @cindex expressions in Ada
16023 @menu
16024 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16025 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16026 in @value{GDBN}.
16027 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16028 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16029 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16030 subprograms.
16031 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16032 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16033 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16034 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16035 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16036 Profile
16037 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16038 @end menu
16039
16040 @node Ada Mode Intro
16041 @subsubsection Introduction
16042 @cindex Ada mode, general
16043
16044 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16045 syntax, with some extensions.
16046 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16047
16048 @itemize @bullet
16049 @item
16050 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16051 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16052 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16053 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16054
16055 @item
16056 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16057 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16058
16059 @item
16060 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16061 @end itemize
16062
16063 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16064 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16065 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16066 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16067 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16068
16069 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16070 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16071 was translated from an Ada source file.
16072
16073 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16074 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16075 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16076 middle (to allow based literals).
16077
16078 @node Omissions from Ada
16079 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16080 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16081
16082 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16083
16084 @itemize @bullet
16085 @item
16086 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16087
16088 @itemize @minus
16089 @item
16090 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16091 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16092
16093 @item
16094 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16095
16096 @item
16097 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16098
16099 @item
16100 @t{'Tag}.
16101
16102 @item
16103 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16104 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16105
16106 @item
16107 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16108 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16109
16110 @item
16111 @t{'Address}.
16112 @end itemize
16113
16114 @item
16115 The names in
16116 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16117 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16118 not currently available.
16119
16120 @item
16121 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16122 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16123 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16124 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16125 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16126 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16127 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16128 indeterminate values.
16129
16130 @item
16131 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16132 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16133 are not implemented.
16134
16135 @item
16136 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16137 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16138 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16139 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16140 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16141
16142 @smallexample
16143 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16144 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16145 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16146 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16147 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16148 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16149 @end smallexample
16150
16151 Changing a
16152 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16153 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16154 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16155 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16156 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16157 declared to have a type such as:
16158
16159 @smallexample
16160 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16161 Id : Integer;
16162 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16163 end record;
16164 @end smallexample
16165
16166 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16167 assignments:
16168
16169 @smallexample
16170 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16171 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16172 @end smallexample
16173
16174 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16175 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16176 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16177 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16178 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16179 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16180 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16181 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16182
16183 @item
16184 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16185
16186 @item
16187 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16188 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16189 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16190 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16191 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16192 the proper resolution.
16193
16194 @item
16195 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16196
16197 @item
16198 Entry calls are not implemented.
16199
16200 @item
16201 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16202 formats are not supported.
16203
16204 @item
16205 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16206
16207 @item
16208 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16209 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16210 context.
16211 Should your program
16212 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16213 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16214 @end itemize
16215
16216 @node Additions to Ada
16217 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16218 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16219
16220 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16221 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16222
16223 @itemize @bullet
16224 @item
16225 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16226 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16227 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16228 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16229 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16230 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16231 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16232 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16233
16234 @item
16235 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16236 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16237 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16238
16239 @item
16240 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16241 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16242
16243 @item
16244 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16245 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16246 @end itemize
16247
16248 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16249 additions specific to Ada:
16250
16251 @itemize @bullet
16252 @item
16253 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16254 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16255
16256 @smallexample
16257 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16258 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16259 @end smallexample
16260
16261 @item
16262 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16263 the value of its right-hand operand.
16264 This allows, for example,
16265 complex conditional breaks:
16266
16267 @smallexample
16268 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16269 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16270 @end smallexample
16271
16272 @item
16273 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16274 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16275 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16276 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16277 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16278 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16279 in strings. For example,
16280 @smallexample
16281 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16282 @end smallexample
16283 @noindent
16284 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16285 after each period.
16286
16287 @item
16288 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16289 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16290 to write
16291
16292 @smallexample
16293 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16294 @end smallexample
16295
16296 @item
16297 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16298 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16299 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16300 of 3 might print as
16301
16302 @smallexample
16303 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16304 @end smallexample
16305
16306 @noindent
16307 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16308 clause.
16309
16310 @item
16311 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16312 multi-character subsequence of
16313 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16314 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16315 in place of @t{a'length}.
16316
16317 @item
16318 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16319 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16320 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16321 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16322 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16323 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16324 For example,
16325 @smallexample
16326 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16327 @end smallexample
16328
16329 @item
16330 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16331 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16332 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16333 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16334 object.
16335
16336 @end itemize
16337
16338 @node Overloading support for Ada
16339 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16340 @cindex overloading, Ada
16341
16342 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16343 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16344 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16345 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16346 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16347 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16348
16349 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16350 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16351 use, for instance:
16352
16353 @smallexample
16354 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16355 Multiple matches for f
16356 [0] cancel
16357 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16358 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16359 >
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16363 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16364 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16365
16366 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16367 case:
16368
16369 @table @code
16370
16371 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16372 @item set ada print-signatures
16373 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16374 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16375 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16376
16377 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16378 @item show ada print-signatures
16379 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16380 overloads selection menu.
16381 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16382
16383 @end table
16384
16385 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16386 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16387
16388 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16389 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16390 before reaching the main procedure.
16391 As defined in the Ada Reference
16392 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16393 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16394 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16395 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16396
16397 @node Ada Exceptions
16398 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16399
16400 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16401
16402 @table @code
16403 @kindex info exceptions
16404 @item info exceptions
16405 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16406 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16407 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16408 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16409 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16410 @end table
16411
16412 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16413 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16414 argument.
16415
16416 @smallexample
16417 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16418 All defined Ada exceptions:
16419 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16420 program_error: 0x613d20
16421 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16422 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16423 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16424 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16425 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16426 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16427 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16428 @end smallexample
16429
16430 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16431 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16432
16433 @node Ada Tasks
16434 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16435 @cindex Ada, tasking
16436
16437 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16438 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16439
16440 @table @code
16441 @kindex info tasks
16442 @item info tasks
16443 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16444
16445
16446 @smallexample
16447 @iftex
16448 @leftskip=0.5cm
16449 @end iftex
16450 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16451 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16452 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16453 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16454 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16455 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16456
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @noindent
16460 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16461 task currently being inspected.
16462
16463 @table @asis
16464 @item ID
16465 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16466
16467 @item TID
16468 The Ada task ID.
16469
16470 @item P-ID
16471 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16472
16473 @item Pri
16474 The base priority of the task.
16475
16476 @item State
16477 Current state of the task.
16478
16479 @table @code
16480 @item Unactivated
16481 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16482 executing.
16483
16484 @item Runnable
16485 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16486 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16487
16488 @item Terminated
16489 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16490 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16491 terminated themselves.
16492
16493 @item Child Activation Wait
16494 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16495
16496 @item Accept Statement
16497 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16498
16499 @item Waiting on entry call
16500 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16501
16502 @item Async Select Wait
16503 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16504 select statement.
16505
16506 @item Delay Sleep
16507 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16508 alternative open.
16509
16510 @item Child Termination Wait
16511 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16512 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16513 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16514
16515 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16516 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16517 finish terminating.
16518
16519 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16520 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16521 @end table
16522
16523 @item Name
16524 Name of the task in the program.
16525
16526 @end table
16527
16528 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16529 @item info task @var{taskno}
16530 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16531 the following example:
16532 @smallexample
16533 @iftex
16534 @leftskip=0.5cm
16535 @end iftex
16536 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16537 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16538 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16539 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16540 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16541 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16542 Name: task_1
16543 Thread: 0x807f378
16544 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16545 Base Priority: 15
16546 State: Runnable
16547 @end smallexample
16548
16549 @item task
16550 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16551 @cindex current Ada task ID
16552 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16553
16554 @smallexample
16555 @iftex
16556 @leftskip=0.5cm
16557 @end iftex
16558 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16559 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16560 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16561 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16562 (@value{GDBP}) task
16563 [Current task is 2]
16564 @end smallexample
16565
16566 @item task @var{taskno}
16567 @cindex Ada task switching
16568 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16569 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16570 from the current task to the given task.
16571
16572 @smallexample
16573 @iftex
16574 @leftskip=0.5cm
16575 @end iftex
16576 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16577 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16578 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16579 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16580 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16581 [Switching to task 1]
16582 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16583 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16584 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16585 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16586 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16587 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16588 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16589 @end smallexample
16590
16591 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16592 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16593 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16594 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16595 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16596 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16597 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16598 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16599 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16600
16601 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16602 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16603 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16604 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16605 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16606
16607 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16608 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16609 program.
16610
16611 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16612 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16613 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16614
16615 For example,
16616
16617 @smallexample
16618 @iftex
16619 @leftskip=0.5cm
16620 @end iftex
16621 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16622 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16623 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16624 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16625 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16626 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16627 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16628 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16629 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16630 Continuing.
16631 task # 1 running
16632 task # 2 running
16633
16634 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16635 15 flush;
16636 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16637 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16638 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16639 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16640 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16641 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16642 @end smallexample
16643 @end table
16644
16645 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16646 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16647 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16648
16649 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16650 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16651 the platform being used.
16652 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16653 switching is not supported.
16654
16655 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16656 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16657 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16658 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16659 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16660 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16661
16662 @node Ravenscar Profile
16663 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16664 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16665
16666 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16667 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16668 requirements.
16669
16670 @table @code
16671 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16672 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16673 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16674 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16675 Profile. This is the default.
16676
16677 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16678 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16679 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16680 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16681 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16682 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16683 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16684
16685 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16686 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16687 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16688 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16689
16690 @end table
16691
16692 @node Ada Glitches
16693 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16694 @cindex Ada, problems
16695
16696 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16697 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16698 @value{GDBN},
16699 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16700 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16701
16702 @itemize @bullet
16703 @item
16704 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16705 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16706
16707 @item
16708 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16709 argument lists are treated as positional).
16710
16711 @item
16712 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16713
16714 @item
16715 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16716 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16717 the host machine.
16718
16719 @item
16720 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16721 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16722 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16723 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16724 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16725 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16726 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16727 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16728 you can usually resolve the confusion
16729 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16730 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16731 @end itemize
16732
16733 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16734 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16735 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16736 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16737 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16738 enabled.
16739
16740 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16741 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16742 @table @code
16743
16744 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16745 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16746 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16747 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16748 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16749 This is the default.
16750
16751 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16752 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16753 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16754 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16755 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16756 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16757 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16758
16759 @end table
16760
16761 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16762 @cindex GNAT encoding
16763 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16764 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16765 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16766 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16767 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16768 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16769
16770 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16771 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16772 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16773 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16774 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16775 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16776 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16777 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16778
16779 @table @code
16780
16781 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16782 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16783 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16784 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16785
16786 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16787 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16788 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16789
16790 @end table
16791
16792 @node Unsupported Languages
16793 @section Unsupported Languages
16794
16795 @cindex unsupported languages
16796 @cindex minimal language
16797 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16798 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16799 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16800 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16801 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16802 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16803
16804 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16805 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16806 language.
16807
16808 @node Symbols
16809 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16810
16811 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16812 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16813 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16814 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16815 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16816 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16817 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16818
16819 @cindex symbol names
16820 @cindex names of symbols
16821 @cindex quoting names
16822 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16823 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16824 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16825 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16826 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16827 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16828 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16829 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16830
16831 @smallexample
16832 p 'foo.c'::x
16833 @end smallexample
16834
16835 @noindent
16836 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16837
16838 @table @code
16839 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16840 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16841 @kindex set case-sensitive
16842 @item set case-sensitive on
16843 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16844 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16845 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16846 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16847 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16848 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16849 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16850 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16851 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16852 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16853 case-insensitive matches.
16854
16855 @kindex show case-sensitive
16856 @item show case-sensitive
16857 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16858 lookups.
16859
16860 @kindex set print type methods
16861 @item set print type methods
16862 @itemx set print type methods on
16863 @itemx set print type methods off
16864 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16865 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16866 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16867 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16868 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16869 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16870
16871 @kindex show print type methods
16872 @item show print type methods
16873 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16874 classes.
16875
16876 @kindex set print type typedefs
16877 @item set print type typedefs
16878 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16879 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16880
16881 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16882 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16883 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16884 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16885 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16886 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16887 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16888 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16889 types.
16890
16891 @kindex show print type typedefs
16892 @item show print type typedefs
16893 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16894 printing classes.
16895
16896 @kindex info address
16897 @cindex address of a symbol
16898 @item info address @var{symbol}
16899 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16900 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16901 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16902 is always stored.
16903
16904 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16905 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16906 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16907
16908 @kindex info symbol
16909 @cindex symbol from address
16910 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16911 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16912 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16913 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16914 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16915
16916 @smallexample
16917 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16918 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16919 @end smallexample
16920
16921 @noindent
16922 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16923 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16924
16925 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16926 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16927
16928 @smallexample
16929 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16930 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16931 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16932 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16933 @end smallexample
16934
16935 @kindex demangle
16936 @cindex demangle
16937 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16938 Demangle @var{name}.
16939 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16940 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16941
16942 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16943 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16944
16945 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16946 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16947
16948 @kindex whatis
16949 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16950 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16951 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16952 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16953
16954 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16955 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16956 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16957
16958 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16959 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16960 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16961 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16962 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16963 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16964 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16965 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16966 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16967
16968 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16969 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16970 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16971 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16972 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16973 unroll it.
16974
16975 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16976 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16977 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16978
16979 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16980 Available flags are:
16981
16982 @table @code
16983 @item r
16984 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16985 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16986 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16987
16988 @item m
16989 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16990
16991 @item M
16992 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16993 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16994
16995 @item t
16996 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16997 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16998 names are substituted when printing other types.
16999
17000 @item T
17001 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17002 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17003 @end table
17004
17005 @kindex ptype
17006 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17007 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17008 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17009 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17010
17011 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17012 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17013 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17014 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17015 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17016 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17017 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17018 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17019
17020 For example, for this variable declaration:
17021
17022 @smallexample
17023 typedef double real_t;
17024 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17025 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17026 complex_t var;
17027 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17028 @end smallexample
17029
17030 @noindent
17031 the two commands give this output:
17032
17033 @smallexample
17034 @group
17035 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17036 type = complex_t
17037 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17038 type = struct complex @{
17039 real_t real;
17040 double imag;
17041 @}
17042 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17043 type = struct complex
17044 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17045 type = struct complex
17046 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17047 type = struct complex @{
17048 real_t real;
17049 double imag;
17050 @}
17051 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17052 type = real_t *
17053 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17054 type = double *
17055 @end group
17056 @end smallexample
17057
17058 @noindent
17059 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17060 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17061
17062 @cindex incomplete type
17063 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17064 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17065 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17066 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17067 given these declarations:
17068
17069 @smallexample
17070 struct foo;
17071 struct foo *fooptr;
17072 @end smallexample
17073
17074 @noindent
17075 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17076
17077 @smallexample
17078 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17079 $1 = <incomplete type>
17080 @end smallexample
17081
17082 @noindent
17083 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17084 completely specified.
17085
17086 @kindex info types
17087 @item info types @var{regexp}
17088 @itemx info types
17089 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17090 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17091 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17092 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17093 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17094 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17095 name is @code{value}.
17096
17097 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17098 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17099 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17100
17101 @kindex info type-printers
17102 @item info type-printers
17103 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17104 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17105 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17106 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17107 type printers.
17108
17109 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17110
17111 @kindex enable type-printer
17112 @kindex disable type-printer
17113 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17114 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17115 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17116
17117 @kindex info scope
17118 @cindex local variables
17119 @item info scope @var{location}
17120 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17121 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17122 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17123 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17124 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17125
17126 @smallexample
17127 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17128 Scope for command_line_handler:
17129 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17130 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17131 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17132 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17133 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17134 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17135 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17136 @end smallexample
17137
17138 @noindent
17139 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17140 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17141 collect}.
17142
17143 @kindex info source
17144 @item info source
17145 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17146 the function containing the current point of execution:
17147 @itemize @bullet
17148 @item
17149 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17150 @item
17151 the directory it was compiled in,
17152 @item
17153 its length, in lines,
17154 @item
17155 which programming language it is written in,
17156 @item
17157 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17158 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17159 @item
17160 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17161 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17162 @item
17163 whether the debugging information includes information about
17164 preprocessor macros.
17165 @end itemize
17166
17167
17168 @kindex info sources
17169 @item info sources
17170 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17171 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17172 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17173
17174 @kindex info functions
17175 @item info functions
17176 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17177
17178 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17179 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17180 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17181 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17182 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17183 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17184 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17185 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17186
17187 @kindex info variables
17188 @item info variables
17189 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17190 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17191
17192 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17193 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17194 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17195 @var{regexp}.
17196
17197 @kindex info classes
17198 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17199 @item info classes
17200 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17201 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17202 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17203 expression.
17204
17205 @kindex info selectors
17206 @item info selectors
17207 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17208 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17209 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17210 expression.
17211
17212 @ignore
17213 This was never implemented.
17214 @kindex info methods
17215 @item info methods
17216 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17217 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17218 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17219 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17220 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17221 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17222 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17223 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17224 @end ignore
17225
17226 @cindex opaque data types
17227 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17228 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17229 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17230 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17231 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17232 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17233 another source file. The default is on.
17234
17235 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17236 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17237
17238 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17239 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17240 is printed as follows:
17241 @smallexample
17242 @{<no data fields>@}
17243 @end smallexample
17244
17245 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17246 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17247 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17248
17249 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17250 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17251 @item set print symbol-loading
17252 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17253 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17254 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17255 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17256 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17257 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17258 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17259 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17260 can be annoying.
17261 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17262 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17263 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17264 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17265
17266 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17267 @item show print symbol-loading
17268 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17269 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17270
17271 @kindex maint print symbols
17272 @cindex symbol dump
17273 @kindex maint print psymbols
17274 @cindex partial symbol dump
17275 @kindex maint print msymbols
17276 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17277 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17278 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17279 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17280 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17281 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17282 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17283 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17284 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17285 that objfile.
17286 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17287 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17288 @code{main}.
17289 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17290 source file.
17291
17292 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17293 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17294 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17295 tables.
17296 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17297 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17298 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17299 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17300 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17301 ``ELF symbols''.
17302
17303 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17304 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17305
17306 @kindex maint info symtabs
17307 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17308 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17309 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17310 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17311 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17312 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17313 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17314
17315 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17316 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17317 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17318 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17319 structure in more detail. For example:
17320
17321 @smallexample
17322 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17323 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17324 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17325 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17326 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17327 readin no
17328 fullname (null)
17329 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17330 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17331 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17332 dependencies (none)
17333 @}
17334 @}
17335 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17336 (@value{GDBP})
17337 @end smallexample
17338 @noindent
17339 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17340 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17341 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17342 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17343 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17344
17345 @smallexample
17346 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17347 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17348 line 1574.
17349 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17350 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17351 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17352 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17353 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17354 dirname (null)
17355 fullname (null)
17356 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17357 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17358 debugformat DWARF 2
17359 @}
17360 @}
17361 (@value{GDBP})
17362 @end smallexample
17363
17364 @kindex maint info line-table
17365 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17366 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17367 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17368
17369 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17370 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17371 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17372
17373 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17374 @cindex symbol cache size
17375 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17376 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17377 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17378 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17379 with different sizes.
17380
17381 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17382 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17383 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17384
17385 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17386 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17387 @item maint print symbol-cache
17388 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17389 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17390
17391 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17392 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17393 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17394 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17395 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17396
17397 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17398 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17399 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17400 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17401 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17402 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17403
17404 @end table
17405
17406 @node Altering
17407 @chapter Altering Execution
17408
17409 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17410 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17411 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17412 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17413 program.
17414
17415 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17416 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17417 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17418
17419 @menu
17420 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17421 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17422 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17423 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17424 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17425 * Patching:: Patching your program
17426 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17427 @end menu
17428
17429 @node Assignment
17430 @section Assignment to Variables
17431
17432 @cindex assignment
17433 @cindex setting variables
17434 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17435 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17436
17437 @smallexample
17438 print x=4
17439 @end smallexample
17440
17441 @noindent
17442 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17443 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17444 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17445 information on operators in supported languages.
17446
17447 @kindex set variable
17448 @cindex variables, setting
17449 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17450 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17451 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17452 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17453 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17454
17455 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17456 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17457 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17458 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17459 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17460 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17461 command @code{set width}:
17462
17463 @smallexample
17464 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17465 type = double
17466 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17467 $4 = 13
17468 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17469 Invalid syntax in expression.
17470 @end smallexample
17471
17472 @noindent
17473 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17474 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17475
17476 @smallexample
17477 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17478 @end smallexample
17479
17480 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17481 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17482 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17483 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17484 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17485 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17486
17487 @smallexample
17488 @group
17489 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17490 type = double
17491 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17492 $1 = 1
17493 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17494 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17495 $2 = 1
17496 (@value{GDBP}) r
17497 The program being debugged has been started already.
17498 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17499 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17500 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17501 Invalid bfd target.
17502 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17503 The current BFD target is "=4".
17504 @end group
17505 @end smallexample
17506
17507 @noindent
17508 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17509 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17510 @code{g}, use
17511
17512 @smallexample
17513 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17514 @end smallexample
17515
17516 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17517 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17518 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17519 same length or shorter.
17520 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17521 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17522
17523 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17524 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17525 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17526 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17527 and representation in memory), and
17528
17529 @smallexample
17530 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17531 @end smallexample
17532
17533 @noindent
17534 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17535
17536 @node Jumping
17537 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17538
17539 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17540 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17541 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17542
17543 @table @code
17544 @kindex jump
17545 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17546 @item jump @var{location}
17547 @itemx j @var{location}
17548 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17549 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17550 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17551 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17552 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17553
17554 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17555 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17556 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17557 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17558 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17559 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17560 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17561 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17562 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17563 @end table
17564
17565 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17566 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17567 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17568 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17569 example,
17570
17571 @smallexample
17572 set $pc = 0x485
17573 @end smallexample
17574
17575 @noindent
17576 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17577 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17578 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17579
17580 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17581 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17582 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17583 detail.
17584
17585 @c @group
17586 @node Signaling
17587 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17588 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17589
17590 @table @code
17591 @kindex signal
17592 @item signal @var{signal}
17593 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17594 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17595 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17596 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17597
17598 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17599 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17600 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17601 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17602 signal.
17603
17604 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17605 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17606 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17607 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17608 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17609 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17610 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17611 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17612
17613 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17614 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17615 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17616 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17617 passes the signal directly to your program.
17618
17619 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17620 after executing the command.
17621
17622 @kindex queue-signal
17623 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17624 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17625 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17626 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17627 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17628 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17629 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17630 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17631 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17632
17633 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17634 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17635 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17636 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17637 @code{continue} command.
17638
17639 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17640 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17641 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17642 (@pxref{Signals}).
17643 @end table
17644 @c @end group
17645
17646 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17647 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17648
17649 @node Returning
17650 @section Returning from a Function
17651
17652 @table @code
17653 @cindex returning from a function
17654 @kindex return
17655 @item return
17656 @itemx return @var{expression}
17657 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17658 command. If you give an
17659 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17660 value.
17661 @end table
17662
17663 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17664 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17665 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17666 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17667
17668 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17669 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17670 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17671 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17672 of functions.
17673
17674 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17675 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17676 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17677 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17678 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17679
17680 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17681 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17682 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17683 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17684 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17685 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17686 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17687 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17688 assignment into the right register(s).
17689
17690 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17691 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17692 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17693 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17694 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17695 into a @code{long long int}:
17696
17697 @smallexample
17698 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17699 29 return 31;
17700 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17701 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17702 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17703 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17704 (@value{GDBP})
17705 @end smallexample
17706
17707 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17708 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17709 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17710 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17711 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17712 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17713 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17714 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17715
17716 @smallexample
17717 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17718 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17719 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17720 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17721 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17722 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17723 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17724 (@value{GDBP})
17725 @end smallexample
17726
17727 @node Calling
17728 @section Calling Program Functions
17729
17730 @table @code
17731 @cindex calling functions
17732 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17733 @item print @var{expr}
17734 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17735 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17736 debugged.
17737
17738 @kindex call
17739 @item call @var{expr}
17740 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17741 returned values.
17742
17743 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17744 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17745 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17746 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17747 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17748 value history.
17749 @end table
17750
17751 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17752 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17753 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17754 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17755
17756 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17757 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17758 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17759 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17760 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17761 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17762 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17763 in that case is controlled by the
17764 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17765
17766 @table @code
17767 @item set unwindonsignal
17768 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17769 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17770 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17771 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17772 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17773 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17774 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17775 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17776 received.
17777
17778 @item show unwindonsignal
17779 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17780 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17781 @value{GDBN}.
17782
17783 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17784 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17785 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17786 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17787 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17788 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17789 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17790 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17791 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17792 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17793
17794 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17795 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17796 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17797 @value{GDBN}.
17798
17799 @end table
17800
17801 @cindex weak alias functions
17802 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17803 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17804 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17805 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17806 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17807 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17808 function instead.
17809
17810 @node Patching
17811 @section Patching Programs
17812
17813 @cindex patching binaries
17814 @cindex writing into executables
17815 @cindex writing into corefiles
17816
17817 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17818 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17819 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17820 patching your program's binary.
17821
17822 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17823 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17824 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17825 repairs.
17826
17827 @table @code
17828 @kindex set write
17829 @item set write on
17830 @itemx set write off
17831 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17832 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17833 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17834
17835 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17836 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17837 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17838
17839 @item show write
17840 @kindex show write
17841 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17842 as well as reading.
17843 @end table
17844
17845 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17846 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17847 @cindex injecting code
17848 @cindex writing into executables
17849 @cindex compiling code
17850
17851 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17852 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17853 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17854 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17855
17856 @table @code
17857 @kindex compile code
17858 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17859 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17860 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17861 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17862 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17863 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17864 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17865 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17866 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17867 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17868 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17869 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17870
17871 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17872 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17873 E.g.:
17874
17875 @smallexample
17876 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17877 @end smallexample
17878
17879 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17880 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17881 from actual source code. E.g.:
17882
17883 @smallexample
17884 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17885 @end smallexample
17886
17887 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17888 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17889 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17890 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17891 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17892 editor.
17893
17894 @smallexample
17895 compile code
17896 >printf ("hello\n");
17897 >printf ("world\n");
17898 >end
17899 @end smallexample
17900
17901 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17902 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17903 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17904 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17905 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17906 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17907 inferior symbols otherwise.
17908
17909 @kindex compile file
17910 @item compile file @var{filename}
17911 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17912 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17913
17914 @smallexample
17915 compile file /home/user/example.c
17916 @end smallexample
17917 @end table
17918
17919 @table @code
17920 @item compile print @var{expr}
17921 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17922 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17923 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17924 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17925 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17926 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17927 Formats}.
17928
17929 @item compile print
17930 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17931 @cindex reprint the last value
17932 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17933 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17934 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17935 multiple-line editor.
17936 @end table
17937
17938 @noindent
17939 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17940
17941 @table @code
17942 @anchor{set debug compile}
17943 @item set debug compile
17944 @cindex compile command debugging info
17945 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17946 injecting the code. The default is off.
17947
17948 @item show debug compile
17949 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17950 compiling and injecting the code.
17951 @end table
17952
17953 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17954
17955 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17956 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17957 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17958 injecting process.
17959
17960 @noindent
17961 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17962
17963 @table @asis
17964 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17965 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17966 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17967 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17968
17969 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17970 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17971 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17972 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17973 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17974 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17975 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17976 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17977
17978 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17979 @end table
17980
17981 @noindent
17982 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17983
17984 @table @code
17985 @item set compile-args
17986 @cindex compile command options override
17987 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17988 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17989 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17990 compilation.
17991
17992 @item show compile-args
17993 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17994 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17995 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17996 @end table
17997
17998 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17999
18000 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18001 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18002 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18003
18004 @table @asis
18005 @item C code examples and caveats
18006 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18007 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18008 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18009 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18010 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18011
18012 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18013 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18014 much like any other normal debugging session.
18015
18016 @smallexample
18017 void function1 (void)
18018 @{
18019 int i = 42;
18020 printf ("function 1\n");
18021 @}
18022
18023 void function2 (void)
18024 @{
18025 int j = 12;
18026 function1 ();
18027 @}
18028
18029 int main(void)
18030 @{
18031 int k = 6;
18032 int *p;
18033 function2 ();
18034 return 0;
18035 @}
18036 @end smallexample
18037
18038 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18039 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18040 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18041
18042 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18043 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18044 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18045 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18046 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18047
18048 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18049 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18050 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18051 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18052 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18053 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18054 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18055 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18056 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18057 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18058
18059 @smallexample
18060 compile code k = 3;
18061 @end smallexample
18062
18063 @noindent
18064 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18065 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18066 @code{compile} command changes it.
18067
18068 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18069 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18070 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18071 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18072 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18073
18074 @smallexample
18075 compile code j = 3;
18076 @end smallexample
18077
18078 @noindent
18079 will result in a compilation error message.
18080
18081 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18082 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18083 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18084
18085 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18086 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18087 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18088 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18089
18090 @smallexample
18091 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18092 @end smallexample
18093
18094 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18095 command has completed:
18096
18097 @smallexample
18098 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18099 @end smallexample
18100
18101 @noindent
18102 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18103 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18104 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18105 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18106 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18107
18108 @smallexample
18109 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18110 @end smallexample
18111
18112 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18113 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18114 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18115 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18116 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18117 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18118 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18119 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18120
18121 @smallexample
18122 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18123 @end smallexample
18124
18125 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18126 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18127 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18128 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18129 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18130 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18131 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18132
18133 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18134 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18135 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18136 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18137 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18138 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18139
18140 @smallexample
18141 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18142 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18143 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18144 Compilation failed.
18145 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18146 42
18147 @end smallexample
18148
18149 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18150 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18151 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18152 will print to the console.
18153 @end table
18154
18155 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18156
18157 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18158 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18159 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18160 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18161 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18162 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18163 target architecture and operating system.
18164
18165 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18166 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18167 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18168 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18169 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18170 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18171 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18172
18173 @node GDB Files
18174 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18175
18176 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18177 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18178 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18179 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18180
18181 @menu
18182 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18183 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18184 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18185 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18186 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18187 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18188 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18189 @end menu
18190
18191 @node Files
18192 @section Commands to Specify Files
18193
18194 @cindex symbol table
18195 @cindex core dump file
18196
18197 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18198 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18199 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18200 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18201
18202 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18203 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18204 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18205 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18206 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18207 new files are useful.
18208
18209 @table @code
18210 @cindex executable file
18211 @kindex file
18212 @item file @var{filename}
18213 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18214 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18215 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18216 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18217 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18218 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18219 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18220 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18221
18222 @cindex unlinked object files
18223 @cindex patching object files
18224 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18225 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18226 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18227 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18228 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18229 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18230 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18231 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18232
18233 @item file
18234 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18235 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18236
18237 @kindex exec-file
18238 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18239 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18240 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18241 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18242 discard information on the executable file.
18243
18244 @kindex symbol-file
18245 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18246 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18247 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18248 table and program to run from the same file.
18249
18250 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18251 program's symbol table.
18252
18253 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18254 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18255 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18256 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18257 @value{GDBN}.
18258
18259 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18260 executing it once.
18261
18262 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18263 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18264 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18265 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18266 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18267 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18268 optimized code.
18269
18270 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18271 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18272 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18273 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18274 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18275
18276 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18277 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18278 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18279 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18280 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18281 Warnings and Messages}.)
18282
18283 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18284 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18285 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18286 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18287 in stabs format.
18288
18289 @kindex readnow
18290 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18291 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18292 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18293 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18294 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18295 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18296 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18297 entire symbol table available.
18298
18299 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18300 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18301 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18302 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18303 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18304 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18305 @c files.
18306
18307 @kindex core-file
18308 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18309 @itemx core
18310 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18311 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18312 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18313 executable file itself for other parts.
18314
18315 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18316 to be used.
18317
18318 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18319 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18320 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18321 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18322 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18323
18324 @kindex add-symbol-file
18325 @cindex dynamic linking
18326 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18327 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18328 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18329 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18330 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18331 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18332 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18333 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18334 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18335 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18336 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18337 @var{address} as an expression.
18338
18339 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18340 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18341 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18342 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18343
18344 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18345
18346 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18347 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18348 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18349 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18350 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18351 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18352 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18353 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18354 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18355
18356 @itemize @bullet
18357 @item
18358 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18359 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18360 @item
18361 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18362 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18363 @item
18364 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18365 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18366 @end itemize
18367
18368 @noindent
18369 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18370 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18371 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18372 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18373 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18374 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18375 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18376 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18377 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18378 way.
18379
18380 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18381
18382 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18383 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18384 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18385 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18386 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18387 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18388
18389 @smallexample
18390 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18391 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18392 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18393 (y or n) y
18394 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18395 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18396 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18397 (gdb)
18398 @end smallexample
18399
18400
18401 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18402
18403 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18404 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18405 @cindex load symbols from memory
18406 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18407 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18408 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18409 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18410 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18411 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18412 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18413 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18414 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18415
18416 @kindex section
18417 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18418 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18419 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18420 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18421 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18422 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18423 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18424 their addresses.
18425
18426 @kindex info files
18427 @kindex info target
18428 @item info files
18429 @itemx info target
18430 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18431 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18432 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18433 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18434 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18435 current ones.
18436
18437 @kindex maint info sections
18438 @item maint info sections
18439 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18440 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18441 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18442 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18443 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18444 may be arbitrarily combined):
18445
18446 @table @code
18447 @item ALLOBJ
18448 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18449 @item @var{sections}
18450 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18451 @item @var{section-flags}
18452 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18453 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18454 @table @code
18455 @item ALLOC
18456 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18457 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18458 @item LOAD
18459 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18460 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18461 @item RELOC
18462 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18463 @item READONLY
18464 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18465 @item CODE
18466 Section contains executable code only.
18467 @item DATA
18468 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18469 @item ROM
18470 Section will reside in ROM.
18471 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18472 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18473 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18474 Section is not empty.
18475 @item NEVER_LOAD
18476 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18477 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18478 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18479 COFF shared library information.
18480 @item IS_COMMON
18481 Section contains common symbols.
18482 @end table
18483 @end table
18484 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18485 @cindex read-only sections
18486 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18487 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18488 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18489 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18490 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18491 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18492 enhancement to debugging performance.
18493
18494 The default is off.
18495
18496 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18497 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18498 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18499 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18500
18501 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18502 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18503 @end table
18504
18505 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18506 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18507 name and remembers it that way.
18508
18509 @cindex shared libraries
18510 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18511 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18512 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18513 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18514
18515 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18516 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18517
18518 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18519 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18520 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18521 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18522 debugging a core file).
18523
18524 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18525 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18526 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18527
18528 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18529 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18530 particularly large or there are many of them.
18531
18532 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18533 commands:
18534
18535 @table @code
18536 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18537 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18538 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18539 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18540 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18541 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18542 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18543 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18544
18545 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18546 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18547 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18548 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18549 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18550 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18551 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18552 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18553 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18554
18555 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18556 @item show auto-solib-add
18557 Display the current autoloading mode.
18558 @end table
18559
18560 @cindex load shared library
18561 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18562 command:
18563
18564 @table @code
18565 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18566 @kindex info share
18567 @item info share @var{regex}
18568 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18569 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18570 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18571 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18572
18573 @kindex info dll
18574 @item info dll @var{regex}
18575 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18576
18577 @kindex sharedlibrary
18578 @kindex share
18579 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18580 @itemx share @var{regex}
18581 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18582 Unix regular expression.
18583 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18584 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18585 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18586 loaded.
18587
18588 @item nosharedlibrary
18589 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18590 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18591 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18592 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18593 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18594 discarded.
18595 @end table
18596
18597 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18598 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18599 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18600 Catchpoints}).
18601
18602 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18603 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18604 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18605 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18606
18607 @table @code
18608 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18609 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18610 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18611 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18612 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18613 shared library.
18614
18615 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18616 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18617 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18618 library events happen.
18619 @end table
18620
18621 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18622 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18623 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18624 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18625 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18626 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18627 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18628 not.
18629
18630 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18631 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18632 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18633 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18634 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18635
18636 @table @code
18637 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18638 @cindex system root, alternate
18639 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18640 @kindex set sysroot
18641 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18642 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18643 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18644 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18645 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18646 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18647 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18648 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18649 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18650 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18651 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18652 @var{path}.
18653
18654 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18655 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18656 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18657 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18658 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18659 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18660 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18661 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18662 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18663 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18664 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18665 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18666 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18667 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18668
18669 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18670 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18671 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18672 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18673 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18674
18675 @smallexample
18676 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18677 @end smallexample
18678
18679 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18680 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18681 system:
18682
18683 @smallexample
18684 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18685 @end smallexample
18686
18687 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18688 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18689 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18690 colons:
18691
18692 @smallexample
18693 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18694 @end smallexample
18695
18696 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18697 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18698 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18699 @samp{z}):
18700
18701 @smallexample
18702 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18703 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18704 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18705 @end smallexample
18706
18707 @noindent
18708 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18709 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18710 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18711
18712 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18713 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18714
18715 @smallexample
18716 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18717 @end smallexample
18718
18719 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18720 if you don't want or need to.
18721
18722 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18723 sysroot}.
18724
18725 @cindex default system root
18726 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18727 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18728 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18729 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18730 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18731 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18732 location.
18733
18734 @kindex show sysroot
18735 @item show sysroot
18736 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18737
18738 @kindex set solib-search-path
18739 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18740 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18741 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18742 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18743 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18744 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18745 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18746 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18747 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18748 of shared library symbols.
18749
18750 @kindex show solib-search-path
18751 @item show solib-search-path
18752 Display the current shared library search path.
18753
18754 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18755 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18756 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18757 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18758 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18759
18760 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18761 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18762 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18763 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18764 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18765 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18766 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18767 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18768 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18769 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18770 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18771 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18772 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18773 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18774 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18775 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18776 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18777 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18778 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18779 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18780 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18781 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18782
18783 @table @code
18784 @item unix
18785 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18786 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18787 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18788 the forward slash.
18789
18790 @item dos-based
18791 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18792 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18793 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18794 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18795 considered directory separators.
18796
18797 @item auto
18798 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18799 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18800 This is the default.
18801 @end table
18802 @end table
18803
18804 @cindex file name canonicalization
18805 @cindex base name differences
18806 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18807 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18808 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18809 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18810 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18811 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18812 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18813 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18814 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18815 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18816 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18817 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18818 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18819 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18820 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18821
18822 @table @code
18823 @item set basenames-may-differ
18824 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18825 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18826
18827 @item show basenames-may-differ
18828 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18829 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18830 @end table
18831
18832 @node File Caching
18833 @section File Caching
18834 @cindex caching of opened files
18835 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18836
18837 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18838 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18839 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18840 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18841
18842 @table @code
18843 @kindex maint info bfds
18844 @item maint info bfds
18845 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18846 @value{GDBN}.
18847
18848 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18849 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18850 @kindex bfd caching
18851 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18852 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18853 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18854 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18855 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18856 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18857 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18858 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18859 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18860
18861 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18862 @kindex bfd caching
18863 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18864 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18865
18866 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18867 @kindex bfd caching
18868 @item show debug bfd-cache
18869 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18870 @end table
18871
18872 @node Separate Debug Files
18873 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18874 @cindex separate debugging information files
18875 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18876 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18877 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18878 @cindex global debugging information directories
18879 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18880 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18881
18882 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18883 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18884 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18885 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18886 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18887 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18888 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18889
18890 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18891 file:
18892
18893 @itemize @bullet
18894 @item
18895 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18896 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18897 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18898 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18899 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18900 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18901 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18902 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18903
18904 @item
18905 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18906 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18907 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18908 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18909 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18910 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18911 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18912 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18913 below.
18914 @end itemize
18915
18916 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18917 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18918
18919 @itemize @bullet
18920 @item
18921 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18922 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18923 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18924 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18925 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18926
18927 @item
18928 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18929 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18930 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18931 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18932 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18933 hex characters, not 10.)
18934 @end itemize
18935
18936 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18937 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18938 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18939 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18940 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18941 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18942
18943 @itemize @minus
18944 @item
18945 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18946 @item
18947 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18948 @item
18949 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18950 @item
18951 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18952 @end itemize
18953
18954 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18955 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18956 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18957 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18958 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18959
18960 @table @code
18961
18962 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18963 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18964 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18965 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18966 concatenating them by a path separator.
18967
18968 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18969 @item show debug-file-directory
18970 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18971 information files.
18972
18973 @end table
18974
18975 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18976 @cindex debug link sections
18977 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18978 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18979
18980 @itemize
18981 @item
18982 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18983 a zero byte,
18984 @item
18985 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18986 boundary within the section, and
18987 @item
18988 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18989 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18990 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18991 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18992 @end itemize
18993
18994 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18995 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18996 described above.
18997
18998 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18999 @cindex build ID sections
19000 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19001 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19002 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19003 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19004 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19005 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19006 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19007 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19008 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19009
19010 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19011 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19012 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19013 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19014 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19015 in an ordinary executable.
19016
19017 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19018 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19019 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19020 following commands:
19021
19022 @smallexample
19023 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19024 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19025 @end smallexample
19026
19027 @noindent
19028 These commands remove the debugging
19029 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19030 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19031 two files:
19032
19033 @itemize @bullet
19034 @item
19035 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19036 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19037
19038 @smallexample
19039 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19040 @end smallexample
19041
19042 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19043 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19044 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19045 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19046
19047 @item
19048 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19049 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19050 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19051 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19052 @end itemize
19053
19054 @noindent
19055
19056 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19057 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19058 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19059
19060 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19061 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19062 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19063 @c different ways!
19064 @ifhtml
19065 @display
19066 @html
19067 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19068 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19069 @end html
19070 @end display
19071 @end ifhtml
19072 @ifnothtml
19073 @display
19074 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19075 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19076 @end display
19077 @end ifnothtml
19078
19079 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19080 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19081 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19082 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19083 CRC.
19084
19085 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19086 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19087 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19088 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19089 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19090
19091 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19092 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19093 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19094 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19095 @code{0xffffffff}.
19096
19097 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19098 @smallexample
19099 unsigned long
19100 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19101 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19102 @{
19103 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19104 @{
19105 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19106 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19107 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19108 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19109 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19110 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19111 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19112 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19113 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19114 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19115 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19116 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19117 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19118 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19119 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19120 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19121 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19122 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19123 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19124 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19125 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19126 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19127 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19128 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19129 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19130 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19131 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19132 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19133 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19134 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19135 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19136 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19137 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19138 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19139 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19140 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19141 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19142 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19143 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19144 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19145 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19146 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19147 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19148 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19149 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19150 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19151 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19152 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19153 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19154 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19155 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19156 0x2d02ef8d
19157 @};
19158 unsigned char *end;
19159
19160 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19161 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19162 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19163 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19164 @}
19165 @end smallexample
19166
19167 @noindent
19168 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19169
19170 @node MiniDebugInfo
19171 @section Debugging information in a special section
19172 @cindex separate debug sections
19173 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19174
19175 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19176 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19177 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19178 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19179
19180 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19181 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19182 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19183 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19184 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19185 debugging information might be included in the section.
19186
19187 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19188 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19189 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19190
19191 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19192 standard utilities:
19193
19194 @smallexample
19195 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19196 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19197 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19198 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19199
19200 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19201 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19202 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19203 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19204 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19205 | sort > funcsyms
19206
19207 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19208 # table.
19209 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19210
19211 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19212 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19213
19214 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19215 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19216 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19217 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19218
19219 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19220 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19221
19222 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19223 # original binary.
19224 xz mini_debuginfo
19225 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19226 @end smallexample
19227
19228 @node Index Files
19229 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19230 @cindex index files
19231 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19232
19233 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19234 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19235 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19236 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19237 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19238 startup.
19239
19240 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19241 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19242 using @command{objcopy}.
19243
19244 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19245
19246 @table @code
19247 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19248 @kindex save gdb-index
19249 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19250 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19251 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19252 @var{directory}.
19253 @end table
19254
19255 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19256 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19257
19258 @smallexample
19259 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19260 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19261 @end smallexample
19262
19263 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19264 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19265 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19266 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19267 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19268 The default is @code{off}.
19269 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19270 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19271
19272 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19273 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19274
19275 @smallexample
19276 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19277 @end smallexample
19278
19279 Instead you must do, for example,
19280
19281 @smallexample
19282 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19283 @end smallexample
19284
19285 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19286 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19287 currently work for programs using Ada.
19288
19289 @node Symbol Errors
19290 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19291
19292 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19293 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19294 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19295 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19296 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19297 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19298 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19299 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19300 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19301 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19302 Messages}).
19303
19304 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19305
19306 @table @code
19307 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19308
19309 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19310 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19311 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19312 in its outer scope blocks.
19313
19314 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19315 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19316 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19317 function.
19318
19319 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19320
19321 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19322 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19323 do so.
19324
19325 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19326 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19327 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19328 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19329 Messages}.)
19330
19331 @item bad block start address patched
19332
19333 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19334 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19335 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19336
19337 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19338 starting on the previous source line.
19339
19340 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19341
19342 @cindex foo
19343 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19344 larger than the size of the string table.
19345
19346 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19347 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19348 with this name.
19349
19350 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19351
19352 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19353 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19354 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19355
19356 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19357 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19358 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19359 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19360 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19361 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19362
19363 @item stub type has NULL name
19364
19365 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19366
19367 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19368 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19369 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19370 it.
19371
19372 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19373
19374 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19375
19376 @end table
19377
19378 @node Data Files
19379 @section GDB Data Files
19380
19381 @cindex prefix for data files
19382 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19383 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19384
19385 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19386 is currently using.
19387
19388 @table @code
19389 @kindex set data-directory
19390 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19391 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19392 to @var{directory}.
19393
19394 @kindex show data-directory
19395 @item show data-directory
19396 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19397 @end table
19398
19399 @cindex default data directory
19400 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19401 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19402 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19403 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19404 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19405 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19406 location.
19407
19408 The data directory may also be specified with the
19409 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19410 @xref{Mode Options}.
19411
19412 @node Targets
19413 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19414
19415 @cindex debugging target
19416 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19417
19418 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19419 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19420 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19421 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19422 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19423 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19424 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19425 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19426
19427 @cindex target architecture
19428 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19429 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19430 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19431 command.
19432
19433 @table @code
19434 @kindex set architecture
19435 @kindex show architecture
19436 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19437 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19438 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19439 supported architectures.
19440
19441 @item show architecture
19442 Show the current target architecture.
19443
19444 @item set processor
19445 @itemx processor
19446 @kindex set processor
19447 @kindex show processor
19448 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19449 and @code{show architecture}.
19450 @end table
19451
19452 @menu
19453 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19454 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19455 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19456 @end menu
19457
19458 @node Active Targets
19459 @section Active Targets
19460
19461 @cindex stacking targets
19462 @cindex active targets
19463 @cindex multiple targets
19464
19465 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19466 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19467 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19468 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19469 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19470 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19471 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19472 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19473 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19474
19475 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19476 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19477 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19478 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19479
19480 @node Target Commands
19481 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19482
19483 @table @code
19484 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19485 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19486 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19487 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19488 protocol of the target machine.
19489
19490 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19491 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19492 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19493
19494 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19495 after executing the command.
19496
19497 @kindex help target
19498 @item help target
19499 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19500 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19501 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19502
19503 @item help target @var{name}
19504 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19505 select it.
19506
19507 @kindex set gnutarget
19508 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19509 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19510 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19511 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19512 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19513 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19514
19515 @quotation
19516 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19517 you must know the actual BFD name.
19518 @end quotation
19519
19520 @noindent
19521 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19522
19523 @kindex show gnutarget
19524 @item show gnutarget
19525 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19526 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19527 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19528 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19529 @end table
19530
19531 @cindex common targets
19532 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19533 configuration):
19534
19535 @table @code
19536 @kindex target
19537 @item target exec @var{program}
19538 @cindex executable file target
19539 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19540 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19541
19542 @item target core @var{filename}
19543 @cindex core dump file target
19544 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19545 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19546
19547 @item target remote @var{medium}
19548 @cindex remote target
19549 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19550 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19551 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19552
19553 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19554 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19555
19556 @smallexample
19557 target remote /dev/ttya
19558 @end smallexample
19559
19560 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19561 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19562 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19563 clobbered by the download.
19564
19565 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19566 @cindex built-in simulator target
19567 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19568 In general,
19569 @smallexample
19570 target sim
19571 load
19572 run
19573 @end smallexample
19574 @noindent
19575 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19576 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19577 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19578 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19579 Processors}.
19580
19581 @item target native
19582 @cindex native target
19583 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19584 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19585 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19586 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19587
19588 @end table
19589
19590 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19591 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19592
19593 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19594 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19595 various aspects of this process.
19596
19597 @table @code
19598
19599 @item set hash
19600 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19601 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19602 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19603 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19604 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19605 monitor.
19606
19607 @item show hash
19608 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19609 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19610
19611 @item set debug monitor
19612 @kindex set debug monitor
19613 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19614 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19615 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19616
19617 @item show debug monitor
19618 @kindex show debug monitor
19619 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19620 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19621 @end table
19622
19623 @table @code
19624
19625 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19626 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19627 @anchor{load}
19628 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19629 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19630 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19631 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19632 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19633 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19634
19635 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19636 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19637 target is @dots{}}''
19638
19639 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19640 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19641 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19642 specifies a fixed address.
19643 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19644
19645 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19646 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19647 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19648
19649 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19650 load programs into flash memory.
19651
19652 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19653 @end table
19654
19655 @table @code
19656
19657 @kindex flash-erase
19658 @item flash-erase
19659 @anchor{flash-erase}
19660
19661 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19662
19663 @end table
19664
19665 @node Byte Order
19666 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19667
19668 @cindex choosing target byte order
19669 @cindex target byte order
19670
19671 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19672 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19673 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19674 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19675 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19676 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19677
19678 @table @code
19679 @kindex set endian
19680 @item set endian big
19681 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19682
19683 @item set endian little
19684 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19685
19686 @item set endian auto
19687 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19688 executable.
19689
19690 @item show endian
19691 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19692
19693 @end table
19694
19695 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19696 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19697 target system.
19698
19699
19700 @node Remote Debugging
19701 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19702 @cindex remote debugging
19703
19704 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19705 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19706 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19707 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19708 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19709
19710 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19711 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19712 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19713 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19714 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19715 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19716
19717 Other remote targets may be available in your
19718 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19719
19720 @menu
19721 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19722 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19723 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19724 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19725 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19726 @end menu
19727
19728 @node Connecting
19729 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19730 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19731 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19732 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19733 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19734 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19735 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19736
19737 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19738 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19739 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19740 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19741
19742 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19743
19744 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19745 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19746 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19747 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19748
19749 @table @asis
19750
19751 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19752 @item Result of detach or program exit
19753 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19754 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19755 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19756
19757 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19758 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19759 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19760 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19761
19762 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19763 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19764 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19765 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19766
19767 @item Specifying the program to debug
19768 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19769 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19770 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19771 target.
19772
19773 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19774 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19775 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19776
19777 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19778 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19779 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19780 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19781
19782 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19783 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19784 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19785 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19786 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19787 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19788 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19789 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19790 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19791
19792 @item The @code{run} command
19793 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19794 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19795 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19796 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19797 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19798
19799 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19800 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19801 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19802 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19803 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19804
19805 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19806 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19807 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19808 @code{target remote} mode.
19809
19810 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19811 @item Attaching
19812 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19813 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19814 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19815
19816 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19817 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19818 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19819 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19820 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19821
19822 @end table
19823
19824 @anchor{Host and target files}
19825 @subsection Host and Target Files
19826 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19827 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19828
19829 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19830 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19831 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19832 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19833 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19834
19835 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19836 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19837 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19838 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19839 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19840
19841 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19842 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19843 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19844 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19845 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19846 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19847 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19848 target libraries.
19849
19850 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19851 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19852 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19853 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19854 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19855 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19856 programs.
19857
19858 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19859 @cindex remote connection commands
19860 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19861 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19862 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19863 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19864 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19865 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19866 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19867
19868 @table @code
19869
19870 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19871 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19872 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19873 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19874 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19875
19876 @smallexample
19877 target remote /dev/ttyb
19878 @end smallexample
19879
19880 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19881 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19882 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19883 @code{target} command.
19884
19885 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19886 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19887 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19888 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19889 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19890 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19891 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19892 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19893 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19894 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19895 target.
19896
19897 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19898 @code{manyfarms}:
19899
19900 @smallexample
19901 target remote manyfarms:2828
19902 @end smallexample
19903
19904 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19905 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19906 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19907 port 1234 on your local machine:
19908
19909 @smallexample
19910 target remote :1234
19911 @end smallexample
19912 @noindent
19913
19914 Note that the colon is still required here.
19915
19916 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19917 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19918 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19919 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19920 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19921
19922 @smallexample
19923 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19924 @end smallexample
19925
19926 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19927 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19928 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19929 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19930
19931 @item target remote | @var{command}
19932 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19933 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19934 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19935 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19936 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19937 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19938 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19939 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19940 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19941
19942 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19943 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19944 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19945
19946 @end table
19947
19948 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19949 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19950 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19951 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19952 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19953 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19954 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19955
19956 @smallexample
19957 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19958 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19959 @end smallexample
19960
19961 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19962 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19963 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19964 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19965
19966 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19967 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19968
19969 @table @code
19970 @kindex detach (remote)
19971 @item detach
19972 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19973 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19974 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19975 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19976 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19977 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19978 still connected to the target.
19979
19980 @kindex disconnect
19981 @item disconnect
19982 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19983 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19984 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19985 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19986 another target.
19987
19988 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19989 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19990 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19991 @kindex monitor
19992 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19993 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19994 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19995 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19996 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19997 and implement.
19998 @end table
19999
20000 @node File Transfer
20001 @section Sending files to a remote system
20002 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20003 @cindex file transfer
20004 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20005
20006 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20007 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20008 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20009 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20010 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20011 the only way to upload or download files.
20012
20013 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20014
20015 @table @code
20016 @kindex remote put
20017 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20018 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20019 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20020
20021 @kindex remote get
20022 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20023 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20024 on the host system.
20025
20026 @kindex remote delete
20027 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20028 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20029
20030 @end table
20031
20032 @node Server
20033 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20034
20035 @kindex gdbserver
20036 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20037 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20038 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20039 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20040 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20041
20042 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20043 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20044 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20045 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20046 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20047 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20048 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20049 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20050 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20051 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20052 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20053 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20054 choice for debugging.
20055
20056 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20057 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20058 protocol.
20059
20060 @quotation
20061 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20062 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20063 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20064 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20065 @code{gdbserver}.
20066 @end quotation
20067
20068 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20069 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20070 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20071 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20072
20073 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20074 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20075 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20076 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20077 system does all the symbol handling.
20078
20079 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20080 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20081 syntax is:
20082
20083 @smallexample
20084 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20085 @end smallexample
20086
20087 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20088 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20089 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20090 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20091 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20092 @file{/dev/com1}:
20093
20094 @smallexample
20095 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20096 @end smallexample
20097
20098 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20099 with it.
20100
20101 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20102
20103 @smallexample
20104 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20105 @end smallexample
20106
20107 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20108 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20109 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20110 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20111 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20112 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20113 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20114 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20115 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20116 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20117 @code{target remote} command.
20118
20119 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20120 with ssh:
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20127 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20128 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20129 You could elide it if you want to.
20130
20131 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20132 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20133 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20134 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20135
20136 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20137 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20138 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20139 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20140
20141 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20142 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20143
20144 @smallexample
20145 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20146 @end smallexample
20147
20148 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20149 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20150
20151 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20152 @value{GDBN} attach command
20153 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20154
20155 @pindex pidof
20156 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20157 @code{pidof} utility:
20158
20159 @smallexample
20160 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20161 @end smallexample
20162
20163 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20164 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20165 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20166
20167 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20168
20169 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20170 port.
20171
20172 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20173 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20174 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20175 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20176 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20177 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20178 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20179 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20180
20181 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20182 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20183 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20184
20185 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20186 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20187 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20188 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20189 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20190 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20191 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20192 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20193 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20194 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20195 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20196 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20197
20198 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20199 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20200
20201 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20202 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20203 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20204 program. For more information,
20205 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20206
20207 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20208 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20209 status information about the debugging process.
20210 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20211 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20212 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20213 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20214
20215 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20216 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20217 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20218 Possible options are:
20219
20220 @table @code
20221 @item none
20222 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20223 @item all
20224 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20225 @item timestamps
20226 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20227 @end table
20228
20229 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20230 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20231
20232 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20233 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20234 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20235 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20236 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20237
20238 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20239 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20240 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20241 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20242
20243 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20244 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20245 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20246 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20247
20248 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20249 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20250 environment:
20251
20252 @smallexample
20253 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20254 @end smallexample
20255
20256 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20257 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20258
20259 @smallexample
20260 $ gdbserver --selftest
20261 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20262 @end smallexample
20263
20264 These tests are disabled in release.
20265 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20266
20267 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20268 @itemize
20269
20270 @item
20271 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20272
20273 @item
20274 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20275 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20276 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20277 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20278 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20279 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20280
20281 @item
20282 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20283 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20284 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20285 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20286 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20287 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20288 program is already on the target.
20289
20290 @end itemize
20291
20292 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20293 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20294 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20295
20296 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20297 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20298 Here are the available commands.
20299
20300 @table @code
20301 @item monitor help
20302 List the available monitor commands.
20303
20304 @item monitor set debug 0
20305 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20306 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20307
20308 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20309 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20310 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20311 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20312
20313 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20314 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20315 Possible options are:
20316
20317 @table @code
20318 @item none
20319 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20320 @item all
20321 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20322 @item timestamps
20323 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20324 @end table
20325
20326 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20327 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20328
20329 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20330 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20331 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20332 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20333 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20334 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20335
20336 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20337 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20338
20339 @item monitor exit
20340 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20341 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20342 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20343 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20344 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20345
20346 @end table
20347
20348 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20349 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20350
20351 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20352 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20353
20354 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20355 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20356 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20357 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20358 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20359 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20360 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20361 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20362 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20363 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20364 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20365 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20366
20367 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20368
20369 @table @code
20370 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20371
20372 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20373 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20374 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20375
20376 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20377
20378 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20379 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20380 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20381 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20382 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20383 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20384
20385 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20386
20387 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20388 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20389 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20390 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20391 command for that. For example:
20392
20393 @smallexample
20394 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20395 @end smallexample
20396
20397 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20398 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20399 @end table
20400
20401 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20402 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20403 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20404 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20405 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20406 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20407 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20408 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20409 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20410 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20411
20412 @smallexample
20413 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20414 @end smallexample
20415
20416 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20417
20418 @smallexample
20419 $ gdb myprogram
20420 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20421 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20422 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20423 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20424 @end smallexample
20425
20426 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20427 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20428 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20429 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20430 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20431 tracing.
20432
20433 @node Remote Configuration
20434 @section Remote Configuration
20435
20436 @kindex set remote
20437 @kindex show remote
20438 This section documents the configuration options available when
20439 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20440 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20441 system-call-allowed}.
20442
20443 @table @code
20444 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20445 @cindex address size for remote targets
20446 @cindex bits in remote address
20447 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20448 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20449 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20450 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20451
20452 @item show remoteaddresssize
20453 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20454
20455 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20456 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20457 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20458 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20459 remote targets.
20460
20461 @item show serial baud
20462 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20463
20464 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20465 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20466 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20467
20468 @item show serial parity
20469 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20470
20471 @item set remotebreak
20472 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20473 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20474 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20475 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20476 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20477 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20478 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20479 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20480
20481 @item show remotebreak
20482 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20483 interrupt the remote program.
20484
20485 @item set remoteflow on
20486 @itemx set remoteflow off
20487 @kindex set remoteflow
20488 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20489 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20490
20491 @item show remoteflow
20492 @kindex show remoteflow
20493 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20494
20495 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20496 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20497 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20498 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20499 @code{ascii}.
20500
20501 @item show remotelogbase
20502 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20503 protocol.
20504
20505 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20506 @cindex record serial communications on file
20507 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20508 default is not to record at all.
20509
20510 @item show remotelogfile.
20511 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20512 serial communications.
20513
20514 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20515 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20516 @cindex remote timeout
20517 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20518 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20519
20520 @item show remotetimeout
20521 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20522 responses.
20523
20524 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20525 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20526 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20527 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20528 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20529 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20530 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20531 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20532
20533 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20534 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20535 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20536 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20537 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20538 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20539 as unlimited.
20540
20541 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20542 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20543 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20544
20545 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20546 @itemx show remote exec-file
20547 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20548 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20549 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20550 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20551 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20552 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20553
20554 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20555 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20556 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20557 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20558 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20559 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20560 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20561 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20562 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20563 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20564
20565 @item show interrupt-sequence
20566 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20567 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20568 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20569 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20570
20571 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20572 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20573 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20574 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20575 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20576 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20577
20578 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20579 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20580 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20581
20582 @kindex set tcp
20583 @kindex show tcp
20584 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20585 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20586 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20587 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20588 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20589 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20590 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20591 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20592 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20593
20594 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20595 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20596
20597 @item show tcp auto-retry
20598 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20599
20600 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20601 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20602 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20603 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20604 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20605 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20606 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20607 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20608 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20609 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20610 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20611
20612 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20613 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20614 @end table
20615
20616 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20617 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20618 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20619 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20620 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20621 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20622 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20623 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20624 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20625
20626 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20627 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20628 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20629 @value{GDBN} developers.
20630
20631 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20632 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20633 are:
20634
20635 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20636 @item Command Name
20637 @tab Remote Packet
20638 @tab Related Features
20639
20640 @item @code{fetch-register}
20641 @tab @code{p}
20642 @tab @code{info registers}
20643
20644 @item @code{set-register}
20645 @tab @code{P}
20646 @tab @code{set}
20647
20648 @item @code{binary-download}
20649 @tab @code{X}
20650 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20651
20652 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20653 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20654 @tab @code{info auxv}
20655
20656 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20657 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20658 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20659
20660 @item @code{attach}
20661 @tab @code{vAttach}
20662 @tab @code{attach}
20663
20664 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20665 @tab @code{vCont}
20666 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20667
20668 @item @code{run}
20669 @tab @code{vRun}
20670 @tab @code{run}
20671
20672 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20673 @tab @code{Z0}
20674 @tab @code{break}
20675
20676 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20677 @tab @code{Z1}
20678 @tab @code{hbreak}
20679
20680 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20681 @tab @code{Z2}
20682 @tab @code{watch}
20683
20684 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20685 @tab @code{Z3}
20686 @tab @code{rwatch}
20687
20688 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20689 @tab @code{Z4}
20690 @tab @code{awatch}
20691
20692 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20693 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20694 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20695
20696 @item @code{target-features}
20697 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20698 @tab @code{set architecture}
20699
20700 @item @code{library-info}
20701 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20702 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20703
20704 @item @code{memory-map}
20705 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20706 @tab @code{info mem}
20707
20708 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20709 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20710 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20711
20712 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20713 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20714 @tab @code{info spu}
20715
20716 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20717 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20718 @tab @code{info spu}
20719
20720 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20721 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20722 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20723
20724 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20725 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20726 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20727
20728 @item @code{threads}
20729 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20730 @tab @code{info threads}
20731
20732 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20733 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20734 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20735
20736 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20737 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20738 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20739
20740 @item @code{search-memory}
20741 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20742 @tab @code{find}
20743
20744 @item @code{supported-packets}
20745 @tab @code{qSupported}
20746 @tab Remote communications parameters
20747
20748 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20749 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20750 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20751
20752 @item @code{pass-signals}
20753 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20754 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20755
20756 @item @code{program-signals}
20757 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20758 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20759
20760 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20761 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20762 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20763
20764 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20765 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20766 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20767
20768 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20769 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20770 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20771
20772 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20773 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20774 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20775
20776 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20777 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20778 @tab @code{remote delete}
20779
20780 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20781 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20782 @tab Host I/O
20783
20784 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20785 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20786 @tab Host I/O
20787
20788 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20789 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20790 @tab Host I/O
20791
20792 @item @code{noack-packet}
20793 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20794 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20795
20796 @item @code{osdata}
20797 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20798 @tab @code{info os}
20799
20800 @item @code{query-attached}
20801 @tab @code{qAttached}
20802 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20803
20804 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20805 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20806 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20807
20808 @item @code{trace-status}
20809 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20810 @tab @code{tstatus}
20811
20812 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20813 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20814 @tab Traceframe info
20815
20816 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20817 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20818 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20819
20820 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20821 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20822 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20823
20824 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
20825 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
20826 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
20827
20828 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20829 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20830 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20831
20832 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20833 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20834 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20835
20836 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20837 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20838 @tab @code{break}
20839
20840 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20841 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20842 @tab @code{hbreak}
20843
20844 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20845 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20846 @tab @code{fork}
20847
20848 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20849 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20850 @tab @code{vfork}
20851
20852 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20853 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20854 @tab @code{exec}
20855
20856 @item @code{thread-events}
20857 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20858 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20859
20860 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20861 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20862 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20863
20864 @end multitable
20865
20866 @node Remote Stub
20867 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20868
20869 @cindex debugging stub, example
20870 @cindex remote stub, example
20871 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20872 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20873 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20874 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20875 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20876 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20877 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20878 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20879
20880 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20881 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20882 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20883 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20884 program, you need:
20885
20886 @enumerate
20887 @item
20888 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20889 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20890 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20891
20892 @item
20893 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20894 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20895
20896 @item
20897 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20898 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20899 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20900 documentation.
20901 @end enumerate
20902
20903 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20904 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20905 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20906
20907 @table @emph
20908 @item On the host,
20909 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20910 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20911 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20912
20913 @item On the target,
20914 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20915 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20916 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20917
20918 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20919 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20920 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20921 @end table
20922
20923 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20924 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20925 @sc{sparc} boards.
20926
20927 @cindex remote serial stub list
20928 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20929
20930 @table @code
20931
20932 @item i386-stub.c
20933 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20934 @cindex Intel
20935 @cindex i386
20936 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20937
20938 @item m68k-stub.c
20939 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20940 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20941 @cindex m680x0
20942 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20943
20944 @item sh-stub.c
20945 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20946 @cindex Renesas
20947 @cindex SH
20948 For Renesas SH architectures.
20949
20950 @item sparc-stub.c
20951 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20952 @cindex Sparc
20953 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20954
20955 @item sparcl-stub.c
20956 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20957 @cindex Fujitsu
20958 @cindex SparcLite
20959 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20960
20961 @end table
20962
20963 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20964 recently added stubs.
20965
20966 @menu
20967 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20968 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20969 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20970 @end menu
20971
20972 @node Stub Contents
20973 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20974
20975 @cindex remote serial stub
20976 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20977 subroutines:
20978
20979 @table @code
20980 @item set_debug_traps
20981 @findex set_debug_traps
20982 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20983 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20984 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20985 program's startup code.
20986
20987 @item handle_exception
20988 @findex handle_exception
20989 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20990 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20991 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20992 run when a trap is triggered.
20993
20994 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20995 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20996 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20997 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20998 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20999 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21000 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21001 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21002 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21003 machine.
21004
21005 @item breakpoint
21006 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21007 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21008 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21009 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21010 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21011 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21012 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21013 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21014 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21015 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21016 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21017
21018 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21019 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21020 start of your debugging session.
21021 @end table
21022
21023 @node Bootstrapping
21024 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21025
21026 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21027 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21028 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21029 debugging target machine.
21030
21031 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21032 serial port.
21033
21034 @table @code
21035 @item int getDebugChar()
21036 @findex getDebugChar
21037 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21038 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21039 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21040
21041 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21042 @findex putDebugChar
21043 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21044 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21045 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21046 @end table
21047
21048 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21049 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21050 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21051 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21052 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21053 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21054 remote system to stop.
21055
21056 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21057 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21058 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21059 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21060
21061 Other routines you need to supply are:
21062
21063 @table @code
21064 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21065 @findex exceptionHandler
21066 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21067 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21068 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21069 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21070 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21071 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21072 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21073 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21074 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21075 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21076 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21077 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21078 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21079
21080 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21081 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21082 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21083 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21084 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21085
21086 @item void flush_i_cache()
21087 @findex flush_i_cache
21088 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21089 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21090 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21091
21092 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21093 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21094 @end table
21095
21096 @noindent
21097 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21098
21099 @table @code
21100 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21101 @findex memset
21102 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21103 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21104 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21105 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21106 @end table
21107
21108 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21109 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21110 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21111 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21112
21113
21114 @node Debug Session
21115 @subsection Putting it All Together
21116
21117 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21118 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21119 steps.
21120
21121 @enumerate
21122 @item
21123 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21124 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21125 @display
21126 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21127 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21128 @end display
21129
21130 @item
21131 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21132 procedure is called:
21133
21134 @smallexample
21135 set_debug_traps();
21136 breakpoint();
21137 @end smallexample
21138
21139 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21140 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21141 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21142 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21143 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21144 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21145 progress.
21146
21147 @item
21148 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21149 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21150
21151 @smallexample
21152 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21153 @end smallexample
21154
21155 @noindent
21156 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21157 function in your program, that function is called when
21158 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21159 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21160 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21161
21162 @item
21163 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21164 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21165
21166 @item
21167 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21168 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21169
21170 @item
21171 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21172 @c document that. FIXME.
21173 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21174 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21175
21176 @item
21177 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21178 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21179
21180 @end enumerate
21181
21182 @node Configurations
21183 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21184
21185 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21186 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21187 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21188
21189 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21190 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21191 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21192 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21193 are quite different from each other.
21194
21195 @menu
21196 * Native::
21197 * Embedded OS::
21198 * Embedded Processors::
21199 * Architectures::
21200 @end menu
21201
21202 @node Native
21203 @section Native
21204
21205 This section describes details specific to particular native
21206 configurations.
21207
21208 @menu
21209 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21210 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21211 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21212 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21213 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21214 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21215 @end menu
21216
21217 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21218 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21219
21220 @cindex libkvm
21221 @cindex kernel memory image
21222 @cindex kernel crash dump
21223
21224 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21225 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21226 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21227 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21228 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21229 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21230 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21231 @code{kvm} target:
21232
21233 @smallexample
21234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21235 @end smallexample
21236
21237 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21238 argument:
21239
21240 @smallexample
21241 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21242 @end smallexample
21243
21244 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21245 available:
21246
21247 @table @code
21248 @kindex kvm
21249 @item kvm pcb
21250 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21251
21252 @item kvm proc
21253 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21254 modern FreeBSD systems.
21255 @end table
21256
21257 @node SVR4 Process Information
21258 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21259 @cindex /proc
21260 @cindex examine process image
21261 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21262
21263 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21264 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21265 process using file-system subroutines.
21266
21267 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21268 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21269 information about the process running your program, or about any
21270 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21271 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21272
21273 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21274 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21275
21276 @table @code
21277 @kindex info proc
21278 @cindex process ID
21279 @item info proc
21280 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21281 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21282 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21283 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21284 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21285 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21286 executable file's absolute file name.
21287
21288 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21289 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21290 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21291 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21292 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21293 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21294
21295 @item info proc cmdline
21296 @cindex info proc cmdline
21297 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21298 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21299
21300 @item info proc cwd
21301 @cindex info proc cwd
21302 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21303 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21304
21305 @item info proc exe
21306 @cindex info proc exe
21307 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21308 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21309
21310 @item info proc mappings
21311 @cindex memory address space mappings
21312 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21313 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21314 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21315 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21316 memory access rights to that range.
21317
21318 @item info proc stat
21319 @itemx info proc status
21320 @cindex process detailed status information
21321 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21322 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21323 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21324 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21325 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21326 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21327 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21328
21329 @item info proc all
21330 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21331 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21332
21333 @ignore
21334 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21335 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21336 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21337 @kindex info proc times
21338 @item info proc times
21339 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21340 its children.
21341
21342 @kindex info proc id
21343 @item info proc id
21344 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21345 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21346 @end ignore
21347
21348 @item set procfs-trace
21349 @kindex set procfs-trace
21350 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21351 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21352
21353 @item show procfs-trace
21354 @kindex show procfs-trace
21355 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21356
21357 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21358 @kindex set procfs-file
21359 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21360 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21361 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21362 standard output.
21363
21364 @item show procfs-file
21365 @kindex show procfs-file
21366 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21367
21368 @item proc-trace-entry
21369 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21370 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21371 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21372 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21373 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21374 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21375 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21376 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21377 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21378
21379 @item info pidlist
21380 @kindex info pidlist
21381 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21382 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21383 processes and all the threads within each process.
21384
21385 @item info meminfo
21386 @kindex info meminfo
21387 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21388 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21389 @end table
21390
21391 @node DJGPP Native
21392 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21393 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21394 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21395 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21396
21397 @cindex DPMI
21398 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21399 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21400 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21401 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21402
21403 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21404 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21405 subsection describes those commands.
21406
21407 @table @code
21408 @kindex info dos
21409 @item info dos
21410 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21411 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21412
21413 @kindex sysinfo
21414 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21415 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21416 @item info dos sysinfo
21417 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21418 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21419 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21420
21421 @cindex GDT
21422 @cindex LDT
21423 @cindex IDT
21424 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21425 @cindex descriptor tables display
21426 @item info dos gdt
21427 @itemx info dos ldt
21428 @itemx info dos idt
21429 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21430 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21431 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21432 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21433 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21434 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21435 rights.
21436
21437 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21438 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21439 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21440 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21441 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21442
21443 @cindex garbled pointers
21444 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21445 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21446 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21447 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21448 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21449 debugged program's data segment:
21450
21451 @smallexample
21452 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21453 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21454 @end smallexample
21455
21456 @noindent
21457 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21458 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21459
21460 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21461 @item info dos pde
21462 @itemx info dos pte
21463 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21464 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21465 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21466 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21467 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21468 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21469 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21470 that is currently in use.
21471
21472 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21473 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21474 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21475 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21476 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21477 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21478 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21479
21480 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21481 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21482 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21483 controller.
21484
21485 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21486
21487 @cindex physical address from linear address
21488 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21489 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21490 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21491 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21492 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21493 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21494 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21495
21496 @smallexample
21497 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21498 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21499 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21500 @end smallexample
21501
21502 @noindent
21503 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21504 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21505 attributes of that page.
21506
21507 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21508 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21509 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21510 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21511 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21512 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21513
21514 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21515 transfer buffer:
21516
21517 @smallexample
21518 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21519 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21520 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21521 @end smallexample
21522
21523 @noindent
21524 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21525 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21526 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21527 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21528 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21529
21530 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21531 @end table
21532
21533 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21534 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21535 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21536 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21537
21538 @table @code
21539 @kindex set com1base
21540 @kindex set com1irq
21541 @kindex set com2base
21542 @kindex set com2irq
21543 @kindex set com3base
21544 @kindex set com3irq
21545 @kindex set com4base
21546 @kindex set com4irq
21547 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21548 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21549 port.
21550
21551 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21552 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21553 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21554
21555 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21556 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21557 other 3 COM ports.
21558
21559 @kindex show com1base
21560 @kindex show com1irq
21561 @kindex show com2base
21562 @kindex show com2irq
21563 @kindex show com3base
21564 @kindex show com3irq
21565 @kindex show com4base
21566 @kindex show com4irq
21567 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21568 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21569 lines used by the COM ports.
21570
21571 @item info serial
21572 @kindex info serial
21573 @cindex DOS serial port status
21574 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21575 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21576 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21577 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21578 @end table
21579
21580
21581 @node Cygwin Native
21582 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21583 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21584 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21585 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21586
21587 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21588 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21589
21590 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21591 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21592 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21593 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21594 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21595 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21596 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21597 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21598
21599 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21600 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21601 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21602
21603 @table @code
21604 @kindex info w32
21605 @item info w32
21606 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21607 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21608
21609 @item info w32 selector
21610 This command displays information returned by
21611 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21612 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21613 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21614 Without argument, this command displays information
21615 about the six segment registers.
21616
21617 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21618 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21619 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21620 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21621
21622 @kindex signal-event
21623 @item signal-event @var{id}
21624 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21625 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21626
21627 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21628 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21629 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21630 (for x86_64 versions):
21631
21632 @itemize @minus
21633 @item
21634 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21635 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21636 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21637
21638 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21639 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21640 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21641 to attach.
21642
21643 @item
21644 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21645 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21646 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21647 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21648 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21649 @end itemize
21650
21651 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21652 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21653 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21654 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21655 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21656 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21657 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21658 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21659 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21660 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21661 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21662
21663 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21664 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21665 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21666 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21667
21668 @kindex set new-console
21669 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21670 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21671 be started in a new console on next start.
21672 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21673 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21674
21675 @kindex show new-console
21676 @item show new-console
21677 Displays whether a new console is used
21678 when the debuggee is started.
21679
21680 @kindex set new-group
21681 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21682 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21683 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21684 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21685 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21686
21687 @kindex show new-group
21688 @item show new-group
21689 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21690
21691 @kindex set debugevents
21692 @item set debugevents
21693 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21694 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21695 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21696 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21697 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21698
21699 @kindex set debugexec
21700 @item set debugexec
21701 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21702 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21703
21704 @kindex set debugexceptions
21705 @item set debugexceptions
21706 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21707 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21708
21709 @kindex set debugmemory
21710 @item set debugmemory
21711 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21712 and writes by the debugger.
21713
21714 @kindex set shell
21715 @item set shell
21716 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21717 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21718
21719 @kindex show shell
21720 @item show shell
21721 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21722
21723 @end table
21724
21725 @menu
21726 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21727 @end menu
21728
21729 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21730 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21731 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21732 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21733
21734 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21735 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21736 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21737 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21738 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21739 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21740 ``minimal symbols''.
21741
21742 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21743 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21744 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21745 program run once to completion.
21746
21747 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21748
21749 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21750 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21751 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21752 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21753 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21754 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21755 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21756 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21757 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21758
21759 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21760 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21761 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21762 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21763 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21764 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21765
21766 @smallexample
21767 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21768 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21769
21770 Non-debugging symbols:
21771 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21772 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21773 @end smallexample
21774
21775 @smallexample
21776 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21777 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21778
21779 Non-debugging symbols:
21780 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21781 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21782 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21783 [etc...]
21784 @end smallexample
21785
21786 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21787
21788 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21789 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21790 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21791 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21792 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21793 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21794 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21795
21796 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21797 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21798 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21799 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21800 problem:
21801
21802 @smallexample
21803 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21804 $1 = 268572168
21805 @end smallexample
21806
21807 @smallexample
21808 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21809 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21810 @end smallexample
21811
21812 And two possible solutions:
21813
21814 @smallexample
21815 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21816 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21817 @end smallexample
21818
21819 @smallexample
21820 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21821 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21822 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21823 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21824 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21825 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21826 @end smallexample
21827
21828 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21829 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21830 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21831 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21832 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21833
21834 @smallexample
21835 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21836 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21837 @end smallexample
21838
21839 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21840 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21841 safe.
21842
21843 @node Hurd Native
21844 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21845 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21846
21847 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21848 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21849
21850 @table @code
21851 @item set signals
21852 @itemx set sigs
21853 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21854 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21855 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21856 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21857 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21858 @code{signals}.
21859
21860 @item show signals
21861 @itemx show sigs
21862 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21863 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21864 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21865
21866 @item set signal-thread
21867 @itemx set sigthread
21868 @kindex set signal-thread
21869 @kindex set sigthread
21870 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21871 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21872 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21873 signal-thread}.
21874
21875 @item show signal-thread
21876 @itemx show sigthread
21877 @kindex show signal-thread
21878 @kindex show sigthread
21879 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21880 delivered a signal.
21881
21882 @item set stopped
21883 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21884 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21885 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21886 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21887
21888 @item show stopped
21889 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21890 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21891 stopped.
21892
21893 @item set exceptions
21894 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21895 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21896 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21897 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21898 trapping on.
21899
21900 @item show exceptions
21901 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21902 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21903
21904 @item set task pause
21905 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21906 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21907 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21908 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21909 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21910 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21911 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21912 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21913 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21914
21915 @item show task pause
21916 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21917 Show the current state of task suspension.
21918
21919 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21920 @cindex task suspend count
21921 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21922 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21923 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21924
21925 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21926 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21927
21928 @item set task exception-port
21929 @itemx set task excp
21930 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21931 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21932 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21933 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21934
21935 @item set noninvasive
21936 @cindex noninvasive task options
21937 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21938 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21939 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21940 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21941
21942 @item info send-rights
21943 @itemx info receive-rights
21944 @itemx info port-rights
21945 @itemx info port-sets
21946 @itemx info dead-names
21947 @itemx info ports
21948 @itemx info psets
21949 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21950 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21951 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21952 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21953 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21954 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21955 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21956 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21957 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21958
21959 @item set thread pause
21960 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21961 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21962 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21963 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21964 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21965 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21966 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21967 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21968 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21969 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21970 only the current thread.
21971
21972 @item show thread pause
21973 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21974 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21975
21976 @item set thread run
21977 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21978
21979 @item show thread run
21980 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21981
21982 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21983 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21984 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21985 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21986 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21987 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21988 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21989
21990 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21991 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21992 detaching.
21993
21994 @item set thread exception-port
21995 @itemx set thread excp
21996 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21997 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21998 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21999
22000 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22001 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22002 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22003 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22004
22005 @item set thread default
22006 @itemx show thread default
22007 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22008 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22009 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22010 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22011 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22012 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22013 the non-default commands.
22014 @end table
22015
22016 @node Darwin
22017 @subsection Darwin
22018 @cindex Darwin
22019
22020 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22021
22022 @table @code
22023 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22024 @kindex set debug darwin
22025 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22026 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22027
22028 @item show debug darwin
22029 @kindex show debug darwin
22030 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22031
22032 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22033 @kindex set debug mach-o
22034 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22035 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22036 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22037 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22038 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22039 usage.
22040
22041 @item show debug mach-o
22042 @kindex show debug mach-o
22043 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22044
22045 @item set mach-exceptions on
22046 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22047 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22048 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22049 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22050 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22051 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22052
22053 @item show mach-exceptions
22054 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22055 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22056 @end table
22057
22058
22059 @node Embedded OS
22060 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22061
22062 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22063 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22064 architectures.
22065
22066 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22067 various real-time operating systems.
22068
22069 @node Embedded Processors
22070 @section Embedded Processors
22071
22072 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22073 configurations.
22074
22075 @cindex send command to simulator
22076 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22077 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22078
22079 @table @code
22080 @item sim @var{command}
22081 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22082 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22083 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22084 acceptable commands.
22085 @end table
22086
22087
22088 @menu
22089 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22090 * ARM:: ARM
22091 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22092 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22093 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22094 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22095 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22096 * CRIS:: CRIS
22097 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22098 @end menu
22099
22100 @node ARC
22101 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22102 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22103 @cindex ARC specific commands
22104 @cindex ARC600
22105 @cindex ARC700
22106 @cindex ARC EM
22107 @cindex ARC HS
22108
22109 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22110
22111 @table @code
22112 @item set debug arc
22113 @kindex set debug arc
22114 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22115 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22116
22117 @item show debug arc
22118 @kindex show debug arc
22119 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22120
22121 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22122 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22123 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22124
22125 @end table
22126
22127 @node ARM
22128 @subsection ARM
22129
22130 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22131
22132 @table @code
22133 @item set arm disassembler
22134 @kindex set arm
22135 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22136 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22137
22138 @item show arm disassembler
22139 @kindex show arm
22140 Show the current disassembly style.
22141
22142 @item set arm apcs32
22143 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22144 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22145
22146 @item show arm apcs32
22147 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22148
22149 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22150 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22151 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22152
22153 @table @code
22154 @item auto
22155 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22156 @item softfpa
22157 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22158 processors.
22159 @item fpa
22160 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22161 @item softvfp
22162 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22163 @item vfp
22164 VFP co-processor.
22165 @end table
22166
22167 @item show arm fpu
22168 Show the current type of the FPU.
22169
22170 @item set arm abi
22171 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22172
22173 @item show arm abi
22174 Show the currently used ABI.
22175
22176 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22177 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22178 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22179 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22180 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22181 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22182 register).
22183
22184 @item show arm fallback-mode
22185 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22186
22187 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22188 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22189 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22190 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22191 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22192
22193 @item show arm force-mode
22194 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22195
22196 @item set debug arm
22197 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22198 target support subsystem.
22199
22200 @item show debug arm
22201 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22202 @end table
22203
22204 @table @code
22205 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22206 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22207
22208 @table @code
22209 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22210 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22211 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22212 The default value is @code{all}.
22213
22214 @table @code
22215 @item none
22216 @item demon
22217 @item angel
22218 @item redboot
22219 @item all
22220 @end table
22221 @end table
22222 @end table
22223
22224 @node M68K
22225 @subsection M68k
22226
22227 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22228
22229 @node MicroBlaze
22230 @subsection MicroBlaze
22231 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22232 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22233
22234 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22235 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22236 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22237 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22238 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22239 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22240 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22241 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22242 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22243 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22244 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22245
22246 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22247
22248 @table @code
22249 @item target remote :1234
22250 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22251 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22252
22253 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22254 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22255 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22256
22257 @item load
22258 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22259
22260 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22261 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22262
22263 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22264 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22265 @end table
22266
22267 @node MIPS Embedded
22268 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22269
22270 @noindent
22271 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22272
22273 @table @code
22274 @item set mipsfpu double
22275 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22276 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22277 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22278 @itemx show mipsfpu
22279 @kindex set mipsfpu
22280 @kindex show mipsfpu
22281 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22282 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22283 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22284 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22285 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22286 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22287 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22288 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22289 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22290 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22291 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22292 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22293 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22294
22295 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22296 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22297 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22298
22299 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22300 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22301 @end table
22302
22303 @node PowerPC Embedded
22304 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22305
22306 @cindex DVC register
22307 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22308 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22309
22310 @smallexample
22311 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22312 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22313 @end smallexample
22314
22315 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22316 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22317 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22318 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22319 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22320 or newer.
22321
22322 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22323 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22324 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22325 watching variables of scalar types.
22326
22327 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22328 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22329
22330 @smallexample
22331 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22332 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22333 @end smallexample
22334
22335 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22336 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22337
22338 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22339 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22340 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22341 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22342 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22343 use the @code{break-range} command.
22344
22345 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22346
22347 @table @code
22348 @kindex break-range
22349 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22350 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22351 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22352 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22353 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22354 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22355 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22356 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22357 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22358
22359 @kindex set powerpc
22360 @item set powerpc soft-float
22361 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22362 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22363 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22364 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22365
22366 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22367 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22368 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22369 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22370 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22371 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22372 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22373 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22374
22375 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22376 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22377 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22378 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22379 address of its first byte.
22380
22381 @end table
22382
22383 @node AVR
22384 @subsection Atmel AVR
22385 @cindex AVR
22386
22387 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22388 following AVR-specific commands:
22389
22390 @table @code
22391 @item info io_registers
22392 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22393 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22394 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22395 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22396 @end table
22397
22398 @node CRIS
22399 @subsection CRIS
22400 @cindex CRIS
22401
22402 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22403 following CRIS-specific commands:
22404
22405 @table @code
22406 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22407 @cindex CRIS version
22408 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22409 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22410 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22411
22412 @item show cris-version
22413 Show the current CRIS version.
22414
22415 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22416 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22417 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22418 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22419 @code{R59}.
22420
22421 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22422 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22423
22424 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22425 @cindex CRIS mode
22426 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22427 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22428 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22429
22430 @item show cris-mode
22431 Show the current CRIS mode.
22432 @end table
22433
22434 @node Super-H
22435 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22436 @cindex Super-H
22437
22438 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22439 commands:
22440
22441 @table @code
22442 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22443 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22444 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22445 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22446 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22447 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22448 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22449 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22450 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22451 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22452 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22453 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22454
22455 @item show sh calling-convention
22456 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22457 Show the current calling convention setting.
22458
22459 @end table
22460
22461
22462 @node Architectures
22463 @section Architectures
22464
22465 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22466 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22467
22468 @menu
22469 * AArch64::
22470 * i386::
22471 * Alpha::
22472 * MIPS::
22473 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22474 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22475 * PowerPC::
22476 * Nios II::
22477 * Sparc64::
22478 @end menu
22479
22480 @node AArch64
22481 @subsection AArch64
22482 @cindex AArch64 support
22483
22484 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22485 following special commands:
22486
22487 @table @code
22488 @item set debug aarch64
22489 @kindex set debug aarch64
22490 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22491 messages are to be displayed.
22492
22493 @item show debug aarch64
22494 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22495
22496 @end table
22497
22498 @node i386
22499 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22500
22501 @table @code
22502 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22503 @kindex set struct-convention
22504 @cindex struct return convention
22505 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22506 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22507 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22508 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22509 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22510 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22511 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22512 be returned in a register.
22513
22514 @item show struct-convention
22515 @kindex show struct-convention
22516 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22517 from functions.
22518 @end table
22519
22520
22521 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22522 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22523
22524 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22525 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22526 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22527 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22528 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22529 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22530 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22531
22532 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22533 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22534 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22535 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22536 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22537 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22538
22539 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22540 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22541 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22542
22543 @smallexample
22544 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22545 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22546 @end smallexample
22547
22548 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22549 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22550 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22551 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22552 the pointer.
22553
22554 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22555 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22556 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22557 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22558 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22559
22560 @table @code
22561 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22562 @kindex show mpx bound
22563 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22564
22565 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22566 @kindex set mpx bound
22567 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22568 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22569 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22570 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22571 @end table
22572
22573 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22574 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22575 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22576 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22577
22578 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22579 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22580 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22581 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22582 function.
22583
22584 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22585 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22586 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22587 continuing the execution. For example:
22588
22589 @smallexample
22590 $ break *upper
22591 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22592 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22593 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22594 $ print $bnd0
22595 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22596 @end smallexample
22597
22598 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22599 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22600 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22601
22602 @node Alpha
22603 @subsection Alpha
22604
22605 See the following section.
22606
22607 @node MIPS
22608 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22609
22610 @cindex stack on Alpha
22611 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22612 @cindex Alpha stack
22613 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22614 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22615 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22616 find the beginning of a function.
22617
22618 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22619 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22620 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22621 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22622 commands:
22623
22624 @table @code
22625 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22626 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22627 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22628 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22629 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22630 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22631 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22632 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22633
22634 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22635 Display the current limit.
22636 @end table
22637
22638 @noindent
22639 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22640 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22641
22642 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22643 programs:
22644
22645 @table @code
22646 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22647 @kindex set mips abi
22648 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22649 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22650 values of @var{arg} are:
22651
22652 @table @samp
22653 @item auto
22654 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22655 default).
22656 @item o32
22657 @item o64
22658 @item n32
22659 @item n64
22660 @item eabi32
22661 @item eabi64
22662 @end table
22663
22664 @item show mips abi
22665 @kindex show mips abi
22666 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22667
22668 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22669 @kindex set mips compression
22670 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22671 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22672 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22673 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22674 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22675 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22676 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22677 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22678 provided by the executable.
22679
22680 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22681 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22682 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22683 identified as such.
22684
22685 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22686 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22687 implicitly from an executable.
22688
22689 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22690 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22691 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22692 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22693 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22694
22695 @item show mips compression
22696 @kindex show mips compression
22697 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22698 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22699
22700 @item set mipsfpu
22701 @itemx show mipsfpu
22702 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22703
22704 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22705 @kindex set mips mask-address
22706 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22707 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22708 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22709 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22710 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22711
22712 @item show mips mask-address
22713 @kindex show mips mask-address
22714 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22715 not.
22716
22717 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22718 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22719 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22720 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22721 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22722 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22723
22724 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22725 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22726 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22727
22728 @item set debug mips
22729 @kindex set debug mips
22730 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22731 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22732
22733 @item show debug mips
22734 @kindex show debug mips
22735 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22736 @end table
22737
22738
22739 @node HPPA
22740 @subsection HPPA
22741 @cindex HPPA support
22742
22743 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22744 following special commands:
22745
22746 @table @code
22747 @item set debug hppa
22748 @kindex set debug hppa
22749 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22750 messages are to be displayed.
22751
22752 @item show debug hppa
22753 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22754
22755 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22756 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22757 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22758 given @var{address}.
22759
22760 @end table
22761
22762
22763 @node SPU
22764 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22765 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22766 @cindex SPU
22767
22768 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22769 it provides the following special commands:
22770
22771 @table @code
22772 @item info spu event
22773 @kindex info spu
22774 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22775 and pending event status.
22776
22777 @item info spu signal
22778 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22779 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22780 notification channels.
22781
22782 @item info spu mailbox
22783 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22784 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22785 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22786
22787 @item info spu dma
22788 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22789 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22790 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22791
22792 @item info spu proxydma
22793 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22794 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22795 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22796
22797 @end table
22798
22799 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22800 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22801 special commands:
22802
22803 @table @code
22804 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22805 @kindex set spu
22806 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22807 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22808 function. The default is @code{off}.
22809
22810 @item show spu stop-on-load
22811 @kindex show spu
22812 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22813
22814 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22815 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22816 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22817 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22818 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22819 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22820
22821 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22822 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22823
22824 @end table
22825
22826 @node PowerPC
22827 @subsection PowerPC
22828 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22829
22830 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22831 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22832 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22833 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22834 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22835
22836 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22837 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22838 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22839
22840 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22841 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22842
22843 @node Nios II
22844 @subsection Nios II
22845 @cindex Nios II architecture
22846
22847 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22848 it provides the following special commands:
22849
22850 @table @code
22851
22852 @item set debug nios2
22853 @kindex set debug nios2
22854 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22855 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22856
22857 @item show debug nios2
22858 @kindex show debug nios2
22859 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22860 @end table
22861
22862 @node Sparc64
22863 @subsection Sparc64
22864 @cindex Sparc64 support
22865 @cindex Application Data Integrity
22866 @subsubsection ADI Support
22867
22868 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
22869 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
22870 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
22871 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
22872 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
22873 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
22874 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
22875 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
22876 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
22877 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
22878 signal.
22879
22880 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
22881 ADI-enabled.
22882
22883 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
22884 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
22885
22886
22887 @table @code
22888 @kindex adi examine
22889 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
22890
22891 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
22892 cacheline.
22893
22894 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
22895 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
22896 block size, to display.
22897
22898 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
22899 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
22900
22901 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
22902
22903 @smallexample
22904 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
22905 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
22906 @end smallexample
22907
22908 @kindex adi assign
22909 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
22910
22911 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
22912 to an address.
22913
22914 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
22915 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
22916 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
22917
22918 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
22919 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
22920
22921 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
22922
22923 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
22924 variable "shmaddr":
22925
22926 @smallexample
22927 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
22928 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
22929 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
22930 @end smallexample
22931
22932 @end table
22933
22934 @node Controlling GDB
22935 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22936
22937 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22938 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22939 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22940 described here.
22941
22942 @menu
22943 * Prompt:: Prompt
22944 * Editing:: Command editing
22945 * Command History:: Command history
22946 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22947 * Numbers:: Numbers
22948 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22949 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22950 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22951 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22952 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22953 @end menu
22954
22955 @node Prompt
22956 @section Prompt
22957
22958 @cindex prompt
22959
22960 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22961 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22962 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22963 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22964 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22965 which one you are talking to.
22966
22967 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22968 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22969 or a prompt that does not.
22970
22971 @table @code
22972 @kindex set prompt
22973 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22974 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22975
22976 @kindex show prompt
22977 @item show prompt
22978 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22979 @end table
22980
22981 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22982 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22983 are:
22984
22985 @table @code
22986 @kindex set extended-prompt
22987 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22988 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22989 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22990 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22991 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22992 is displayed.
22993
22994 For example:
22995
22996 @smallexample
22997 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22998 @end smallexample
22999
23000 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23001 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23002
23003 @kindex show extended-prompt
23004 @item show extended-prompt
23005 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23006 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23007 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23008 @end table
23009
23010 @node Editing
23011 @section Command Editing
23012 @cindex readline
23013 @cindex command line editing
23014
23015 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23016 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23017 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23018 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23019 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23020 debugging sessions.
23021
23022 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23023 command @code{set}.
23024
23025 @table @code
23026 @kindex set editing
23027 @cindex editing
23028 @item set editing
23029 @itemx set editing on
23030 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23031
23032 @item set editing off
23033 Disable command line editing.
23034
23035 @kindex show editing
23036 @item show editing
23037 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23038 @end table
23039
23040 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23041 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23042 @end ifset
23043 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23044 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23045 @end ifclear
23046 for more details about the Readline
23047 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23048 encouraged to read that chapter.
23049
23050 @node Command History
23051 @section Command History
23052 @cindex command history
23053
23054 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23055 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23056 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23057 history facility.
23058
23059 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23060 package, to provide the history facility.
23061 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23062 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23063 @end ifset
23064 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23065 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23066 @end ifclear
23067 for the detailed description of the History library.
23068
23069 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23070 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23071 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23072 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23073 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23074 pressed on a line by itself.
23075
23076 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23077 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23078 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23079 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23080
23081 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23082 history.
23083
23084 @table @code
23085 @cindex history substitution
23086 @cindex history file
23087 @kindex set history filename
23088 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23089 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23090 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23091 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23092 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23093 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23094 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23095 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23096 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23097 is not set.
23098
23099 @cindex save command history
23100 @kindex set history save
23101 @item set history save
23102 @itemx set history save on
23103 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23104 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23105
23106 @item set history save off
23107 Stop recording command history in a file.
23108
23109 @cindex history size
23110 @kindex set history size
23111 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23112 @item set history size @var{size}
23113 @itemx set history size unlimited
23114 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23115 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23116 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23117 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23118 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23119 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23120
23121 @cindex remove duplicate history
23122 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23123 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23124 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23125 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23126 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23127 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23128 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23129 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23130 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23131
23132 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23133 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23134
23135 @end table
23136
23137 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23138 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23139 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23140 @end ifset
23141 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23142 @xref{Event Designators},
23143 @end ifclear
23144 for more details.
23145
23146 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23147 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23148 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23149 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23150 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23151 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23152 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23153 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23154
23155 The commands to control history expansion are:
23156
23157 @table @code
23158 @item set history expansion on
23159 @itemx set history expansion
23160 @kindex set history expansion
23161 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23162
23163 @item set history expansion off
23164 Disable history expansion.
23165
23166 @c @group
23167 @kindex show history
23168 @item show history
23169 @itemx show history filename
23170 @itemx show history save
23171 @itemx show history size
23172 @itemx show history expansion
23173 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23174 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23175 @c @end group
23176 @end table
23177
23178 @table @code
23179 @kindex show commands
23180 @cindex show last commands
23181 @cindex display command history
23182 @item show commands
23183 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23184
23185 @item show commands @var{n}
23186 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23187
23188 @item show commands +
23189 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23190 @end table
23191
23192 @node Screen Size
23193 @section Screen Size
23194 @cindex size of screen
23195 @cindex screen size
23196 @cindex pagination
23197 @cindex page size
23198 @cindex pauses in output
23199
23200 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23201 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23202 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23203 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23204 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23205 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23206 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23207 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23208
23209 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23210 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23211 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23212 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23213 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23214 width} commands:
23215
23216 @table @code
23217 @kindex set height
23218 @kindex set width
23219 @kindex show width
23220 @kindex show height
23221 @item set height @var{lpp}
23222 @itemx set height unlimited
23223 @itemx show height
23224 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23225 @itemx set width unlimited
23226 @itemx show width
23227 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23228 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23229 commands display the current settings.
23230
23231 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23232 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23233 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23234 buffer.
23235
23236 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23237 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23238
23239 @item set pagination on
23240 @itemx set pagination off
23241 @kindex set pagination
23242 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23243 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23244 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23245 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23246
23247 @item show pagination
23248 @kindex show pagination
23249 Show the current pagination mode.
23250 @end table
23251
23252 @node Numbers
23253 @section Numbers
23254 @cindex number representation
23255 @cindex entering numbers
23256
23257 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23258 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23259 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23260 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23261 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23262 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23263 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23264 both input and output with the commands described below.
23265
23266 @table @code
23267 @kindex set input-radix
23268 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23269 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23270 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23271 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23272 example, any of
23273
23274 @smallexample
23275 set input-radix 012
23276 set input-radix 10.
23277 set input-radix 0xa
23278 @end smallexample
23279
23280 @noindent
23281 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23282 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23283 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23284 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23285 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23286 change the radix.
23287
23288 @kindex set output-radix
23289 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23290 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23291 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23292 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23293
23294 @kindex show input-radix
23295 @item show input-radix
23296 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23297
23298 @kindex show output-radix
23299 @item show output-radix
23300 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23301
23302 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23303 @itemx show radix
23304 @kindex set radix
23305 @kindex show radix
23306 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23307 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23308 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23309 default value of 10.
23310
23311 @end table
23312
23313 @node ABI
23314 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23315
23316 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23317 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23318 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23319 current ABI.
23320
23321 @cindex OS ABI
23322 @kindex set osabi
23323 @kindex show osabi
23324 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23325
23326 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23327 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23328 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23329 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23330 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23331 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23332 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23333 platform provides.
23334
23335 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23336 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23337 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23338 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23339
23340 @table @code
23341 @item show osabi
23342 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23343
23344 @item set osabi
23345 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23346
23347 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23348 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23349 @end table
23350
23351 @cindex float promotion
23352
23353 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23354 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23355 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23356 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23357 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23358 @code{double} and then passed.
23359
23360 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23361 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23362 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23363
23364 @table @code
23365 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23366 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23367 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23368 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23369 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23370
23371 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23372 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23373 functions.
23374
23375 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23376 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23377 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23378 @end table
23379
23380 @kindex set cp-abi
23381 @kindex show cp-abi
23382 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23383 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23384 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23385 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23386 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23387 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23388 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23389 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23390 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23391 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23392 ``auto''.
23393
23394 @table @code
23395 @item show cp-abi
23396 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23397
23398 @item set cp-abi
23399 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23400
23401 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23402 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23403 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23404 @end table
23405
23406 @node Auto-loading
23407 @section Automatically loading associated files
23408 @cindex auto-loading
23409
23410 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23411 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23412 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23413 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23414 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23415 sources).
23416
23417 @menu
23418 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23419 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23420
23421 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23422 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23423 @end menu
23424
23425 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23426 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23427 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23428
23429 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23430 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23431 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23432
23433 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23434 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23435
23436 @table @code
23437 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23438 @kindex set auto-load off
23439 @item set auto-load off
23440 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23441 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23442 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23443 @smallexample
23444 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23445 @end smallexample
23446
23447 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23448 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23449 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23450 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23451 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23452 @code{set auto-load no}.
23453
23454 @anchor{show auto-load}
23455 @kindex show auto-load
23456 @item show auto-load
23457 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23458 or disabled.
23459
23460 @smallexample
23461 (gdb) show auto-load
23462 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23463 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23464 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23465 is on.
23466 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23467 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23468 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23469 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23470 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23471 @end smallexample
23472
23473 @anchor{info auto-load}
23474 @kindex info auto-load
23475 @item info auto-load
23476 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23477 not.
23478
23479 @smallexample
23480 (gdb) info auto-load
23481 gdb-scripts:
23482 Loaded Script
23483 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23484 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23485 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23486 loaded.
23487 python-scripts:
23488 Loaded Script
23489 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23490 @end smallexample
23491 @end table
23492
23493 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23494
23495 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23496 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23497 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23498 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23499 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23500 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23501 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23502 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23503 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23504 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23505 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23506 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23507 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23508 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23509 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23510 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23511 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23512 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23513 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23514 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23515 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23516 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23517 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23518 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23519 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23520 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23521 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23522 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23523 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23524 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23525 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23526 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23527 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23528 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23529 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23530 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23531 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23532 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23533 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23534 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23535 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23536 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23537 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23538 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23539 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23540 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23541 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23542 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23543 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23544 @end multitable
23545
23546 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23547 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23548 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23549
23550 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23551 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23552 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23553
23554 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23555 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23556
23557 @table @code
23558 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23559 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23560 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23561 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23562 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23563
23564 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23565 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23566 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23567 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23568 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23569
23570 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23571 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23572 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23573 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23574 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23575 @end table
23576
23577 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23578 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23579 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23580
23581 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23582
23583 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23584 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23585
23586 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23587 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23588 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23589 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23590 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23591 library.
23592
23593 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23594 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23595
23596 @table @code
23597 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23598 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23599 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23600 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23601
23602 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23603 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23604 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23605 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23606 enabled or disabled.
23607
23608 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23609 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23610 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23611 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23612 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23613 @end table
23614
23615 @node Auto-loading safe path
23616 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23617 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23618
23619 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23620 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23621 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23622 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23623 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23624
23625 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23626 get loaded:
23627
23628 @smallexample
23629 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23630 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23631 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23632 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23633 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23634 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23635 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23636 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23637 @end smallexample
23638
23639 @noindent
23640 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23641 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23642
23643 @smallexample
23644 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23645 @end smallexample
23646
23647 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23648
23649 @table @code
23650 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23651 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23652 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23653 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23654 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23655 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23656 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23657 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23658 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23659 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23660
23661 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23662 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23663 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23664
23665 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23666 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23667 @item show auto-load safe-path
23668 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23669 scripts.
23670
23671 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23672 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23673 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23674 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23675 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23676 by the host platform path separator in use.
23677 @end table
23678
23679 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23680 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23681 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23682 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23683 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23684
23685 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23686 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23687 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23688 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23689 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23690 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23691 init file in the current directory
23692 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23693
23694 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23695 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23696
23697 @table @asis
23698 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23699 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23700 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23701 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23702
23703 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23704 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23705 @value{GDBN} session.
23706
23707 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23708 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23709 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23710 from trusted sources.
23711
23712 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23713 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23714 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23715 trusted sources.
23716 @end table
23717
23718 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23719 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23720
23721 @table @asis
23722 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23723 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23724
23725 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23726 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23727 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23728 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23729 @end table
23730
23731 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23732 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23733 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23734 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23735 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23736 recommended to be entered.
23737
23738 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23739 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23740 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23741
23742 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23743 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23744 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23745 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23746 be printed.
23747
23748 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23749 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23750 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23751
23752 @smallexample
23753 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23754 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23755 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23756 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23757 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23758 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23759 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23760 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23761 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23762 @end smallexample
23763
23764 @table @code
23765 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23766 @kindex set debug auto-load
23767 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23768 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23769
23770 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23771 @kindex show debug auto-load
23772 @item show debug auto-load
23773 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23774 on or off.
23775 @end table
23776
23777 @node Messages/Warnings
23778 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23779
23780 @cindex verbose operation
23781 @cindex optional warnings
23782 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23783 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23784 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23785 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23786
23787 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23788 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23789 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23790
23791 @table @code
23792 @kindex set verbose
23793 @item set verbose on
23794 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23795
23796 @item set verbose off
23797 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23798
23799 @kindex show verbose
23800 @item show verbose
23801 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23802 @end table
23803
23804 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23805 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23806 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23807 Symbol Files}).
23808
23809 @table @code
23810
23811 @kindex set complaints
23812 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23813 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23814 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23815 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23816 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23817
23818 @kindex show complaints
23819 @item show complaints
23820 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23821
23822 @end table
23823
23824 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23825 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23826 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23827 you try to run a program which is already running:
23828
23829 @smallexample
23830 (@value{GDBP}) run
23831 The program being debugged has been started already.
23832 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23833 @end smallexample
23834
23835 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23836 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23837
23838 @table @code
23839
23840 @kindex set confirm
23841 @cindex flinching
23842 @cindex confirmation
23843 @cindex stupid questions
23844 @item set confirm off
23845 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23846 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23847 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23848
23849 @item set confirm on
23850 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23851
23852 @kindex show confirm
23853 @item show confirm
23854 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23855
23856 @end table
23857
23858 @cindex command tracing
23859 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23860 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23861 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23862 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23863
23864 @table @code
23865 @kindex set trace-commands
23866 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23867 @item set trace-commands on
23868 Enable command tracing.
23869 @item set trace-commands off
23870 Disable command tracing.
23871 @item show trace-commands
23872 Display the current state of command tracing.
23873 @end table
23874
23875 @node Debugging Output
23876 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23877 @cindex optional debugging messages
23878
23879 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23880 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23881 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23882 section documents those commands.
23883
23884 @table @code
23885 @kindex set exec-done-display
23886 @item set exec-done-display
23887 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23888 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23889 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23890 @kindex show exec-done-display
23891 @item show exec-done-display
23892 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23893 notification.
23894 @kindex set debug
23895 @cindex ARM AArch64
23896 @item set debug aarch64
23897 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23898 The default is off.
23899 @kindex show debug
23900 @item show debug aarch64
23901 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23902 ARM AArch64.
23903 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23904 @cindex architecture debugging info
23905 @item set debug arch
23906 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23907 @item show debug arch
23908 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23909 @item set debug aix-solib
23910 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23911 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23912 support module. The default is off.
23913 @item show debug aix-thread
23914 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23915 @item set debug aix-thread
23916 @cindex AIX threads
23917 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23918 module.
23919 @item show debug aix-thread
23920 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23921 @item set debug check-physname
23922 @cindex physname
23923 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23924 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23925 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23926 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23927 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23928 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23929 @item show debug check-physname
23930 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23931 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23932 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23933 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23934 exported symbols. The default is off.
23935 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23936 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23937 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23938 @item set debug dwarf-die
23939 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23940 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23941 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23942 A value of zero turns off the display.
23943 @item show debug dwarf-die
23944 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23945 @item set debug dwarf-line
23946 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23947 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23948 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23949 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23950 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23951 @item show debug dwarf-line
23952 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23953 @item set debug dwarf-read
23954 @cindex DWARF Reading
23955 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23956 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23957 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23958 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23959 @item show debug dwarf-read
23960 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23961 @item set debug displaced
23962 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23963 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23964 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23965 @item show debug displaced
23966 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23967 related to displaced stepping.
23968 @item set debug event
23969 @cindex event debugging info
23970 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23971 default is off.
23972 @item show debug event
23973 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23974 info.
23975 @item set debug expression
23976 @cindex expression debugging info
23977 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23978 expression parsing. The default is off.
23979 @item show debug expression
23980 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23981 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23982 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23983 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23984 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23985 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23986 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23987 @item set debug frame
23988 @cindex frame debugging info
23989 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23990 default is off.
23991 @item show debug frame
23992 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23993 info.
23994 @item set debug gnu-nat
23995 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23996 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23997 @item show debug gnu-nat
23998 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23999 @item set debug infrun
24000 @cindex inferior debugging info
24001 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24002 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24003 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24004 @item show debug infrun
24005 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24006 @item set debug jit
24007 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24008 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24009 @item show debug jit
24010 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24011 @item set debug lin-lwp
24012 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24013 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24014 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24015 @item show debug lin-lwp
24016 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24017 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24018 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24019 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24020 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24021 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24022 @item set debug mach-o
24023 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24024 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24025 processing. The default is off.
24026 @item show debug mach-o
24027 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24028 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24029 @item set debug notification
24030 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24031 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24032 The default is off.
24033 @item show debug notification
24034 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24035 @item set debug observer
24036 @cindex observer debugging info
24037 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24038 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24039 @item show debug observer
24040 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24041 @item set debug overload
24042 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24043 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24044 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24045 is off.
24046 @item show debug overload
24047 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24048 debugging info.
24049 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24050 @cindex debug expression parser
24051 @item set debug parser
24052 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24053 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24054 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24055 details. The default is off.
24056 @item show debug parser
24057 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24058 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24059 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24060 @cindex debug remote protocol
24061 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24062 @cindex display remote packets
24063 @item set debug remote
24064 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24065 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24066 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24067 @item show debug remote
24068 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24069
24070 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24071 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24072 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24073 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24074
24075 @item set debug serial
24076 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24077 default is off.
24078 @item show debug serial
24079 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24080 info.
24081 @item set debug solib-frv
24082 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24083 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24084 @item show debug solib-frv
24085 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24086 messages.
24087 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24088 @cindex symbol lookup
24089 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24090 The default is 0 (off).
24091 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24092 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24093 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24094 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24095 @item set debug symfile
24096 @cindex symbol file functions
24097 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24098 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24099 @item show debug symfile
24100 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24101 @item set debug symtab-create
24102 @cindex symbol table creation
24103 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24104 The default is 0 (off).
24105 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24106 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24107 @item show debug symtab-create
24108 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24109 @item set debug target
24110 @cindex target debugging info
24111 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24112 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24113 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24114 value of large memory transfers.
24115 @item show debug target
24116 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24117 info.
24118 @item set debug timestamp
24119 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24120 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24121 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24122 message.
24123 @item show debug timestamp
24124 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24125 debugging info.
24126 @item set debug varobj
24127 @cindex variable object debugging info
24128 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24129 info. The default is off.
24130 @item show debug varobj
24131 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24132 debugging info.
24133 @item set debug xml
24134 @cindex XML parser debugging
24135 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24136 @item show debug xml
24137 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24138 @end table
24139
24140 @node Other Misc Settings
24141 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24142 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24143
24144 @table @code
24145 @kindex set interactive-mode
24146 @item set interactive-mode
24147 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24148 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24149 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24150 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24151 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24152 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24153 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24154 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24155
24156 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24157 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24158 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24159 inside a cygwin window.
24160
24161 @kindex show interactive-mode
24162 @item show interactive-mode
24163 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24164 @end table
24165
24166 @node Extending GDB
24167 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24168 @cindex extending GDB
24169
24170 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24171 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24172 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24173 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24174 being debugged.
24175
24176 @menu
24177 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24178 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24179 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24180 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24181 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24182 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24183 @end menu
24184
24185 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24186 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24187 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24188 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24189 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24190 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24191
24192 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24193 setting:
24194
24195 @table @code
24196 @kindex set script-extension
24197 @kindex show script-extension
24198 @item set script-extension off
24199 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24200
24201 @item set script-extension soft
24202 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24203 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24204 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24205 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24206
24207 @item set script-extension strict
24208 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24209 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24210 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24211
24212 @item show script-extension
24213 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24214
24215 @end table
24216
24217 @node Sequences
24218 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24219
24220 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24221 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24222 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24223 files.
24224
24225 @menu
24226 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24227 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24228 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24229 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24230 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24231 @end menu
24232
24233 @node Define
24234 @subsection User-defined Commands
24235
24236 @cindex user-defined command
24237 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24238 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24239 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24240 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24241 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24242 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24243
24244 @smallexample
24245 define adder
24246 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24247 end
24248 @end smallexample
24249
24250 @noindent
24251 To execute the command use:
24252
24253 @smallexample
24254 adder 1 2 3
24255 @end smallexample
24256
24257 @noindent
24258 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24259 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24260 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24261 functions calls.
24262
24263 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24264 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24265 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24266 been passed.
24267
24268 @smallexample
24269 define adder
24270 if $argc == 2
24271 print $arg0 + $arg1
24272 end
24273 if $argc == 3
24274 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24275 end
24276 end
24277 @end smallexample
24278
24279 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24280 to process a variable number of arguments:
24281
24282 @smallexample
24283 define adder
24284 set $i = 0
24285 set $sum = 0
24286 while $i < $argc
24287 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24288 set $i = $i + 1
24289 end
24290 print $sum
24291 end
24292 @end smallexample
24293
24294 @table @code
24295
24296 @kindex define
24297 @item define @var{commandname}
24298 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24299 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24300 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24301 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24302 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24303 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24304
24305 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24306 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24307 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24308
24309 @kindex document
24310 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24311 @item document @var{commandname}
24312 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24313 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24314 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24315 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24316 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24317 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24318
24319 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24320 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24321 does not change the documentation.
24322
24323 @kindex dont-repeat
24324 @cindex don't repeat command
24325 @item dont-repeat
24326 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24327 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24328 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24329
24330 @kindex help user-defined
24331 @item help user-defined
24332 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24333 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24334 included (if any).
24335
24336 @kindex show user
24337 @item show user
24338 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24339 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24340 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24341 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24342 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24343
24344 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24345 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24346 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24347 @item show max-user-call-depth
24348 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24349 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24350 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24351 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24352 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24353 @end table
24354
24355 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24356 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24357
24358 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24359 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24360 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24361
24362 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24363 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24364 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24365 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24366
24367 @node Hooks
24368 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24369 @cindex command hooks
24370 @cindex hooks, for commands
24371 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24372
24373 @kindex hook
24374 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24375 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24376 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24377 before that command.
24378
24379 @cindex hooks, post-command
24380 @kindex hookpost
24381 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24382 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24383 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24384 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24385 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24386
24387 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24388 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24389
24390 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24391 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24392
24393 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24394 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24395 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24396 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24397 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24398
24399 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24400 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24401 you could define:
24402
24403 @smallexample
24404 define hook-stop
24405 handle SIGALRM nopass
24406 end
24407
24408 define hook-run
24409 handle SIGALRM pass
24410 end
24411
24412 define hook-continue
24413 handle SIGALRM pass
24414 end
24415 @end smallexample
24416
24417 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24418 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24419 you could define:
24420
24421 @smallexample
24422 define hook-echo
24423 echo <<<---
24424 end
24425
24426 define hookpost-echo
24427 echo --->>>\n
24428 end
24429
24430 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24431 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24432 (@value{GDBP})
24433
24434 @end smallexample
24435
24436 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24437 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24438 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24439 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24440 @c or not?
24441 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24442 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24443 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24444
24445 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24446 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24447 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24448
24449 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24450 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24451
24452 @node Command Files
24453 @subsection Command Files
24454
24455 @cindex command files
24456 @cindex scripting commands
24457 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24458 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24459 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24460 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24461 terminal.
24462
24463 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24464 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24465 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24466 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24467 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24468
24469 @table @code
24470 @kindex source
24471 @cindex execute commands from a file
24472 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24473 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24474 @end table
24475
24476 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24477 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24478 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24479 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24480 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24481
24482 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24483 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24484 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24485 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24486 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24487 is not relevant to scripts.
24488
24489 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24490 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24491 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24492 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24493 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24494 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24495 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24496 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24497 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24498 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24499 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24500 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24501 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24502 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24503
24504 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24505 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24506 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24507
24508 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24509 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24510 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24511 when called from command files.
24512
24513 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24514 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24515 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24516 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24517 the next command.
24518
24519 @smallexample
24520 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24521 @end smallexample
24522
24523 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24524 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24525 would be directed to @file{log}.
24526
24527 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24528 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24529 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24530 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24531 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24532 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24533 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24534 conditionally, etc.
24535
24536 @table @code
24537 @kindex if
24538 @kindex else
24539 @item if
24540 @itemx else
24541 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24542 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24543 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24544 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24545 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24546 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24547 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24548
24549 @kindex while
24550 @item while
24551 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24552 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24553 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24554 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24555 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24556 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24557
24558 @kindex loop_break
24559 @item loop_break
24560 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24561 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24562 line.
24563
24564 @kindex loop_continue
24565 @item loop_continue
24566 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24567 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24568 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24569 the controlling expression.
24570
24571 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24572 @item end
24573 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24574 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24575 @end table
24576
24577
24578 @node Output
24579 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24580
24581 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24582 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24583 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24584 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24585 want.
24586
24587 @table @code
24588 @kindex echo
24589 @item echo @var{text}
24590 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24591 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24592 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24593 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24594 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24595 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24596 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24597 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24598 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24599 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24600 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24601
24602 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24603 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24604
24605 @smallexample
24606 echo This is some text\n\
24607 which is continued\n\
24608 onto several lines.\n
24609 @end smallexample
24610
24611 produces the same output as
24612
24613 @smallexample
24614 echo This is some text\n
24615 echo which is continued\n
24616 echo onto several lines.\n
24617 @end smallexample
24618
24619 @kindex output
24620 @item output @var{expression}
24621 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24622 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24623 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24624 on expressions.
24625
24626 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24627 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24628 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24629 Formats}, for more information.
24630
24631 @kindex printf
24632 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24633 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24634 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24635 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24636 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24637 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24638 executing the code below:
24639
24640 @smallexample
24641 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24642 @end smallexample
24643
24644 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24645 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24646 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24647 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24648 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24649 printed.
24650
24651 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24652
24653 @smallexample
24654 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24655 @end smallexample
24656
24657 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24658 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24659 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24660
24661 @itemize @bullet
24662 @item
24663 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24664
24665 @item
24666 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24667 width.
24668
24669 @item
24670 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24671 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24672
24673 @item
24674 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24675 supported.
24676
24677 @item
24678 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24679
24680 @item
24681 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24682 @end itemize
24683
24684 @noindent
24685 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24686 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24687 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24688 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24689
24690 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24691 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24692 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24693 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24694 supported.
24695
24696 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24697 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24698 together with a floating point specifier.
24699 letters:
24700
24701 @itemize @bullet
24702 @item
24703 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24704
24705 @item
24706 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24707
24708 @item
24709 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24710 @end itemize
24711
24712 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24713 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24714 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24715
24716 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24717 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24718
24719 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24720 @smallexample
24721 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24722 @end smallexample
24723
24724 @anchor{eval}
24725 @kindex eval
24726 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24727 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24728 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24729
24730 @end table
24731
24732 @node Auto-loading sequences
24733 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24734 @cindex native script auto-loading
24735
24736 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24737 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24738 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24739 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24740
24741 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24742 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24743
24744 @table @code
24745 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24746 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24747 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24748 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24749
24750 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24751 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24752 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24753 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24754 disabled.
24755
24756 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24757 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24758 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24759 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24760 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24761 auto-loaded.
24762 @end table
24763
24764 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24765 matching names are printed.
24766
24767 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24768 @include python.texi
24769
24770 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24771 @include guile.texi
24772
24773 @node Auto-loading extensions
24774 @section Auto-loading extensions
24775 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24776
24777 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24778 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24779 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24780 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24781 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24782
24783 @menu
24784 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24785 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24786 * Which flavor to choose?::
24787 @end menu
24788
24789 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24790 debugging commands and features.
24791
24792 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24793 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24794 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24795 for more information.
24796 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24797 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24798
24799 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24800 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24801
24802 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24803 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24804 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24805 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24806 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24807
24808 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24809 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24810 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24811 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24812
24813 @table @code
24814 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24815 GDB's own command language
24816 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24817 Python
24818 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24819 Guile
24820 @end table
24821
24822 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24823 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24824 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24825 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24826 script in the specified extension language.
24827
24828 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24829 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24830
24831 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24832 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24833
24834 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24835 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24836 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24837 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24838 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24839 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24840
24841 @table @code
24842 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24843 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24844 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24845 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24846 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24847 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24848
24849 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24850 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24851
24852 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24853 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24854 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24855 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24856
24857 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24858 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24859 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24860 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24861 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24862 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24863 platform.
24864
24865 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24866 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24867 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24868
24869 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24870 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24871 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24872 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24873
24874 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24875 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24876 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24877 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24878 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24879 @end table
24880
24881 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24882 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24883 @var{objfile} is opened.
24884 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24885 is evaluated more than once.
24886
24887 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24888 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24889 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24890
24891 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24892 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24893 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24894 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24895 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24896 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24897 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24898
24899 The following entries are supported:
24900
24901 @table @code
24902 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24903 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24904 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24905 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24906 @end table
24907
24908 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24909
24910 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24911 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24912 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24913 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24914 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24915
24916 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24917 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24918
24919 @example
24920 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24921 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24922 asm("\
24923 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24924 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24925 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24926 .popsection \n\
24927 ");
24928 @end example
24929
24930 @noindent
24931 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24932 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24933
24934 @example
24935 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24936 @end example
24937
24938 The script name may include directories if desired.
24939
24940 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24941 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24942
24943 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24944 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24945 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24946 will remove duplicates.
24947
24948 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24949
24950 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24951 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24952 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24953 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24954 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24955 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24956 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24957 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24958 on its name.
24959
24960 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24961 testsuite.
24962
24963 @example
24964 #include "symcat.h"
24965 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24966 asm(
24967 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24968 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24969 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24970 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24971 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24972 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24973 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24974 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24975 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24976 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24977 ".byte 0\n"
24978 ".popsection\n"
24979 );
24980 @end example
24981
24982 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24983 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24984 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24985 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24986
24987 @node Which flavor to choose?
24988 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24989
24990 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24991 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24992
24993 @noindent
24994 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24995
24996 @itemize @bullet
24997 @item
24998 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24999
25000 @item
25001 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25002
25003 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25004 in the source search path.
25005 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25006 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25007
25008 @item
25009 Doesn't require source code additions.
25010 @end itemize
25011
25012 @noindent
25013 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25014
25015 @itemize @bullet
25016 @item
25017 Works with static linking.
25018
25019 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25020 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25021 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25022 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25023 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25024
25025 @item
25026 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25027
25028 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25029 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25030
25031 @item
25032 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25033
25034 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25035 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25036 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25037 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25038 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25039 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25040 @end itemize
25041
25042 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25043 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25044
25045 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25046 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25047 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25048
25049 @subsection Python comes first
25050
25051 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25052 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25053 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25054 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25055 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25056 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25057 pretty-printed form of a value).
25058 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25059 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25060 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25061
25062 @node Aliases
25063 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25064 @cindex aliases for commands
25065
25066 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25067 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25068 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25069 that involves less typing.
25070
25071 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25072 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25073 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25074
25075 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25076 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25077 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25078
25079 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25080
25081 @table @code
25082
25083 @kindex alias
25084 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25085
25086 @end table
25087
25088 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25089 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25090 underscores.
25091
25092 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25093 that is being aliased.
25094
25095 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25096 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25097 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25098
25099 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25100 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25101
25102 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25103 of a command so that there is less to type.
25104 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25105 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25106 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25107 The following will accomplish this.
25108
25109 @smallexample
25110 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25111 @end smallexample
25112
25113 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25114 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25115 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25116 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25117
25118 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25119 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25120 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25121 of a command.
25122
25123 @smallexample
25124 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25125 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25126 (gdb) set p elms 20
25127 (gdb) show p elms
25128 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25129 @end smallexample
25130
25131 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25132 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25133 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25134
25135 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25136 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25137
25138 @smallexample
25139 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25140 @end smallexample
25141
25142 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25143 alias for a more complex command.
25144 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25145
25146 @smallexample
25147 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25148 (gdb) spe 20
25149 @end smallexample
25150
25151 @node Interpreters
25152 @chapter Command Interpreters
25153 @cindex command interpreters
25154
25155 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25156 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25157 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25158
25159 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25160 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25161 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25162 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25163
25164 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25165 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25166 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25167 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25168
25169 @table @code
25170 @item console
25171 @cindex console interpreter
25172 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25173 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25174 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25175
25176 @item mi
25177 @cindex mi interpreter
25178 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25179 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25180 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25181 Interface}.
25182
25183 @item mi2
25184 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25185 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25186
25187 @item mi1
25188 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25189 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25190
25191 @end table
25192
25193 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25194
25195 @kindex interpreter-exec
25196 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25197 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25198 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25199
25200 @smallexample
25201 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25202 @end smallexample
25203
25204 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25205 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25206
25207 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25208 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25209 permanently.
25210
25211 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25212
25213 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25214 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25215 device (usually a tty).
25216
25217 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25218 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25219 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25220 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25221 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25222 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25223 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25224 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25225 the separate MI interpreter.
25226
25227 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25228 @code{new-ui} command:
25229
25230 @kindex new-ui
25231 @cindex new user interface
25232 @smallexample
25233 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25234 @end smallexample
25235
25236 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25237 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25238 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25239 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25240 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25241 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25242
25243 @smallexample
25244 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25245 @end smallexample
25246
25247 @noindent
25248 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25249
25250 @node TUI
25251 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25252 @cindex TUI
25253 @cindex Text User Interface
25254
25255 @menu
25256 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25257 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25258 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25259 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25260 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25261 @end menu
25262
25263 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25264 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25265 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25266 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25267 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25268 is available.
25269
25270 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25271 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25272 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25273 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25274 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25275 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25276
25277 @node TUI Overview
25278 @section TUI Overview
25279
25280 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25281
25282 @table @emph
25283 @item command
25284 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25285 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25286 managed using readline.
25287
25288 @item source
25289 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25290 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25291
25292 @item assembly
25293 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25294
25295 @item register
25296 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25297 when their values change.
25298 @end table
25299
25300 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25301 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25302 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25303 indicates the breakpoint type:
25304
25305 @table @code
25306 @item B
25307 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25308
25309 @item b
25310 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25311
25312 @item H
25313 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25314
25315 @item h
25316 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25317 @end table
25318
25319 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25320
25321 @table @code
25322 @item +
25323 Breakpoint is enabled.
25324
25325 @item -
25326 Breakpoint is disabled.
25327 @end table
25328
25329 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25330 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25331 changes.
25332
25333 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25334 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25335 layouts:
25336
25337 @itemize @bullet
25338 @item
25339 source only,
25340
25341 @item
25342 assembly only,
25343
25344 @item
25345 source and assembly,
25346
25347 @item
25348 source and registers, or
25349
25350 @item
25351 assembly and registers.
25352 @end itemize
25353
25354 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25355
25356 @table @emph
25357 @item target
25358 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25359 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25360
25361 @item process
25362 Gives the current process or thread number.
25363 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25364
25365 @item function
25366 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25367 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25368 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25369 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25370
25371 @item line
25372 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25373 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25374
25375 @item pc
25376 Indicates the current program counter address.
25377 @end table
25378
25379 @node TUI Keys
25380 @section TUI Key Bindings
25381 @cindex TUI key bindings
25382
25383 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25384 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25385 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25386 @end ifset
25387 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25388 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25389 @end ifclear
25390 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25391 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25392
25393 @table @kbd
25394 @kindex C-x C-a
25395 @item C-x C-a
25396 @kindex C-x a
25397 @itemx C-x a
25398 @kindex C-x A
25399 @itemx C-x A
25400 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25401 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25402 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25403 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25404 The screen is then refreshed.
25405
25406 @kindex C-x 1
25407 @item C-x 1
25408 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25409 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25410 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25411
25412 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25413
25414 @kindex C-x 2
25415 @item C-x 2
25416 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25417 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25418 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25419 previous layout and the new one.
25420
25421 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25422
25423 @kindex C-x o
25424 @item C-x o
25425 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25426 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25427 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25428
25429 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25430
25431 @kindex C-x s
25432 @item C-x s
25433 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25434 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25435 @end table
25436
25437 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25438
25439 @table @asis
25440 @kindex PgUp
25441 @item @key{PgUp}
25442 Scroll the active window one page up.
25443
25444 @kindex PgDn
25445 @item @key{PgDn}
25446 Scroll the active window one page down.
25447
25448 @kindex Up
25449 @item @key{Up}
25450 Scroll the active window one line up.
25451
25452 @kindex Down
25453 @item @key{Down}
25454 Scroll the active window one line down.
25455
25456 @kindex Left
25457 @item @key{Left}
25458 Scroll the active window one column left.
25459
25460 @kindex Right
25461 @item @key{Right}
25462 Scroll the active window one column right.
25463
25464 @kindex C-L
25465 @item @kbd{C-L}
25466 Refresh the screen.
25467 @end table
25468
25469 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25470 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25471 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25472 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25473 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25474
25475 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25476 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25477 @cindex TUI single key mode
25478
25479 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25480 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25481 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25482
25483 @table @kbd
25484 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25485 @item c
25486 continue
25487
25488 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25489 @item d
25490 down
25491
25492 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25493 @item f
25494 finish
25495
25496 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25497 @item n
25498 next
25499
25500 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25501 @item o
25502 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25503
25504 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25505 @item q
25506 exit the SingleKey mode.
25507
25508 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25509 @item r
25510 run
25511
25512 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25513 @item s
25514 step
25515
25516 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25517 @item i
25518 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25519
25520 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25521 @item u
25522 up
25523
25524 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25525 @item v
25526 info locals
25527
25528 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25529 @item w
25530 where
25531 @end table
25532
25533 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25534 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25535 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25536 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25537 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25538 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25539
25540
25541 @node TUI Commands
25542 @section TUI-specific Commands
25543 @cindex TUI commands
25544
25545 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25546 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25547 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25548 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25549
25550 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25551 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25552 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25553 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25554 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25555
25556 @table @code
25557 @item tui enable
25558 @kindex tui enable
25559 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25560 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25561 otherwise a default layout is used.
25562
25563 @item tui disable
25564 @kindex tui disable
25565 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25566
25567 @item info win
25568 @kindex info win
25569 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25570
25571 @item layout @var{name}
25572 @kindex layout
25573 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25574 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25575 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25576
25577 @table @code
25578 @item next
25579 Display the next layout.
25580
25581 @item prev
25582 Display the previous layout.
25583
25584 @item src
25585 Display the source and command windows.
25586
25587 @item asm
25588 Display the assembly and command windows.
25589
25590 @item split
25591 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25592
25593 @item regs
25594 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25595 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25596 register, assembler, and command windows.
25597 @end table
25598
25599 @item focus @var{name}
25600 @kindex focus
25601 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25602 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25603
25604 @table @code
25605 @item next
25606 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25607
25608 @item prev
25609 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25610
25611 @item src
25612 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25613
25614 @item asm
25615 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25616
25617 @item regs
25618 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25619
25620 @item cmd
25621 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25622 @end table
25623
25624 @item refresh
25625 @kindex refresh
25626 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25627
25628 @item tui reg @var{group}
25629 @kindex tui reg
25630 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25631 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25632 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25633 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25634 following groups are available on most targets:
25635 @table @code
25636 @item next
25637 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25638 through all of the available register groups.
25639
25640 @item prev
25641 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25642 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25643 @var{next}.
25644
25645 @item general
25646 Display the general registers.
25647 @item float
25648 Display the floating point registers.
25649 @item system
25650 Display the system registers.
25651 @item vector
25652 Display the vector registers.
25653 @item all
25654 Display all registers.
25655 @end table
25656
25657 @item update
25658 @kindex update
25659 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25660
25661 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25662 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25663 @kindex winheight
25664 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25665 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25666 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25667 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25668 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25669
25670 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25671 @kindex tabset
25672 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25673 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25674 assembly windows.
25675 @end table
25676
25677 @node TUI Configuration
25678 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25679 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25680
25681 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25682
25683 @table @code
25684 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25685 @kindex set tui border-kind
25686 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25687 The possible values are the following:
25688 @table @code
25689 @item space
25690 Use a space character to draw the border.
25691
25692 @item ascii
25693 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25694
25695 @item acs
25696 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25697 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25698 @end table
25699
25700 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25701 @kindex set tui border-mode
25702 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25703 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25704 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25705 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25706 @table @code
25707 @item normal
25708 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25709
25710 @item standout
25711 Use standout mode.
25712
25713 @item reverse
25714 Use reverse video mode.
25715
25716 @item half
25717 Use half bright mode.
25718
25719 @item half-standout
25720 Use half bright and standout mode.
25721
25722 @item bold
25723 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25724
25725 @item bold-standout
25726 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25727 @end table
25728 @end table
25729
25730 @node Emacs
25731 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25732
25733 @cindex Emacs
25734 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25735 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25736 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25737 @value{GDBN}.
25738
25739 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25740 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25741 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25742 created Emacs buffer.
25743 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25744
25745 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25746 things:
25747
25748 @itemize @bullet
25749 @item
25750 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25751 the GUD buffer.
25752
25753 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25754 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25755
25756 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25757 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25758 in this way.
25759
25760 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25761 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25762 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25763 stop.
25764
25765 @item
25766 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25767
25768 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25769 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25770 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25771 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25772 and the source.
25773
25774 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25775 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25776 @end itemize
25777
25778 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25779 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25780 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25781 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25782
25783 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25784 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25785 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25786 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25787 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25788 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25789 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25790 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25791 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25792
25793 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25794 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25795 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25796 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25797
25798 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25799 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25800 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25801 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25802 one you want.
25803
25804 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25805 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25806
25807 @table @kbd
25808 @item C-h m
25809 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25810
25811 @item C-c C-s
25812 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25813 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25814
25815 @item C-c C-n
25816 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25817 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25818 to show the current file and location.
25819
25820 @item C-c C-i
25821 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25822 display window accordingly.
25823
25824 @item C-c C-f
25825 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25826 @code{finish} command.
25827
25828 @item C-c C-r
25829 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25830 command.
25831
25832 @item C-c <
25833 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25834 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25835 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25836
25837 @item C-c >
25838 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25839 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25840 @end table
25841
25842 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25843 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25844
25845 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25846 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25847 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25848 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25849 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25850 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25851 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25852
25853 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25854 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25855 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25856 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25857 frame.
25858
25859 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25860 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25861 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25862 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25863 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25864 to correspond properly with the code.
25865
25866 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25867 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25868 Emacs Manual}).
25869
25870 @node GDB/MI
25871 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25872
25873 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25874
25875 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25876 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25877 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25878 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25879 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25880 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25881
25882 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25883 in the form of a reference manual.
25884
25885 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25886 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25887 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25888
25889 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25890
25891 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25892 This chapter uses the following notation:
25893
25894 @itemize @bullet
25895 @item
25896 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25897
25898 @item
25899 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25900 it may or may not be given.
25901
25902 @item
25903 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25904 may repeat zero or more times.
25905
25906 @item
25907 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25908 may repeat one or more times.
25909
25910 @item
25911 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25912 @end itemize
25913
25914 @ignore
25915 @heading Dependencies
25916 @end ignore
25917
25918 @menu
25919 * GDB/MI General Design::
25920 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25921 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25922 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25923 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25924 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25925 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25926 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25927 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25928 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25929 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25930 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25931 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25932 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25933 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25934 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25935 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25936 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25937 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25938 @ignore
25939 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25940 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25941 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25942 @end ignore
25943 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25944 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25945 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25946 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25947 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25948 @end menu
25949
25950 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25951 @node GDB/MI General Design
25952 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25953 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25954
25955 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25956 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25957 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25958 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25959 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25960 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25961 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25962 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25963 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25964 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25965
25966 The important examples of notifications are:
25967 @itemize @bullet
25968
25969 @item
25970 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25971 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25972 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25973 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25974 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25975 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25976 command itself was successfully executed.
25977
25978 @item
25979 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25980 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25981 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25982 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25983 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25984 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25985
25986 @item
25987 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25988 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25989 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25990 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25991 orthogonal frontend design.
25992
25993 @end itemize
25994
25995 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25996 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25997 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25998 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25999 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26000 the user interface.
26001
26002
26003 @menu
26004 * Context management::
26005 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26006 * Thread groups::
26007 @end menu
26008
26009 @node Context management
26010 @subsection Context management
26011
26012 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26013
26014 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26015 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26016 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26017 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26018 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26019 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26020 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26021 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26022 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26023
26024 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26025 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26026 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26027 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26028 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26029 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26030 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26031 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26032 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26033 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26034 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26035
26036 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26037 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26038 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26039 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26040 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26041 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26042 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26043 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26044 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26045 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26046
26047 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26048 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26049 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26050 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26051 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26052 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26053 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26054 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26055 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26056 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26057 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26058 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26059 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26060 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26061 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26062 @samp{--frame} options.
26063
26064 @subsubsection Language
26065
26066 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26067 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26068 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26069 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26070 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26071 For instance:
26072
26073 @smallexample
26074 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26075 ^done,value="4"
26076 (gdb)
26077 @end smallexample
26078
26079 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26080 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26081 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26082
26083 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26084 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26085
26086 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26087 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26088 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26089 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26090 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26091 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26092 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26093 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26094 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26095
26096 @table @code
26097 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26098 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26099 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26100
26101 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26102 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26103 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26104
26105 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26106 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26107 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26108 MI commands even while the target is running.
26109
26110 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26111 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26112 @end table
26113
26114 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26115 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26116 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26117 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26118 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26119 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26120
26121 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26122 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26123 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26124 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26125 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26126 are running.
26127
26128 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26129 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26130 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26131 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26132 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26133 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26134 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26135 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26136 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26137 @samp{--thread} option).
26138
26139 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26140 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26141 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26142 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26143
26144 @node Thread groups
26145 @subsection Thread groups
26146 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26147 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26148 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26149 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26150 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26151
26152 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26153 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26154 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26155 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26156 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26157 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26158 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26159 into processes.
26160
26161 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26162 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26163 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26164 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26165 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26166 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26167 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26168 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26169 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26170 the members of specific thread group.
26171
26172 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26173 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26174 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26175 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26176 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26177 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26178 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26179 after attaching to that thread group.
26180
26181 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26182 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26183 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26184 such thread groups.
26185
26186 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26187 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26188 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26189
26190 @menu
26191 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26192 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26193 @end menu
26194
26195 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26196 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26197
26198 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26199 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26200 @table @code
26201 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26202 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26203
26204 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26205 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26206 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26207
26208 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26209 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26210 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26211
26212 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26213 "any sequence of digits"
26214
26215 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26216 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26217
26218 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26219 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26220
26221 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26222 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26223
26224 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26225 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26226 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26227
26228 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26229 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26230
26231 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26232 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26233 @end table
26234
26235 @noindent
26236 Notes:
26237
26238 @itemize @bullet
26239 @item
26240 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26241 output is described below.
26242
26243 @item
26244 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26245 finishes.
26246
26247 @item
26248 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26249 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26250 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26251 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26252 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26253 @end itemize
26254
26255 Pragmatics:
26256
26257 @itemize @bullet
26258 @item
26259 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26260
26261 @item
26262 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26263 @end itemize
26264
26265 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26266 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26267
26268 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26269 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26270 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26271 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26272 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26273 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26274
26275 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26276 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26277 @var{token}.
26278
26279 @table @code
26280 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26281 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26282
26283 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26284 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26285
26286 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26287 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26288
26289 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26290 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26291
26292 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26293 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26294
26295 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26296 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26297
26298 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26299 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26300
26301 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26302 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26303
26304 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26305 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26306
26307 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26308 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26309 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26310
26311 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26312 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26313
26314 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26315 @code{ @var{string} }
26316
26317 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26318 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26319
26320 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26321 @code{@var{c-string}}
26322
26323 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26324 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26325
26326 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26327 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26328 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26329
26330 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26331 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26332
26333 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26334 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26335
26336 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26337 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26338
26339 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26340 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26341
26342 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26343 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26344
26345 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26346 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26347 @end table
26348
26349 @noindent
26350 Notes:
26351
26352 @itemize @bullet
26353 @item
26354 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26355
26356 @item
26357 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26358 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26359 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26360 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26361 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26362 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26363 prior command.
26364
26365 @item
26366 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26367 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26368 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26369 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26370
26371 @item
26372 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26373 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26374 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26375 @samp{*}.
26376
26377 @item
26378 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26379 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26380 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26381 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26382
26383 @item
26384 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26385 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26386 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26387 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26388
26389 @item
26390 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26391 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26392 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26393
26394 @item
26395 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26396 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26397 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26398 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26399
26400 @item
26401 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26402 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26403 @var{values}.
26404
26405
26406 @end itemize
26407
26408 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26409 details about the various output records.
26410
26411 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26412 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26413 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26414
26415 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26416 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26417
26418 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26419 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26420 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26421 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26422 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26423 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26424
26425 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26426 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26427 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26428
26429 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26430 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26431 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26432 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26433
26434 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26435 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26436
26437 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26438 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26439 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26440 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26441 might change.
26442
26443 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26444 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26445 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26446 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26447
26448 @itemize @bullet
26449 @item
26450 New MI commands may be added.
26451
26452 @item
26453 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26454
26455 @item
26456 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26457 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26458
26459 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26460 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26461
26462 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26463 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26464 @end itemize
26465
26466 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26467 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26468 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26469 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26470 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26471
26472 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26473 @c version?
26474
26475 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26476 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26477 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26478 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26479 @cindex mailing lists
26480
26481 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26482 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26483 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26484
26485 @menu
26486 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26487 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26488 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26489 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26490 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26491 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26492 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26493 @end menu
26494
26495 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26496 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26497
26498 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26499 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26500 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26501 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26502
26503 @table @code
26504 @findex ^done
26505 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26506 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26507 values.
26508
26509 @item "^running"
26510 @findex ^running
26511 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26512 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26513 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26514 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26515 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26516 which threads are resumed.
26517
26518 @item "^connected"
26519 @findex ^connected
26520 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26521
26522 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26523 @findex ^error
26524 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26525 the corresponding error message.
26526
26527 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26528 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26529 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26530
26531 @table @samp
26532 @item "undefined-command"
26533 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26534 @end table
26535
26536 @item "^exit"
26537 @findex ^exit
26538 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26539
26540 @end table
26541
26542 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26543 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26544
26545 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26546 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26547 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26548 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26549 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26550
26551 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26552 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26553 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26554 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26555 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26556
26557 @table @code
26558 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26559 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26560 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26561
26562 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26563 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26564 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26565 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26566
26567 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26568 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26569 internals.
26570 @end table
26571
26572 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26573 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26574
26575 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26576 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26577 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26578 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26579 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26580 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26581
26582 The following is the list of possible async records:
26583
26584 @table @code
26585
26586 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26587 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26588 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26589 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26590 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26591 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26592 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26593 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26594 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26595 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26596 it run freely.
26597
26598 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26599 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26600 following values:
26601
26602 @table @code
26603 @item breakpoint-hit
26604 A breakpoint was reached.
26605 @item watchpoint-trigger
26606 A watchpoint was triggered.
26607 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26608 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26609 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26610 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26611 @item function-finished
26612 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26613 @item location-reached
26614 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26615 @item watchpoint-scope
26616 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26617 @item end-stepping-range
26618 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26619 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26620 @item exited-signalled
26621 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26622 @item exited
26623 The inferior exited.
26624 @item exited-normally
26625 The inferior exited normally.
26626 @item signal-received
26627 A signal was received by the inferior.
26628 @item solib-event
26629 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26630 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26631 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26632 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26633 @item fork
26634 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26635 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26636 @item vfork
26637 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26638 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26639 @item syscall-entry
26640 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26641 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26642 @item syscall-return
26643 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26644 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26645 @item exec
26646 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26647 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26648 @end table
26649
26650 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26651 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26652 Depending on whether all-stop
26653 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26654 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26655 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26656 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26657 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26658 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26659 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26660 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26661 if such information is not available.
26662
26663 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26664 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26665 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26666 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26667 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26668 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26669 cannot be used in any way.
26670
26671 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26672 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26673 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26674 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26675 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26676 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26677
26678 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26679 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26680 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26681 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26682 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26683 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26684
26685 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26686 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26687 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26688 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26689 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26690
26691 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26692 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26693 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26694 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26695 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26696 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26697 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26698 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26699 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26700
26701 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26702 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26703
26704 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26705 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26706 that thread.
26707
26708 @item =library-loaded,...
26709 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26710 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26711 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26712 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26713 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26714 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26715 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26716 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26717 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26718 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26719 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26720 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26721 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26722 to this library.
26723
26724 @item =library-unloaded,...
26725 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26726 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26727 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26728 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26729 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26730 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26731 thread groups.
26732
26733 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26734 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26735 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26736 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26737 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26738
26739 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26740 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26741 initial value @var{initial}.
26742
26743 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26744 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26745 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26746 trace state variables are deleted.
26747
26748 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26749 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26750 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26751 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26752 value of trace state variable is known.
26753
26754 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26755 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26756 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26757 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26758 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26759 user.
26760
26761 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26762 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26763 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26764
26765 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26766 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26767
26768 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26769 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26770 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26771 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26772 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26773
26774 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26775 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26776 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26777 for existing method and format values.
26778
26779 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26780 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26781 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26782 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26783 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26784 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26785
26786 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26787 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26788 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26789 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26790 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26791 executable code.
26792 @end table
26793
26794 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26795 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26796
26797 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26798 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26799 following fields:
26800
26801 @table @code
26802 @item number
26803 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26804 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26805 @samp{1.2}.
26806
26807 @item type
26808 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26809 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26810
26811 @item catch-type
26812 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26813 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26814
26815 @item disp
26816 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26817 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26818 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26819
26820 @item enabled
26821 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26822 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26823 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26824
26825 @item addr
26826 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26827 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26828 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26829 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26830 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26831
26832 @item func
26833 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26834 If not known, this field is not present.
26835
26836 @item filename
26837 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26838 If not known, this field is not present.
26839
26840 @item fullname
26841 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26842 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26843
26844 @item line
26845 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26846 If not known, this field is not present.
26847
26848 @item at
26849 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26850 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26851 by a symbol name.
26852
26853 @item pending
26854 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26855 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26856
26857 @item evaluated-by
26858 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26859 @samp{target}.
26860
26861 @item thread
26862 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26863 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26864
26865 @item task
26866 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26867 field will hold the task identifier.
26868
26869 @item cond
26870 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26871
26872 @item ignore
26873 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26874
26875 @item enable
26876 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26877
26878 @item traceframe-usage
26879 FIXME.
26880
26881 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26882 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26883
26884 @item mask
26885 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26886
26887 @item pass
26888 A tracepoint's pass count.
26889
26890 @item original-location
26891 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26892 This field is optional.
26893
26894 @item times
26895 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26896
26897 @item installed
26898 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26899 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26900 is not.
26901
26902 @item what
26903 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26904
26905 @end table
26906
26907 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26908 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26909
26910 @smallexample
26911 -> -break-insert main
26912 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26913 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26914 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26915 times="0"@}
26916 <- (gdb)
26917 @end smallexample
26918
26919 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26920 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26921
26922 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26923 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26924 fields:
26925
26926 @table @code
26927 @item level
26928 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26929 zero. This field is always present.
26930
26931 @item func
26932 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26933 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26934
26935 @item addr
26936 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26937
26938 @item file
26939 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26940 address. This field may be absent.
26941
26942 @item line
26943 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26944 may be absent.
26945
26946 @item from
26947 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26948 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26949
26950 @end table
26951
26952 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26953 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26954
26955 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26956 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
26957 stated otherwise.
26958
26959 @table @code
26960 @item id
26961 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
26962
26963 @item target-id
26964 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
26965
26966 @item details
26967 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26968 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26969 frontend. This field is optional.
26970
26971 @item name
26972 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26973 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26974 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26975 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26976 field is omitted.
26977
26978 @item state
26979 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
26980 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
26981
26982 @item frame
26983 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
26984 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
26985 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
26986
26987 @item core
26988 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26989 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26990 @end table
26991
26992 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26993 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26994
26995 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26996 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26997 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26998 the @code{exception-name} field.
26999
27000 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27001 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27002 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27003 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27004
27005 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27006 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27007 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27008 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27009
27010 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27011 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27012
27013 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27014
27015 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27016 information of the breakpoint.
27017
27018 @smallexample
27019 -> -break-insert main
27020 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27021 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27022 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27023 times="0"@}
27024 <- (gdb)
27025 @end smallexample
27026
27027 @subheading Program Execution
27028
27029 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27030 reason that execution stopped.
27031
27032 @smallexample
27033 -> -exec-run
27034 <- ^running
27035 <- (gdb)
27036 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27037 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27038 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27039 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27040 <- (gdb)
27041 -> -exec-continue
27042 <- ^running
27043 <- (gdb)
27044 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27045 <- (gdb)
27046 @end smallexample
27047
27048 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27049
27050 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27051
27052 @smallexample
27053 -> (gdb)
27054 <- -gdb-exit
27055 <- ^exit
27056 @end smallexample
27057
27058 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27059 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27060 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27061 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27062 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27063 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27064
27065 @subheading A Bad Command
27066
27067 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27068
27069 @smallexample
27070 -> -rubbish
27071 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27072 <- (gdb)
27073 @end smallexample
27074
27075
27076 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27077 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27078 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27079
27080 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27081 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27082
27083 @subheading Motivation
27084
27085 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27086
27087 @subheading Introduction
27088
27089 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27090
27091 @subheading Commands
27092
27093 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27094
27095 @subsubheading Synopsis
27096
27097 @smallexample
27098 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27099 @end smallexample
27100
27101 @subsubheading Result
27102
27103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27104
27105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27106
27107 @subsubheading Example
27108
27109 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27110 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27111
27112
27113 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27114 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27115 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27116
27117 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27118 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27119 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27120 breakpoints.
27121
27122 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27123 @findex -break-after
27124
27125 @subsubheading Synopsis
27126
27127 @smallexample
27128 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27129 @end smallexample
27130
27131 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27132 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27133 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27134 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27135
27136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27137
27138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27139
27140 @subsubheading Example
27141
27142 @smallexample
27143 (gdb)
27144 -break-insert main
27145 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27146 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27147 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27148 times="0"@}
27149 (gdb)
27150 -break-after 1 3
27151 ~
27152 ^done
27153 (gdb)
27154 -break-list
27155 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27156 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27157 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27158 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27159 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27160 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27161 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27162 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27163 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27164 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27165 (gdb)
27166 @end smallexample
27167
27168 @ignore
27169 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27170 @findex -break-catch
27171 @end ignore
27172
27173 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27174 @findex -break-commands
27175
27176 @subsubheading Synopsis
27177
27178 @smallexample
27179 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27180 @end smallexample
27181
27182 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27183 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27184 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27185 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27186 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27187 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27188
27189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27190
27191 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27192
27193 @subsubheading Example
27194
27195 @smallexample
27196 (gdb)
27197 -break-insert main
27198 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27199 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27200 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27201 times="0"@}
27202 (gdb)
27203 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27204 ^done
27205 (gdb)
27206 @end smallexample
27207
27208 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27209 @findex -break-condition
27210
27211 @subsubheading Synopsis
27212
27213 @smallexample
27214 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27215 @end smallexample
27216
27217 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27218 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27219 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27220 command below).
27221
27222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27223
27224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27225
27226 @subsubheading Example
27227
27228 @smallexample
27229 (gdb)
27230 -break-condition 1 1
27231 ^done
27232 (gdb)
27233 -break-list
27234 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27235 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27236 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27237 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27238 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27239 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27240 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27241 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27242 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27243 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27244 (gdb)
27245 @end smallexample
27246
27247 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27248 @findex -break-delete
27249
27250 @subsubheading Synopsis
27251
27252 @smallexample
27253 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27254 @end smallexample
27255
27256 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27257 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27258
27259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27260
27261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27262
27263 @subsubheading Example
27264
27265 @smallexample
27266 (gdb)
27267 -break-delete 1
27268 ^done
27269 (gdb)
27270 -break-list
27271 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27272 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27273 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27274 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27275 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27276 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27277 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27278 body=[]@}
27279 (gdb)
27280 @end smallexample
27281
27282 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27283 @findex -break-disable
27284
27285 @subsubheading Synopsis
27286
27287 @smallexample
27288 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27289 @end smallexample
27290
27291 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27292 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27293
27294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27295
27296 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27297
27298 @subsubheading Example
27299
27300 @smallexample
27301 (gdb)
27302 -break-disable 2
27303 ^done
27304 (gdb)
27305 -break-list
27306 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27307 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27308 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27309 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27310 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27311 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27312 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27313 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27314 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27315 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27316 (gdb)
27317 @end smallexample
27318
27319 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27320 @findex -break-enable
27321
27322 @subsubheading Synopsis
27323
27324 @smallexample
27325 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27326 @end smallexample
27327
27328 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27329
27330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27331
27332 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27333
27334 @subsubheading Example
27335
27336 @smallexample
27337 (gdb)
27338 -break-enable 2
27339 ^done
27340 (gdb)
27341 -break-list
27342 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27343 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27344 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27345 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27346 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27347 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27348 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27349 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27350 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27351 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27352 (gdb)
27353 @end smallexample
27354
27355 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27356 @findex -break-info
27357
27358 @subsubheading Synopsis
27359
27360 @smallexample
27361 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27362 @end smallexample
27363
27364 @c REDUNDANT???
27365 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27366
27367 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27368 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27369 table.
27370
27371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27372
27373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27374
27375 @subsubheading Example
27376 N.A.
27377
27378 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27379 @findex -break-insert
27380 @anchor{-break-insert}
27381
27382 @subsubheading Synopsis
27383
27384 @smallexample
27385 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27386 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27387 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27388 @end smallexample
27389
27390 @noindent
27391 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27392
27393 @table @var
27394 @item linespec location
27395 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27396
27397 @item explicit location
27398 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27399 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27400 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27401
27402 @table @samp
27403 @item --source @var{filename}
27404 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27405 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27406
27407 @item --function @var{function}
27408 The name of a function or method.
27409
27410 @item --label @var{label}
27411 The name of a label.
27412
27413 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27414 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27415 @end table
27416
27417 @item address location
27418 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27419 @end table
27420
27421 @noindent
27422 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27423
27424 @table @samp
27425 @item -t
27426 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27427 @item -h
27428 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27429 @item -f
27430 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27431 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27432 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27433 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27434 cannot be parsed.
27435 @item -d
27436 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27437 @item -a
27438 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27439 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27440 @item -c @var{condition}
27441 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27442 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27443 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27444 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27445 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27446 @var{thread-id}.
27447 @end table
27448
27449 @subsubheading Result
27450
27451 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27452 resulting breakpoint.
27453
27454 Note: this format is open to change.
27455 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27456
27457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27458
27459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27460 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27461
27462 @subsubheading Example
27463
27464 @smallexample
27465 (gdb)
27466 -break-insert main
27467 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27468 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27469 times="0"@}
27470 (gdb)
27471 -break-insert -t foo
27472 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27473 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27474 times="0"@}
27475 (gdb)
27476 -break-list
27477 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27478 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27479 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27480 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27481 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27482 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27483 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27484 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27485 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27486 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27487 times="0"@},
27488 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27489 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27490 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27491 times="0"@}]@}
27492 (gdb)
27493 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27494 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27495 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27496 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27497 @c times="0"@}
27498 @c (gdb)
27499 @end smallexample
27500
27501 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27502 @findex -dprintf-insert
27503
27504 @subsubheading Synopsis
27505
27506 @smallexample
27507 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27508 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27509 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27510 [ @var{argument} ]
27511 @end smallexample
27512
27513 @noindent
27514 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27515 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27516
27517 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27518
27519 @table @samp
27520 @item -t
27521 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27522 @item -f
27523 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27524 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27525 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27526 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27527 cannot be parsed.
27528 @item -d
27529 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27530 @item -c @var{condition}
27531 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27532 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27533 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27534 to @var{ignore-count}.
27535 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27536 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27537 @var{thread-id}.
27538 @end table
27539
27540 @subsubheading Result
27541
27542 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27543 resulting breakpoint.
27544
27545 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27546
27547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27548
27549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27550
27551 @subsubheading Example
27552
27553 @smallexample
27554 (gdb)
27555 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27556 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27557 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27558 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27559 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27560 original-location="foo"@}
27561 (gdb)
27562 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27563 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27564 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27565 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27566 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27567 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27568 (gdb)
27569 @end smallexample
27570
27571 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27572 @findex -break-list
27573
27574 @subsubheading Synopsis
27575
27576 @smallexample
27577 -break-list
27578 @end smallexample
27579
27580 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27581
27582 @table @samp
27583 @item Number
27584 number of the breakpoint
27585 @item Type
27586 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27587 @item Disposition
27588 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27589 or @samp{nokeep}
27590 @item Enabled
27591 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27592 @item Address
27593 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27594 @item What
27595 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27596 name, line number
27597 @item Thread-groups
27598 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27599 @item Times
27600 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27601 @end table
27602
27603 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27604 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27605
27606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27607
27608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27609
27610 @subsubheading Example
27611
27612 @smallexample
27613 (gdb)
27614 -break-list
27615 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27616 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27617 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27618 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27619 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27620 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27621 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27622 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27623 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27624 times="0"@},
27625 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27626 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27627 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27628 (gdb)
27629 @end smallexample
27630
27631 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27632
27633 @smallexample
27634 (gdb)
27635 -break-list
27636 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27637 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27638 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27639 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27640 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27641 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27642 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27643 body=[]@}
27644 (gdb)
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27648 @findex -break-passcount
27649
27650 @subsubheading Synopsis
27651
27652 @smallexample
27653 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27654 @end smallexample
27655
27656 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27657 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27658 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27659 command @samp{passcount}.
27660
27661 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27662 @findex -break-watch
27663
27664 @subsubheading Synopsis
27665
27666 @smallexample
27667 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27668 @end smallexample
27669
27670 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27671 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27672 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27673 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27674 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27675 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27676 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27677 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27678
27679 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27680 breakpoints inserted.
27681
27682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27683
27684 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27685 @samp{rwatch}.
27686
27687 @subsubheading Example
27688
27689 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27690
27691 @smallexample
27692 (gdb)
27693 -break-watch x
27694 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27695 (gdb)
27696 -exec-continue
27697 ^running
27698 (gdb)
27699 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27700 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27701 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27702 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27703 (gdb)
27704 @end smallexample
27705
27706 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27707 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27708 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27709
27710 @smallexample
27711 (gdb)
27712 -break-watch C
27713 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27714 (gdb)
27715 -exec-continue
27716 ^running
27717 (gdb)
27718 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27719 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27720 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27721 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27722 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27723 (gdb)
27724 -exec-continue
27725 ^running
27726 (gdb)
27727 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27728 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27729 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27730 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27731 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27732 (gdb)
27733 @end smallexample
27734
27735 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27736 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27737 deleted.
27738
27739 @smallexample
27740 (gdb)
27741 -break-watch C
27742 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27743 (gdb)
27744 -break-list
27745 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27746 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27747 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27748 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27749 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27750 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27751 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27752 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27753 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27754 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27755 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27756 times="1"@},
27757 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27758 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27759 (gdb)
27760 -exec-continue
27761 ^running
27762 (gdb)
27763 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27764 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27765 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27766 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27767 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27768 (gdb)
27769 -break-list
27770 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27771 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27772 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27773 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27774 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27775 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27776 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27777 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27778 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27779 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27780 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27781 times="1"@},
27782 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27783 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27784 (gdb)
27785 -exec-continue
27786 ^running
27787 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27788 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27789 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27790 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27791 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27792 (gdb)
27793 -break-list
27794 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27795 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27796 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27797 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27798 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27799 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27800 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27801 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27802 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27803 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27804 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27805 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27806 (gdb)
27807 @end smallexample
27808
27809
27810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27811 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27813
27814 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27815 catchpoints.
27816
27817 @menu
27818 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27819 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27820 @end menu
27821
27822 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27823 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27824
27825 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27826 @findex -catch-load
27827
27828 @subsubheading Synopsis
27829
27830 @smallexample
27831 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27832 @end smallexample
27833
27834 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27835 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27836 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27837 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27838 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27839
27840
27841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27842
27843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27844
27845 @subsubheading Example
27846
27847 @smallexample
27848 -catch-load -t foo.so
27849 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27850 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27851 (gdb)
27852 @end smallexample
27853
27854
27855 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27856 @findex -catch-unload
27857
27858 @subsubheading Synopsis
27859
27860 @smallexample
27861 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27862 @end smallexample
27863
27864 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27865 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27866 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27867 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27868 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27869
27870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27871
27872 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27873
27874 @subsubheading Example
27875
27876 @smallexample
27877 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27878 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27879 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27880 (gdb)
27881 @end smallexample
27882
27883 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27884 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27885
27886 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27887 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27888
27889 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27890 @findex -catch-assert
27891
27892 @subsubheading Synopsis
27893
27894 @smallexample
27895 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27896 @end smallexample
27897
27898 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27899
27900 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27901
27902 @table @samp
27903 @item -c @var{condition}
27904 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27905 @item -d
27906 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27907 @item -t
27908 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27909 @end table
27910
27911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27912
27913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27914
27915 @subsubheading Example
27916
27917 @smallexample
27918 -catch-assert
27919 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27920 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27921 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27922 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27923 (gdb)
27924 @end smallexample
27925
27926 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27927 @findex -catch-exception
27928
27929 @subsubheading Synopsis
27930
27931 @smallexample
27932 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27933 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27934 @end smallexample
27935
27936 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27937 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27938 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27939 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27940 catchpoints.
27941
27942 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27943
27944 @table @samp
27945 @item -c @var{condition}
27946 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27947 @item -d
27948 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27949 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27950 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27951 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27952 @item -t
27953 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27954 @item -u
27955 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27956 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27957 @end table
27958
27959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27960
27961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27962 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27963
27964 @subsubheading Example
27965
27966 @smallexample
27967 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27968 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27969 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27970 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27971 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27972 (gdb)
27973 @end smallexample
27974
27975 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27976 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27977 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27978
27979 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27980 @findex -exec-arguments
27981
27982
27983 @subsubheading Synopsis
27984
27985 @smallexample
27986 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27987 @end smallexample
27988
27989 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27990 @samp{-exec-run}.
27991
27992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27993
27994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27995
27996 @subsubheading Example
27997
27998 @smallexample
27999 (gdb)
28000 -exec-arguments -v word
28001 ^done
28002 (gdb)
28003 @end smallexample
28004
28005
28006 @ignore
28007 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28008 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28009
28010 @subsubheading Synopsis
28011
28012 @smallexample
28013 -exec-show-arguments
28014 @end smallexample
28015
28016 Print the arguments of the program.
28017
28018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28019
28020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28021
28022 @subsubheading Example
28023 N.A.
28024 @end ignore
28025
28026
28027 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28028 @findex -environment-cd
28029
28030 @subsubheading Synopsis
28031
28032 @smallexample
28033 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28034 @end smallexample
28035
28036 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28037
28038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28039
28040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28041
28042 @subsubheading Example
28043
28044 @smallexample
28045 (gdb)
28046 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28047 ^done
28048 (gdb)
28049 @end smallexample
28050
28051
28052 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28053 @findex -environment-directory
28054
28055 @subsubheading Synopsis
28056
28057 @smallexample
28058 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28059 @end smallexample
28060
28061 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28062 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28063 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28064 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28065 occurs as normal.
28066 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28067 multiple directories in a single command
28068 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28069 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28070 If blanks are needed as
28071 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28072 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28073 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28074 character must not be used
28075 in any directory name.
28076 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28077
28078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28079
28080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28081
28082 @subsubheading Example
28083
28084 @smallexample
28085 (gdb)
28086 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28087 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28088 (gdb)
28089 -environment-directory ""
28090 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28091 (gdb)
28092 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28093 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28094 (gdb)
28095 -environment-directory -r
28096 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28097 (gdb)
28098 @end smallexample
28099
28100
28101 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28102 @findex -environment-path
28103
28104 @subsubheading Synopsis
28105
28106 @smallexample
28107 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28108 @end smallexample
28109
28110 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28111 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28112 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28113 supplied in addition to the
28114 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28115 occurs as normal.
28116 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28117 multiple directories in a single command
28118 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28119 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28120 If blanks are needed as
28121 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28122 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28123 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28124 character must not be used
28125 in any directory name.
28126 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28127
28128
28129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28130
28131 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28132
28133 @subsubheading Example
28134
28135 @smallexample
28136 (gdb)
28137 -environment-path
28138 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28139 (gdb)
28140 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28141 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28142 (gdb)
28143 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28144 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28145 (gdb)
28146 @end smallexample
28147
28148
28149 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28150 @findex -environment-pwd
28151
28152 @subsubheading Synopsis
28153
28154 @smallexample
28155 -environment-pwd
28156 @end smallexample
28157
28158 Show the current working directory.
28159
28160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28161
28162 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28163
28164 @subsubheading Example
28165
28166 @smallexample
28167 (gdb)
28168 -environment-pwd
28169 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28170 (gdb)
28171 @end smallexample
28172
28173 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28174 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28175 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28176
28177
28178 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28179 @findex -thread-info
28180
28181 @subsubheading Synopsis
28182
28183 @smallexample
28184 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28185 @end smallexample
28186
28187 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28188 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28189 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28190 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28191 current thread.
28192
28193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28194
28195 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28196 about all threads.
28197
28198 @subsubheading Result
28199
28200 The result contains the following attributes:
28201
28202 @table @samp
28203 @item threads
28204 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28205 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28206
28207 @item current-thread-id
28208 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28209 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28210 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28211 the command.
28212
28213 @end table
28214
28215 @subsubheading Example
28216
28217 @smallexample
28218 -thread-info
28219 ^done,threads=[
28220 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28221 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28222 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28223 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28224 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28225 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28226 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28227 state="running"@}],
28228 current-thread-id="1"
28229 (gdb)
28230 @end smallexample
28231
28232 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28233 @findex -thread-list-ids
28234
28235 @subsubheading Synopsis
28236
28237 @smallexample
28238 -thread-list-ids
28239 @end smallexample
28240
28241 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28242 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28243 threads.
28244
28245 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28246 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28247
28248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28249
28250 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28251
28252 @subsubheading Example
28253
28254 @smallexample
28255 (gdb)
28256 -thread-list-ids
28257 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28258 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28259 (gdb)
28260 @end smallexample
28261
28262
28263 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28264 @findex -thread-select
28265
28266 @subsubheading Synopsis
28267
28268 @smallexample
28269 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28270 @end smallexample
28271
28272 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28273 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28274 topmost frame for that thread.
28275
28276 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28277 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28278
28279 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28280
28281 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28282
28283 @subsubheading Example
28284
28285 @smallexample
28286 (gdb)
28287 -exec-next
28288 ^running
28289 (gdb)
28290 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28291 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28292 (gdb)
28293 -thread-list-ids
28294 ^done,
28295 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28296 number-of-threads="3"
28297 (gdb)
28298 -thread-select 3
28299 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28300 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28301 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28302 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28303 (gdb)
28304 @end smallexample
28305
28306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28307 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28308 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28309
28310 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28311 @findex -ada-task-info
28312
28313 @subsubheading Synopsis
28314
28315 @smallexample
28316 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28317 @end smallexample
28318
28319 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28320 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28321
28322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28323
28324 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28325 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28326
28327 @subsubheading Result
28328
28329 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28330 defined for each Ada task:
28331
28332 @table @samp
28333 @item current
28334 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28335
28336 @item id
28337 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28338
28339 @item task-id
28340 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28341
28342 @item thread-id
28343 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28344 task.
28345
28346 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28347 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28348 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28349
28350 @item parent-id
28351 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28352 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28353
28354 @item priority
28355 The base priority of the task.
28356
28357 @item state
28358 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28359 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28360
28361 @item name
28362 The name of the task.
28363
28364 @end table
28365
28366 @subsubheading Example
28367
28368 @smallexample
28369 -ada-task-info
28370 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28371 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28372 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28373 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28374 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28375 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28376 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28377 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28378 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28379 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28380 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28381 (gdb)
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28385 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28386 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28387
28388 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28389 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28390 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28391 other cases.
28392
28393 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28394 @findex -exec-continue
28395
28396 @subsubheading Synopsis
28397
28398 @smallexample
28399 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28400 @end smallexample
28401
28402 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28403 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28404 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28405 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28406 @itemize @bullet
28407 @item
28408 breakpoints or watchpoints
28409 @item
28410 signals or exceptions
28411 @item
28412 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28413 @item
28414 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28415 @end itemize
28416 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28417 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28418 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28419 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28420 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28421 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28422
28423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28424
28425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28426
28427 @subsubheading Example
28428
28429 @smallexample
28430 -exec-continue
28431 ^running
28432 (gdb)
28433 @@Hello world
28434 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28435 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28436 line="13"@}
28437 (gdb)
28438 @end smallexample
28439
28440
28441 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28442 @findex -exec-finish
28443
28444 @subsubheading Synopsis
28445
28446 @smallexample
28447 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28448 @end smallexample
28449
28450 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28451 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28452 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28453 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28454 function was called.
28455
28456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28457
28458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28459
28460 @subsubheading Example
28461
28462 Function returning @code{void}.
28463
28464 @smallexample
28465 -exec-finish
28466 ^running
28467 (gdb)
28468 @@hello from foo
28469 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28470 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28471 (gdb)
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28475 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28476 value itself.
28477
28478 @smallexample
28479 -exec-finish
28480 ^running
28481 (gdb)
28482 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28483 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28484 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28485 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28486 (gdb)
28487 @end smallexample
28488
28489
28490 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28491 @findex -exec-interrupt
28492
28493 @subsubheading Synopsis
28494
28495 @smallexample
28496 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28497 @end smallexample
28498
28499 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28500 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28501 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28502 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28503 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28504
28505 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28506 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28507 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28508 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28509
28510 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28511 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28512 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28513 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28514
28515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28516
28517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28518
28519 @subsubheading Example
28520
28521 @smallexample
28522 (gdb)
28523 111-exec-continue
28524 111^running
28525
28526 (gdb)
28527 222-exec-interrupt
28528 222^done
28529 (gdb)
28530 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28531 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28532 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28533 (gdb)
28534
28535 (gdb)
28536 -exec-interrupt
28537 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28538 (gdb)
28539 @end smallexample
28540
28541 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28542 @findex -exec-jump
28543
28544 @subsubheading Synopsis
28545
28546 @smallexample
28547 -exec-jump @var{location}
28548 @end smallexample
28549
28550 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28551 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28552 different forms of @var{location}.
28553
28554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28555
28556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28557
28558 @subsubheading Example
28559
28560 @smallexample
28561 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28562 *running,thread-id="all"
28563 ^running
28564 @end smallexample
28565
28566
28567 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28568 @findex -exec-next
28569
28570 @subsubheading Synopsis
28571
28572 @smallexample
28573 -exec-next [--reverse]
28574 @end smallexample
28575
28576 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28577 of the next source line is reached.
28578
28579 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28580 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28581 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28582 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28583 source line where the function was called.
28584
28585
28586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28587
28588 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28589
28590 @subsubheading Example
28591
28592 @smallexample
28593 -exec-next
28594 ^running
28595 (gdb)
28596 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28597 (gdb)
28598 @end smallexample
28599
28600
28601 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28602 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28603
28604 @subsubheading Synopsis
28605
28606 @smallexample
28607 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28608 @end smallexample
28609
28610 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28611 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28612 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28613 printed as well.
28614
28615 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28616 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28617 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28618 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28619 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28620
28621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28622
28623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28624
28625 @subsubheading Example
28626
28627 @smallexample
28628 (gdb)
28629 -exec-next-instruction
28630 ^running
28631
28632 (gdb)
28633 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28634 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28635 (gdb)
28636 @end smallexample
28637
28638
28639 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28640 @findex -exec-return
28641
28642 @subsubheading Synopsis
28643
28644 @smallexample
28645 -exec-return
28646 @end smallexample
28647
28648 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28649 Displays the new current frame.
28650
28651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28652
28653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28654
28655 @subsubheading Example
28656
28657 @smallexample
28658 (gdb)
28659 200-break-insert callee4
28660 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28661 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28662 (gdb)
28663 000-exec-run
28664 000^running
28665 (gdb)
28666 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28667 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28668 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28669 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28670 (gdb)
28671 205-break-delete
28672 205^done
28673 (gdb)
28674 111-exec-return
28675 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28676 args=[@{name="strarg",
28677 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28678 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28679 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28680 (gdb)
28681 @end smallexample
28682
28683
28684 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28685 @findex -exec-run
28686
28687 @subsubheading Synopsis
28688
28689 @smallexample
28690 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28691 @end smallexample
28692
28693 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28694 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28695 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28696 the program has exited exceptionally.
28697
28698 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28699 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28700 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28701 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28702 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28703
28704 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28705 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28706 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28707 (@pxref{Starting}).
28708
28709 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28710
28711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28712
28713 @subsubheading Examples
28714
28715 @smallexample
28716 (gdb)
28717 -break-insert main
28718 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28719 (gdb)
28720 -exec-run
28721 ^running
28722 (gdb)
28723 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28724 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28725 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28726 (gdb)
28727 @end smallexample
28728
28729 @noindent
28730 Program exited normally:
28731
28732 @smallexample
28733 (gdb)
28734 -exec-run
28735 ^running
28736 (gdb)
28737 x = 55
28738 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28739 (gdb)
28740 @end smallexample
28741
28742 @noindent
28743 Program exited exceptionally:
28744
28745 @smallexample
28746 (gdb)
28747 -exec-run
28748 ^running
28749 (gdb)
28750 x = 55
28751 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28752 (gdb)
28753 @end smallexample
28754
28755 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28756 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28757
28758 @smallexample
28759 (gdb)
28760 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28761 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28762 @end smallexample
28763
28764
28765 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28766
28767
28768 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28769 @findex -exec-step
28770
28771 @subsubheading Synopsis
28772
28773 @smallexample
28774 -exec-step [--reverse]
28775 @end smallexample
28776
28777 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28778 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28779 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28780 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28781 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28782 previously executed source line.
28783
28784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28785
28786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28787
28788 @subsubheading Example
28789
28790 Stepping into a function:
28791
28792 @smallexample
28793 -exec-step
28794 ^running
28795 (gdb)
28796 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28797 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28798 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28799 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28800 (gdb)
28801 @end smallexample
28802
28803 Regular stepping:
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 -exec-step
28807 ^running
28808 (gdb)
28809 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28810 (gdb)
28811 @end smallexample
28812
28813
28814 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28815 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28816
28817 @subsubheading Synopsis
28818
28819 @smallexample
28820 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28821 @end smallexample
28822
28823 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28824 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28825 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28826 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28827 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28828 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28829 as well.
28830
28831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28832
28833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28834
28835 @subsubheading Example
28836
28837 @smallexample
28838 (gdb)
28839 -exec-step-instruction
28840 ^running
28841
28842 (gdb)
28843 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28844 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28845 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28846 (gdb)
28847 -exec-step-instruction
28848 ^running
28849
28850 (gdb)
28851 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28852 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28853 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28854 (gdb)
28855 @end smallexample
28856
28857
28858 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28859 @findex -exec-until
28860
28861 @subsubheading Synopsis
28862
28863 @smallexample
28864 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28865 @end smallexample
28866
28867 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28868 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28869 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28870 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28871
28872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28873
28874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28875
28876 @subsubheading Example
28877
28878 @smallexample
28879 (gdb)
28880 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28881 ^running
28882 (gdb)
28883 x = 55
28884 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28885 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28886 (gdb)
28887 @end smallexample
28888
28889 @ignore
28890 @subheading -file-clear
28891 Is this going away????
28892 @end ignore
28893
28894 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28895 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28896 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28897
28898 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28899 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28900
28901 @smallexample
28902 -enable-frame-filters
28903 @end smallexample
28904
28905 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28906 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28907 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28908 request that this functionality be enabled.
28909
28910 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28911
28912 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28913 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28914
28915 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28916 @findex -stack-info-frame
28917
28918 @subsubheading Synopsis
28919
28920 @smallexample
28921 -stack-info-frame
28922 @end smallexample
28923
28924 Get info on the selected frame.
28925
28926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28927
28928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28929 (without arguments).
28930
28931 @subsubheading Example
28932
28933 @smallexample
28934 (gdb)
28935 -stack-info-frame
28936 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28937 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28938 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28939 (gdb)
28940 @end smallexample
28941
28942 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28943 @findex -stack-info-depth
28944
28945 @subsubheading Synopsis
28946
28947 @smallexample
28948 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28949 @end smallexample
28950
28951 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28952 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28953
28954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28955
28956 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28957
28958 @subsubheading Example
28959
28960 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28961
28962 @smallexample
28963 (gdb)
28964 -stack-info-depth
28965 ^done,depth="12"
28966 (gdb)
28967 -stack-info-depth 4
28968 ^done,depth="4"
28969 (gdb)
28970 -stack-info-depth 12
28971 ^done,depth="12"
28972 (gdb)
28973 -stack-info-depth 11
28974 ^done,depth="11"
28975 (gdb)
28976 -stack-info-depth 13
28977 ^done,depth="12"
28978 (gdb)
28979 @end smallexample
28980
28981 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28982 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28983 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28984
28985 @subsubheading Synopsis
28986
28987 @smallexample
28988 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28989 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28990 @end smallexample
28991
28992 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28993 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28994 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28995 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28996 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28997 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28998 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28999 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29000
29001 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29002 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29003 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29004 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29005 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29006 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29007
29008 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29009 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29010 are still displayed, however.
29011
29012 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29013 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29014
29015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29016
29017 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29018 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29019 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29020
29021 @subsubheading Example
29022
29023 @smallexample
29024 (gdb)
29025 -stack-list-frames
29026 ^done,
29027 stack=[
29028 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29029 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29030 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29031 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29032 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29033 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29034 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29035 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29036 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29037 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29038 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29039 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29040 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29041 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29042 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29043 (gdb)
29044 -stack-list-arguments 0
29045 ^done,
29046 stack-args=[
29047 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29048 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29049 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29050 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29051 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29052 (gdb)
29053 -stack-list-arguments 1
29054 ^done,
29055 stack-args=[
29056 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29057 frame=@{level="1",
29058 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29059 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29060 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29061 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29062 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29063 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29064 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29065 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29066 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29067 (gdb)
29068 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29069 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29070 (gdb)
29071 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29072 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29073 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29074 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29075 (gdb)
29076 @end smallexample
29077
29078 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29079
29080
29081 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29082 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29083 @findex -stack-list-frames
29084
29085 @subsubheading Synopsis
29086
29087 @smallexample
29088 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29089 @end smallexample
29090
29091 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29092 following info:
29093
29094 @table @samp
29095 @item @var{level}
29096 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29097 @item @var{addr}
29098 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29099 @item @var{func}
29100 Function name.
29101 @item @var{file}
29102 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29103 @item @var{fullname}
29104 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29105 @item @var{line}
29106 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29107 @item @var{from}
29108 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29109 if the frame's function is not known.
29110 @end table
29111
29112 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29113 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29114 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29115 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29116 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29117 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29118 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29119 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29120 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29121
29122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29123
29124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29125
29126 @subsubheading Example
29127
29128 Full stack backtrace:
29129
29130 @smallexample
29131 (gdb)
29132 -stack-list-frames
29133 ^done,stack=
29134 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29135 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29136 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29137 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29138 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29139 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29140 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29141 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29142 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29143 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29144 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29145 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29146 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29147 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29148 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29149 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29150 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29151 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29152 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29153 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29154 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29155 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29156 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29157 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29158 (gdb)
29159 @end smallexample
29160
29161 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29162
29163 @smallexample
29164 (gdb)
29165 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29166 ^done,stack=
29167 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29168 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29169 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29170 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29171 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29172 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29173 (gdb)
29174 @end smallexample
29175
29176 Show a single frame:
29177
29178 @smallexample
29179 (gdb)
29180 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29181 ^done,stack=
29182 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29183 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29184 (gdb)
29185 @end smallexample
29186
29187
29188 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29189 @findex -stack-list-locals
29190 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29191
29192 @subsubheading Synopsis
29193
29194 @smallexample
29195 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29196 @end smallexample
29197
29198 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29199 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29200 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29201 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29202 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29203 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29204 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29205 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29206 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29207 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29208
29209 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29210 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29211 variables are still displayed, however.
29212
29213 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29214 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29215
29216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29217
29218 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29219
29220 @subsubheading Example
29221
29222 @smallexample
29223 (gdb)
29224 -stack-list-locals 0
29225 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29226 (gdb)
29227 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29228 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29229 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29230 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29231 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29232 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29233 (gdb)
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29237 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29238 @findex -stack-list-variables
29239
29240 @subsubheading Synopsis
29241
29242 @smallexample
29243 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29244 @end smallexample
29245
29246 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29247 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29248 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29249 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29250 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29251 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29252 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29253
29254 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29255 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29256 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29257
29258 @subsubheading Example
29259
29260 @smallexample
29261 (gdb)
29262 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29263 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29264 (gdb)
29265 @end smallexample
29266
29267
29268 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29269 @findex -stack-select-frame
29270
29271 @subsubheading Synopsis
29272
29273 @smallexample
29274 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29275 @end smallexample
29276
29277 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29278 the stack.
29279
29280 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29281 option to every command.
29282
29283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29284
29285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29286 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29287
29288 @subsubheading Example
29289
29290 @smallexample
29291 (gdb)
29292 -stack-select-frame 2
29293 ^done
29294 (gdb)
29295 @end smallexample
29296
29297 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29298 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29299 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29300
29301 @ignore
29302
29303 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29304
29305 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29306 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29307 used by @code{Insight}.
29308
29309 The two main reasons for that are:
29310
29311 @enumerate 1
29312 @item
29313 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29314
29315 @item
29316 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29317 now).
29318 @end enumerate
29319
29320 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29321 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29322 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29323 hints about their use.
29324
29325 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29326 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29327 least, the following operations:
29328
29329 @itemize @bullet
29330 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29331 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29332 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29333 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29334 @end itemize
29335
29336 @end ignore
29337
29338 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29339
29340 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29341
29342 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29343 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29344 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29345 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29346 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29347 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29348 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29349 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29350 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29351 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29352 object, or to change display format.
29353
29354 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29355 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29356 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29357 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29358 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29359 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29360 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29361 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29362 child will be created.
29363
29364 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29365 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29366 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29367 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29368 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29369
29370 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29371 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29372 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29373 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29374 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29375 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29376 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29377 variables that frontend has created.
29378
29379 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29380 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29381 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29382 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29383 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29384 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29385 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29386 implicitly updated.
29387
29388 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29389 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29390 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29391 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29392 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29393 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29394 frame. Consider this example:
29395
29396 @smallexample
29397 void do_work(...)
29398 @{
29399 struct work_state state;
29400
29401 if (...)
29402 do_work(...);
29403 @}
29404 @end smallexample
29405
29406 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29407 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29408 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29409 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29410 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29411
29412 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29413 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29414 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29415 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29416 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29417 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29418
29419 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29420 access this functionality:
29421
29422 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29423 @item @strong{Operation}
29424 @tab @strong{Description}
29425
29426 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29427 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29428 @item @code{-var-create}
29429 @tab create a variable object
29430 @item @code{-var-delete}
29431 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29432 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29433 @tab set the display format of this variable
29434 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29435 @tab show the display format of this variable
29436 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29437 @tab tells how many children this object has
29438 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29439 @tab return a list of the object's children
29440 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29441 @tab show the type of this variable object
29442 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29443 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29444 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29445 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29446 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29447 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29448 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29449 @tab get the value of this variable
29450 @item @code{-var-assign}
29451 @tab set the value of this variable
29452 @item @code{-var-update}
29453 @tab update the variable and its children
29454 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29455 @tab set frozeness attribute
29456 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29457 @tab set range of children to display on update
29458 @end multitable
29459
29460 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29461 how it can be used.
29462
29463 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29464
29465 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29466 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29467
29468 @smallexample
29469 -enable-pretty-printing
29470 @end smallexample
29471
29472 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29473 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29474 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29475 request that this functionality be enabled.
29476
29477 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29478
29479 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29480 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29481
29482 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29483 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29484
29485 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29486 @findex -var-create
29487
29488 @subsubheading Synopsis
29489
29490 @smallexample
29491 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29492 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29493 @end smallexample
29494
29495 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29496 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29497 register.
29498
29499 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29500 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29501 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29502 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29503 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29504
29505 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29506 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29507 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29508 object must be created.
29509
29510 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29511 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29512
29513 @itemize @bullet
29514 @item
29515 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29516
29517 @item
29518 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29519
29520 @item
29521 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29522 @end itemize
29523
29524 @cindex dynamic varobj
29525 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29526 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29527 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29528 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29529 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29530 compatibility for existing clients.
29531
29532 @subsubheading Result
29533
29534 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29535 are:
29536
29537 @table @samp
29538 @item name
29539 The name of the varobj.
29540
29541 @item numchild
29542 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29543 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29544 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29545
29546 @item value
29547 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29548 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29549 will not be interesting.
29550
29551 @item type
29552 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29553 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29554 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29555 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29556 @emph{declared} one.
29557
29558 @item thread-id
29559 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29560 thread's global identifier.
29561
29562 @item has_more
29563 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29564 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29565
29566 @item dynamic
29567 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29568 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29569 then this attribute will not be present.
29570
29571 @item displayhint
29572 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29573 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29574 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29575 @end table
29576
29577 Typical output will look like this:
29578
29579 @smallexample
29580 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29581 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29582 @end smallexample
29583
29584
29585 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29586 @findex -var-delete
29587
29588 @subsubheading Synopsis
29589
29590 @smallexample
29591 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29592 @end smallexample
29593
29594 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29595 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29596
29597 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29598
29599
29600 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29601 @findex -var-set-format
29602
29603 @subsubheading Synopsis
29604
29605 @smallexample
29606 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29607 @end smallexample
29608
29609 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29610 @var{format-spec}.
29611
29612 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29613 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29614
29615 @smallexample
29616 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29617 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29618 @end smallexample
29619
29620 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29621 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29622 for pointers, etc.).
29623
29624 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29625 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29626 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29627 zero-hexadecimal format.
29628
29629 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29630 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29631
29632 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29633 @findex -var-show-format
29634
29635 @subsubheading Synopsis
29636
29637 @smallexample
29638 -var-show-format @var{name}
29639 @end smallexample
29640
29641 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29642
29643 @smallexample
29644 @var{format} @expansion{}
29645 @var{format-spec}
29646 @end smallexample
29647
29648
29649 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29650 @findex -var-info-num-children
29651
29652 @subsubheading Synopsis
29653
29654 @smallexample
29655 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29656 @end smallexample
29657
29658 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29659
29660 @smallexample
29661 numchild=@var{n}
29662 @end smallexample
29663
29664 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29665 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29666 be available.
29667
29668
29669 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29670 @findex -var-list-children
29671
29672 @subsubheading Synopsis
29673
29674 @smallexample
29675 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29676 @end smallexample
29677 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29678
29679 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29680 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29681 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29682 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29683 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29684 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29685 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29686 and unions.
29687
29688 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29689 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29690 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29691 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29692 reported.
29693
29694 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29695 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29696 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29697 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29698 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29699 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29700 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29701 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29702 the visible items.
29703
29704 For each child the following results are returned:
29705
29706 @table @var
29707
29708 @item name
29709 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29710
29711 @item exp
29712 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29713 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29714
29715 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29716 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29717
29718 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29719 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29720 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29721 type and value are not present.
29722
29723 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29724 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29725 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29726
29727 @item numchild
29728 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29729 0.
29730
29731 @item type
29732 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29733 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29734 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29735 @emph{declared} one.
29736
29737 @item value
29738 If values were requested, this is the value.
29739
29740 @item thread-id
29741 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29742 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29743
29744 @item frozen
29745 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29746
29747 @item displayhint
29748 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29749 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29750 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29751
29752 @item dynamic
29753 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29754 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29755 then this attribute will not be present.
29756
29757 @end table
29758
29759 The result may have its own attributes:
29760
29761 @table @samp
29762 @item displayhint
29763 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29764 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29765 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29766
29767 @item has_more
29768 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29769 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29770 @end table
29771
29772 @subsubheading Example
29773
29774 @smallexample
29775 (gdb)
29776 -var-list-children n
29777 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29778 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29779 (gdb)
29780 -var-list-children --all-values n
29781 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29782 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29783 @end smallexample
29784
29785
29786 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29787 @findex -var-info-type
29788
29789 @subsubheading Synopsis
29790
29791 @smallexample
29792 -var-info-type @var{name}
29793 @end smallexample
29794
29795 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29796 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29797 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29798
29799 @smallexample
29800 type=@var{typename}
29801 @end smallexample
29802
29803
29804 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29805 @findex -var-info-expression
29806
29807 @subsubheading Synopsis
29808
29809 @smallexample
29810 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29811 @end smallexample
29812
29813 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29814 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29815 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29816
29817 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29818 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29819
29820 @smallexample
29821 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29822 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29823 @end smallexample
29824
29825 @noindent
29826 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29827 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29828
29829 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29830 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29831 is of limited use.
29832
29833 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29834 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29835
29836 @subsubheading Synopsis
29837
29838 @smallexample
29839 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29840 @end smallexample
29841
29842 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29843 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29844 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29845 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29846 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29847 watchpoint from a variable object.
29848
29849 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29850 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29851
29852 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29853 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29854 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29855 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29856 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29857 @smallexample
29858 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29859 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29860 @end smallexample
29861
29862 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29863 @findex -var-show-attributes
29864
29865 @subsubheading Synopsis
29866
29867 @smallexample
29868 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29869 @end smallexample
29870
29871 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29872
29873 @smallexample
29874 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29875 @end smallexample
29876
29877 @noindent
29878 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29879
29880 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29881 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29882
29883 @subsubheading Synopsis
29884
29885 @smallexample
29886 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29887 @end smallexample
29888
29889 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29890 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29891 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29892 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29893 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29894 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29895 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29896
29897 @smallexample
29898 value=@var{value}
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29902 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29903
29904 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29905 @findex -var-assign
29906
29907 @subsubheading Synopsis
29908
29909 @smallexample
29910 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29911 @end smallexample
29912
29913 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29914 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29915 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29916 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29917
29918 @subsubheading Example
29919
29920 @smallexample
29921 (gdb)
29922 -var-assign var1 3
29923 ^done,value="3"
29924 (gdb)
29925 -var-update *
29926 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29927 (gdb)
29928 @end smallexample
29929
29930 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29931 @findex -var-update
29932
29933 @subsubheading Synopsis
29934
29935 @smallexample
29936 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29937 @end smallexample
29938
29939 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29940 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29941 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29942 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29943 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29944 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29945 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29946 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29947 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29948 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29949 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29950 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29951 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29952
29953 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29954 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29955 diagnostic.
29956
29957 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29958 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29959
29960 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29961 @samp{changelist}.
29962
29963 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29964
29965 @table @samp
29966 @item name
29967 The name of the varobj.
29968
29969 @item value
29970 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29971 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29972
29973 @item in_scope
29974 @anchor{-var-update}
29975 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29976
29977 @table @code
29978 @item "true"
29979 The variable object's current value is valid.
29980
29981 @item "false"
29982 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29983 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29984 scope.
29985
29986 @item "invalid"
29987 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29988 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29989 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29990 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29991 objects.
29992 @end table
29993
29994 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29995 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29996
29997 @item type_changed
29998 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29999 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30000 be @samp{false}.
30001
30002 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30003 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30004 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30005 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30006 unset.
30007
30008 @item new_type
30009 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30010 hold the new type.
30011
30012 @item new_num_children
30013 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30014 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30015
30016 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30017 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30018 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30019 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30020 children which may be available.
30021
30022 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30023 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30024 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30025 only happen at the end of the update range).
30026
30027 @item displayhint
30028 The display hint, if any.
30029
30030 @item has_more
30031 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30032 available outside the varobj's update range.
30033
30034 @item dynamic
30035 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30036 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30037 then this attribute will not be present.
30038
30039 @item new_children
30040 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30041 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30042 be listed in this attribute.
30043 @end table
30044
30045 @subsubheading Example
30046
30047 @smallexample
30048 (gdb)
30049 -var-assign var1 3
30050 ^done,value="3"
30051 (gdb)
30052 -var-update --all-values var1
30053 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30054 type_changed="false"@}]
30055 (gdb)
30056 @end smallexample
30057
30058 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30059 @findex -var-set-frozen
30060 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30061
30062 @subsubheading Synopsis
30063
30064 @smallexample
30065 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30069 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30070 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30071 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30072 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30073 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30074 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30075 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30076 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30077 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30078 @code{-var-update} does.
30079
30080 @subsubheading Example
30081
30082 @smallexample
30083 (gdb)
30084 -var-set-frozen V 1
30085 ^done
30086 (gdb)
30087 @end smallexample
30088
30089 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30090 @findex -var-set-update-range
30091 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30092
30093 @subsubheading Synopsis
30094
30095 @smallexample
30096 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30097 @end smallexample
30098
30099 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30100 @code{-var-update}.
30101
30102 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30103 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30104 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30105 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30106
30107 @subsubheading Example
30108
30109 @smallexample
30110 (gdb)
30111 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30112 ^done
30113 @end smallexample
30114
30115 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30116 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30117 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30118
30119 @subsubheading Synopsis
30120
30121 @smallexample
30122 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30123 @end smallexample
30124
30125 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30126
30127 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30128 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30129
30130 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30131 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30132 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30133 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30134 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30135 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30136 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30137
30138 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30139 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30140 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30141 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30142
30143 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30144 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30145 can be used to check this.
30146
30147 @subsubheading Example
30148
30149 Resetting the visualizer:
30150
30151 @smallexample
30152 (gdb)
30153 -var-set-visualizer V None
30154 ^done
30155 @end smallexample
30156
30157 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30158
30159 @smallexample
30160 (gdb)
30161 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30162 ^done
30163 @end smallexample
30164
30165 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30166 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30167
30168 @smallexample
30169 (gdb)
30170 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30171 ^done
30172 @end smallexample
30173
30174 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30175 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30176 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30177
30178 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30179 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30180 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30181 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30182
30183 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30184 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30185
30186 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30187 @c @subheading -data-assign
30188 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30189 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30190 @c set variable
30191 @c @subsubheading Example
30192 @c N.A.
30193
30194 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30195 @findex -data-disassemble
30196
30197 @subsubheading Synopsis
30198
30199 @smallexample
30200 -data-disassemble
30201 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30202 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30203 -- @var{mode}
30204 @end smallexample
30205
30206 @noindent
30207 Where:
30208
30209 @table @samp
30210 @item @var{start-addr}
30211 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30212 @item @var{end-addr}
30213 is the end address
30214 @item @var{filename}
30215 is the name of the file to disassemble
30216 @item @var{linenum}
30217 is the line number to disassemble around
30218 @item @var{lines}
30219 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30220 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30221 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30222 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30223 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30224 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30225 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30226 are displayed.
30227 @item @var{mode}
30228 is one of:
30229 @itemize @bullet
30230 @item 0 disassembly only
30231 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30232 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30233 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30234 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30235 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30236 @end itemize
30237
30238 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30239 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30240 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30241 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30242 @end table
30243
30244 @subsubheading Result
30245
30246 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30247 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30248 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30249
30250 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30251 following fields:
30252
30253 @table @code
30254 @item address
30255 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30256
30257 @item func-name
30258 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30259
30260 @item offset
30261 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30262
30263 @item inst
30264 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30265
30266 @item opcodes
30267 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30268 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30269
30270 @end table
30271
30272 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30273 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30274
30275 @table @code
30276 @item line
30277 The line number within @samp{file}.
30278
30279 @item file
30280 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30281 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30282 used.
30283
30284 @item fullname
30285 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30286 using the source file search path
30287 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30288 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30289
30290 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30291 present in the debug information.
30292
30293 @item line_asm_insn
30294 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30295 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30296 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30297 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30298 @samp{opcodes}.
30299
30300 @end table
30301
30302 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30303 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30304 adjust its format.
30305
30306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30307
30308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30309
30310 @subsubheading Example
30311
30312 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30313
30314 @smallexample
30315 (gdb)
30316 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30317 ^done,
30318 asm_insns=[
30319 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30320 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30321 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30322 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30323 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30324 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30325 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30326 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30327 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30328 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30329 (gdb)
30330 @end smallexample
30331
30332 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30333 @code{main}.
30334
30335 @smallexample
30336 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30337 ^done,asm_insns=[
30338 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30339 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30340 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30341 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30342 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30343 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30344 [@dots{}]
30345 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30346 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30347 (gdb)
30348 @end smallexample
30349
30350 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30351
30352 @smallexample
30353 (gdb)
30354 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30355 ^done,asm_insns=[
30356 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30357 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30358 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30359 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30360 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30361 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30362 (gdb)
30363 @end smallexample
30364
30365 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30366
30367 @smallexample
30368 (gdb)
30369 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30370 ^done,asm_insns=[
30371 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30372 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30373 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30374 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30375 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30376 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30377 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30378 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30379 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30380 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30381 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30382 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30383 (gdb)
30384 @end smallexample
30385
30386
30387 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30388 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30389
30390 @subsubheading Synopsis
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30394 @end smallexample
30395
30396 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30397 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30398 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30399
30400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30401
30402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30403 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30404 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30405
30406 @subsubheading Example
30407
30408 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30409 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30410 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30411 output.
30412
30413 @smallexample
30414 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30415 211^done,value="1"
30416 (gdb)
30417 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30418 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30419 (gdb)
30420 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30421 411^done,value="4"
30422 (gdb)
30423 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30424 511^done,value="4"
30425 (gdb)
30426 @end smallexample
30427
30428
30429 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30430 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30431
30432 @subsubheading Synopsis
30433
30434 @smallexample
30435 -data-list-changed-registers
30436 @end smallexample
30437
30438 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30439
30440 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30441
30442 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30443 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30444
30445 @subsubheading Example
30446
30447 On a PPC MBX board:
30448
30449 @smallexample
30450 (gdb)
30451 -exec-continue
30452 ^running
30453
30454 (gdb)
30455 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30456 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30457 line="5"@}
30458 (gdb)
30459 -data-list-changed-registers
30460 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30461 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30462 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30463 (gdb)
30464 @end smallexample
30465
30466
30467 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30468 @findex -data-list-register-names
30469
30470 @subsubheading Synopsis
30471
30472 @smallexample
30473 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30474 @end smallexample
30475
30476 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30477 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30478 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30479 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30480 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30481 include empty register names.
30482
30483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30484
30485 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30486 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30487 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30488
30489 @subsubheading Example
30490
30491 For the PPC MBX board:
30492 @smallexample
30493 (gdb)
30494 -data-list-register-names
30495 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30496 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30497 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30498 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30499 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30500 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30501 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30502 (gdb)
30503 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30504 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30505 (gdb)
30506 @end smallexample
30507
30508 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30509 @findex -data-list-register-values
30510
30511 @subsubheading Synopsis
30512
30513 @smallexample
30514 -data-list-register-values
30515 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30516 @end smallexample
30517
30518 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30519 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30520 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30521 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30522 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30523 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30524
30525 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30526
30527 @table @code
30528 @item x
30529 Hexadecimal
30530 @item o
30531 Octal
30532 @item t
30533 Binary
30534 @item d
30535 Decimal
30536 @item r
30537 Raw
30538 @item N
30539 Natural
30540 @end table
30541
30542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30543
30544 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30545 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30546
30547 @subsubheading Example
30548
30549 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30550 don't appear in the actual output):
30551
30552 @smallexample
30553 (gdb)
30554 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30555 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30556 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30557 (gdb)
30558 -data-list-register-values x
30559 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30560 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30561 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30562 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30563 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30564 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30565 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30566 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30567 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30568 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30569 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30570 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30571 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30572 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30573 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30574 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30575 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30576 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30577 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30578 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30579 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30580 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30581 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30582 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30583 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30584 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30585 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30586 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30587 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30588 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30589 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30590 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30591 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30592 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30593 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30594 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30595 (gdb)
30596 @end smallexample
30597
30598
30599 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30600 @findex -data-read-memory
30601
30602 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30603
30604 @subsubheading Synopsis
30605
30606 @smallexample
30607 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30608 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30609 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30610 @end smallexample
30611
30612 @noindent
30613 where:
30614
30615 @table @samp
30616 @item @var{address}
30617 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30618 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30619 quoted using the C convention.
30620
30621 @item @var{word-format}
30622 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30623 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30624 ,Output Formats}).
30625
30626 @item @var{word-size}
30627 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30628
30629 @item @var{nr-rows}
30630 The number of rows in the output table.
30631
30632 @item @var{nr-cols}
30633 The number of columns in the output table.
30634
30635 @item @var{aschar}
30636 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30637 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30638 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30639 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30640
30641 @item @var{byte-offset}
30642 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30643 @end table
30644
30645 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30646 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30647 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30648 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30649 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30650 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30651 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30652 @samp{addr}.
30653
30654 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30655 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30656 @samp{prev-page}.
30657
30658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30659
30660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30661 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30662
30663 @subsubheading Example
30664
30665 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30666 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30667 word. Display each word in hex.
30668
30669 @smallexample
30670 (gdb)
30671 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30672 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30673 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30674 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30675 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30676 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30677 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30678 (gdb)
30679 @end smallexample
30680
30681 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30682 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30683
30684 @smallexample
30685 (gdb)
30686 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30687 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30688 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30689 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30690 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30691 (gdb)
30692 @end smallexample
30693
30694 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30695 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30696 used as the non-printable character.
30697
30698 @smallexample
30699 (gdb)
30700 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30701 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30702 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30703 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30704 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30705 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30706 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30707 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30708 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30709 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30710 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30711 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30712 (gdb)
30713 @end smallexample
30714
30715 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30716 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30717
30718 @subsubheading Synopsis
30719
30720 @smallexample
30721 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30722 @var{address} @var{count}
30723 @end smallexample
30724
30725 @noindent
30726 where:
30727
30728 @table @samp
30729 @item @var{address}
30730 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30731 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30732 quoted using the C convention.
30733
30734 @item @var{count}
30735 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30736 literal.
30737
30738 @item @var{offset}
30739 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30740 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30741 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30742 arithmetics itself.
30743
30744 @end table
30745
30746 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30747 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30748 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30749 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30750 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30751 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30752
30753 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30754 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30755 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30756 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30757 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30758 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30759 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30760 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30761
30762 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30763 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30764 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30765 and has the following fields:
30766
30767 @table @code
30768 @item begin
30769 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30770
30771 @item end
30772 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30773
30774 @item offset
30775 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30776 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30777
30778 @item contents
30779 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30780
30781 @end table
30782
30783
30784
30785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30786
30787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30788
30789 @subsubheading Example
30790
30791 @smallexample
30792 (gdb)
30793 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30794 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30795 end="0xbffff15e",
30796 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30797 (gdb)
30798 @end smallexample
30799
30800
30801 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30802 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30803
30804 @subsubheading Synopsis
30805
30806 @smallexample
30807 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30808 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30809 @end smallexample
30810
30811 @noindent
30812 where:
30813
30814 @table @samp
30815 @item @var{address}
30816 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30817 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30818 be quoted using the C convention.
30819
30820 @item @var{contents}
30821 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30822 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30823
30824 @item @var{count}
30825 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30826 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30827 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30828 @var{count} memory units.
30829
30830 @end table
30831
30832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30833
30834 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30835
30836 @subsubheading Example
30837
30838 @smallexample
30839 (gdb)
30840 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30841 ^done
30842 (gdb)
30843 @end smallexample
30844
30845 @smallexample
30846 (gdb)
30847 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30848 ^done
30849 (gdb)
30850 @end smallexample
30851
30852 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30853 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30854 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30855
30856 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30857 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30858
30859 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30860 @findex -trace-find
30861
30862 @subsubheading Synopsis
30863
30864 @smallexample
30865 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30866 @end smallexample
30867
30868 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30869 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30870 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30871
30872 @table @samp
30873
30874 @item none
30875 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30876
30877 @item frame-number
30878 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30879 that index.
30880
30881 @item tracepoint-number
30882 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30883 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30884
30885 @item pc
30886 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30887 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30888 address.
30889
30890 @item pc-inside-range
30891 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30892 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30893 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30894
30895 @item pc-outside-range
30896 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30897 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30898 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30899
30900 @item line
30901 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30902 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30903 the specified location.
30904
30905 @end table
30906
30907 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30908 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30909
30910 @table @samp
30911 @item found
30912 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30913 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30914
30915 @item traceframe
30916 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30917 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30918
30919 @item tracepoint
30920 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30921 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30922
30923 @item frame
30924 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30925 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30926 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30927
30928 @end table
30929
30930 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30931
30932 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30933
30934 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30935 @findex -trace-define-variable
30936
30937 @subsubheading Synopsis
30938
30939 @smallexample
30940 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30941 @end smallexample
30942
30943 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30944 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30945 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30946 with the @samp{$} character.
30947
30948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30949
30950 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30951
30952 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30953 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30954
30955 @subsubheading Synopsis
30956
30957 @smallexample
30958 -trace-frame-collected
30959 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30960 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30961 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30962 [--memory-contents]
30963 @end smallexample
30964
30965 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30966 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30967 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30968 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30969 See the output description table below for more details.
30970
30971 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30972 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30973 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30974 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30975 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30976
30977 For instance, if the actions were
30978 @smallexample
30979 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30980 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30981 @end smallexample
30982
30983 @noindent
30984 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30985 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30986 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30987 objects would be computed expressions.
30988
30989 An example output would be:
30990
30991 @smallexample
30992 (gdb)
30993 -trace-frame-collected
30994 ^done,
30995 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30996 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30997 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30998 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30999 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31000 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31001 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31002 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31003 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31004 ...
31005 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31006 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31007 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31008 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31009 (gdb)
31010 @end smallexample
31011
31012 Where:
31013
31014 @table @code
31015 @item explicit-variables
31016 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31017 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31018 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31019 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31020 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31021 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31022 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31023 arrays, structures and unions.
31024
31025 @item computed-expressions
31026 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31027 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31028 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31029 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31030
31031 @item registers
31032 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31033 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31034 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31035 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31036 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31037
31038 @item tvars
31039 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31040 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31041 current value are returned.
31042
31043 @item memory
31044 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31045 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31046 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31047
31048 @table @code
31049 @item address
31050 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31051
31052 @item length
31053 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31054
31055 @item contents
31056 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31057 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31058
31059 @end table
31060
31061 @end table
31062
31063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31064
31065 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31066
31067 @subsubheading Example
31068
31069 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31070 @findex -trace-list-variables
31071
31072 @subsubheading Synopsis
31073
31074 @smallexample
31075 -trace-list-variables
31076 @end smallexample
31077
31078 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31079 table has the following fields:
31080
31081 @table @samp
31082 @item name
31083 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31084
31085 @item initial
31086 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31087 field is always present.
31088
31089 @item current
31090 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31091 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31092 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31093 presently running.
31094
31095 @end table
31096
31097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31098
31099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31100
31101 @subsubheading Example
31102
31103 @smallexample
31104 (gdb)
31105 -trace-list-variables
31106 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31107 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31108 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31109 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31110 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31111 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31112 (gdb)
31113 @end smallexample
31114
31115 @subheading -trace-save
31116 @findex -trace-save
31117
31118 @subsubheading Synopsis
31119
31120 @smallexample
31121 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31122 @end smallexample
31123
31124 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31125 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31126 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31127 to perform the save.
31128
31129 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31130 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31131 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31132
31133 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31134
31135 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31136
31137
31138 @subheading -trace-start
31139 @findex -trace-start
31140
31141 @subsubheading Synopsis
31142
31143 @smallexample
31144 -trace-start
31145 @end smallexample
31146
31147 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31148 have any fields.
31149
31150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31151
31152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31153
31154 @subheading -trace-status
31155 @findex -trace-status
31156
31157 @subsubheading Synopsis
31158
31159 @smallexample
31160 -trace-status
31161 @end smallexample
31162
31163 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31164 the following fields:
31165
31166 @table @samp
31167
31168 @item supported
31169 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31170 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31171 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31172 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31173 started. This field is always present.
31174
31175 @item running
31176 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31177 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31178 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31179
31180 @item stop-reason
31181 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31182 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31183 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31184 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31185 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31186 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31187 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31188 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31189 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31190
31191 @item stopping-tracepoint
31192 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31193 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31194 @samp{passcount}.
31195
31196 @item frames
31197 @itemx frames-created
31198 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31199 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31200 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31201 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31202
31203 @item buffer-size
31204 @itemx buffer-free
31205 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31206 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31207
31208 @item circular
31209 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31210 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31211 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31212 and may fill up.
31213
31214 @item disconnected
31215 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31216 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31217 that the trace run will stop.
31218
31219 @item trace-file
31220 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31221 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31222
31223 @end table
31224
31225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31226
31227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31228
31229 @subheading -trace-stop
31230 @findex -trace-stop
31231
31232 @subsubheading Synopsis
31233
31234 @smallexample
31235 -trace-stop
31236 @end smallexample
31237
31238 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31239 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31240 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31241
31242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31243
31244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31245
31246
31247 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31248 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31249 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31250
31251
31252 @ignore
31253 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31254 @findex -symbol-info-address
31255
31256 @subsubheading Synopsis
31257
31258 @smallexample
31259 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31260 @end smallexample
31261
31262 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31263
31264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31265
31266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31267
31268 @subsubheading Example
31269 N.A.
31270
31271
31272 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31273 @findex -symbol-info-file
31274
31275 @subsubheading Synopsis
31276
31277 @smallexample
31278 -symbol-info-file
31279 @end smallexample
31280
31281 Show the file for the symbol.
31282
31283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31284
31285 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31286 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31287
31288 @subsubheading Example
31289 N.A.
31290
31291
31292 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31293 @findex -symbol-info-function
31294
31295 @subsubheading Synopsis
31296
31297 @smallexample
31298 -symbol-info-function
31299 @end smallexample
31300
31301 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31302
31303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31304
31305 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31306
31307 @subsubheading Example
31308 N.A.
31309
31310
31311 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31312 @findex -symbol-info-line
31313
31314 @subsubheading Synopsis
31315
31316 @smallexample
31317 -symbol-info-line
31318 @end smallexample
31319
31320 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31321
31322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31323
31324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31325 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31326
31327 @subsubheading Example
31328 N.A.
31329
31330
31331 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31332 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31333
31334 @subsubheading Synopsis
31335
31336 @smallexample
31337 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31338 @end smallexample
31339
31340 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31341
31342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31343
31344 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31345
31346 @subsubheading Example
31347 N.A.
31348
31349
31350 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31351 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31352
31353 @subsubheading Synopsis
31354
31355 @smallexample
31356 -symbol-list-functions
31357 @end smallexample
31358
31359 List the functions in the executable.
31360
31361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31362
31363 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31364 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31365
31366 @subsubheading Example
31367 N.A.
31368 @end ignore
31369
31370
31371 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31372 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31373
31374 @subsubheading Synopsis
31375
31376 @smallexample
31377 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31378 @end smallexample
31379
31380 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31381 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31382 ascending PC order.
31383
31384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31385
31386 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31387
31388 @subsubheading Example
31389 @smallexample
31390 (gdb)
31391 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31392 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31393 (gdb)
31394 @end smallexample
31395
31396
31397 @ignore
31398 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31399 @findex -symbol-list-types
31400
31401 @subsubheading Synopsis
31402
31403 @smallexample
31404 -symbol-list-types
31405 @end smallexample
31406
31407 List all the type names.
31408
31409 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31410
31411 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31412 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31413
31414 @subsubheading Example
31415 N.A.
31416
31417
31418 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31419 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31420
31421 @subsubheading Synopsis
31422
31423 @smallexample
31424 -symbol-list-variables
31425 @end smallexample
31426
31427 List all the global and static variable names.
31428
31429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31430
31431 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31432
31433 @subsubheading Example
31434 N.A.
31435
31436
31437 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31438 @findex -symbol-locate
31439
31440 @subsubheading Synopsis
31441
31442 @smallexample
31443 -symbol-locate
31444 @end smallexample
31445
31446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31447
31448 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31449
31450 @subsubheading Example
31451 N.A.
31452
31453
31454 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31455 @findex -symbol-type
31456
31457 @subsubheading Synopsis
31458
31459 @smallexample
31460 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31461 @end smallexample
31462
31463 Show type of @var{variable}.
31464
31465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31466
31467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31468 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31469
31470 @subsubheading Example
31471 N.A.
31472 @end ignore
31473
31474
31475 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31476 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31477 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31478
31479 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31480 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31481
31482 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31483 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31484
31485 @subsubheading Synopsis
31486
31487 @smallexample
31488 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31489 @end smallexample
31490
31491 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31492 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31493 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31494 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31495 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31496 notification.
31497
31498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31499
31500 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31501
31502 @subsubheading Example
31503
31504 @smallexample
31505 (gdb)
31506 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31507 ^done
31508 (gdb)
31509 @end smallexample
31510
31511
31512 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31513 @findex -file-exec-file
31514
31515 @subsubheading Synopsis
31516
31517 @smallexample
31518 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31519 @end smallexample
31520
31521 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31522 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31523 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31524 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31525 notification.
31526
31527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31528
31529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31530
31531 @subsubheading Example
31532
31533 @smallexample
31534 (gdb)
31535 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31536 ^done
31537 (gdb)
31538 @end smallexample
31539
31540
31541 @ignore
31542 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31543 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31544
31545 @subsubheading Synopsis
31546
31547 @smallexample
31548 -file-list-exec-sections
31549 @end smallexample
31550
31551 List the sections of the current executable file.
31552
31553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31554
31555 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31556 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31557 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31558
31559 @subsubheading Example
31560 N.A.
31561 @end ignore
31562
31563
31564 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31565 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31566
31567 @subsubheading Synopsis
31568
31569 @smallexample
31570 -file-list-exec-source-file
31571 @end smallexample
31572
31573 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31574 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31575 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31576 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31577
31578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31579
31580 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31581
31582 @subsubheading Example
31583
31584 @smallexample
31585 (gdb)
31586 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31587 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31588 (gdb)
31589 @end smallexample
31590
31591
31592 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31593 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31594
31595 @subsubheading Synopsis
31596
31597 @smallexample
31598 -file-list-exec-source-files
31599 @end smallexample
31600
31601 List the source files for the current executable.
31602
31603 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31604 name) of a source file.
31605
31606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31607
31608 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31609 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31610
31611 @subsubheading Example
31612 @smallexample
31613 (gdb)
31614 -file-list-exec-source-files
31615 ^done,files=[
31616 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31617 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31618 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31619 (gdb)
31620 @end smallexample
31621
31622 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31623 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31624
31625 @subsubheading Synopsis
31626
31627 @smallexample
31628 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31629 @end smallexample
31630
31631 List the shared libraries in the program.
31632 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31633 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31634
31635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31636
31637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31638 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31639 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31640 library. Each range has the following fields:
31641
31642 @table @samp
31643 @item from
31644 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31645 @item to
31646 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31647 @end table
31648
31649 @subsubheading Example
31650 @smallexample
31651 (gdb)
31652 -file-list-exec-source-files
31653 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31654 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31655 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31656 (gdb)
31657 @end smallexample
31658
31659
31660 @ignore
31661 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31662 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31663
31664 @subsubheading Synopsis
31665
31666 @smallexample
31667 -file-list-symbol-files
31668 @end smallexample
31669
31670 List symbol files.
31671
31672 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31673
31674 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31675
31676 @subsubheading Example
31677 N.A.
31678 @end ignore
31679
31680
31681 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31682 @findex -file-symbol-file
31683
31684 @subsubheading Synopsis
31685
31686 @smallexample
31687 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31688 @end smallexample
31689
31690 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31691 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31692 produced, except for a completion notification.
31693
31694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31695
31696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31697
31698 @subsubheading Example
31699
31700 @smallexample
31701 (gdb)
31702 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31703 ^done
31704 (gdb)
31705 @end smallexample
31706
31707 @ignore
31708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31709 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31710 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31711
31712 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31713
31714 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31715
31716 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31717
31718 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31719
31720 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31721
31722 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31723
31724 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31725
31726 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31727
31728 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31729 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31730 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31731
31732 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31733
31734 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31735
31736 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31737
31738 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31739 @end ignore
31740
31741
31742 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31743 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31744 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31745
31746
31747 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31748 @findex -target-attach
31749
31750 @subsubheading Synopsis
31751
31752 @smallexample
31753 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31754 @end smallexample
31755
31756 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31757 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31758 group, the id previously returned by
31759 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31760
31761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31762
31763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31764
31765 @subsubheading Example
31766 @smallexample
31767 (gdb)
31768 -target-attach 34
31769 =thread-created,id="1"
31770 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31771 ^done
31772 (gdb)
31773 @end smallexample
31774
31775 @ignore
31776 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31777 @findex -target-compare-sections
31778
31779 @subsubheading Synopsis
31780
31781 @smallexample
31782 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31783 @end smallexample
31784
31785 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31786 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31787
31788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31789
31790 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31791
31792 @subsubheading Example
31793 N.A.
31794 @end ignore
31795
31796
31797 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31798 @findex -target-detach
31799
31800 @subsubheading Synopsis
31801
31802 @smallexample
31803 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31804 @end smallexample
31805
31806 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31807 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31808 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31809
31810 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31811
31812 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31813
31814 @subsubheading Example
31815
31816 @smallexample
31817 (gdb)
31818 -target-detach
31819 ^done
31820 (gdb)
31821 @end smallexample
31822
31823
31824 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31825 @findex -target-disconnect
31826
31827 @subsubheading Synopsis
31828
31829 @smallexample
31830 -target-disconnect
31831 @end smallexample
31832
31833 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31834 generally not resumed.
31835
31836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31837
31838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31839
31840 @subsubheading Example
31841
31842 @smallexample
31843 (gdb)
31844 -target-disconnect
31845 ^done
31846 (gdb)
31847 @end smallexample
31848
31849
31850 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31851 @findex -target-download
31852
31853 @subsubheading Synopsis
31854
31855 @smallexample
31856 -target-download
31857 @end smallexample
31858
31859 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31860 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31861
31862 @table @samp
31863 @item section
31864 The name of the section.
31865 @item section-sent
31866 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31867 @item section-size
31868 The size of the section.
31869 @item total-sent
31870 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31871 @item total-size
31872 The size of the overall executable to download.
31873 @end table
31874
31875 @noindent
31876 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31877 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31878
31879 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31880 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31881
31882 @table @samp
31883 @item section
31884 The name of the section.
31885 @item section-size
31886 The size of the section.
31887 @item total-size
31888 The size of the overall executable to download.
31889 @end table
31890
31891 @noindent
31892 At the end, a summary is printed.
31893
31894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31895
31896 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31897
31898 @subsubheading Example
31899
31900 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31901 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31902
31903 @smallexample
31904 (gdb)
31905 -target-download
31906 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31907 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31908 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31909 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31910 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31911 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31912 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31913 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31914 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31915 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31916 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31917 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31918 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31919 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31920 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31921 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31922 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31923 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31924 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31925 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31926 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31927 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31928 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31929 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31930 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31931 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31932 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31933 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31934 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31935 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31936 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31937 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31938 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31939 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31940 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31941 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31942 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31943 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31944 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31945 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31946 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31947 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31948 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31949 write-rate="429"
31950 (gdb)
31951 @end smallexample
31952
31953
31954 @ignore
31955 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31956 @findex -target-exec-status
31957
31958 @subsubheading Synopsis
31959
31960 @smallexample
31961 -target-exec-status
31962 @end smallexample
31963
31964 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31965 not, for instance).
31966
31967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31968
31969 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31970
31971 @subsubheading Example
31972 N.A.
31973
31974
31975 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31976 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31977
31978 @subsubheading Synopsis
31979
31980 @smallexample
31981 -target-list-available-targets
31982 @end smallexample
31983
31984 List the possible targets to connect to.
31985
31986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31987
31988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31989
31990 @subsubheading Example
31991 N.A.
31992
31993
31994 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31995 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31996
31997 @subsubheading Synopsis
31998
31999 @smallexample
32000 -target-list-current-targets
32001 @end smallexample
32002
32003 Describe the current target.
32004
32005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32006
32007 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32008 other things).
32009
32010 @subsubheading Example
32011 N.A.
32012
32013
32014 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32015 @findex -target-list-parameters
32016
32017 @subsubheading Synopsis
32018
32019 @smallexample
32020 -target-list-parameters
32021 @end smallexample
32022
32023 @c ????
32024 @end ignore
32025
32026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32027
32028 No equivalent.
32029
32030 @subsubheading Example
32031 N.A.
32032
32033 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32034 @findex -target-flash-erase
32035
32036 @subsubheading Synopsis
32037
32038 @smallexample
32039 -target-flash-erase
32040 @end smallexample
32041
32042 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32043
32044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32045
32046 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32047 addresses and memory region sizes.
32048
32049 @smallexample
32050 (gdb)
32051 -target-flash-erase
32052 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32053 (gdb)
32054 @end smallexample
32055
32056 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32057 @findex -target-select
32058
32059 @subsubheading Synopsis
32060
32061 @smallexample
32062 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32063 @end smallexample
32064
32065 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32066
32067 @table @samp
32068 @item @var{type}
32069 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32070 @item @var{parameters}
32071 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32072 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32073 @end table
32074
32075 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32076 which the target program is, in the following form:
32077
32078 @smallexample
32079 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32080 args=[@var{arg list}]
32081 @end smallexample
32082
32083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32084
32085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32086
32087 @subsubheading Example
32088
32089 @smallexample
32090 (gdb)
32091 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32092 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32093 (gdb)
32094 @end smallexample
32095
32096 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32097 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32098 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32099
32100
32101 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32102 @findex -target-file-put
32103
32104 @subsubheading Synopsis
32105
32106 @smallexample
32107 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32108 @end smallexample
32109
32110 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32111 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32112
32113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32114
32115 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32116
32117 @subsubheading Example
32118
32119 @smallexample
32120 (gdb)
32121 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32122 ^done
32123 (gdb)
32124 @end smallexample
32125
32126
32127 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32128 @findex -target-file-get
32129
32130 @subsubheading Synopsis
32131
32132 @smallexample
32133 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32134 @end smallexample
32135
32136 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32137 on the host system.
32138
32139 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32140
32141 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32142
32143 @subsubheading Example
32144
32145 @smallexample
32146 (gdb)
32147 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32148 ^done
32149 (gdb)
32150 @end smallexample
32151
32152
32153 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32154 @findex -target-file-delete
32155
32156 @subsubheading Synopsis
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32160 @end smallexample
32161
32162 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32163
32164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32165
32166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32167
32168 @subsubheading Example
32169
32170 @smallexample
32171 (gdb)
32172 -target-file-delete remotefile
32173 ^done
32174 (gdb)
32175 @end smallexample
32176
32177
32178 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32179 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32180 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32181
32182 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32183 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32184
32185 @subsubheading Synopsis
32186
32187 @smallexample
32188 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32189 @end smallexample
32190
32191 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32192 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32193 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32194
32195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32196
32197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32198
32199 @subsubheading Result
32200
32201 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32202 defined for each exception:
32203
32204 @table @samp
32205 @item name
32206 The name of the exception.
32207
32208 @item address
32209 The address of the exception.
32210
32211 @end table
32212
32213 @subsubheading Example
32214
32215 @smallexample
32216 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32217 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32218 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32219 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32220 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32221 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32222 @end smallexample
32223
32224 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32225
32226 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32227 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32228 Catchpoint Commands}.
32229
32230
32231 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32232 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32233 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32234
32235 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32236 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32237 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32238 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32239
32240 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32241 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32242 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32243
32244 @subsubheading Synopsis
32245
32246 @smallexample
32247 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32248 @end smallexample
32249
32250 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32251
32252 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32253 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32254 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32255 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32256 dash.
32257
32258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32259
32260 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32261
32262 @subsubheading Result
32263
32264 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32265
32266 @table @samp
32267 @item exists
32268 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32269 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32270
32271 @end table
32272
32273 @subsubheading Example
32274
32275 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32276
32277 @smallexample
32278 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32279 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32280 @end smallexample
32281
32282 @noindent
32283 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32284 to the debugger:
32285
32286 @smallexample
32287 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32288 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32289 @end smallexample
32290
32291 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32292 @findex -list-features
32293 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32294
32295 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32296 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32297 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32298 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32299 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32300 startup.
32301
32302 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32303 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32304 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32305 is given below.
32306
32307 Example output:
32308
32309 @smallexample
32310 (gdb) -list-features
32311 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32312 @end smallexample
32313
32314 The current list of features is:
32315
32316 @ftable @samp
32317 @item frozen-varobjs
32318 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32319 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32320 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32321 @item pending-breakpoints
32322 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32323 command.
32324 @item python
32325 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32326 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32327 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32328 @item thread-info
32329 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32330 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32331 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32332 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32333 @item breakpoint-notifications
32334 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32335 CLI will be announced via async records.
32336 @item ada-task-info
32337 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32338 @item language-option
32339 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32340 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32341 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32342 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32343 @item undefined-command-error-code
32344 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32345 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32346 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32347 @item exec-run-start-option
32348 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32349 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32350 @end ftable
32351
32352 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32353 @findex -list-target-features
32354
32355 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32356 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32357 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32358 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32359 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32360 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32361 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32362 Example output:
32363
32364 @smallexample
32365 (gdb) -list-target-features
32366 ^done,result=["async"]
32367 @end smallexample
32368
32369 The current list of features is:
32370
32371 @table @samp
32372 @item async
32373 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32374 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32375 while the target is running.
32376
32377 @item reverse
32378 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32379 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32380
32381 @end table
32382
32383 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32384 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32385 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32386
32387 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32388
32389 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32390 @findex -gdb-exit
32391
32392 @subsubheading Synopsis
32393
32394 @smallexample
32395 -gdb-exit
32396 @end smallexample
32397
32398 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32399
32400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32401
32402 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32403
32404 @subsubheading Example
32405
32406 @smallexample
32407 (gdb)
32408 -gdb-exit
32409 ^exit
32410 @end smallexample
32411
32412
32413 @ignore
32414 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32415 @findex -exec-abort
32416
32417 @subsubheading Synopsis
32418
32419 @smallexample
32420 -exec-abort
32421 @end smallexample
32422
32423 Kill the inferior running program.
32424
32425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32426
32427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32428
32429 @subsubheading Example
32430 N.A.
32431 @end ignore
32432
32433
32434 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32435 @findex -gdb-set
32436
32437 @subsubheading Synopsis
32438
32439 @smallexample
32440 -gdb-set
32441 @end smallexample
32442
32443 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32444 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32445
32446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32447
32448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32449
32450 @subsubheading Example
32451
32452 @smallexample
32453 (gdb)
32454 -gdb-set $foo=3
32455 ^done
32456 (gdb)
32457 @end smallexample
32458
32459
32460 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32461 @findex -gdb-show
32462
32463 @subsubheading Synopsis
32464
32465 @smallexample
32466 -gdb-show
32467 @end smallexample
32468
32469 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32470
32471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32472
32473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32474
32475 @subsubheading Example
32476
32477 @smallexample
32478 (gdb)
32479 -gdb-show annotate
32480 ^done,value="0"
32481 (gdb)
32482 @end smallexample
32483
32484 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32485
32486
32487 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32488 @findex -gdb-version
32489
32490 @subsubheading Synopsis
32491
32492 @smallexample
32493 -gdb-version
32494 @end smallexample
32495
32496 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32497
32498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32499
32500 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32501 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32502
32503 @subsubheading Example
32504
32505 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32506 @c box in TeX.
32507 @smallexample
32508 (gdb)
32509 -gdb-version
32510 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32511 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32512 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32513 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32514 ~ certain conditions.
32515 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32516 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32517 ~ details.
32518 ~This GDB was configured as
32519 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32520 ^done
32521 (gdb)
32522 @end smallexample
32523
32524 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32525 @findex -list-thread-groups
32526
32527 @subheading Synopsis
32528
32529 @smallexample
32530 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32531 @end smallexample
32532
32533 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32534 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32535 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32536 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32537 top-level thread groups.
32538
32539 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32540 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32541 available on the target.
32542
32543 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32544 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32545 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32546 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32547 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32548 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32549 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32550 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32551
32552 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32553 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32554 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32555 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32556 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32557 @samp{threads} field.
32558
32559 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32560 the following caveats:
32561
32562 @itemize @bullet
32563 @item
32564 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32565 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32566 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32567
32568 @item
32569 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32570 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32571 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32572 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32573 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32574 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32575
32576 @end itemize
32577
32578 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32579 have the following fields:
32580
32581 @table @code
32582 @item id
32583 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32584 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32585 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32586
32587 @item type
32588 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32589 valid type.
32590
32591 @item pid
32592 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32593 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32594
32595 @item exit-code
32596 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32597 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32598 only if the process is not running.
32599
32600 @item num_children
32601 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32602 absent for an available thread group.
32603
32604 @item threads
32605 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32606 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32607 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32608
32609 @item cores
32610 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32611 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32612 such information is not available.
32613
32614 @item executable
32615 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32616 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32617 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32618
32619 @end table
32620
32621 @subheading Example
32622
32623 @smallexample
32624 @value{GDBP}
32625 -list-thread-groups
32626 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32627 -list-thread-groups 17
32628 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32629 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32630 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32631 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32632 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32633 -list-thread-groups --available
32634 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32635 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32636 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32637 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32638 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32639 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32640 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32641 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32642 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32643 @end smallexample
32644
32645 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32646 @findex -info-os
32647
32648 @subsubheading Synopsis
32649
32650 @smallexample
32651 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32652 @end smallexample
32653
32654 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32655 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32656 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32657 of data of that type.
32658
32659 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32660 system.
32661
32662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32663
32664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32665
32666 @subsubheading Example
32667
32668 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32669 like this:
32670
32671 @smallexample
32672 @value{GDBP}
32673 -info-os
32674 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32675 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32676 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32677 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32678 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32679 col2="CPUs"@},
32680 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32681 col2="File descriptors"@},
32682 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32683 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32684 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32685 col2="Message queues"@},
32686 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32687 col2="Processes"@},
32688 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32689 col2="Process groups"@},
32690 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32691 col2="Semaphores"@},
32692 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32693 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32694 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32695 col2="Sockets"@},
32696 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32697 col2="Threads"@}]
32698 @value{GDBP}
32699 -info-os processes
32700 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32701 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32702 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32703 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32704 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32705 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32706 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32707 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32708 ...
32709 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32710 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32711 (gdb)
32712 @end smallexample
32713
32714 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32715 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32716 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32717 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32718 @code{info os} omits it.)
32719
32720 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32721 @findex -add-inferior
32722
32723 @subheading Synopsis
32724
32725 @smallexample
32726 -add-inferior
32727 @end smallexample
32728
32729 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32730 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32731 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32732 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32733 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32734 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32735
32736 @subheading Example
32737
32738 @smallexample
32739 @value{GDBP}
32740 -add-inferior
32741 ^done,inferior="i3"
32742 @end smallexample
32743
32744 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32745 @findex -interpreter-exec
32746
32747 @subheading Synopsis
32748
32749 @smallexample
32750 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32751 @end smallexample
32752 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32753
32754 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32755
32756 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32757
32758 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32759
32760 @subheading Example
32761
32762 @smallexample
32763 (gdb)
32764 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32765 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32766 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32767 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32768 ^done
32769 (gdb)
32770 @end smallexample
32771
32772 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32773 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32774
32775 @subheading Synopsis
32776
32777 @smallexample
32778 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32779 @end smallexample
32780
32781 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32782
32783 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32784
32785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32786
32787 @subheading Example
32788
32789 @smallexample
32790 (gdb)
32791 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32792 ^done
32793 (gdb)
32794 @end smallexample
32795
32796 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32797 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32798
32799 @subheading Synopsis
32800
32801 @smallexample
32802 -inferior-tty-show
32803 @end smallexample
32804
32805 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32806
32807 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32808
32809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32810
32811 @subheading Example
32812
32813 @smallexample
32814 (gdb)
32815 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32816 ^done
32817 (gdb)
32818 -inferior-tty-show
32819 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32820 (gdb)
32821 @end smallexample
32822
32823 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32824 @findex -enable-timings
32825
32826 @subheading Synopsis
32827
32828 @smallexample
32829 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32830 @end smallexample
32831
32832 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32833 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32834 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32835 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32836
32837 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32838
32839 No equivalent.
32840
32841 @subheading Example
32842
32843 @smallexample
32844 (gdb)
32845 -enable-timings
32846 ^done
32847 (gdb)
32848 -break-insert main
32849 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32850 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32851 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32852 times="0"@},
32853 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32854 (gdb)
32855 -enable-timings no
32856 ^done
32857 (gdb)
32858 -exec-run
32859 ^running
32860 (gdb)
32861 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32862 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32863 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32864 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32865 (gdb)
32866 @end smallexample
32867
32868 @node Annotations
32869 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32870
32871 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32872 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32873 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32874 relatively high level.
32875
32876 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32877 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32878
32879 @ignore
32880 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32881 @end ignore
32882
32883 @menu
32884 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32885 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32886 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32887 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32888 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32889 * Annotations for Running::
32890 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32891 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32892 @end menu
32893
32894 @node Annotations Overview
32895 @section What is an Annotation?
32896 @cindex annotations
32897
32898 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32899 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32900 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32901 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32902 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32903 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32904 cannot contain newline characters.
32905
32906 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32907 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32908 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32909 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32910 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32911 means those three characters as output.
32912
32913 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32914 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32915 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32916 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32917 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32918 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32919 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32920 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32921 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32922
32923 @table @code
32924 @kindex set annotate
32925 @item set annotate @var{level}
32926 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32927 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32928
32929 @item show annotate
32930 @kindex show annotate
32931 Show the current annotation level.
32932 @end table
32933
32934 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32935
32936 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32937
32938 @smallexample
32939 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32940 GNU gdb 6.0
32941 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32942 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32943 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32944 under certain conditions.
32945 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32946 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32947 for details.
32948 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32949
32950 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32951 (@value{GDBP})
32952 ^Z^Zprompt
32953 @kbd{quit}
32954
32955 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32956 $
32957 @end smallexample
32958
32959 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32960 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32961 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32962 output from @value{GDBN}.
32963
32964 @node Server Prefix
32965 @section The Server Prefix
32966 @cindex server prefix
32967
32968 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32969 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32970 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32971 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32972 a transparent manner.
32973
32974 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32975 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32976 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32977 @code{print} command.
32978
32979 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32980 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32981
32982 @node Prompting
32983 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32984
32985 @cindex annotations for prompts
32986 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32987 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32988 over, etc.
32989
32990 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32991 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32992 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32993 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32994 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32995 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32996 features the following annotations:
32997
32998 @smallexample
32999 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33000 ^Z^Zprompt
33001 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33002 @end smallexample
33003
33004 The input types are
33005
33006 @table @code
33007 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33008 @findex prompt annotation
33009 @findex post-prompt annotation
33010 @item prompt
33011 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33012
33013 @findex pre-commands annotation
33014 @findex commands annotation
33015 @findex post-commands annotation
33016 @item commands
33017 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33018 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33019
33020 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33021 @findex overload-choice annotation
33022 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33023 @item overload-choice
33024 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33025
33026 @findex pre-query annotation
33027 @findex query annotation
33028 @findex post-query annotation
33029 @item query
33030 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33031
33032 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33033 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33034 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33035 @item prompt-for-continue
33036 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33037 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33038 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33039 presence of annotations.
33040 @end table
33041
33042 @node Errors
33043 @section Errors
33044 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33045
33046 @findex quit annotation
33047 @smallexample
33048 ^Z^Zquit
33049 @end smallexample
33050
33051 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33052
33053 @findex error annotation
33054 @smallexample
33055 ^Z^Zerror
33056 @end smallexample
33057
33058 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33059
33060 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33061 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33062 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33063 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33064 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33065 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33066 to the top level.
33067
33068 @findex error-begin annotation
33069 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33070
33071 @smallexample
33072 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33073 @end smallexample
33074
33075 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33076 message.
33077
33078 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33079 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33080 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33081
33082 @node Invalidation
33083 @section Invalidation Notices
33084
33085 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33086 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33087 changed.
33088
33089 @table @code
33090 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33091 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33092
33093 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33094 have changed.
33095
33096 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33097 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33098
33099 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33100 deleted a breakpoint.
33101 @end table
33102
33103 @node Annotations for Running
33104 @section Running the Program
33105 @cindex annotations for running programs
33106
33107 @findex starting annotation
33108 @findex stopping annotation
33109 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33110 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33111
33112 @smallexample
33113 ^Z^Zstarting
33114 @end smallexample
33115
33116 is output. When the program stops,
33117
33118 @smallexample
33119 ^Z^Zstopped
33120 @end smallexample
33121
33122 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33123 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33124
33125 @table @code
33126 @findex exited annotation
33127 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33128 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33129 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33130
33131 @findex signalled annotation
33132 @findex signal-name annotation
33133 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33134 @findex signal-string annotation
33135 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33136 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33137 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33138 annotation continues:
33139
33140 @smallexample
33141 @var{intro-text}
33142 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33143 @var{name}
33144 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33145 @var{middle-text}
33146 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33147 @var{string}
33148 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33149 @var{end-text}
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152 @noindent
33153 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33154 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33155 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33156 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33157 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33158
33159 @findex signal annotation
33160 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33161 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33162 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33163 terminated with it.
33164
33165 @findex breakpoint annotation
33166 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33167 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33168
33169 @findex watchpoint annotation
33170 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33171 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33172 @end table
33173
33174 @node Source Annotations
33175 @section Displaying Source
33176 @cindex annotations for source display
33177
33178 @findex source annotation
33179 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33180
33181 @smallexample
33182 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33183 @end smallexample
33184
33185 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33186 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33187 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33188 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33189 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33190 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33191 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33192 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33193 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33194 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33195 depend on the language).
33196
33197 @node JIT Interface
33198 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33199 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33200 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33201
33202 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33203 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33204 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33205 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33206
33207 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33208 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33209 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33210 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33211 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33212 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33213
33214 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33215 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33216 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33217 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33218 LLVM JIT.
33219
33220 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33221 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33222 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33223 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33224 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33225 out about additional code.
33226
33227 @menu
33228 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33229 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33230 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33231 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33232 @end menu
33233
33234 @node Declarations
33235 @section JIT Declarations
33236
33237 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33238 implement the interface:
33239
33240 @smallexample
33241 typedef enum
33242 @{
33243 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33244 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33245 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33246 @} jit_actions_t;
33247
33248 struct jit_code_entry
33249 @{
33250 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33251 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33252 const char *symfile_addr;
33253 uint64_t symfile_size;
33254 @};
33255
33256 struct jit_descriptor
33257 @{
33258 uint32_t version;
33259 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33260 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33261 uint32_t action_flag;
33262 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33263 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33264 @};
33265
33266 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33267 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33268
33269 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33270 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33271 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33272 @end smallexample
33273
33274 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33275 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33276 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33277
33278 @node Registering Code
33279 @section Registering Code
33280
33281 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33282
33283 @itemize @bullet
33284 @item
33285 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33286 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33287
33288 @item
33289 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33290 file.
33291
33292 @item
33293 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33294
33295 @item
33296 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33297
33298 @item
33299 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33300 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33301 @end itemize
33302
33303 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33304 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33305 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33306 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33307
33308 @node Unregistering Code
33309 @section Unregistering Code
33310
33311 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33312
33313 @itemize @bullet
33314 @item
33315 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33316
33317 @item
33318 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33319
33320 @item
33321 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33322 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33323 @end itemize
33324
33325 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33326 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33327
33328 @node Custom Debug Info
33329 @section Custom Debug Info
33330 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33331 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33332
33333 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33334 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33335 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33336 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33337 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33338 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33339 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33340 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33341 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33342
33343 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33344 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33345 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33346 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33347 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33348 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33349 compiler.
33350
33351 @menu
33352 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33353 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33354 @end menu
33355
33356 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33357 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33358 @kindex jit-reader-load
33359 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33360
33361 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33362 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33363
33364 @table @code
33365 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33366 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33367 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33368 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33369 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33370 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33371 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33372
33373 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33374 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33375 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33376 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33377 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33378
33379 @item jit-reader-unload
33380 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33381
33382 @end table
33383
33384 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33385 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33386 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33387
33388 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33389 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33390
33391 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33392 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33393 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33394 the system include directory.
33395
33396 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33397 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33398 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33399
33400 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33401 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33402
33403 @findex gdb_init_reader
33404 @smallexample
33405 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33406 @end smallexample
33407
33408 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33409
33410 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33411 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33412 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33413 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33414 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33415 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33416
33417 @smallexample
33418 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33419 @{
33420 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33421 int reader_version;
33422
33423 /* For use by the reader. */
33424 void *priv_data;
33425
33426 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33427 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33428 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33429 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33430 @};
33431 @end smallexample
33432
33433 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33434 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33435
33436 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33437 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33438 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33439 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33440 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33441 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33442 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33443 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33444 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33445 target's address space.
33446
33447 @node In-Process Agent
33448 @chapter In-Process Agent
33449 @cindex debugging agent
33450 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33451 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33452 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33453 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33454 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33455 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33456 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33457 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33458 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33459 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33460 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33461 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33462 behavior without interrupting it.
33463
33464 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33465 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33466 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33467 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33468 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33469 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33470 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33471 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33472 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33473
33474 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33475 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33476 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33477 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33478
33479 @anchor{Control Agent}
33480 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33481 debugging with the following commands:
33482
33483 @table @code
33484 @kindex set agent on
33485 @item set agent on
33486 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33487 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33488 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33489 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33490 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33491 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33492
33493 @kindex set agent off
33494 @item set agent off
33495 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33496 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33497
33498 @kindex show agent
33499 @item show agent
33500 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33501 the in-process agent.
33502 @end table
33503
33504 @menu
33505 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33506 @end menu
33507
33508 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33509 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33510 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33511
33512 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33513 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33514 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33515 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33516 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33517 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33518 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33519 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33520 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33521
33522 @menu
33523 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33524 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33525 @end menu
33526
33527 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33528 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33529 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33530
33531 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33532 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33533
33534 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33535 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33536 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33537 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33538
33539 @enumerate
33540 @item
33541 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33542 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33543 @item
33544 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33545 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33546 the other one.
33547 @end enumerate
33548
33549 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33550
33551 @enumerate
33552 @item
33553 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33554 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33555 @anchor{agent expression object}
33556 @item
33557 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33558 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33559 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33560 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33561 @item
33562 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33563 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33564
33565 @end enumerate
33566
33567 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33568 object:
33569
33570 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33571 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33572 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33573 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33574 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33575 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33576 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33577 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33578 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33579 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33580 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33581 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33582 memory address for collecting.
33583 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33584 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33585 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33586 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33587 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33588 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33589 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33590 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33591 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33592 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33593 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33594 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33595 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33596 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33597 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33598 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33599 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33600 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33601 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33602 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33603 @ref{agent expression object}
33604 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33605 @ref{agent expression object}
33606 @item actions @tab variable
33607 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33608 @end multitable
33609
33610 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33611 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33612 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33613
33614 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33615 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33616
33617 @table @samp
33618
33619 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33620 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33621 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33622 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33623 in IPA finally.
33624
33625 Replies:
33626 @table @samp
33627 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33628 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33629 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33630 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33631 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33632 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33633 @item E @var{NN}
33634 for an error
33635
33636 @end table
33637
33638 @item close
33639 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33640 is about to kill inferiors.
33641
33642 @item qTfSTM
33643 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33644 @item qTsSTM
33645 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33646 @item qTSTMat
33647 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33648 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33649 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33650
33651 Replies:
33652 @table @samp
33653 @item E @var{NN}
33654 for an error
33655 @end table
33656 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33657 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33658 @end table
33659
33660 @node GDB Bugs
33661 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33662 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33663 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33664
33665 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33666
33667 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33668 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33669 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33670 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33671
33672 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33673 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33674
33675 @menu
33676 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33677 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33678 @end menu
33679
33680 @node Bug Criteria
33681 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33682 @cindex bug criteria
33683
33684 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33685
33686 @itemize @bullet
33687 @cindex fatal signal
33688 @cindex debugger crash
33689 @cindex crash of debugger
33690 @item
33691 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33692 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33693
33694 @cindex error on valid input
33695 @item
33696 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33697 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33698 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33699
33700 @cindex invalid input
33701 @item
33702 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33703 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33704 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33705 for traditional practice''.
33706
33707 @item
33708 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33709 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33710 @end itemize
33711
33712 @node Bug Reporting
33713 @section How to Report Bugs
33714 @cindex bug reports
33715 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33716
33717 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33718 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33719 contact that organization first.
33720
33721 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33722 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33723 distribution.
33724 @c should add a web page ref...
33725
33726 @ifset BUGURL
33727 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33728 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33729 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33730 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33731 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33732 be used.
33733
33734 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33735 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33736 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33737 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33738
33739 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33740 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33741 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33742 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33743 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33744 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33745 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33746 bug reports to the mailing list.
33747 @end ifset
33748 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33749 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33750 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33751 @end ifclear
33752 @end ifset
33753
33754 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33755 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33756 fact or leave it out, state it!
33757
33758 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33759 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33760 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33761 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33762 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33763 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33764 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33765 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33766 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33767
33768 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33769 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33770 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33771 self-contained.
33772
33773 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33774 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33775 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33776 bugs properly.
33777
33778 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33779
33780 @itemize @bullet
33781 @item
33782 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33783 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33784 version}.
33785
33786 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33787 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33788
33789 @item
33790 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33791 version number.
33792
33793 @item
33794 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33795 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33796 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33797 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33798
33799 @item
33800 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33801 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33802
33803 @item
33804 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33805 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33806 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33807 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33808 those compilers.
33809
33810 @item
33811 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33812 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33813 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33814 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33815
33816 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33817 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33818
33819 @item
33820 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33821 reproduce the bug.
33822
33823 @item
33824 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33825 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33826
33827 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33828 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33829 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33830 a chance to make a mistake.
33831
33832 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33833 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33834 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33835 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33836 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33837 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33838 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33839 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33840
33841 @pindex script
33842 @cindex recording a session script
33843 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33844 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33845 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33846 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33847
33848 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33849 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33850
33851 @item
33852 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33853 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33854 it by context, not by line number.
33855
33856 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33857 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33858
33859 @end itemize
33860
33861 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33862
33863 @itemize @bullet
33864 @item
33865 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33866
33867 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33868 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33869 changes will not affect it.
33870
33871 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33872 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33873 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33874 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33875
33876 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33877 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33878 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33879 less time, and so on.
33880
33881 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33882 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33883
33884 @item
33885 A patch for the bug.
33886
33887 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33888 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33889 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33890 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33891
33892 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33893 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33894 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33895 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33896
33897 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33898 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33899 help us to understand.
33900
33901 @item
33902 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33903
33904 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33905 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33906 @end itemize
33907
33908 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33909 @c and consists of the two following files:
33910 @c rluser.texi
33911 @c hsuser.texi
33912 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33913 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33914 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33915 @include rluser.texi
33916 @include hsuser.texi
33917 @end ifclear
33918
33919 @node In Memoriam
33920 @appendix In Memoriam
33921
33922 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33923 contributors:
33924
33925 @table @code
33926 @item Fred Fish
33927 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33928 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33929 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33930
33931 @item Michael Snyder
33932 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33933 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33934 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33935 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33936 @end table
33937
33938 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33939 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33940
33941 @node Formatting Documentation
33942 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33943
33944 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33945 @cindex reference card
33946 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33947 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33948 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33949 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33950 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33951 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33952
33953 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33954 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33955
33956 @smallexample
33957 make refcard.dvi
33958 @end smallexample
33959
33960 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33961 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33962 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33963 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33964 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33965
33966 @cindex documentation
33967
33968 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33969 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33970 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33971 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33972 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33973 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33974
33975 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33976 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33977 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33978 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33979 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33980 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33981 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33982 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33983
33984 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33985 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33986 @code{makeinfo}.
33987
33988 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33989 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33990 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33991
33992 @smallexample
33993 cd gdb
33994 make gdb.info
33995 @end smallexample
33996
33997 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33998 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33999 Texinfo definitions file.
34000
34001 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34002 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34003 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34004 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34005 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34006 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34007 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34008
34009 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34010 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34011 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34012 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34013 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34014 directory.
34015
34016 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34017 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34018 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34019 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34020
34021 @smallexample
34022 make gdb.dvi
34023 @end smallexample
34024
34025 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34026
34027 @node Installing GDB
34028 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34029 @cindex installation
34030
34031 @menu
34032 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34033 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34034 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34035 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34036 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34037 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34038 @end menu
34039
34040 @node Requirements
34041 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34042 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34043
34044 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34045 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34046
34047 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34048 @table @asis
34049 @item ISO C90 compiler
34050 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34051 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34052
34053 @end table
34054
34055 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34056 @table @asis
34057 @item Expat
34058 @anchor{Expat}
34059 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34060 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34061 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34062 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34063 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34064 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34065
34066 Expat is used for:
34067
34068 @itemize @bullet
34069 @item
34070 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34071 @item
34072 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34073 @item
34074 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34075 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34076 @item
34077 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34078 @item
34079 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34080 @item
34081 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34082 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34083 @end itemize
34084
34085 @item zlib
34086 @cindex compressed debug sections
34087 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34088 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34089 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34090 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34091 information in such binaries.
34092
34093 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34094 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34095 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34096
34097 @item iconv
34098 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34099 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34100 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34101 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34102
34103 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34104 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34105 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34106 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34107
34108 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34109 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34110 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34111
34112 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34113 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34114 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34115 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34116 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34117 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34118 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34119 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34120 @end table
34121
34122 @node Running Configure
34123 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34124 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34125 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34126 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34127 build the @code{gdb} program.
34128 @iftex
34129 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34130 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34131 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34132 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34133 @end iftex
34134
34135 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34136 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34137 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34138
34139 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34140 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34141
34142 @table @code
34143 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34144 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34145
34146 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34147 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34148
34149 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34150 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34151
34152 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34153 @sc{gnu} include files
34154
34155 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34156 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34157
34158 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34159 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34160
34161 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34162 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34163
34164 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34165 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34166
34167 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34168 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34169 @end table
34170
34171 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34172 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34173 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34174
34175 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34176 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34177 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34178 argument.
34179
34180 For example:
34181
34182 @smallexample
34183 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34184 ./configure @var{host}
34185 make
34186 @end smallexample
34187
34188 @noindent
34189 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34190 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34191 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34192 correct value by examining your system.)
34193
34194 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34195 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34196 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34197 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34198
34199 @need 750
34200 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34201 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34202 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34203
34204 @smallexample
34205 sh configure @var{host}
34206 @end smallexample
34207
34208 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34209 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34210 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34211 @file{configure}
34212 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34213 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34214
34215 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34216 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34217 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34218 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34219 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34220 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34221 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34222 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34223 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34224
34225 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34226 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34227 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34228 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34229 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34230
34231 @node Separate Objdir
34232 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34233
34234 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34235 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34236 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34237 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34238 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34239 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34240 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34241 program specified there.
34242
34243 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34244 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34245 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34246 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34247 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34248 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34249
34250 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34251 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34252
34253 @smallexample
34254 @group
34255 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34256 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34257 cd ../gdb-sun4
34258 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34259 make
34260 @end group
34261 @end smallexample
34262
34263 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34264 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34265 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34266 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34267 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34268 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34269
34270 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34271 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34272 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34273 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34274 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34275
34276 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34277 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34278 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34279 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34280 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34281 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34282
34283 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34284 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34285 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34286
34287 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34288 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34289 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34290 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34291 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34292
34293 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34294 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34295 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34296 with each other.
34297
34298 @node Config Names
34299 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34300
34301 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34302 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34303 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34304 of information in the following pattern:
34305
34306 @smallexample
34307 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34308 @end smallexample
34309
34310 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34311 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34312 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34313
34314 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34315 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34316 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34317 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34318 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34319 abbreviations---for example:
34320
34321 @smallexample
34322 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34323 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34324 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34325 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34326 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34327 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34328 % sh config.sub sun4
34329 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34330 % sh config.sub sun3
34331 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34332 % sh config.sub i986v
34333 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34334 @end smallexample
34335
34336 @noindent
34337 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34338 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34339
34340 @node Configure Options
34341 @section @file{configure} Options
34342
34343 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34344 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34345 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34346 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34347
34348 @smallexample
34349 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34350 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34351 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34352 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34353 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34354 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34355 @var{host}
34356 @end smallexample
34357
34358 @noindent
34359 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34360 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34361 @samp{--}.
34362
34363 @table @code
34364 @item --help
34365 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34366
34367 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34368 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34369 @file{@var{dir}}.
34370
34371 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34372 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34373 @file{@var{dir}}.
34374
34375 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34376 @need 2000
34377 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34378 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34379 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34380 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34381 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34382 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34383 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34384 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34385 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34386 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34387 @var{dirname}.
34388
34389 @item --norecursion
34390 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34391 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34392
34393 @item --target=@var{target}
34394 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34395 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34396 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34397
34398 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34399
34400 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34401 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34402
34403 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34404 @end table
34405
34406 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34407 needed for special purposes only.
34408
34409 @node System-wide configuration
34410 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34411 @cindex system-wide init file
34412
34413 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34414 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34415 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34416
34417 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34418
34419 @table @code
34420 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34421 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34422 @var{file}.
34423 @end table
34424
34425 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34426 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34427
34428 @itemize @bullet
34429 @item
34430 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34431 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34432 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34433 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34434 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34435 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34436
34437 @item
34438 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34439 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34440 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34441 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34442 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34443 @end itemize
34444
34445 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34446 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34447 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34448 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34449 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34450 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34451 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34452 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34453 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34454 reread.
34455
34456 @menu
34457 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34458 @end menu
34459
34460 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34461 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34462 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34463
34464 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34465 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34466 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34467 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34468 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34469 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34470
34471 The following scripts are currently available:
34472 @itemize @bullet
34473
34474 @item @file{elinos.py}
34475 @pindex elinos.py
34476 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34477 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34478 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34479 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34480 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34481 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34482
34483 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34484 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34485 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34486 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34487 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34488 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34489
34490 @end itemize
34491
34492 @node Maintenance Commands
34493 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34494 @cindex maintenance commands
34495 @cindex internal commands
34496
34497 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34498 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34499 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34500 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34501 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34502
34503 @table @code
34504 @kindex maint agent
34505 @kindex maint agent-eval
34506 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34507 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34508 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34509 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34510 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34511 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34512 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34513 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34514 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34515 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34516 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34517 addition and return the sum.
34518 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34519 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34520
34521 @kindex maint agent-printf
34522 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34523 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34524 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34525 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34526 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34527
34528 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34529 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34530 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34531 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34532 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34533 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34534 is shown:
34535
34536 @table @code
34537 @item breakpoint
34538 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34539
34540 @item watchpoint
34541 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34542
34543 @item longjmp
34544 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34545 @code{longjmp} calls.
34546
34547 @item longjmp resume
34548 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34549
34550 @item until
34551 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34552
34553 @item finish
34554 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34555
34556 @item shlib events
34557 Shared library events.
34558
34559 @end table
34560
34561 @kindex maint info btrace
34562 @item maint info btrace
34563 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34564
34565 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34566 @item maint btrace packet-history
34567 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34568 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34569 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34570 recording format.
34571
34572 @table @code
34573 @item bts
34574 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34575 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34576
34577 @table @asis
34578 @item Block number
34579 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34580 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34581 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34582 @end table
34583
34584 @item pt
34585 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34586 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34587 information is printed:
34588
34589 @table @asis
34590 @item Packet number
34591 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34592 @item Trace offset
34593 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34594 @item Packet opcode and payload
34595 @end table
34596 @end table
34597
34598 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34599 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34600 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34601 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34602 needed.
34603
34604 @kindex maint btrace clear
34605 @item maint btrace clear
34606 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34607 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34608
34609 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34610 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34611 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34612 buffer.
34613
34614 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34615 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34616 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34617 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34618 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34619 packet history.
34620
34621 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34622 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34623 @cindex displaced stepping support
34624 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34625 @item set displaced-stepping
34626 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34627 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34628 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34629 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34630 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34631 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34632
34633 @table @code
34634 @item set displaced-stepping on
34635 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34636 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34637
34638 @item set displaced-stepping off
34639 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34640 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34641
34642 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34643 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34644 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34645 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34646 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34647 @end table
34648
34649 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34650 @item maint check-psymtabs
34651 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34652 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34653
34654 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34655 @item maint check-symtabs
34656 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34657
34658 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34659 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34660 Expand symbol tables.
34661 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34662 names matching @var{regexp}.
34663
34664 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34665 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34666 @cindex demangler crashes
34667 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34668 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34669 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34670 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34671 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34672 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34673 option to terminate the current session.
34674
34675 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34676 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34677 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34678
34679 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34680 @item maint cplus namespace
34681 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34682
34683 @kindex maint deprecate
34684 @kindex maint undeprecate
34685 @cindex deprecated commands
34686 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34687 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34688 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34689 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34690 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34691 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34692 the replacement as part of the warning.
34693
34694 @kindex maint dump-me
34695 @item maint dump-me
34696 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34697 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34698 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34699 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34700
34701 @kindex maint internal-error
34702 @kindex maint internal-warning
34703 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34704 @cindex demangler crashes
34705 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34706 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34707 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34708
34709 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34710 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34711 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34712 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34713 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34714 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34715 @value{GDBN} session.
34716
34717 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34718 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34719
34720 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34721
34722 @smallexample
34723 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34724 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34725 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34726 debugging may prove unreliable.
34727 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34728 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34729 (@value{GDBP})
34730 @end smallexample
34731
34732 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34733 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34734 @cindex demangler crashes
34735
34736 @kindex maint set internal-error
34737 @kindex maint show internal-error
34738 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34739 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34740 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34741 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34742 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34743 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34744 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34745 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34746 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34747 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34748 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34749 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34750 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34751 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34752 described in the table below.
34753
34754 @table @samp
34755 @item quit
34756 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34757 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34758
34759 @item corefile
34760 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34761 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34762 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34763 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34764 disabled.
34765 @end table
34766
34767 @kindex maint packet
34768 @item maint packet @var{text}
34769 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34770 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34771 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34772 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34773 checksum.
34774
34775 @kindex maint print architecture
34776 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34777 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34778 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34779
34780 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34781 @item maint print c-tdesc
34782 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34783 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
34784 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
34785 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
34786 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
34787 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
34788 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
34789 modify XML target descriptions.
34790
34791 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
34792 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
34793 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
34794 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
34795
34796 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34797 @item maint print dummy-frames
34798 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34799
34800 @smallexample
34801 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34802 @dots{}
34803 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34804 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34805 58 return (a + b);
34806 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34807 @dots{}
34808 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34809 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34810 (@value{GDBP})
34811 @end smallexample
34812
34813 Takes an optional file parameter.
34814
34815 @kindex maint print registers
34816 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34817 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34818 @kindex maint print register-groups
34819 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34820 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34821 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34822 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34823 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34824 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34825 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34826
34827 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34828 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34829 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34830 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34831 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34832 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34833 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34834 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34835
34836 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34837 write the information.
34838
34839 @kindex maint print reggroups
34840 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34841 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34842 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34843 information.
34844
34845 The register groups info looks like this:
34846
34847 @smallexample
34848 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34849 Group Type
34850 general user
34851 float user
34852 all user
34853 vector user
34854 system user
34855 save internal
34856 restore internal
34857 @end smallexample
34858
34859 @kindex flushregs
34860 @item flushregs
34861 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34862
34863 @kindex maint print objfiles
34864 @cindex info for known object files
34865 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34866 Print a dump of all known object files.
34867 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34868 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34869 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34870
34871 @kindex maint print user-registers
34872 @cindex user registers
34873 @item maint print user-registers
34874 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34875 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34876 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34877 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34878 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34879 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34880 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34881
34882 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34883 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34884 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34885 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34886 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34887 matching @var{regexp}.
34888 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34889 and the full path if known.
34890 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34891
34892 @kindex maint print statistics
34893 @cindex bcache statistics
34894 @item maint print statistics
34895 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34896 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34897 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34898 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34899 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34900 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34901 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34902 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34903 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34904 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34905 lengths.
34906
34907 @kindex maint print target-stack
34908 @cindex target stack description
34909 @item maint print target-stack
34910 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34911 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34912 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34913 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34914 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34915 address.
34916
34917 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34918 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34919
34920 @kindex maint print type
34921 @cindex type chain of a data type
34922 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34923 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34924 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34925 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34926 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34927 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34928
34929 @kindex maint selftest
34930 @cindex self tests
34931 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34932 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34933
34934 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34935 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34936 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34937 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34938 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34939 information.
34940
34941 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34942 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34943 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34944 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34945 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34946 always see the disassembly form.
34947
34948 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34949
34950 @smallexample
34951 (gdb) info addr argc
34952 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34953 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34954 @end smallexample
34955
34956 For more information on these expressions, see
34957 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34958
34959 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34960 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34961 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34962 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34963 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34964
34965 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34966 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34967 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34968 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34969 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34970 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34971 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34972 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34973 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34974
34975 @kindex maint set profile
34976 @kindex maint show profile
34977 @cindex profiling GDB
34978 @item maint set profile
34979 @itemx maint show profile
34980 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34981
34982 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34983 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34984 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34985 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34986 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34987 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34988 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34989
34990 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34991 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34992
34993 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34994 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34995 @cindex hardware debug registers
34996 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34997 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34998 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34999 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35000 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35001 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35002 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35003
35004 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35005 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35006 @item maint set show-all-tib
35007 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35008 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35009 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35010 command.
35011
35012 @kindex maint set target-async
35013 @kindex maint show target-async
35014 @item maint set target-async
35015 @itemx maint show target-async
35016 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35017 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35018 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35019 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35020
35021 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35022 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35023 @item maint set target-non-stop
35024 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35025
35026 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35027 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35028 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35029 if supported by the target.
35030
35031 @table @code
35032 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35033 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35034 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35035
35036 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35037 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35038 does not indicate support.
35039
35040 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35041 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35042 target supports it.
35043 @end table
35044
35045 @kindex maint set per-command
35046 @kindex maint show per-command
35047 @item maint set per-command
35048 @itemx maint show per-command
35049 @cindex resources used by commands
35050
35051 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35052 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35053
35054 @table @code
35055 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35056 @itemx maint show per-command space
35057 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35058 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35059 took, following the command's own output.
35060 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35061 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35062
35063 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35064 @itemx maint show per-command time
35065 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35066 for each command.
35067 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35068 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35069 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35070 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35071 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35072 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35073 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35074 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35075 spent by the program been debugged.
35076 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35077 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35078
35079 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35080 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35081 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35082 for each command.
35083 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35084
35085 @enumerate a
35086 @item
35087 number of symbol tables
35088 @item
35089 number of primary symbol tables
35090 @item
35091 number of blocks in the blockvector
35092 @end enumerate
35093 @end table
35094
35095 @kindex maint space
35096 @cindex memory used by commands
35097 @item maint space @var{value}
35098 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35099 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35100
35101 @kindex maint time
35102 @cindex time of command execution
35103 @item maint time @var{value}
35104 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35105 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35106
35107 @kindex maint translate-address
35108 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35109 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35110 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35111 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35112 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35113 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35114 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35115
35116 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35117 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35118 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35119
35120 @end table
35121
35122 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35123 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35124
35125 @table @code
35126 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35127 @kindex set watchdog
35128 @cindex watchdog timer
35129 @cindex timeout for commands
35130 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35131 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35132 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35133
35134 @item show watchdog
35135 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35136 @end table
35137
35138 @node Remote Protocol
35139 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35140
35141 @menu
35142 * Overview::
35143 * Packets::
35144 * Stop Reply Packets::
35145 * General Query Packets::
35146 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35147 * Tracepoint Packets::
35148 * Host I/O Packets::
35149 * Interrupts::
35150 * Notification Packets::
35151 * Remote Non-Stop::
35152 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35153 * Examples::
35154 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35155 * Library List Format::
35156 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35157 * Memory Map Format::
35158 * Thread List Format::
35159 * Traceframe Info Format::
35160 * Branch Trace Format::
35161 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35162 @end menu
35163
35164 @node Overview
35165 @section Overview
35166
35167 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35168 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35169 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35170 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35171
35172 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35173 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35174
35175 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35176 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35177 @cindex remote serial protocol
35178 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35179 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35180 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35181 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35182 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35183
35184 @smallexample
35185 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35186 @end smallexample
35187 @noindent
35188
35189 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35190 @noindent
35191 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35192 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35193 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35194
35195 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35196 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35197
35198 @smallexample
35199 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35200 @end smallexample
35201
35202 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35203 @noindent
35204 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35205 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35206 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35207
35208 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35209 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35210 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35211 retransmission):
35212
35213 @smallexample
35214 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35215 <- @code{+}
35216 @end smallexample
35217 @noindent
35218
35219 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35220 once a connection is established.
35221 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35222
35223 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35224 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35225 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35226 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35227 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35228 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35229 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35230
35231 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35232 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35233 exceptions).
35234
35235 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35236 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35237 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35238 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35239
35240 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35241 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35242 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35243
35244 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35245 @anchor{Binary Data}
35246 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35247 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35248 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35249 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35250 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35251 binary data.
35252
35253 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35254 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35255 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35256 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35257 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35258 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35259 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35260 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35261 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35262 (described next).
35263
35264 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35265 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35266 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35267 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35268 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35269 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35270 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35271 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35272 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35273 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35274 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35275 3}} more times.
35276
35277 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35278 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35279 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35280 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35281 @samp{0*"00}.
35282
35283 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35284 error number. That number is not well defined.
35285
35286 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35287 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35288 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35289 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35290 on that response.
35291
35292 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35293 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35294 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35295 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35296 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35297 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35298
35299 @node Packets
35300 @section Packets
35301
35302 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35303 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35304 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35305 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35306
35307 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35308 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35309 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35310 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35311 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35312 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35313 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35314 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35315 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35316 @var{baz}.
35317
35318 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35319 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35320 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35321 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35322 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35323 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35324 pick any thread.
35325
35326 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35327 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35328 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35329 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35330 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35331 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35332 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35333 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35334 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35335 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35336 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35337 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35338 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35339
35340 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35341 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35342 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35343 more information.
35344
35345 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35346 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35347
35348 Here are the packet descriptions.
35349
35350 @table @samp
35351
35352 @item !
35353 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35354 @anchor{extended mode}
35355 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35356 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35357 debugged.
35358
35359 Reply:
35360 @table @samp
35361 @item OK
35362 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35363 @end table
35364
35365 @item ?
35366 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35367 @anchor{? packet}
35368 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35369 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35370 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35371
35372 Reply:
35373 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35374
35375 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35376 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35377 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35378 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35379 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35380
35381 Reply:
35382 @table @samp
35383 @item OK
35384 The arguments were set.
35385 @item E @var{NN}
35386 An error occurred.
35387 @end table
35388
35389 @item b @var{baud}
35390 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35391 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35392 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35393
35394 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35395 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35396 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35397
35398 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35399 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35400 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35401 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35402 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35403
35404 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35405 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35406 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35407 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35408
35409 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35410 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35411
35412 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35413 @anchor{bc}
35414 @item bc
35415 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35416 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35417
35418 Reply:
35419 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35420
35421 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35422 @anchor{bs}
35423 @item bs
35424 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35425 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35426
35427 Reply:
35428 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35429
35430 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35431 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35432 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35433 is omitted, resume at current address.
35434
35435 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35436 packet}.
35437
35438 Reply:
35439 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35440
35441 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35442 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35443 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35444 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35445
35446 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35447 packet}.
35448
35449 Reply:
35450 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35451
35452 @item d
35453 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35454 Toggle debug flag.
35455
35456 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35457 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35458
35459 @item D
35460 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35461 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35462 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35463 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35464 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35465
35466 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35467 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35468 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35469 big-endian hex string.
35470
35471 Reply:
35472 @table @samp
35473 @item OK
35474 for success
35475 @item E @var{NN}
35476 for an error
35477 @end table
35478
35479 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35480 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35481 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35482 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35483 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35484
35485 @item g
35486 @anchor{read registers packet}
35487 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35488 Read general registers.
35489
35490 Reply:
35491 @table @samp
35492 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35493 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35494 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35495 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35496 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35497 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35498
35499 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35500 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35501 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35502 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35503 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35504 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35505 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35506 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35507
35508 @smallexample
35509 -> @code{g}
35510 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35511 @end smallexample
35512
35513 @item E @var{NN}
35514 for an error.
35515 @end table
35516
35517 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35518 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35519 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35520 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35521
35522 Reply:
35523 @table @samp
35524 @item OK
35525 for success
35526 @item E @var{NN}
35527 for an error
35528 @end table
35529
35530 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35531 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35532 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35533 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35534 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35535 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35536 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35537 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35538 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35539
35540 Reply:
35541 @table @samp
35542 @item OK
35543 for success
35544 @item E @var{NN}
35545 for an error
35546 @end table
35547
35548 @c FIXME: JTC:
35549 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35550 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35551 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35552 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35553 @c described. For example:
35554 @c
35555 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35556 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35557 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35558 @c
35559 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35560 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35561 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35562
35563 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35564 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35565 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35566 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35567 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35568 step starting at that address.
35569
35570 @item I
35571 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35572 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35573 step packet}.
35574
35575 @item k
35576 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35577 Kill request.
35578
35579 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35580
35581 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35582 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35583
35584 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35585
35586 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35587 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35588 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35589
35590 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35591 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35592 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35593
35594 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35595 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35596 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35597 (@pxref{? packet}).
35598
35599 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35600 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35601 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35602 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35603 any particular boundary.
35604
35605 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35606 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35607 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35608 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35609 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35610 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35611 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35612 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35613
35614 Reply:
35615 @table @samp
35616 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35617 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35618 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35619 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35620 @item E @var{NN}
35621 @var{NN} is errno
35622 @end table
35623
35624 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35625 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35626 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35627 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35628 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35629
35630 Reply:
35631 @table @samp
35632 @item OK
35633 for success
35634 @item E @var{NN}
35635 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35636 written).
35637 @end table
35638
35639 @item p @var{n}
35640 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35641 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35642 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35643 register value is encoded.
35644
35645 Reply:
35646 @table @samp
35647 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35648 the register's value
35649 @item E @var{NN}
35650 for an error
35651 @item @w{}
35652 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35653 @end table
35654
35655 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35656 @anchor{write register packet}
35657 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35658 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35659 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35660 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35661
35662 Reply:
35663 @table @samp
35664 @item OK
35665 for success
35666 @item E @var{NN}
35667 for an error
35668 @end table
35669
35670 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35671 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35672 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35673 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35674 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35675 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35676
35677 @item r
35678 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35679 Reset the entire system.
35680
35681 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35682
35683 @item R @var{XX}
35684 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35685 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35686 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35687
35688 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35689
35690 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35691 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35692 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35693 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35694
35695 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35696 packet}.
35697
35698 Reply:
35699 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35700
35701 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35702 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35703 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35704 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35705 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35706
35707 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35708 packet}.
35709
35710 Reply:
35711 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35712
35713 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35714 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35715 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35716 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35717 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35718
35719 @item T @var{thread-id}
35720 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35721 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35722
35723 Reply:
35724 @table @samp
35725 @item OK
35726 thread is still alive
35727 @item E @var{NN}
35728 thread is dead
35729 @end table
35730
35731 @item v
35732 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35733 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35734
35735 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35736 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35737 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35738 The process ID is a
35739 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35740 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35741 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35742
35743 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35744 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35745 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35746 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35747 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35748 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35749 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35750 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35751
35752 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35753
35754 Reply:
35755 @table @samp
35756 @item E @var{nn}
35757 for an error
35758 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35759 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35760 @item OK
35761 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35762 @end table
35763
35764 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35765 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35766 @anchor{vCont packet}
35767 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35768
35769 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35770 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35771 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35772 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35773 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35774 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35775 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35776 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35777 error.
35778
35779 Currently supported actions are:
35780
35781 @table @samp
35782 @item c
35783 Continue.
35784 @item C @var{sig}
35785 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35786 @item s
35787 Step.
35788 @item S @var{sig}
35789 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35790 @item t
35791 Stop.
35792 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35793 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35794 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35795 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35796 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35797 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35798
35799 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35800 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35801 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35802 jumps to @var{start}).
35803
35804 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35805 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35806 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35807
35808 @end table
35809
35810 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35811 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35812 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35813
35814 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35815 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35816 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35817 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35818 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35819 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35820 as an implementation detail.
35821
35822 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35823 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35824 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35825 stopped.
35826
35827 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35828 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35829 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35830
35831 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35832 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35833
35834 Reply:
35835 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35836
35837 @item vCont?
35838 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35839 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35840
35841 Reply:
35842 @table @samp
35843 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35844 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35845 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35846 @item @w{}
35847 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35848 @end table
35849
35850 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35851 @item vCtrlC
35852 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35853 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35854 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35855 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35856 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35857 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35858 variant.
35859
35860 Reply:
35861 @table @samp
35862 @item E @var{nn}
35863 for an error
35864 @item OK
35865 for success
35866 @end table
35867
35868 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35869 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35870 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35871 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35872
35873 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35874 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35875 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35876 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35877 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35878 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35879 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35880 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35881 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35882 packet is received.
35883
35884 Reply:
35885 @table @samp
35886 @item OK
35887 for success
35888 @item E @var{NN}
35889 for an error
35890 @end table
35891
35892 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35893 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35894 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35895 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35896 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35897 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35898 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35899 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35900 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35901 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35902 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35903 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35904
35905
35906 Reply:
35907 @table @samp
35908 @item OK
35909 for success
35910 @item E.memtype
35911 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35912 @item E @var{NN}
35913 for an error
35914 @end table
35915
35916 @item vFlashDone
35917 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35918 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35919 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35920 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35921 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35922 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35923 request is completed.
35924
35925 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35926 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35927 @anchor{vKill packet}
35928 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35929 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35930 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35931 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35932
35933 Reply:
35934 @table @samp
35935 @item E @var{nn}
35936 for an error
35937 @item OK
35938 for success
35939 @end table
35940
35941 @item vMustReplyEmpty
35942 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
35943 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
35944 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
35945 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
35946
35947 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
35948 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
35949 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
35950 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
35951 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
35952 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
35953
35954 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35955 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35956 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35957 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35958 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35959 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35960 state.
35961
35962 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35963
35964 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35965
35966 Reply:
35967 @table @samp
35968 @item E @var{nn}
35969 for an error
35970 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35971 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35972 @end table
35973
35974 @item vStopped
35975 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35976 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35977
35978 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35979 @anchor{X packet}
35980 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35981 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35982 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35983 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35984 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35985
35986 Reply:
35987 @table @samp
35988 @item OK
35989 for success
35990 @item E @var{NN}
35991 for an error
35992 @end table
35993
35994 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35995 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35996 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35997 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35998 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35999 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36000 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36001
36002 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36003 separately.
36004
36005 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36006 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36007 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36008 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36009 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36010 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36011
36012 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36013 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36014 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36015 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36016 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36017 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36018
36019 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36020 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36021 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36022 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36023 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36024 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36025 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36026 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36027 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36028 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36029 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36030 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36031 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36032
36033 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36034 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36035
36036 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36037 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36038
36039 @table @samp
36040
36041 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36042 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36043 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36044
36045 @end table
36046
36047 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36048 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36049 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36050 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36051 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36052 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36053 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36054
36055 @table @samp
36056
36057 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36058 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36059 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36060
36061 @end table
36062
36063 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36064 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36065 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36066 target, is not defined.}
36067
36068 Reply:
36069 @table @samp
36070 @item OK
36071 success
36072 @item @w{}
36073 not supported
36074 @item E @var{NN}
36075 for an error
36076 @end table
36077
36078 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36079 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36080 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36081 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36082 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36083 address @var{addr}.
36084
36085 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36086 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36087 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36088 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36089
36090 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36091 movement.}
36092
36093 Reply:
36094 @table @samp
36095 @item OK
36096 success
36097 @item @w{}
36098 not supported
36099 @item E @var{NN}
36100 for an error
36101 @end table
36102
36103 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36104 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36105 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36106 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36107 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36108 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36109
36110 Reply:
36111 @table @samp
36112 @item OK
36113 success
36114 @item @w{}
36115 not supported
36116 @item E @var{NN}
36117 for an error
36118 @end table
36119
36120 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36121 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36122 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36123 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36124 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36125 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36126
36127 Reply:
36128 @table @samp
36129 @item OK
36130 success
36131 @item @w{}
36132 not supported
36133 @item E @var{NN}
36134 for an error
36135 @end table
36136
36137 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36138 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36139 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36140 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36141 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36142 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36143
36144 Reply:
36145 @table @samp
36146 @item OK
36147 success
36148 @item @w{}
36149 not supported
36150 @item E @var{NN}
36151 for an error
36152 @end table
36153
36154 @end table
36155
36156 @node Stop Reply Packets
36157 @section Stop Reply Packets
36158 @cindex stop reply packets
36159
36160 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36161 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36162 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36163 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36164 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36165 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36166 @value{GDBN} source code.
36167
36168 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36169 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36170 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36171
36172 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36173 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36174 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36175 components.
36176
36177 @table @samp
36178
36179 @item S @var{AA}
36180 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36181 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36182 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36183
36184 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36185 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36186 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36187 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36188 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36189 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36190 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36191 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36192
36193 @itemize @bullet
36194 @item
36195 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36196 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36197 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36198 two-digit hex number.
36199
36200 @item
36201 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36202 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36203
36204 @item
36205 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36206 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36207
36208 @item
36209 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36210 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36211 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36212 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36213
36214 @item
36215 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36216 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36217 future.
36218 @end itemize
36219
36220 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36221
36222 @table @samp
36223 @item watch
36224 @itemx rwatch
36225 @itemx awatch
36226 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36227 hex.
36228
36229 @item syscall_entry
36230 @itemx syscall_return
36231 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36232 syscall number, in hex.
36233
36234 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36235 @item library
36236 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36237 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36238 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36239
36240 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36241 @item replaylog
36242 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36243 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36244 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36245 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36246 for more information.
36247
36248 @item swbreak
36249 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36250 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36251 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36252 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36253 part must be left empty.
36254
36255 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36256 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36257 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36258 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36259 address.
36260
36261 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36262 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36263 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36264 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36265 indicating support.
36266
36267 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36268
36269 @item hwbreak
36270 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36271 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36272
36273 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36274 apply.
36275
36276 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36277 @item fork
36278 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36279 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36280 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36281 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36282 fork events.
36283
36284 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36285 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36286 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36287 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36288 indicating support.
36289
36290 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36291 @item vfork
36292 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36293 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36294 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36295 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36296 vfork events.
36297
36298 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36299 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36300 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36301 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36302 indicating support.
36303
36304 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36305 @item vforkdone
36306 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36307 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36308 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36309 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36310 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36311
36312 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36313 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36314 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36315 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36316 indicating support.
36317
36318 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36319 @item exec
36320 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36321 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36322 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36323
36324 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36325 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36326 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36327 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36328 indicating support.
36329
36330 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36331 @anchor{thread create event}
36332 @item create
36333 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36334 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36335 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36336 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36337 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36338 @var{r} part is ignored.
36339
36340 @end table
36341
36342 @item W @var{AA}
36343 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36344 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36345 applicable to certain targets.
36346
36347 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36348 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36349 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36350 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36351 hex strings.
36352
36353 @item X @var{AA}
36354 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36355 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36356
36357 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36358 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36359 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36360 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36361 hex strings.
36362
36363 @anchor{thread exit event}
36364 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36365 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36366
36367 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36368 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36369 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36370 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36371
36372 @item N
36373 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36374 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36375 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36376 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36377 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36378 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36379 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36380 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36381 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36382 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36383 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36384 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36385 support.
36386
36387 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36388 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36389 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36390 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36391 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36392
36393 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36394 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36395 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36396 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36397 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36398 system calls.
36399
36400 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36401 this very system call.
36402
36403 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36404 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36405 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36406 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36407 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36408 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36409
36410 @end table
36411
36412 @node General Query Packets
36413 @section General Query Packets
36414 @cindex remote query requests
36415
36416 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36417 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36418 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36419 sending information to and from the stub.
36420
36421 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36422 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36423 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36424 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36425 conventions:
36426
36427 @itemize @bullet
36428 @item
36429 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36430 @item
36431 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36432 letter.
36433 @item
36434 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36435 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36436 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36437 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36438 @end itemize
36439
36440 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36441 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36442 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36443 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36444 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36445 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36446 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36447 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36448 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36449 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36450 packet.}.
36451
36452 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36453 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36454 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36455 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36456 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36457
36458 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36459
36460 @table @samp
36461
36462 @item QAgent:1
36463 @itemx QAgent:0
36464 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36465 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36466
36467 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36468 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36469 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36470 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36471 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36472 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36473 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36474 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36475 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36476 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36477 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36478
36479 @item qC
36480 @cindex current thread, remote request
36481 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36482 Return the current thread ID.
36483
36484 Reply:
36485 @table @samp
36486 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36487 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36488 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36489 @item @r{(anything else)}
36490 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36491 @end table
36492
36493 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36494 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36495 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36496 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36497 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36498 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36499 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36500 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36501
36502 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36503 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36504 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36505 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36506 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36507 detect trailing zeros.
36508
36509 Reply:
36510 @table @samp
36511 @item E @var{NN}
36512 An error (such as memory fault)
36513 @item C @var{crc32}
36514 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36515 @end table
36516
36517 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36518 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36519 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36520 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36521 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36522 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36523 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36524 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36525 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36526 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36527 randomization.
36528
36529 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36530
36531 Reply:
36532 @table @samp
36533 @item OK
36534 The request succeeded.
36535
36536 @item E @var{nn}
36537 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36538
36539 @item @w{}
36540 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36541 by the stub.
36542 @end table
36543
36544 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36545 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36546 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36547 address space randomization.
36548
36549 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36550 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36551 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36552 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36553 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36554 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36555 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36556 inferior using a shell or not.
36557
36558 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36559 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36560 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36561 values are considered an error.
36562
36563 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36564 mode}).
36565
36566 Reply:
36567 @table @samp
36568 @item OK
36569 The request succeeded.
36570
36571 @item E @var{nn}
36572 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36573 @end table
36574
36575 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36576 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36577 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36578 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36579
36580 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36581 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36582
36583 @item qfThreadInfo
36584 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36585 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36586 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36587 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36588 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36589 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36590 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36591 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36592 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36593 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36594
36595 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36596
36597 Reply:
36598 @table @samp
36599 @item m @var{thread-id}
36600 A single thread ID
36601 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36602 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36603 @item l
36604 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36605 @end table
36606
36607 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36608 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36609 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36610 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36611 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36612 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36613 fields.
36614
36615 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36616 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36617 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36618 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36619 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36620
36621 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36622 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36623 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36624 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36625 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36626
36627 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36628 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36629
36630 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36631 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36632 information associated with the variable.)
36633
36634 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36635 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36636 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36637 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36638 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36639 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36640
36641 Reply:
36642 @table @samp
36643 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36644 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36645 local storage requested.
36646
36647 @item E @var{nn}
36648 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36649
36650 @item @w{}
36651 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36652 @end table
36653
36654 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36655 @cindex get thread information block address
36656 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36657 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36658
36659 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36660
36661 Reply:
36662 @table @samp
36663 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36664 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36665 thread information block.
36666
36667 @item E @var{nn}
36668 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36669 address could not be retrieved.
36670
36671 @item @w{}
36672 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36673 @end table
36674
36675 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36676 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36677 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36678 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36679 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36680 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36681 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36682
36683 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36684
36685 Reply:
36686 @table @samp
36687 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36688 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36689 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36690 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36691 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36692 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36693 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36694 @end table
36695
36696 @item qOffsets
36697 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36698 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36699 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36700 image.
36701
36702 Reply:
36703 @table @samp
36704 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36705 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36706 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36707 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36708 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36709 segments by the supplied offsets.
36710
36711 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36712 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36713 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36714
36715 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36716 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36717 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36718 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36719 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36720 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36721 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36722 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36723 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36724 @end table
36725
36726 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36727 @cindex thread information, remote request
36728 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36729 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36730 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36731 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36732
36733 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36734 (see below).
36735
36736 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36737
36738 @item QNonStop:1
36739 @itemx QNonStop:0
36740 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36741 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36742 @anchor{QNonStop}
36743 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36744 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36745
36746 Reply:
36747 @table @samp
36748 @item OK
36749 The request succeeded.
36750
36751 @item E @var{nn}
36752 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36753
36754 @item @w{}
36755 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36756 the stub.
36757 @end table
36758
36759 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36760 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36761 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36762 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36763
36764 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36765 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36766 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36767 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36768 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36769 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36770 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36771
36772 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36773 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36774 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36775
36776 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36777 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36778 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36779 report the requested syscalls.
36780
36781 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36782 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36783
36784 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36785 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36786 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36787 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36788
36789 Reply:
36790 @table @samp
36791 @item OK
36792 The request succeeded.
36793
36794 @item E @var{nn}
36795 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36796
36797 @item @w{}
36798 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36799 the stub.
36800 @end table
36801
36802 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36803 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36804 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36805 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36806
36807 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36808 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36809 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36810 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36811 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36812 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36813 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36814 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36815 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36816 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36817 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36818 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36819 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36820
36821 Reply:
36822 @table @samp
36823 @item OK
36824 The request succeeded.
36825
36826 @item E @var{nn}
36827 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36828
36829 @item @w{}
36830 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36831 the stub.
36832 @end table
36833
36834 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36835 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36836 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36837 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36838
36839 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36840 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36841 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36842 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36843 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36844 Others should be silently discarded.
36845
36846 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36847 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36848 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36849 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36850 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36851 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36852 signals.
36853
36854 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36855 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36856
36857 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36858 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36859 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36860 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36861 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36862
36863 Reply:
36864 @table @samp
36865 @item OK
36866 The request succeeded.
36867
36868 @item E @var{nn}
36869 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36870
36871 @item @w{}
36872 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36873 by the stub.
36874 @end table
36875
36876 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36877 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36878 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36879 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36880
36881 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36882 @item QThreadEvents:1
36883 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36884 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36885 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36886
36887 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36888 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36889 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36890 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36891 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36892 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36893 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36894 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36895 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36896 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36897
36898 Reply:
36899 @table @samp
36900 @item OK
36901 The request succeeded.
36902
36903 @item E @var{nn}
36904 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36905
36906 @item @w{}
36907 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36908 the stub.
36909 @end table
36910
36911 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36912 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36913
36914 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36915 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36916 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36917 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36918 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36919 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36920 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36921 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36922 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36923
36924 Reply:
36925 @table @samp
36926 @item OK
36927 A command response with no output.
36928 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36929 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36930 @item E @var{NN}
36931 Indicate a badly formed request.
36932 @item @w{}
36933 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36934 @end table
36935
36936 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36937 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36938 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36939 packets.)
36940
36941 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36942 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36943 @ifnotinfo
36944 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36945 @end ifnotinfo
36946 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36947 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36948 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36949 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36950 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36951
36952 Reply:
36953 @table @samp
36954 @item 0
36955 The pattern was not found.
36956 @item 1,address
36957 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36958 @item E @var{NN}
36959 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36960 @item @w{}
36961 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36962 @end table
36963
36964 @item QStartNoAckMode
36965 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36966 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36967 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36968 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36969
36970 Reply:
36971 @table @samp
36972 @item OK
36973 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36974 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36975 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36976 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36977 @item @w{}
36978 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36979 @end table
36980
36981 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36982 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36983 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36984 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36985 @anchor{qSupported}
36986 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36987 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36988 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36989 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36990 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36991 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36992 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36993 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36994 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36995 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36996 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36997 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36998 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36999 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37000
37001 Reply:
37002 @table @samp
37003 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37004 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37005 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37006 possible forms).
37007 @item @w{}
37008 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37009 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37010 @end table
37011
37012 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37013 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37014 are:
37015
37016 @table @samp
37017 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37018 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37019 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37020 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37021 @item @var{name}+
37022 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37023 need an associated value.
37024 @item @var{name}-
37025 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37026 @item @var{name}?
37027 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37028 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37029 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37030 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37031 @end table
37032
37033 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37034 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37035 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37036 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37037 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37038
37039 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37040 are defined:
37041
37042 @table @samp
37043 @item multiprocess
37044 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37045 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37046 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37047 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37048 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37049
37050 @item xmlRegisters
37051 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37052 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37053 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37054 description.
37055
37056 @item qRelocInsn
37057 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37058 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37059 instruction reply packet}).
37060
37061 @item swbreak
37062 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37063 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37064
37065 @item hwbreak
37066 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37067 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37068
37069 @item fork-events
37070 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37071 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37072 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37073 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37074
37075 @item vfork-events
37076 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37077 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37078 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37079 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37080
37081 @item exec-events
37082 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37083 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37084 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37085 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37086
37087 @item vContSupported
37088 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37089 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37090 @end table
37091
37092 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37093 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37094 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37095 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37096 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37097 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37098 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37099 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37100 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37101 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37102 all the features it supports.
37103
37104 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37105 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37106
37107 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37108 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37109 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37110 form response.
37111
37112 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37113 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37114 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37115 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37116
37117 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37118 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37119 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37120 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37121 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37122
37123 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37124
37125 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37126 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37127 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37128 @item Feature Name
37129 @tab Value Required
37130 @tab Default
37131 @tab Probe Allowed
37132
37133 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37134 @tab Yes
37135 @tab @samp{-}
37136 @tab No
37137
37138 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37139 @tab No
37140 @tab @samp{-}
37141 @tab Yes
37142
37143 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37144 @tab No
37145 @tab @samp{-}
37146 @tab Yes
37147
37148 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37149 @tab No
37150 @tab @samp{-}
37151 @tab Yes
37152
37153 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37154 @tab No
37155 @tab @samp{-}
37156 @tab Yes
37157
37158 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37159 @tab No
37160 @tab @samp{-}
37161 @tab Yes
37162
37163 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37164 @tab No
37165 @tab @samp{-}
37166 @tab Yes
37167
37168 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37169 @tab No
37170 @tab @samp{-}
37171 @tab Yes
37172
37173 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37174 @tab No
37175 @tab @samp{-}
37176 @tab No
37177
37178 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37179 @tab No
37180 @tab @samp{-}
37181 @tab Yes
37182
37183 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37184 @tab No
37185 @tab @samp{-}
37186 @tab Yes
37187
37188 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37189 @tab No
37190 @tab @samp{-}
37191 @tab Yes
37192
37193 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37194 @tab No
37195 @tab @samp{-}
37196 @tab Yes
37197
37198 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37199 @tab No
37200 @tab @samp{-}
37201 @tab Yes
37202
37203 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37204 @tab No
37205 @tab @samp{-}
37206 @tab Yes
37207
37208 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37209 @tab No
37210 @tab @samp{-}
37211 @tab Yes
37212
37213 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37214 @tab No
37215 @tab @samp{-}
37216 @tab Yes
37217
37218 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37219 @tab No
37220 @tab @samp{-}
37221 @tab Yes
37222
37223 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37224 @tab No
37225 @tab @samp{-}
37226 @tab Yes
37227
37228 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37229 @tab Yes
37230 @tab @samp{-}
37231 @tab Yes
37232
37233 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37234 @tab Yes
37235 @tab @samp{-}
37236 @tab Yes
37237
37238 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37239 @tab Yes
37240 @tab @samp{-}
37241 @tab Yes
37242
37243 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37244 @tab Yes
37245 @tab @samp{-}
37246 @tab Yes
37247
37248 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37249 @tab Yes
37250 @tab @samp{-}
37251 @tab Yes
37252
37253 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37254 @tab No
37255 @tab @samp{-}
37256 @tab Yes
37257
37258 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37259 @tab No
37260 @tab @samp{-}
37261 @tab Yes
37262
37263 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37264 @tab No
37265 @tab @samp{-}
37266 @tab Yes
37267
37268 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37269 @tab No
37270 @tab @samp{-}
37271 @tab Yes
37272
37273 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37274 @tab No
37275 @tab @samp{-}
37276 @tab No
37277
37278 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37279 @tab No
37280 @tab @samp{-}
37281 @tab No
37282
37283 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37284 @tab No
37285 @tab @samp{-}
37286 @tab No
37287
37288 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37289 @tab No
37290 @tab @samp{-}
37291 @tab No
37292
37293 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37294 @tab No
37295 @tab @samp{-}
37296 @tab No
37297
37298 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37299 @tab No
37300 @tab @samp{-}
37301 @tab No
37302
37303 @item @samp{QAgent}
37304 @tab No
37305 @tab @samp{-}
37306 @tab No
37307
37308 @item @samp{QAllow}
37309 @tab No
37310 @tab @samp{-}
37311 @tab No
37312
37313 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37314 @tab No
37315 @tab @samp{-}
37316 @tab No
37317
37318 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37319 @tab No
37320 @tab @samp{-}
37321 @tab No
37322
37323 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37324 @tab No
37325 @tab @samp{-}
37326 @tab No
37327
37328 @item @samp{tracenz}
37329 @tab No
37330 @tab @samp{-}
37331 @tab No
37332
37333 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37334 @tab No
37335 @tab @samp{-}
37336 @tab No
37337
37338 @item @samp{swbreak}
37339 @tab No
37340 @tab @samp{-}
37341 @tab No
37342
37343 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37344 @tab No
37345 @tab @samp{-}
37346 @tab No
37347
37348 @item @samp{fork-events}
37349 @tab No
37350 @tab @samp{-}
37351 @tab No
37352
37353 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37354 @tab No
37355 @tab @samp{-}
37356 @tab No
37357
37358 @item @samp{exec-events}
37359 @tab No
37360 @tab @samp{-}
37361 @tab No
37362
37363 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37364 @tab No
37365 @tab @samp{-}
37366 @tab No
37367
37368 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37369 @tab No
37370 @tab @samp{-}
37371 @tab No
37372
37373 @end multitable
37374
37375 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37376
37377 @table @samp
37378 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37379 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37380 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37381 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37382 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37383 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37384 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37385 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37386 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37387 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37388
37389 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37390 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37391 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37392
37393 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37394 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37395 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37396
37397 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37398 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37399 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37400
37401 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37402 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37403 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37404
37405 @item qXfer:features:read
37406 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37407 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37408
37409 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37410 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37411 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37412
37413 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37414 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37415 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37416
37417 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37418 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37419 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37420 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37421
37422 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37423 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37424 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37425
37426 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37427 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37428 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37429
37430 @item qXfer:spu:read
37431 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37432 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37433
37434 @item qXfer:spu:write
37435 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37436 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37437
37438 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37439 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37440 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37441
37442 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37443 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37444 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37445
37446 @item qXfer:threads:read
37447 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37448 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37449
37450 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37451 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37452 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37453
37454 @item qXfer:uib:read
37455 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37456 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37457
37458 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37459 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37460 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37461
37462 @item QNonStop
37463 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37464 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37465
37466 @item QCatchSyscalls
37467 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37468 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37469
37470 @item QPassSignals
37471 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37472 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37473
37474 @item QStartNoAckMode
37475 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37476 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37477
37478 @item multiprocess
37479 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37480 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37481 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37482 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37483 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37484 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37485 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37486 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37487 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37488 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37489 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37490
37491 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37492 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37493 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37494
37495 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37496 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37497 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37498 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37499
37500 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37501 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37502 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37503
37504 @item ReverseContinue
37505 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37506 (@pxref{bc}).
37507
37508 @item ReverseStep
37509 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37510 (@pxref{bs}).
37511
37512 @item TracepointSource
37513 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37514 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37515
37516 @item QAgent
37517 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37518
37519 @item QAllow
37520 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37521
37522 @item QDisableRandomization
37523 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37524
37525 @item StaticTracepoint
37526 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37527 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37528
37529 @item InstallInTrace
37530 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37531 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37532
37533 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37534 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37535 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37536 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37537
37538 @item QTBuffer:size
37539 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37540 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37541
37542 @item tracenz
37543 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37544 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37545 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37546
37547 @item BreakpointCommands
37548 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37549 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37550 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37551
37552 @item Qbtrace:off
37553 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37554
37555 @item Qbtrace:bts
37556 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37557
37558 @item Qbtrace:pt
37559 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37560
37561 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37562 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37563
37564 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37565 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37566
37567 @item swbreak
37568 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37569 breakpoints.
37570
37571 @item hwbreak
37572 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37573 breakpoints.
37574
37575 @item fork-events
37576 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37577
37578 @item vfork-events
37579 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37580 and vforkdone events.
37581
37582 @item exec-events
37583 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37584
37585 @item vContSupported
37586 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37587 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37588
37589 @item QThreadEvents
37590 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37591
37592 @item no-resumed
37593 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37594
37595 @end table
37596
37597 @item qSymbol::
37598 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37599 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37600 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37601 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37602
37603 Reply:
37604 @table @samp
37605 @item OK
37606 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37607 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37608 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37609 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37610 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37611 below.
37612 @end table
37613
37614 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37615 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37616
37617 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37618 target has previously requested.
37619
37620 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37621 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37622 will be empty.
37623
37624 Reply:
37625 @table @samp
37626 @item OK
37627 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37628 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37629 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37630 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37631 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37632 @end table
37633
37634 @item qTBuffer
37635 @itemx QTBuffer
37636 @itemx QTDisconnected
37637 @itemx QTDP
37638 @itemx QTDPsrc
37639 @itemx QTDV
37640 @itemx qTfP
37641 @itemx qTfV
37642 @itemx QTFrame
37643 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37644
37645 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37646
37647 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37648 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37649 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37650 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37651 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37652 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37653 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37654 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37655 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37656 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37657 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37658
37659 Reply:
37660 @table @samp
37661 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37662 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37663 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37664 the thread's attributes.
37665 @end table
37666
37667 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37668 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37669 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37670 packets.)
37671
37672 @item QTNotes
37673 @itemx qTP
37674 @itemx QTSave
37675 @itemx qTsP
37676 @itemx qTsV
37677 @itemx QTStart
37678 @itemx QTStop
37679 @itemx QTEnable
37680 @itemx QTDisable
37681 @itemx QTinit
37682 @itemx QTro
37683 @itemx qTStatus
37684 @itemx qTV
37685 @itemx qTfSTM
37686 @itemx qTsSTM
37687 @itemx qTSTMat
37688 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37689
37690 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37691 @cindex read special object, remote request
37692 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37693 @anchor{qXfer read}
37694 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37695 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37696 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37697 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37698 additional details about what data to access.
37699
37700 Reply:
37701 @table @samp
37702 @item m @var{data}
37703 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37704 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37705 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37706 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37707 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37708 request.
37709
37710 @item l @var{data}
37711 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37712 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37713 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37714
37715 @item l
37716 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37717 There is no more data to be read.
37718
37719 @item E00
37720 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37721
37722 @item E @var{nn}
37723 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37724 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37725
37726 @item @w{}
37727 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37728 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37729 @end table
37730
37731 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37732 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37733 formats, listed above.
37734
37735 @table @samp
37736 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37737 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37738 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37739 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37740
37741 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37742 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37743
37744 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37745 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37746
37747 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37748 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37749 packet may have one of the following values:
37750
37751 @table @code
37752 @item all
37753 Returns all available branch trace.
37754
37755 @item new
37756 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37757 the last read request.
37758
37759 @item delta
37760 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37761 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37762 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37763 used to stitch traces together.
37764
37765 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37766 @end table
37767
37768 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37769 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37770
37771 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37772 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37773
37774 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37775 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37776
37777 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37778 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37779
37780 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37781 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37782 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37783 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37784 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37785 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37786 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37787
37788 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37789 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37790
37791 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37792 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37793 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37794 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37795 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37796
37797 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37798 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37799
37800 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37801 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37802 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37803 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37804 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37805
37806 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37807 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37808 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37809
37810 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37811 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37812
37813 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37814 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37815 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37816 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37817 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37818 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37819 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37820 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37821
37822 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37823 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37824
37825 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37826 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37827
37828 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37829 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37830 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37831 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37832
37833 @table @code
37834 @item start=@var{address}
37835 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37836 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37837 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37838 chosen as the starting point.
37839
37840 @item prev=@var{address}
37841 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37842 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37843 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37844 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37845 exists prior to the starting point.
37846
37847 @end table
37848
37849 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37850 ignored.
37851
37852 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37853 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37854 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37855 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37856 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37857
37858 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37859 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37860
37861 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37862 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37863
37864 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37865 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37866 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37867 Action Lists}.
37868
37869 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37870 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37871 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37872
37873 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37874 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37875 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37876 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37877 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37878
37879 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37880 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37881 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37882
37883 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37884 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37885 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37886 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37887 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37888 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37889 in that context to be accessed.
37890
37891 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37892 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37893 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37894
37895 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37896 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37897 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37898 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37899 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37900
37901 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37902 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37903
37904 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37905 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37906
37907 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37908 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37909 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37910
37911 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37912 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37913
37914 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37915 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37916
37917 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37918 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37919
37920 This packet is not probed by default.
37921
37922 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37923 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37924 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37925 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37926 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37927
37928 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37929 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37930
37931 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37932 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37933 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37934 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37935
37936 @end table
37937
37938 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37939 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37940 @anchor{qXfer write}
37941 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37942 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37943 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37944 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37945 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37946 to access.
37947
37948 Reply:
37949 @table @samp
37950 @item @var{nn}
37951 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37952 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37953
37954 @item E00
37955 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37956
37957 @item E @var{nn}
37958 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37959 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37960
37961 @item @w{}
37962 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37963 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37964 @end table
37965
37966 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37967 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37968 formats, listed above.
37969
37970 @table @samp
37971 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37972 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37973 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37974 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37975 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37976
37977 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37978 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37979 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37980
37981 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37982 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37983 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37984 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37985 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37986 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37987 in that context to be accessed.
37988
37989 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37990 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37991 @end table
37992
37993 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37994 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37995 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37996 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37997 must respond with an empty packet.
37998
37999 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38000 @cindex query attached, remote request
38001 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38002 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38003 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38004 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38005 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38006 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38007 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38008
38009 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38010 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38011 the @code{quit} command.
38012
38013 Reply:
38014 @table @samp
38015 @item 1
38016 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38017 @item 0
38018 The remote server created a new process.
38019 @item E @var{NN}
38020 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38021 @end table
38022
38023 @item Qbtrace:bts
38024 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38025
38026 Reply:
38027 @table @samp
38028 @item OK
38029 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38030 @item E.errtext
38031 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38032 @end table
38033
38034 @item Qbtrace:pt
38035 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38036
38037 Reply:
38038 @table @samp
38039 @item OK
38040 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38041 @item E.errtext
38042 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38043 @end table
38044
38045 @item Qbtrace:off
38046 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38047
38048 Reply:
38049 @table @samp
38050 @item OK
38051 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38052 @item E.errtext
38053 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38054 @end table
38055
38056 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38057 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38058 btrace recording method in bts format.
38059
38060 Reply:
38061 @table @samp
38062 @item OK
38063 The ring buffer size has been set.
38064 @item E.errtext
38065 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38066 @end table
38067
38068 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38069 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38070 btrace recording method in pt format.
38071
38072 Reply:
38073 @table @samp
38074 @item OK
38075 The ring buffer size has been set.
38076 @item E.errtext
38077 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38078 @end table
38079
38080 @end table
38081
38082 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38083 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38084
38085 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38086 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38087 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38088
38089 @menu
38090 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38091 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38092 @end menu
38093
38094 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38095 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38096
38097 @menu
38098 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38099 @end menu
38100
38101 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38102 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38103 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38104
38105 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38106
38107 @table @r
38108
38109 @item 2
38110 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38111
38112 @item 3
38113 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38114
38115 @item 4
38116 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38117
38118 @end table
38119
38120 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38121 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38122
38123 @menu
38124 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38125 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38126 @end menu
38127
38128 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38129 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38130 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38131
38132 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38133 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38134 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38135 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38136 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38137 most-significant -- least-significant.
38138
38139 @table @r
38140
38141 @item MIPS32
38142 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38143 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38144 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38145
38146 @item MIPS64
38147 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38148 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38149 as @code{MIPS32}.
38150
38151 @end table
38152
38153 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38154 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38155 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38156
38157 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38158
38159 @table @r
38160
38161 @item 2
38162 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38163
38164 @item 3
38165 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38166
38167 @item 4
38168 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38169
38170 @item 5
38171 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38172
38173 @end table
38174
38175 @node Tracepoint Packets
38176 @section Tracepoint Packets
38177 @cindex tracepoint packets
38178 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38179
38180 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38181 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38182
38183 @table @samp
38184
38185 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38186 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38187 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38188 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38189 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38190 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38191 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38192 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38193 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38194 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38195 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38196 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38197 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38198 actions.
38199
38200 Replies:
38201 @table @samp
38202 @item OK
38203 The packet was understood and carried out.
38204 @item qRelocInsn
38205 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38206 @item @w{}
38207 The packet was not recognized.
38208 @end table
38209
38210 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38211 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38212 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38213 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38214 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38215 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38216 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38217
38218 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38219 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38220 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38221 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38222 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38223 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38224 tracepoint actions.
38225
38226 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38227 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38228 following forms:
38229
38230 @table @samp
38231
38232 @item R @var{mask}
38233 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38234 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38235 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38236 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38237 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38238
38239 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38240 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38241 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38242 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38243 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38244 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38245 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38246
38247 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38248 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38249 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38250 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38251 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38252 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38253 packet).
38254
38255 @end table
38256
38257 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38258 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38259 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38260 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38261 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38262 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38263 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38264 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38265
38266 Replies:
38267 @table @samp
38268 @item OK
38269 The packet was understood and carried out.
38270 @item qRelocInsn
38271 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38272 @item @w{}
38273 The packet was not recognized.
38274 @end table
38275
38276 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38277 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38278 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38279 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38280 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38281 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38282 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38283 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38284
38285 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38286 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38287 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38288 fit in a single packet.
38289 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38290 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38291
38292 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38293 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38294 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38295 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38296
38297 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38298 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38299 query packets.
38300
38301 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38302 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38303 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38304 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38305 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38306 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38307 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38308 be found.
38309
38310 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38311 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38312 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38313 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38314 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38315 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38316 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38317 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38318 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38319 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38320 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38321 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38322 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38323 variable.
38324
38325 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38326 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38327 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38328 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38329 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38330
38331 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38332 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38333 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38334 one of the following forms:
38335
38336 @table @samp
38337 @item F @var{f}
38338 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38339 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38340 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38341
38342 @item T @var{t}
38343 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38344 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38345
38346 @end table
38347
38348 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38349 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38350 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38351 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38352
38353 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38354 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38355 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38356 is a hexadecimal number.
38357
38358 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38359 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38360 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38361 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38362 numbers.
38363
38364 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38365 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38366 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38367
38368 @item qTMinFTPILen
38369 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38370 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38371 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38372 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38373 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38374 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38375 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38376 arrange for that.
38377
38378 Replies:
38379
38380 @table @samp
38381 @item 0
38382 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38383 @item @var{length}
38384 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38385 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38386 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38387 regardless of size.
38388 @item E
38389 An error has occurred.
38390 @item @w{}
38391 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38392 @end table
38393
38394 @item QTStart
38395 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38396 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38397 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38398 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38399 instruction reply packet}).
38400
38401 @item QTStop
38402 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38403 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38404
38405 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38406 @anchor{QTEnable}
38407 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38408 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38409 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38410 of data from it will resume.
38411
38412 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38413 @anchor{QTDisable}
38414 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38415 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38416 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38417 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38418
38419 @item QTinit
38420 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38421 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38422
38423 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38424 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38425 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38426 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38427 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38428
38429 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38430 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38431 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38432 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38433
38434 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38435 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38436 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38437 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38438 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38439 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38440
38441 @item qTStatus
38442 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38443 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38444
38445 The reply has the form:
38446
38447 @table @samp
38448
38449 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38450 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38451 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38452 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38453
38454 @end table
38455
38456 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38457 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38458
38459 @table @samp
38460
38461 @item tnotrun:0
38462 No trace has been run yet.
38463
38464 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38465 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38466 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38467 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38468 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38469
38470 @item tfull:0
38471 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38472
38473 @item tdisconnected:0
38474 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38475
38476 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38477 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38478
38479 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38480 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38481 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38482 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38483 is hex encoded.
38484
38485 @item tunknown:0
38486 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38487
38488 @end table
38489
38490 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38491 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38492 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38493 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38494 trace.
38495
38496 @table @samp
38497
38498 @item tframes:@var{n}
38499 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38500
38501 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38502 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38503 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38504
38505 @item tsize:@var{n}
38506 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38507
38508 @item tfree:@var{n}
38509 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38510
38511 @item circular:@var{n}
38512 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38513 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38514 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38515 and may fill up.
38516
38517 @item disconn:@var{n}
38518 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38519 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38520 that the trace run will stop.
38521
38522 @end table
38523
38524 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38525 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38526 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38527 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38528 address @var{addr}.
38529
38530 Replies:
38531 @table @samp
38532 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38533 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38534 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38535 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38536 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38537
38538 @end table
38539
38540 @item qTV:@var{var}
38541 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38542 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38543 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38544
38545 Replies:
38546 @table @samp
38547 @item V@var{value}
38548 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38549 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38550 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38551 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38552 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38553 program is running.
38554
38555 @item U
38556 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38557 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38558 was not collected.
38559 @end table
38560
38561 @item qTfP
38562 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38563 @itemx qTsP
38564 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38565 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38566 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38567 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38568 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38569 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38570
38571 @item qTfV
38572 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38573 @itemx qTsV
38574 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38575 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38576 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38577 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38578 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38579 trace state variables.
38580
38581 @item qTfSTM
38582 @itemx qTsSTM
38583 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38584 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38585 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38586 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38587 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38588 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38589 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38590 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38591
38592 Reply:
38593 @table @samp
38594 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38595 A single marker
38596 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38597 a comma-separated list of markers
38598 @item l
38599 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38600 @item E @var{nn}
38601 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38602 @item @w{}
38603 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38604 stub.
38605 @end table
38606
38607 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38608 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38609
38610 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38611 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38612 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38613 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38614 @dfn{last}).
38615
38616 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38617 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38618 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38619 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38620 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38621 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38622 tracepoint markers.
38623
38624 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38625 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38626 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38627 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38628 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38629 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38630
38631 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38632 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38633 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38634 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38635 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38636 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38637 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38638 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38639 available.
38640
38641 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38642 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38643 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38644
38645 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38646 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38647 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38648 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38649 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38650 use whatever size it prefers.
38651
38652 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38653 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38654 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38655 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38656 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38657
38658 @end table
38659
38660 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38661 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38662 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38663 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38664 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38665 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38666 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38667 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38668 it had executed in the original location.
38669
38670 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38671 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38672 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38673 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38674 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38675 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38676 format of the request is:
38677
38678 @table @samp
38679 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38680
38681 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38682 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38683 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38684 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38685 memory starting at @var{to}.
38686 @end table
38687
38688 Replies:
38689 @table @samp
38690 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38691 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38692 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38693 @item E @var{NN}
38694 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38695 relocating the instruction.
38696 @end table
38697
38698 @node Host I/O Packets
38699 @section Host I/O Packets
38700 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38701 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38702
38703 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38704 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38705 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38706 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38707 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38708 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38709 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38710 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38711 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38712 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38713
38714 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38715 its arguments. They have this format:
38716
38717 @table @samp
38718
38719 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38720 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38721 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38722 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38723 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38724 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38725 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38726 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38727 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38728
38729 @end table
38730
38731 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38732
38733 @table @samp
38734
38735 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38736 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38737 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38738 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38739 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38740 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38741 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38742 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38743 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38744 @var{attachment}.
38745
38746 @item @w{}
38747 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38748
38749 @end table
38750
38751 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38752
38753 @table @samp
38754 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38755 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38756 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38757 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38758 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38759 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38760 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38761
38762 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38763 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38764 -1 if an error occurs.
38765
38766 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38767 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38768 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38769 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38770 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38771 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38772 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38773 @var{count} was zero.
38774
38775 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38776 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38777 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38778 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38779 some characters were escaped.
38780
38781 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38782 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38783 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38784 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38785 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38786 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38787 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38788 error occurred.
38789
38790 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38791 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38792 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38793 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38794 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38795 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38796
38797 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38798 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38799 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38800
38801 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38802 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38803 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38804
38805 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38806 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38807 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38808 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38809 some characters were escaped.
38810
38811 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38812 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38813 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38814 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38815 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38816 inferior(s).
38817
38818 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38819 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38820 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38821 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38822 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38823 operation.
38824
38825 @end table
38826
38827 @node Interrupts
38828 @section Interrupts
38829 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38830 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38831
38832 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38833 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38834 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38835 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38836
38837 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38838 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38839 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38840 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38841 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38842
38843 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38844 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38845 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38846 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38847 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38848 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38849 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38850 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38851
38852 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38853 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38854 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38855
38856 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38857 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38858 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38859 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38860 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38861 @code{0x03}.
38862
38863 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38864 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38865 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38866 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38867 currently-executing threads and processes.
38868 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38869 running program, it should send one of the stop
38870 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38871 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38872 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38873 Interrupts received while the
38874 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38875 it is resumed next time.
38876
38877 @node Notification Packets
38878 @section Notification Packets
38879 @cindex notification packets
38880 @cindex packets, notification
38881
38882 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38883 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38884 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38885 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38886 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38887 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38888 is not a problem.
38889
38890 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38891 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38892 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38893 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38894 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38895 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38896 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38897
38898 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38899 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38900
38901 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38902 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38903 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38904 not they understand it.
38905
38906 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38907 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38908 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38909 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38910 recipients.
38911
38912 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38913 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38914 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38915 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38916 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38917
38918 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38919 @table @samp
38920 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38921 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38922 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38923 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38924 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38925 @item @var{ack}
38926 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38927 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38928 @end table
38929
38930 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38931 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38932
38933 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38934 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38935 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38936 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38937 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38938 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38939 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38940 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38941 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38942 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38943
38944 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38945 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38946 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38947 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38948 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38949 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38950
38951 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38952 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38953 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38954 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38955 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38956
38957 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38958 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38959 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38960 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38961 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38962 normally.
38963
38964 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38965 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38966 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38967 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38968 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38969 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38970 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38971 the process shall be repeated.
38972
38973 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38974 following example:
38975 @smallexample
38976 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38977 @code{...}
38978 -> @code{vStopped}
38979 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38980 -> @code{vStopped}
38981 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38982 -> @code{vStopped}
38983 <- @code{OK}
38984 @end smallexample
38985
38986 The following notifications are defined:
38987 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38988
38989 @item Notification
38990 @tab Ack
38991 @tab Event
38992 @tab Description
38993
38994 @item Stop
38995 @tab vStopped
38996 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38997 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38998 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38999 @value{GDBN}.
39000 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39001
39002 @end multitable
39003
39004 @node Remote Non-Stop
39005 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39006
39007 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39008 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39009 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39010 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39011
39012 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39013 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39014 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39015 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39016 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39017 probe the target state after a mode change.
39018
39019 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39020 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39021 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39022 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39023 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39024 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39025 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39026 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39027 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39028 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39029 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39030
39031 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39032 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39033 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39034 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39035 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39036 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39037 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39038 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39039 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39040 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39041 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39042 @samp{OK}.
39043
39044 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39045 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39046 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39047 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39048 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39049 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39050 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39051 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39052 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39053 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39054 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39055 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39056 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39057
39058 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39059 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39060
39061 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39062 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39063 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39064 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39065 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39066 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39067 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39068
39069 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39070 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39071 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39072 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39073 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39074
39075 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39076 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39077 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39078 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39079
39080 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39081 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39082 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39083 @pxref{qSupported}.
39084 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39085 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39086 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39087 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39088 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39089 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39090 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39091
39092 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39093 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39094 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39095 connection.
39096 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39097 new connection is established,
39098 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39099 for the current connection, once disabled.
39100
39101 @node Examples
39102 @section Examples
39103
39104 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39105 does not get any direct output:
39106
39107 @smallexample
39108 -> @code{R00}
39109 <- @code{+}
39110 @emph{target restarts}
39111 -> @code{?}
39112 <- @code{+}
39113 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39114 -> @code{+}
39115 @end smallexample
39116
39117 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39118
39119 @smallexample
39120 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39121 <- @code{+}
39122 -> @code{s}
39123 <- @code{+}
39124 @emph{time passes}
39125 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39126 -> @code{+}
39127 -> @code{g}
39128 <- @code{+}
39129 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39130 -> @code{+}
39131 @end smallexample
39132
39133 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39134 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39135 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39136
39137 @menu
39138 * File-I/O Overview::
39139 * Protocol Basics::
39140 * The F Request Packet::
39141 * The F Reply Packet::
39142 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39143 * Console I/O::
39144 * List of Supported Calls::
39145 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39146 * Constants::
39147 * File-I/O Examples::
39148 @end menu
39149
39150 @node File-I/O Overview
39151 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39152 @cindex file-i/o overview
39153
39154 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39155 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39156 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39157 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39158 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39159 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39160
39161 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39162 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39163 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39164 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39165 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39166
39167 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39168 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39169 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39170 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39171 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39172 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39173 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39174
39175 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39176 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39177 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39178 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39179 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39180
39181 @smallexample
39182 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39183 <- target requests 'system call X'
39184 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39185 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39186 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39187 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39188 @end smallexample
39189
39190 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39191 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39192 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39193 system are not supported by this protocol.
39194
39195 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39196
39197 @node Protocol Basics
39198 @subsection Protocol Basics
39199 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39200
39201 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39202 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39203 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39204 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39205 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39206 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39207 to call the appropriate host system call:
39208
39209 @itemize @bullet
39210 @item
39211 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39212
39213 @item
39214 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39215 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39216 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39217 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39218
39219 @end itemize
39220
39221 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39222
39223 @itemize @bullet
39224 @item
39225 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39226 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39227 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39228 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39229 packet.
39230
39231 @item
39232 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39233 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39234
39235 @item
39236 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39237
39238 @item
39239 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39240
39241 @item
39242 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39243 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39244 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39245 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39246 packet.
39247
39248 @end itemize
39249
39250 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39251 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39252
39253 @itemize @bullet
39254 @item
39255 Return value.
39256
39257 @item
39258 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39259
39260 @item
39261 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39262
39263 @end itemize
39264
39265 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39266 the latest continue or step action.
39267
39268 @node The F Request Packet
39269 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39270 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39271 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39272
39273 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39274
39275 @table @samp
39276 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39277
39278 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39279 This is just the name of the function.
39280
39281 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39282 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39283 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39284 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39285 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39286 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39287 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39288
39289 @end table
39290
39291
39292
39293 @node The F Reply Packet
39294 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39295 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39296 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39297
39298 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39299
39300 @table @samp
39301
39302 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39303
39304 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39305
39306 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39307 representation.
39308 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39309
39310 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39311 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39312 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39313
39314 @smallexample
39315 F0,0,C
39316 @end smallexample
39317
39318 @noindent
39319 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39320
39321 @smallexample
39322 F-1,4,C
39323 @end smallexample
39324
39325 @noindent
39326 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39327
39328 @end table
39329
39330
39331 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39332 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39333 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39334
39335 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39336 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39337 the target should behave as if it had
39338 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39339 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39340 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39341 packet.
39342
39343 It's important for the target to know in which
39344 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39345
39346 @itemize @bullet
39347 @item
39348 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39349
39350 @item
39351 The system call on the host has been finished.
39352
39353 @end itemize
39354
39355 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39356 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39357 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39358 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39359 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39360 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39361
39362 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39363 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39364 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39365 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39366 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39367 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39368 or the full action has been completed.
39369
39370 @node Console I/O
39371 @subsection Console I/O
39372 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39373
39374 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39375 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39376 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39377 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39378 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39379 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39380 conditions is met:
39381
39382 @itemize @bullet
39383 @item
39384 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39385 @code{read}
39386 system call is treated as finished.
39387
39388 @item
39389 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39390 newline.
39391
39392 @item
39393 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39394 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39395
39396 @end itemize
39397
39398 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39399 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39400 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39401 is stopped at the user's request.
39402
39403
39404 @node List of Supported Calls
39405 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39406 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39407
39408 @menu
39409 * open::
39410 * close::
39411 * read::
39412 * write::
39413 * lseek::
39414 * rename::
39415 * unlink::
39416 * stat/fstat::
39417 * gettimeofday::
39418 * isatty::
39419 * system::
39420 @end menu
39421
39422 @node open
39423 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39424 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39425
39426 @table @asis
39427 @item Synopsis:
39428 @smallexample
39429 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39430 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39431 @end smallexample
39432
39433 @item Request:
39434 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39435
39436 @noindent
39437 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39438
39439 @table @code
39440 @item O_CREAT
39441 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39442 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39443 are concerned.
39444
39445 @item O_EXCL
39446 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39447 an error and open() fails.
39448
39449 @item O_TRUNC
39450 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39451 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39452 truncated to zero length.
39453
39454 @item O_APPEND
39455 The file is opened in append mode.
39456
39457 @item O_RDONLY
39458 The file is opened for reading only.
39459
39460 @item O_WRONLY
39461 The file is opened for writing only.
39462
39463 @item O_RDWR
39464 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39465 @end table
39466
39467 @noindent
39468 Other bits are silently ignored.
39469
39470
39471 @noindent
39472 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39473
39474 @table @code
39475 @item S_IRUSR
39476 User has read permission.
39477
39478 @item S_IWUSR
39479 User has write permission.
39480
39481 @item S_IRGRP
39482 Group has read permission.
39483
39484 @item S_IWGRP
39485 Group has write permission.
39486
39487 @item S_IROTH
39488 Others have read permission.
39489
39490 @item S_IWOTH
39491 Others have write permission.
39492 @end table
39493
39494 @noindent
39495 Other bits are silently ignored.
39496
39497
39498 @item Return value:
39499 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39500 occurred.
39501
39502 @item Errors:
39503
39504 @table @code
39505 @item EEXIST
39506 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39507
39508 @item EISDIR
39509 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39510
39511 @item EACCES
39512 The requested access is not allowed.
39513
39514 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39515 @var{pathname} was too long.
39516
39517 @item ENOENT
39518 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39519
39520 @item ENODEV
39521 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39522
39523 @item EROFS
39524 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39525 write access was requested.
39526
39527 @item EFAULT
39528 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39529
39530 @item ENOSPC
39531 No space on device to create the file.
39532
39533 @item EMFILE
39534 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39535
39536 @item ENFILE
39537 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39538 has been reached.
39539
39540 @item EINTR
39541 The call was interrupted by the user.
39542 @end table
39543
39544 @end table
39545
39546 @node close
39547 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39548 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39549
39550 @table @asis
39551 @item Synopsis:
39552 @smallexample
39553 int close(int fd);
39554 @end smallexample
39555
39556 @item Request:
39557 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39558
39559 @item Return value:
39560 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39561
39562 @item Errors:
39563
39564 @table @code
39565 @item EBADF
39566 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39567
39568 @item EINTR
39569 The call was interrupted by the user.
39570 @end table
39571
39572 @end table
39573
39574 @node read
39575 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39576 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39577
39578 @table @asis
39579 @item Synopsis:
39580 @smallexample
39581 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39582 @end smallexample
39583
39584 @item Request:
39585 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39586
39587 @item Return value:
39588 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39589 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39590 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39591
39592 @item Errors:
39593
39594 @table @code
39595 @item EBADF
39596 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39597 reading.
39598
39599 @item EFAULT
39600 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39601
39602 @item EINTR
39603 The call was interrupted by the user.
39604 @end table
39605
39606 @end table
39607
39608 @node write
39609 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39610 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39611
39612 @table @asis
39613 @item Synopsis:
39614 @smallexample
39615 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39616 @end smallexample
39617
39618 @item Request:
39619 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39620
39621 @item Return value:
39622 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39623 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39624 is returned.
39625
39626 @item Errors:
39627
39628 @table @code
39629 @item EBADF
39630 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39631 writing.
39632
39633 @item EFAULT
39634 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39635
39636 @item EFBIG
39637 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39638 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39639
39640 @item ENOSPC
39641 No space on device to write the data.
39642
39643 @item EINTR
39644 The call was interrupted by the user.
39645 @end table
39646
39647 @end table
39648
39649 @node lseek
39650 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39651 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39652
39653 @table @asis
39654 @item Synopsis:
39655 @smallexample
39656 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39657 @end smallexample
39658
39659 @item Request:
39660 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39661
39662 @var{flag} is one of:
39663
39664 @table @code
39665 @item SEEK_SET
39666 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39667
39668 @item SEEK_CUR
39669 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39670 bytes.
39671
39672 @item SEEK_END
39673 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39674 bytes.
39675 @end table
39676
39677 @item Return value:
39678 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39679 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39680 value of -1 is returned.
39681
39682 @item Errors:
39683
39684 @table @code
39685 @item EBADF
39686 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39687
39688 @item ESPIPE
39689 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39690
39691 @item EINVAL
39692 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39693
39694 @item EINTR
39695 The call was interrupted by the user.
39696 @end table
39697
39698 @end table
39699
39700 @node rename
39701 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39702 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39703
39704 @table @asis
39705 @item Synopsis:
39706 @smallexample
39707 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39708 @end smallexample
39709
39710 @item Request:
39711 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39712
39713 @item Return value:
39714 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39715
39716 @item Errors:
39717
39718 @table @code
39719 @item EISDIR
39720 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39721 directory.
39722
39723 @item EEXIST
39724 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39725
39726 @item EBUSY
39727 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39728 process.
39729
39730 @item EINVAL
39731 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39732 of itself.
39733
39734 @item ENOTDIR
39735 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39736 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39737 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39738
39739 @item EFAULT
39740 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39741
39742 @item EACCES
39743 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39744
39745 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39746
39747 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39748
39749 @item ENOENT
39750 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39751
39752 @item EROFS
39753 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39754
39755 @item ENOSPC
39756 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39757 directory entry.
39758
39759 @item EINTR
39760 The call was interrupted by the user.
39761 @end table
39762
39763 @end table
39764
39765 @node unlink
39766 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39767 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39768
39769 @table @asis
39770 @item Synopsis:
39771 @smallexample
39772 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39773 @end smallexample
39774
39775 @item Request:
39776 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39777
39778 @item Return value:
39779 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39780
39781 @item Errors:
39782
39783 @table @code
39784 @item EACCES
39785 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39786
39787 @item EPERM
39788 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39789
39790 @item EBUSY
39791 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39792 being used by another process.
39793
39794 @item EFAULT
39795 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39796
39797 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39798 @var{pathname} was too long.
39799
39800 @item ENOENT
39801 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39802
39803 @item ENOTDIR
39804 A component of the path is not a directory.
39805
39806 @item EROFS
39807 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39808
39809 @item EINTR
39810 The call was interrupted by the user.
39811 @end table
39812
39813 @end table
39814
39815 @node stat/fstat
39816 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39817 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39818 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39819
39820 @table @asis
39821 @item Synopsis:
39822 @smallexample
39823 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39824 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39825 @end smallexample
39826
39827 @item Request:
39828 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39829 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39830
39831 @item Return value:
39832 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39833
39834 @item Errors:
39835
39836 @table @code
39837 @item EBADF
39838 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39839
39840 @item ENOENT
39841 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39842 path is an empty string.
39843
39844 @item ENOTDIR
39845 A component of the path is not a directory.
39846
39847 @item EFAULT
39848 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39849
39850 @item EACCES
39851 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39852
39853 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39854 @var{pathname} was too long.
39855
39856 @item EINTR
39857 The call was interrupted by the user.
39858 @end table
39859
39860 @end table
39861
39862 @node gettimeofday
39863 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39864 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39865
39866 @table @asis
39867 @item Synopsis:
39868 @smallexample
39869 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39870 @end smallexample
39871
39872 @item Request:
39873 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39874
39875 @item Return value:
39876 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39877
39878 @item Errors:
39879
39880 @table @code
39881 @item EINVAL
39882 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39883
39884 @item EFAULT
39885 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39886 @end table
39887
39888 @end table
39889
39890 @node isatty
39891 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39892 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39893
39894 @table @asis
39895 @item Synopsis:
39896 @smallexample
39897 int isatty(int fd);
39898 @end smallexample
39899
39900 @item Request:
39901 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39902
39903 @item Return value:
39904 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39905
39906 @item Errors:
39907
39908 @table @code
39909 @item EINTR
39910 The call was interrupted by the user.
39911 @end table
39912
39913 @end table
39914
39915 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39916 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39917 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39918 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39919 needed.
39920
39921
39922 @node system
39923 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39924 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39925
39926 @table @asis
39927 @item Synopsis:
39928 @smallexample
39929 int system(const char *command);
39930 @end smallexample
39931
39932 @item Request:
39933 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39934
39935 @item Return value:
39936 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39937 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39938 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39939 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39940 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39941 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39942 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39943
39944 @item Errors:
39945
39946 @table @code
39947 @item EINTR
39948 The call was interrupted by the user.
39949 @end table
39950
39951 @end table
39952
39953 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39954 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39955 the host is simplified before it's returned
39956 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39957 is discarded, and the return value consists
39958 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39959
39960 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39961 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39962 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39963
39964 @table @code
39965 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39966 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39967 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39968 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39969
39970 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39971 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39972 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39973 protocol.
39974 @end table
39975
39976 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39977 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39978 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39979
39980 @menu
39981 * Integral Datatypes::
39982 * Pointer Values::
39983 * Memory Transfer::
39984 * struct stat::
39985 * struct timeval::
39986 @end menu
39987
39988 @node Integral Datatypes
39989 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39990 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39991
39992 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39993 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39994 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39995
39996 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39997 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39998
39999 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40000
40001 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40002 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40003
40004 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40005
40006 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40007 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40008 byte order.
40009
40010 @node Pointer Values
40011 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40012 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40013
40014 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40015 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40016 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40017 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40018
40019 @smallexample
40020 @code{1aaf/12}
40021 @end smallexample
40022
40023 @noindent
40024 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40025 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40026 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40027 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40028
40029 @smallexample
40030 @code{123456/d}
40031 @end smallexample
40032
40033 @node Memory Transfer
40034 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40035 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40036
40037 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40038 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40039 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40040 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40041 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40042 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40043 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40044
40045
40046 @node struct stat
40047 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40048 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40049
40050 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40051 is defined as follows:
40052
40053 @smallexample
40054 struct stat @{
40055 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40056 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40057 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40058 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40059 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40060 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40061 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40062 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40063 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40064 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40065 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40066 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40067 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40068 @};
40069 @end smallexample
40070
40071 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40072 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40073 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40074
40075 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40076 range of values.
40077
40078 @table @code
40079
40080 @item st_dev
40081 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40082
40083 @item st_ino
40084 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40085
40086 @item st_mode
40087 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40088 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40089
40090 @item st_uid
40091 @itemx st_gid
40092 @itemx st_rdev
40093 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40094
40095 @item st_atime
40096 @itemx st_mtime
40097 @itemx st_ctime
40098 These values have a host and file system dependent
40099 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40100 support exact timing values.
40101 @end table
40102
40103 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40104 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40105 continuing.
40106
40107 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40108 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40109 get truncated on the target.
40110
40111 @node struct timeval
40112 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40113 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40114
40115 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40116 is defined as follows:
40117
40118 @smallexample
40119 struct timeval @{
40120 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40121 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40122 @};
40123 @end smallexample
40124
40125 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40126 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40127 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40128
40129 @node Constants
40130 @subsection Constants
40131 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40132
40133 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40134 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40135 values before and after the call as needed.
40136
40137 @menu
40138 * Open Flags::
40139 * mode_t Values::
40140 * Errno Values::
40141 * Lseek Flags::
40142 * Limits::
40143 @end menu
40144
40145 @node Open Flags
40146 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40147 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40148
40149 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40150
40151 @smallexample
40152 O_RDONLY 0x0
40153 O_WRONLY 0x1
40154 O_RDWR 0x2
40155 O_APPEND 0x8
40156 O_CREAT 0x200
40157 O_TRUNC 0x400
40158 O_EXCL 0x800
40159 @end smallexample
40160
40161 @node mode_t Values
40162 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40163 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40164
40165 All values are given in octal representation.
40166
40167 @smallexample
40168 S_IFREG 0100000
40169 S_IFDIR 040000
40170 S_IRUSR 0400
40171 S_IWUSR 0200
40172 S_IXUSR 0100
40173 S_IRGRP 040
40174 S_IWGRP 020
40175 S_IXGRP 010
40176 S_IROTH 04
40177 S_IWOTH 02
40178 S_IXOTH 01
40179 @end smallexample
40180
40181 @node Errno Values
40182 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40183 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40184
40185 All values are given in decimal representation.
40186
40187 @smallexample
40188 EPERM 1
40189 ENOENT 2
40190 EINTR 4
40191 EBADF 9
40192 EACCES 13
40193 EFAULT 14
40194 EBUSY 16
40195 EEXIST 17
40196 ENODEV 19
40197 ENOTDIR 20
40198 EISDIR 21
40199 EINVAL 22
40200 ENFILE 23
40201 EMFILE 24
40202 EFBIG 27
40203 ENOSPC 28
40204 ESPIPE 29
40205 EROFS 30
40206 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40207 EUNKNOWN 9999
40208 @end smallexample
40209
40210 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40211 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40212
40213 @node Lseek Flags
40214 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40215 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40216
40217 @smallexample
40218 SEEK_SET 0
40219 SEEK_CUR 1
40220 SEEK_END 2
40221 @end smallexample
40222
40223 @node Limits
40224 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40225 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40226
40227 All values are given in decimal representation.
40228
40229 @smallexample
40230 INT_MIN -2147483648
40231 INT_MAX 2147483647
40232 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40233 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40234 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40235 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40236 @end smallexample
40237
40238 @node File-I/O Examples
40239 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40240 @cindex file-i/o examples
40241
40242 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40243 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40244
40245 @smallexample
40246 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40247 @emph{request memory read from target}
40248 -> @code{m1234,6}
40249 <- XXXXXX
40250 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40251 -> @code{F6}
40252 @end smallexample
40253
40254 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40255 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40256
40257 @smallexample
40258 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40259 @emph{request memory write to target}
40260 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40261 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40262 -> @code{F6}
40263 @end smallexample
40264
40265 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40266 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40267
40268 @smallexample
40269 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40270 -> @code{F-1,9}
40271 @end smallexample
40272
40273 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40274 host is called:
40275
40276 @smallexample
40277 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40278 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40279 <- @code{T02}
40280 @end smallexample
40281
40282 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40283 host is called:
40284
40285 @smallexample
40286 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40287 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40288 <- @code{T02}
40289 @end smallexample
40290
40291 @node Library List Format
40292 @section Library List Format
40293 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40294
40295 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40296 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40297 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40298 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40299 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40300 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40301 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40302 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40303 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40304 are loaded.
40305
40306 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40307 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40308 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40309 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40310
40311 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40312 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40313 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40314 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40315 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40316 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40317
40318 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40319 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40320
40321 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40322 offset, looks like this:
40323
40324 @smallexample
40325 <library-list>
40326 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40327 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40328 </library>
40329 </library-list>
40330 @end smallexample
40331
40332 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40333 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40334
40335 @smallexample
40336 <library-list>
40337 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40338 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40339 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40340 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40341 </library>
40342 </library-list>
40343 @end smallexample
40344
40345 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40346
40347 @smallexample
40348 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40349 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40350 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40351 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40352 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40353 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40354 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40355 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40356 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40357 @end smallexample
40358
40359 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40360 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40361 section for each library.
40362
40363 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40364 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40365 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40366
40367 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40368 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40369 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40370 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40371
40372 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40373 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40374 target, the following parameters are reported:
40375
40376 @itemize @minus
40377 @item
40378 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40379 @code{struct link_map}.
40380 @item
40381 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40382 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40383 @item
40384 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40385 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40386 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40387 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40388 @item
40389 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40390 @end itemize
40391
40392 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40393 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40394 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40395
40396 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40397 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40398
40399 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40400 looks like this:
40401
40402 @smallexample
40403 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40404 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40405 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40406 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40407 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40408 </library-list-svr>
40409 @end smallexample
40410
40411 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40412
40413 @smallexample
40414 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40415 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40416 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40417 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40418 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40419 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40420 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40421 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40422 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40423 @end smallexample
40424
40425 @node Memory Map Format
40426 @section Memory Map Format
40427 @cindex memory map format
40428
40429 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40430 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40431 memory map.
40432
40433 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40434 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40435 lists memory regions.
40436
40437 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40438 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40439
40440 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40441
40442 @smallexample
40443 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40444 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40445 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40446 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40447 <memory-map>
40448 region...
40449 </memory-map>
40450 @end smallexample
40451
40452 Each region can be either:
40453
40454 @itemize
40455
40456 @item
40457 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40458 bytes from there:
40459
40460 @smallexample
40461 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40462 @end smallexample
40463
40464
40465 @item
40466 A region of read-only memory:
40467
40468 @smallexample
40469 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40470 @end smallexample
40471
40472
40473 @item
40474 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40475 bytes in length:
40476
40477 @smallexample
40478 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40479 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40480 </memory>
40481 @end smallexample
40482
40483 @end itemize
40484
40485 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40486 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40487 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40488
40489 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40490
40491 @smallexample
40492 <!-- ................................................... -->
40493 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40494 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40495 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40496 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40497 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40498 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40499 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40500 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40501 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40502 and its type, or device. -->
40503 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40504 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40505 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40506 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40507 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40508 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40509 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40510 @end smallexample
40511
40512 @node Thread List Format
40513 @section Thread List Format
40514 @cindex thread list format
40515
40516 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40517 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40518 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40519 the following structure:
40520
40521 @smallexample
40522 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40523 <threads>
40524 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40525 ... description ...
40526 </thread>
40527 </threads>
40528 @end smallexample
40529
40530 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40531 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40532 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40533 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40534 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40535 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40536 auxiliary information.
40537
40538 @node Traceframe Info Format
40539 @section Traceframe Info Format
40540 @cindex traceframe info format
40541
40542 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40543 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40544 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40545 collected in a traceframe.
40546
40547 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40548 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40549
40550 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40551 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40552
40553 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40554
40555 @smallexample
40556 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40557 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40558 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40559 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40560 <traceframe-info>
40561 block...
40562 </traceframe-info>
40563 @end smallexample
40564
40565 Each traceframe block can be either:
40566
40567 @itemize
40568
40569 @item
40570 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40571 @var{length} bytes from there:
40572
40573 @smallexample
40574 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40575 @end smallexample
40576
40577 @item
40578 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40579 collected:
40580
40581 @smallexample
40582 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40583 @end smallexample
40584
40585 @end itemize
40586
40587 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40588
40589 @smallexample
40590 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40591 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40592
40593 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40594 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40595 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40596 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40597 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40598 @end smallexample
40599
40600 @node Branch Trace Format
40601 @section Branch Trace Format
40602 @cindex branch trace format
40603
40604 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40605 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40606 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40607 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40608
40609 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40610 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40611
40612 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40613 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40614
40615 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40616
40617 @smallexample
40618 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40619 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40620 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40621 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40622 <btrace>
40623 block...
40624 </btrace>
40625 @end smallexample
40626
40627 @itemize
40628
40629 @item
40630 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40631 and ending at @var{end}:
40632
40633 @smallexample
40634 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40635 @end smallexample
40636
40637 @end itemize
40638
40639 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40640
40641 @smallexample
40642 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40643 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40644
40645 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40646 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40647 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40648
40649 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40650
40651 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40652
40653 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40654 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40655 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40656 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40657 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40658
40659 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40660 @end smallexample
40661
40662 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40663 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40664 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40665
40666 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40667 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40668 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40669
40670 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40671 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40672
40673 @table @code
40674 @item bts
40675 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40676 @table @code
40677 @item size
40678 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40679 @end table
40680 @item pt
40681 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40682 PT}) format.
40683 @table @code
40684 @item size
40685 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40686 @end table
40687 @end table
40688
40689 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40690 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40691
40692 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40693
40694 @smallexample
40695 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40696 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40697
40698 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40699 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40700
40701 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40702 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40703 @end smallexample
40704
40705 @include agentexpr.texi
40706
40707 @node Target Descriptions
40708 @appendix Target Descriptions
40709 @cindex target descriptions
40710
40711 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40712 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40713 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40714 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40715 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40716 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40717 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40718
40719 @itemize @bullet
40720 @item
40721 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40722 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40723 @item
40724 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40725 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40726 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40727 @item
40728 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40729 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40730 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40731 @end itemize
40732
40733 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40734 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40735 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40736 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40737 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40738
40739 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40740 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40741
40742 @menu
40743 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40744 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40745 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40746 descriptions.
40747 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40748 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40749 @end menu
40750
40751 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40752 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40753
40754 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40755 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40756 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40757 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40758 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40759 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40760 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40761 Format}.
40762
40763 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40764 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40765 specify a file are:
40766
40767 @table @code
40768 @cindex set tdesc filename
40769 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40770 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40771
40772 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40773 @item unset tdesc filename
40774 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40775 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40776
40777 @cindex show tdesc filename
40778 @item show tdesc filename
40779 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40780 @end table
40781
40782
40783 @node Target Description Format
40784 @section Target Description Format
40785 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40786
40787 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40788 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40789 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40790 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40791 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40792 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40793 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40794
40795 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40796 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40797 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40798 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40799 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40800
40801 Here is a simple target description:
40802
40803 @smallexample
40804 <target version="1.0">
40805 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40806 </target>
40807 @end smallexample
40808
40809 @noindent
40810 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40811 the x86-64 architecture.
40812
40813 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40814 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40815 are explained further below.
40816
40817 @smallexample
40818 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40819 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40820 <target version="1.0">
40821 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40822 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40823 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40824 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40825 </target>
40826 @end smallexample
40827
40828 @noindent
40829 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40830 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40831 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40832 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40833 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40834 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40835 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40836 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40837 the version mismatch.
40838
40839 @subsection Inclusion
40840 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40841 @cindex XInclude
40842 @ifnotinfo
40843 @cindex <xi:include>
40844 @end ifnotinfo
40845
40846 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40847 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40848 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40849 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40850 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40851
40852 @smallexample
40853 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40854 @end smallexample
40855
40856 @noindent
40857 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40858 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40859 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40860 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40861 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40862 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40863 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40864 original description.
40865
40866 @subsection Architecture
40867 @cindex <architecture>
40868
40869 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40870
40871 @smallexample
40872 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40873 @end smallexample
40874
40875 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40876 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40877
40878 @subsection OS ABI
40879 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40880
40881 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40882 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40883
40884 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40885
40886 @smallexample
40887 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40888 @end smallexample
40889
40890 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40891 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40892
40893 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40894 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40895
40896 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40897 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40898
40899 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40900
40901 @smallexample
40902 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40903 @end smallexample
40904
40905 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40906 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40907
40908 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40909 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40910 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40911 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40912 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40913 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40914 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40915
40916 @smallexample
40917 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40918 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40919 @end smallexample
40920
40921 @subsection Features
40922 @cindex <feature>
40923
40924 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40925 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40926 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40927 has this form:
40928
40929 @smallexample
40930 <feature name="@var{name}">
40931 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40932 @var{reg}@dots{}
40933 </feature>
40934 @end smallexample
40935
40936 @noindent
40937 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40938 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40939 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40940 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40941
40942 @subsection Types
40943
40944 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40945 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40946 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40947 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40948 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40949 and enum types.
40950
40951 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40952 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40953 Types must be defined before they are used.
40954
40955 @cindex <vector>
40956 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40957 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40958 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40959 @var{count}:
40960
40961 @smallexample
40962 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40963 @end smallexample
40964
40965 @cindex <union>
40966 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40967 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40968 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40969 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40970
40971 @smallexample
40972 <union id="@var{id}">
40973 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40974 @dots{}
40975 </union>
40976 @end smallexample
40977
40978 @cindex <struct>
40979 @cindex <flags>
40980 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40981 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40982 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40983 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40984 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40985 specified.
40986
40987 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40988
40989 @smallexample
40990 <struct id="@var{id}">
40991 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40992 @dots{}
40993 </struct>
40994 @end smallexample
40995
40996 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40997 No implicit padding is added.
40998
40999 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41000
41001 @smallexample
41002 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41003 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41004 @dots{}
41005 </struct>
41006 @end smallexample
41007
41008 @smallexample
41009 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41010 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41011 @dots{}
41012 </flags>
41013 @end smallexample
41014
41015 The @var{name} value is required.
41016 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41017 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41018 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41019
41020 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41021 is optional.
41022 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41023 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41024
41025 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41026 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41027
41028 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41029
41030 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41031 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41032
41033 @itemize @bullet
41034 @item
41035 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41036 @item
41037 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41038 @end itemize
41039
41040 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41041 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41042
41043 @itemize @bullet
41044 @item
41045 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41046
41047 @smallexample
41048 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41049 $1 = 42
41050 @end smallexample
41051
41052 @end itemize
41053
41054 @subsection Registers
41055 @cindex <reg>
41056
41057 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41058
41059 @smallexample
41060 <reg name="@var{name}"
41061 bitsize="@var{size}"
41062 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41063 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41064 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41065 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41066 @end smallexample
41067
41068 @noindent
41069 The components are as follows:
41070
41071 @table @var
41072
41073 @item name
41074 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41075
41076 @item bitsize
41077 The register's size, in bits.
41078
41079 @item regnum
41080 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41081 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41082 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41083 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41084 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41085 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41086 in order of increasing register number.
41087
41088 @item save-restore
41089 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41090 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41091 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41092 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41093 ABI.
41094
41095 @item type
41096 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41097 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41098 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41099 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41100 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41101 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41102
41103 @item group
41104 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41105 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41106 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41107 in @code{info registers}.
41108
41109 @end table
41110
41111 @node Predefined Target Types
41112 @section Predefined Target Types
41113 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41114
41115 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41116 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41117 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41118 types. The currently supported types are:
41119
41120 @table @code
41121
41122 @item bool
41123 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41124
41125 @item int8
41126 @itemx int16
41127 @itemx int32
41128 @itemx int64
41129 @itemx int128
41130 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41131
41132 @item uint8
41133 @itemx uint16
41134 @itemx uint32
41135 @itemx uint64
41136 @itemx uint128
41137 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41138
41139 @item code_ptr
41140 @itemx data_ptr
41141 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41142 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41143 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41144 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41145 may be marked as data pointers.
41146
41147 @item ieee_single
41148 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41149
41150 @item ieee_double
41151 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41152
41153 @item arm_fpa_ext
41154 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41155
41156 @item i387_ext
41157 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41158
41159 @item i386_eflags
41160 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41161
41162 @item i386_mxcsr
41163 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41164
41165 @end table
41166
41167 @node Enum Target Types
41168 @section Enum Target Types
41169 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41170
41171 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41172 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41173
41174 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41175
41176 @smallexample
41177 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41178 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41179 @dots{}
41180 </enum>
41181 @end smallexample
41182
41183 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41184
41185 @smallexample
41186 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41187 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41188 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41189 </enum>
41190 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41191 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41192 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41193 </flags>
41194 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41195 @end smallexample
41196
41197 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41198 would be printed as:
41199
41200 @smallexample
41201 (gdb) info register flags
41202 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41203 @end smallexample
41204
41205 @node Standard Target Features
41206 @section Standard Target Features
41207 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41208
41209 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41210 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41211 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41212 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41213 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41214 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41215 can recognize them.
41216
41217 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41218 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41219 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41220 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41221 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41222 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41223 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41224 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41225
41226 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41227 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41228 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41229
41230 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41231 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41232 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41233 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41234
41235 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41236 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41237 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41238
41239 @menu
41240 * AArch64 Features::
41241 * ARC Features::
41242 * ARM Features::
41243 * i386 Features::
41244 * MicroBlaze Features::
41245 * MIPS Features::
41246 * M68K Features::
41247 * NDS32 Features::
41248 * Nios II Features::
41249 * PowerPC Features::
41250 * S/390 and System z Features::
41251 * Sparc Features::
41252 * TIC6x Features::
41253 @end menu
41254
41255
41256 @node AArch64 Features
41257 @subsection AArch64 Features
41258 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41259
41260 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41261 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41262 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41263
41264 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41265 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41266 and @samp{fpcr}.
41267
41268 @node ARC Features
41269 @subsection ARC Features
41270 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41271
41272 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41273 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41274 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41275 that one of the core registers features is present.
41276 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41277
41278 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41279 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41280 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41281 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41282 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41283 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41284 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41285
41286 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41287 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41288 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41289 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41290 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41291 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41292
41293 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41294 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41295 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41296 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41297 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41298 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41299 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41300 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41301 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41302 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41303
41304 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41305 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41306
41307 @node ARM Features
41308 @subsection ARM Features
41309 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41310
41311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41312 ARM targets.
41313 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41314 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41315
41316 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41317 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41318 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41319 and @samp{xpsr}.
41320
41321 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41322 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41323
41324 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41325 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41326 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41327 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41328
41329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41330 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41331 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41332 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41333 halves of the double-precision registers.
41334
41335 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41336 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41337 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41338 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41339 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41340 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41341
41342 @node i386 Features
41343 @subsection i386 Features
41344 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41345
41346 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41347 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41348
41349 @itemize @minus
41350 @item
41351 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41352 @item
41353 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41354 @item
41355 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41356 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41357 @item
41358 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41359 @item
41360 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41361 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41362 @end itemize
41363
41364 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41365
41366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41367 describe registers:
41368
41369 @itemize @minus
41370 @item
41371 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41372 @item
41373 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41374 @item
41375 @samp{mxcsr}
41376 @end itemize
41377
41378 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41379 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41380 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41381
41382 @itemize @minus
41383 @item
41384 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41385 @item
41386 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41387 @end itemize
41388
41389 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41390 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41391
41392 @itemize @minus
41393 @item
41394 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41395 @item
41396 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41397 @end itemize
41398
41399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41400 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41401
41402 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41403 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41404
41405 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41406 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41407 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41408
41409 @itemize @minus
41410 @item
41411 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41412 @end itemize
41413
41414 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41415
41416 @itemize @minus
41417 @item
41418 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41419 @end itemize
41420
41421 It should
41422 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41423
41424 @itemize @minus
41425 @item
41426 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41427 @item
41428 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41429 @end itemize
41430
41431 It should
41432 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41433
41434 @itemize @minus
41435 @item
41436 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41437 @end itemize
41438
41439 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41440 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41441 valid for i386 and amd64.
41442
41443 @node MicroBlaze Features
41444 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41445 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41446
41447 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41448 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41449 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41450 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41451 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41452
41453 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41454 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41455
41456 @node MIPS Features
41457 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41458 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41459
41460 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41461 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41462 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41463 on the target.
41464
41465 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41466 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41467 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41468
41469 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41470 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41471 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41472 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41473
41474 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41475 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41476 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41477 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41478
41479 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41480 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41481 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41482
41483 @node M68K Features
41484 @subsection M68K Features
41485 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41486
41487 @table @code
41488 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41489 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41490 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41491 One of those features must be always present.
41492 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41493 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41494 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41495 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41496
41497 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41498 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41499 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41500 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41501 @end table
41502
41503 @node NDS32 Features
41504 @subsection NDS32 Features
41505 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41506
41507 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41508 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41509 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41510 and @samp{pc}.
41511
41512 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41513 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41514 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41515 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41516
41517 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41518 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41519 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41520 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41521 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41522 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41523 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41524
41525 @node Nios II Features
41526 @subsection Nios II Features
41527 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41528
41529 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41530 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41531 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41532 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41533 @samp{mpuacc}).
41534
41535 @node PowerPC Features
41536 @subsection PowerPC Features
41537 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41538
41539 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41540 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41541 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41542 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41543
41544 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41545 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41546
41547 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41548 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41549 and @samp{vrsave}.
41550
41551 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41552 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41553 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41554 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41555 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41556 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41557
41558 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41559 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41560 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41561 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41562 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41563 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41564 user.
41565
41566 @node S/390 and System z Features
41567 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41568 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41569 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41570
41571 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41572 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41573 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41574 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41575 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41576 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41577 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41578 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41579 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41580
41581 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41582 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41583 @samp{fpc}.
41584
41585 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41586 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41587
41588 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41589 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41590 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41591 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41592 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41593 32-bit wide.
41594
41595 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41596 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41597 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41598
41599 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41600 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41601 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41602 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41603 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41604 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41605 @samp{v31}.
41606
41607 @node Sparc Features
41608 @subsection Sparc Features
41609 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41610 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41611 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41612 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41613
41614 @itemize @minus
41615 @item
41616 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41617 @item
41618 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41619 @item
41620 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41621 @item
41622 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41623 @end itemize
41624
41625 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41626
41627 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41628 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41629
41630 @itemize @minus
41631 @item
41632 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41633 @item
41634 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41635 @end itemize
41636
41637 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41638 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41639
41640 @itemize @minus
41641 @item
41642 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41643 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41644 @item
41645 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41646 for sparc64
41647 @end itemize
41648
41649 @node TIC6x Features
41650 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41651 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41652 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41653 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41654 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41655 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41656
41657 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41658 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41659 through @samp{B31}.
41660
41661 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41662 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41663
41664 @node Operating System Information
41665 @appendix Operating System Information
41666 @cindex operating system information
41667
41668 @menu
41669 * Process list::
41670 @end menu
41671
41672 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41673 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41674 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41675 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41676 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41677 on a different aspect of target.
41678
41679 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41680 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41681 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41682 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41683
41684 @node Process list
41685 @appendixsection Process list
41686 @cindex operating system information, process list
41687
41688 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41689 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41690 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41691 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41692
41693 An example document is:
41694
41695 @smallexample
41696 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41697 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41698 <osdata type="processes">
41699 <item>
41700 <column name="pid">1</column>
41701 <column name="user">root</column>
41702 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41703 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41704 </item>
41705 </osdata>
41706 @end smallexample
41707
41708 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41709 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41710 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41711 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41712 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41713 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41714 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41715
41716 @node Trace File Format
41717 @appendix Trace File Format
41718 @cindex trace file format
41719
41720 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41721 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41722
41723 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41724 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41725 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41726 in the future.
41727
41728 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41729 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41730 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41731 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41732 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41733 of this section.
41734
41735 @table @code
41736 @item R @var{size}
41737 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41738 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41739 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41740 a single trace file.
41741
41742 @item status @var{status}
41743 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41744 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41745 file.
41746
41747 @item tp @var{payload}
41748 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41749 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41750 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41751 reply packets.
41752
41753 @item tsv @var{payload}
41754 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41755 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41756 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41757 reply packets.
41758
41759 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41760 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41761 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41762 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41763 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41764 file. Includes are not allowed.
41765
41766 @end table
41767
41768 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41769 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41770 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41771 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41772 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41773 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41774 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41775 endianness.
41776
41777 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41778
41779 @table @code
41780 @item R @var{bytes}
41781 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41782 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41783 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41784
41785 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41786 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41787 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41788 @var{length} bytes.
41789
41790 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41791 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41792 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41793
41794 @end table
41795
41796 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41797 of blocks.
41798
41799 @node Index Section Format
41800 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41801 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41802 @cindex index section format
41803
41804 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41805 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41806 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41807 description.
41808
41809 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41810 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41811 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41812 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41813 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41814 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41815
41816 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41817
41818 @enumerate
41819 @item
41820 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41821 unless otherwise noted:
41822
41823 @enumerate
41824 @item
41825 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41826 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41827 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41828 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41829 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41830 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41831 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41832
41833 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41834 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41835 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41836 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41837
41838 @item
41839 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41840
41841 @item
41842 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41843 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41844 to the next offset.
41845
41846 @item
41847 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41848
41849 @item
41850 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41851
41852 @item
41853 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41854 @end enumerate
41855
41856 @item
41857 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41858 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41859 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41860 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41861 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41862 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41863 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41864 CU indices.
41865
41866 @item
41867 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41868 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41869 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41870 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41871
41872 @item
41873 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41874 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41875
41876 @enumerate
41877 @item
41878 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41879
41880 @item
41881 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41882 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41883
41884 @item
41885 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41886 @end enumerate
41887
41888 @item
41889 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41890 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41891
41892 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41893 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41894 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41895 constant pool.
41896
41897 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41898 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41899 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41900
41901 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41902 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41903 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41904 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41905 index version:
41906
41907 @table @asis
41908 @item Version 4
41909 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41910
41911 @item Versions 5 to 7
41912 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41913 @end table
41914
41915 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41916
41917 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41918 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41919 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41920 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41921 collision.
41922
41923 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41924 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41925 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41926 the code.
41927
41928 @item
41929 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41930 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41931 strings.
41932
41933 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41934 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41935 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41936 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41937 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41938 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41939
41940 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41941 @end enumerate
41942
41943 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41944 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41945 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41946
41947 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41948 (bit 0 = LSB):
41949
41950 @table @asis
41951
41952 @item Bits 0-23
41953 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41954 @item Bits 24-27
41955 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41956 @item Bits 28-30
41957 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41958
41959 @table @asis
41960 @item 0
41961 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41962 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41963 with previous versions of the index.
41964 @item 1
41965 The symbol is a type.
41966 @item 2
41967 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41968 @item 3
41969 The symbol is a function.
41970 @item 4
41971 Any other kind of symbol.
41972 @item 5,6,7
41973 These values are reserved.
41974 @end table
41975
41976 @item Bit 31
41977 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41978
41979 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41980 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41981 @value{GDBN} sources.
41982
41983 @end table
41984
41985 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41986 global/static attributes in the index.
41987
41988 @smallexample
41989 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41990 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41991 switch (die->tag)
41992 @{
41993 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41994 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41995 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41996 kind = TYPE;
41997 is_static = 1;
41998 break;
41999 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42000 kind = VARIABLE;
42001 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42002 break;
42003 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42004 kind = FUNCTION;
42005 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42006 break;
42007 case DW_TAG_constant:
42008 kind = VARIABLE;
42009 is_static = ! is_external;
42010 break;
42011 case DW_TAG_variable:
42012 kind = VARIABLE;
42013 is_static = ! is_external;
42014 break;
42015 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42016 kind = TYPE;
42017 is_static = 0;
42018 break;
42019 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42020 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42021 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42022 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42023 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42024 kind = TYPE;
42025 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42026 break;
42027 default:
42028 assert (0);
42029 @}
42030 @end smallexample
42031
42032 @node Man Pages
42033 @appendix Manual pages
42034 @cindex Man pages
42035
42036 @menu
42037 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42038 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42039 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42040 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42041 @end menu
42042
42043 @node gdb man
42044 @heading gdb man
42045
42046 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42047
42048 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42049 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42050 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42051 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42052 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42053 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42054 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42055 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42056 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42057 @c man end
42058
42059 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42060 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42061 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42062 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42063
42064 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42065 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42066
42067 @itemize @bullet
42068 @item
42069 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42070
42071 @item
42072 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42073
42074 @item
42075 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42076
42077 @item
42078 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42079 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42080 @end itemize
42081
42082 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42083 Modula-2.
42084
42085 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42086 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42087 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42088 by using the command @code{help}.
42089
42090 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42091 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42092 executable program as the argument:
42093
42094 @smallexample
42095 gdb program
42096 @end smallexample
42097
42098 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42099
42100 @smallexample
42101 gdb program core
42102 @end smallexample
42103
42104 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42105 to debug a running process:
42106
42107 @smallexample
42108 gdb program 1234
42109 gdb -p 1234
42110 @end smallexample
42111
42112 @noindent
42113 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42114 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42115 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42116
42117 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42118
42119 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42120 @table @env
42121 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42122 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42123
42124 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42125 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42126
42127 @item bt
42128 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42129
42130 @item print @var{expr}
42131 Display the value of an expression.
42132
42133 @item c
42134 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42135
42136 @item next
42137 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42138 function calls in the line.
42139
42140 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42141 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42142
42143 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42144 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42145
42146 @item step
42147 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42148 function calls in the line.
42149
42150 @item help [@var{name}]
42151 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42152 about using @value{GDBN}.
42153
42154 @item quit
42155 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42156 @end table
42157
42158 @ifset man
42159 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42160 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42161 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42162 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42163 @end ifset
42164 @c man end
42165
42166 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42167 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42168 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42169 encountered with no
42170 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42171 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42172 Many options have
42173 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42174 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42175 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42176 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42177 more usual convention.)
42178
42179 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42180 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42181 option is used.
42182
42183 @table @env
42184 @item -help
42185 @itemx -h
42186 List all options, with brief explanations.
42187
42188 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42189 @itemx -s @var{file}
42190 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42191
42192 @item -write
42193 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42194
42195 @item -exec=@var{file}
42196 @itemx -e @var{file}
42197 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42198 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42199 dump.
42200
42201 @item -se=@var{file}
42202 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42203 file.
42204
42205 @item -core=@var{file}
42206 @itemx -c @var{file}
42207 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42208
42209 @item -command=@var{file}
42210 @itemx -x @var{file}
42211 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42212
42213 @item -ex @var{command}
42214 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42215
42216 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42217 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42218 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42219
42220 @item -nh
42221 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42222
42223 @item -nx
42224 @itemx -n
42225 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42226
42227 @item -quiet
42228 @itemx -q
42229 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42230 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42231
42232 @item -batch
42233 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42234 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42235 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42236 commands in the command files.
42237
42238 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42239 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42240 more useful, the message
42241
42242 @smallexample
42243 Program exited normally.
42244 @end smallexample
42245
42246 @noindent
42247 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42248 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42249
42250 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42251 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42252 instead of the current directory.
42253
42254 @item -fullname
42255 @itemx -f
42256 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42257 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42258 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42259 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42260 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42261 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42262 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42263 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42264
42265 @item -b @var{bps}
42266 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42267 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42268
42269 @item -tty=@var{device}
42270 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42271 @end table
42272 @c man end
42273
42274 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42275 @ifset man
42276 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42277 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42278 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42279
42280 @smallexample
42281 info gdb
42282 @end smallexample
42283
42284 @noindent
42285 should give you access to the complete manual.
42286
42287 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42288 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42289 @end ifset
42290 @c man end
42291
42292 @node gdbserver man
42293 @heading gdbserver man
42294
42295 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42296 @format
42297 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42298 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42299
42300 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42301
42302 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42303 @c man end
42304 @end format
42305
42306 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42307 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42308 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42309
42310 @ifclear man
42311 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42312 @end ifclear
42313 @ifset man
42314 Usage (server (target) side):
42315 @end ifset
42316
42317 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42318 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42319 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42320 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42321
42322 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42323 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42324 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42325
42326 @smallexample
42327 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42328 @end smallexample
42329
42330 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42331
42332 @smallexample
42333 @ifset man
42334 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42335 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42336 @end ifset
42337 @ifclear man
42338 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42339 @end ifclear
42340 @end smallexample
42341
42342 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42343 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42344 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42345
42346 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42347
42348 @smallexample
42349 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42350 @end smallexample
42351
42352 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42353 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42354 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42355 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42356 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42357 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42358 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42359 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42360 print an error message and exit.
42361
42362 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42363 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42364
42365 @smallexample
42366 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42367 @end smallexample
42368
42369 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42370 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42371
42372 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42373 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42374 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42375 the program you want to debug.
42376
42377 @smallexample
42378 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42379 @end smallexample
42380
42381 @ifclear man
42382 @subheading Usage (host side)
42383 @end ifclear
42384 @ifset man
42385 Usage (host side):
42386 @end ifset
42387
42388 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42389 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42390 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42391 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42392 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42393 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42394 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42395 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42396 descriptor. For example:
42397
42398 @smallexample
42399 @ifset man
42400 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42401 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42402 @end ifset
42403 @ifclear man
42404 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42405 @end ifclear
42406 @end smallexample
42407
42408 @noindent
42409 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42410
42411 @smallexample
42412 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42413 @end smallexample
42414
42415 @noindent
42416 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42417 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42418 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42419 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42420 `Connection refused'.
42421
42422 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42423 described in
42424 @ifset man
42425 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42426 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42427 @end ifset
42428 @ifclear man
42429 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42430 @end ifclear
42431 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42432
42433 @smallexample
42434 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42435 @end smallexample
42436
42437 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42438 case.
42439 @c man end
42440
42441 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42442 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42443
42444 @itemize @bullet
42445
42446 @item
42447 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42448
42449 @smallexample
42450 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42451 @end smallexample
42452
42453 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42454 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42455 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42456 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42457 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42458 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42459 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42460
42461 @item
42462 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42463 program:
42464
42465 @smallexample
42466 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42467 @end smallexample
42468
42469 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42470 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42471 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42472 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42473
42474 @item
42475 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42476
42477 @smallexample
42478 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42479 @end smallexample
42480
42481 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42482 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42483 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42484 debug several processes in the same session.
42485 @end itemize
42486
42487 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42488
42489 @table @env
42490
42491 @item --help
42492 List all options, with brief explanations.
42493
42494 @item --version
42495 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42496
42497 @item --attach
42498 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42499
42500 @smallexample
42501 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42502 @end smallexample
42503
42504 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42505 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42506
42507 @item --multi
42508 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42509 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42510 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42511 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42512
42513 @smallexample
42514 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42515 @end smallexample
42516
42517 @item --debug
42518 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42519 process.
42520 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42521 the developers.
42522
42523 @item --remote-debug
42524 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42525 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42526 the developers.
42527
42528 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42529 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42530 of debugging output.
42531 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42532
42533 @item --wrapper
42534 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42535 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42536 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42537 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42538
42539 @item --once
42540 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42541 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42542 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42543 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42544
42545 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42546
42547 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42548 @c QDisableRandomization.
42549
42550 @end table
42551 @c man end
42552
42553 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42554 @ifset man
42555 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42556 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42557 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42558
42559 @smallexample
42560 info gdb
42561 @end smallexample
42562
42563 should give you access to the complete manual.
42564
42565 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42566 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42567 @end ifset
42568 @c man end
42569
42570 @node gcore man
42571 @heading gcore
42572
42573 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42574
42575 @format
42576 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42577 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42578 @c man end
42579 @end format
42580
42581 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42582 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42583 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42584 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42585 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42586 running without any change.
42587 @c man end
42588
42589 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42590 @table @env
42591 @item -o @var{filename}
42592 The optional argument
42593 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42594 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42595 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42596 @end table
42597 @c man end
42598
42599 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42600 @ifset man
42601 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42602 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42603 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42604
42605 @smallexample
42606 info gdb
42607 @end smallexample
42608
42609 @noindent
42610 should give you access to the complete manual.
42611
42612 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42613 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42614 @end ifset
42615 @c man end
42616
42617 @node gdbinit man
42618 @heading gdbinit
42619
42620 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42621
42622 @format
42623 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42624 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42625 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42626 @end ifset
42627
42628 ~/.gdbinit
42629
42630 ./.gdbinit
42631 @c man end
42632 @end format
42633
42634 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42635 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42636 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42637 described in
42638 @ifset man
42639 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42640 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42641 @end ifset
42642 @ifclear man
42643 @ref{Sequences}.
42644 @end ifclear
42645
42646 Please read more in
42647 @ifset man
42648 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42649 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42650 @end ifset
42651 @ifclear man
42652 @ref{Startup}.
42653 @end ifclear
42654
42655 @table @env
42656 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42657 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42658 @end ifset
42659 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42660 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42661 @end ifclear
42662 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42663 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42664 See more in
42665 @ifset man
42666 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42667 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42668 @end ifset
42669 @ifclear man
42670 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42671 @end ifclear
42672
42673 @item ~/.gdbinit
42674 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42675 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42676
42677 @item ./.gdbinit
42678 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42679 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42680 See more in
42681 @ifset man
42682 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42683 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42684 @end ifset
42685 @ifclear man
42686 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42687 @end ifclear
42688 @end table
42689 @c man end
42690
42691 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42692 @ifset man
42693 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42694
42695 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42696 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42697 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42698
42699 @smallexample
42700 info gdb
42701 @end smallexample
42702
42703 should give you access to the complete manual.
42704
42705 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42706 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42707 @end ifset
42708 @c man end
42709
42710 @include gpl.texi
42711
42712 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42713 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42714 @include fdl.texi
42715
42716 @node Concept Index
42717 @unnumbered Concept Index
42718
42719 @printindex cp
42720
42721 @node Command and Variable Index
42722 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42723
42724 @printindex fn
42725
42726 @tex
42727 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42728 % meantime:
42729 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42730 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42731 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42732 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42733 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42734 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42735 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42736 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42737 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42738 \page\colophon
42739 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42740 @end tex
42741
42742 @bye
This page took 0.979586 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.